Waircom catalogue

Page 1

Innovation in the air

I N D U S T R I A L P N E U M AT I C C O M P O N E N T S



We give your plans new breath Waircom has always meant

The company can count now

Pneumatics. Benchmark brand in

on three different production units

the components for the industrial

– two located in Vizzolo Predabissi (MI)

automation, Waircom is the popular

and one in Torre d’Arese (PV) – and

name that speaks Italian since

on three logistic units sited in Vizzolo,

fifty years. The range, that nowadays

Riozzo (MI) and Zelo Buon Persico (LO),

spaces into five product lines, and the

that have enabled the rationalization of

company structure more and more

the production, together with a global

articulated since the buyout by MBS

view of the management of the quality

company, are the evident signals of

system conform to the ISO 9001:2000

an unstoppable evolution.

standard.

CORPORATE HEADQUARTERS

PRODUCTION RANGE

CERTIFICATIONS

VIZZOLO PREDABISSI - Milano Head office - Production & Sales

CYLINDERS

UNI EN ISO 9001:2000

TORRE D’ARESE - Pavia Production ZELO BUON PERSICO - Lodi Logistics

VALVES AND SOLENOID VALVES AIR TREATMENT TUBES AND FITTINGS

RIOZZO - Milano Logistics TORINO - WAIRCOM MBS PIEMONTE Associate company

III



Service, counselling, dynamism: the atmosphere you like In Waircom the innovation goes

In fact Waircom customer can

upriver. To the widespread strategy

always count on a timely service.

of zero inventory, we have preferred

A technically qualified and dynamic

the opposite path: with thousands

staff is, in fact, the other key factor

of codes constantly in stock we

of our success: our young yet high

can assure a reduction of the time

grade experienced sales engineers

to market, with important benefits

are always able to support and aid.

regarding the efficiency, flexibility and accuracy in reply to customers needs.

MANAGEMENT

QUALITY MANAGEMENT SYSTEM

R&D

MARKETING & PROMOTION

PRODUCTION

SALES NETWORK

V



Research and design always under pressure In Waircom we give great importance

Not to disappoint the market

to research and to new technologies:

expectancy means to be constantly

the last generation 2D and 3D design

under pressure: in Waircom

software are the tools that allow us

we intend to lower the time

in years to supply customized

to market of the special items too.

solutions for the market demands.

This commitment makes our

Every application is a challenge that

company one of the benchmarks

we face with the conďŹ dence to be

for the division world-wide.

always able to keep the expectations.

CUSTOMER NEEDS

TECHNICAL FEASIBILITY

R&D

FEEDBACK AND AD HOC PRODUCTION

VII



Here quality breaths “house air” Quality is not an empty word.

But speed is nothing without

Quality in Waircom means

accuracy. Waircom has the use

compliance of scrupulous production

of appropriate technology

processes and a meticulous testing

to assure a degree of diligence

of every single item; it means even

without comparison.

a coordinated, flexible and integrated

CNC transfer production and

management of the production

electronic testing machinery,

that must be always able to face

machining centers, shadow

every urgency.

comparator, hard meters and thickness gauges: this technology witnesses our commitment to the Total Quality Management.

RAW MATERIAL QUALITY CONTROL

CNC MACHINING CENTERS

PRODUCTION QUALITY CONTROL

ASSEMBLING

TESTING

IX



A flexible distribution ready to take the flight Waircom has an enviable network:

A wide and complex network that

corporate headquarters

makes all easier: this is the way

and distributors are strategically

we would like to describe our

placed nearby the most important

commitment with respect to service.

industrial districts. This is an

Waircom relies upon a widespread

important plus for a company

net of distributors, retailers and

that intend to be the business

agents both in the national territory

partner for an important share

than branched in many foreign

of the industrial field.

countries thus creating a more and more international network.

STEADY IN STORE AVAILABILITY

NATIONAL NETWORK

INTERNATIONAL NETWORK

XI



A success that flows world-wide Already confident in our nation, we feel ourself ready for foreign countries too. We are ready to bet

AUSTRALIA

KUWAIT

TUNISIA

CANADA

MALAYSIA

TURKEY

CHINA

MOROCCO

VIETNAM

COLOMBIA

NETHERLAND

UNITED ARAB EMIRATES

CÔTE D’IVOIRE

PAKISTAN

UNITED KINGDOM

CYPRUS

POLAND

ZIMBABWE

CZECH REPUBLIC

PORTUGAL

DENMARK

ROMANIA

EGYPT

SAUDI ARABIA

FRANCE

SINGAPORE

GERMANY

SLOVENIA

GREECE

SPAIN

IRAN

SOUTH AFRICA

JAPAN

SYRIA

JORDAN

THAILAND

on the emerging countries, with the consciousness that we can rely on the same flexibility that has set the success of our sales policy in our nation. Whole works thanks to the strategic high potential of Waircom: the person, always and anywhere our actual capital.

XIII


Italian sales network WAIRCOM M.B.S. S.p.A. - HEADQUARTERS AND SALES OFFICE Via Piemonte 13/15 - 20070 Vizzolo Predabissi (MILAN) - ITALY Tel: +39 02 98230821 - Fax: + 39 02 98231854 www.waircom-mbs.com - info@waircom-mbs.com

DISTRIBUTORS AND RETAILERS ABRUZZO A.F.I. S.n.c. Via Penne, 10 - 66013 CHIETI SCALO Tel: 0871/561812 Fax: 0871/552290 DI EMIDIO DOMENICO Via G. di Vittorio - Villa Pavone - 64100 TERAMO Tel: 0861/210242 Fax: 0861/210243 DI EMIDIO S.r.l. Zona Ind.le Colleranesco - 64020 GIULIANOVA (TE) Tel: 085/8004550/8002624 Fax: 085/8004879 ICAM COMMERCIALE S.a.s. Via Ciccarone, 112 - 66054 VASTO (CH) Tel: 0873/3711306 Fax: 0873/3711205 SERAFINI MARIO S.r.l. Via Saletti, Zona Commerciale - 66041 PIAZZANO DI ATESSA (CH) Tel: 0872/897029 Fax: 0872/888923

BASILICATA GIOVANNI VENNERI & C. S.r.l. Via della Fisica, 26 - 85100 POTENZA Tel: 0971/472210-11 Fax: 0971/472212

CALABRIA FIM S.a.s. Viale del Lavoro, 79 - 87012 CASTROVILLARI (CS) Tel. 0981/480102 Fax 0981/483100 FORNITURE INDUSTRIALI LAVILLA GIOVANNI Via Carrera, 49/a - 89122 REGGIO CALABRIA Tel. 0965/650630 Fax 0965/650630

CAMPANIA AR.TEC.SUD S.a.s. Via Appia, 110 - 83100 ATRIPALDA (AV) Tel: 0825/622721 Fax: 0825/1910261 CASA DEL CUSCINETTO S.a.s. Zona Industriale - 84132 FUORNI (SA) Tel: 089/771177 Fax: 089/771131 CAVA CUSCINETTI S.r.l. Via G. Palumbo, 35/37- 84013 CAVA DEI TIRRENI (SA) Tel: 089/340009 Fax: 089/4454984 FIA S.a.s. Via XX Settembre, 76 - 81020 SAN NICOLA LA STRADA (CE) Tel: 0823/421343 Fax: 0823/421343 OLEODINAMICA PARTENOPEA S.a.s. Via Martiri Atellani, 194 - 81030 ORTA DI ATELLA (CE) Tel: 081/5022646 Fax: 081/5022646 PHI-AIR S.a.s. Via Figliola, 57 - 80040 S. SEBASTIANO AL V. (NA) Tel e Fax: 081/6583599-600

XIV

PRIME FORNITURE GENERALI S.a.s. Via Fienile, 1 Contrada Salice - 80013 CASALNUOVO DI NAPOLI (NA) Tel: 081/5228440-8369 Fax: 081/5227401 TECNOLOGIA OLEODINAMICA S.r.l. Via Variante, 7 bis 93 - 80035 NOLA (NA) Tel: 081/8235314 Fax: 081/5125118

EMILIA ROMAGNA ACERO Sr.l. Via A. Calzi, 30 - 48018 FAENZA (RA) Tel: 0546/620731 Fax: 0546/621450 LUIGI BIANCHI S.p.A. Via Giardini, 3 - 40128 BOLOGNA Tel: 051/327844 Fax: 051/327114 AIR MECCANICA S.n.c. Via Coriano, 58 - Blocco n. 32/E - 47900 RIMINI Tel: 0541/387704-302721 Fax: 0541/382510 EUROTECNICA S.r.l. Via Emila Est, 1301 - 41100 MODENA Tel: 059/282640 Fax: 059/282763 FATI S.r.l. Via del Commercio n. 14/16 - 29100 PIACENZA Tel: 0523/593210 Fax: 0523/593272 F.M.I. di FRANCESCHI & C. S.a.s. Via Baganzola n. 28/A - 43100 PARMA Tel: 0521/992200 Fax: 0521/987303

LAZIO CASA DEL FRENO F.LLI PISTILLI S.n.c. Via Epitaffio n. 128 - 04100 LATINA Tel: 0773/663860 Fax: 0773/663528 S.L.M. S.r.l. Via Cerro Antico - 03043 CASSINO (FR) Tel: 0776/300702 Fax: 0776/370247 ELIA D’AGUANNO S.r.l. Via dei Granatieri, 13 - 00060 CASTELNUOVO DI PORTO (ROMA) Tel: 06/9070681 Fax: 06/90190989 TRAS.MEC S.a.s. Via delle Palme, 31/A/B - 00171 ROMA Tel: 06/2154139 Fax: 06/2154292

LIGURIA BM SERVICE S.r.l. Via Bombrini, 26 - ROSSO - 16149 GENOVA Tel: 010/6422287 Fax: 010/6422287


LOMBARDIA

PUGLIA E BASILICATA

ARIA COMPRESSA S.r.l. Corso Martiri della Liberazione, 40 - 23900 LECCO Tel: 0341/282785 Fax: 0341/285273

ATIM S.a.s. Via Monte Pollino, 23 - 70022 ALTAMURA (BA) Tel: 080/3115257 Fax: 080/3143414 ATOM S.n.c. Viale Capruzzi, 266 BC - 70124 BARI Tel: 080/5428971 Fax: 080/5428971 GENERAL RICAMBI S.n.c. C.so del Mezzogiorno, 18/24 - 71100 FOGGIA Tel: 0881/637523 Fax: 0881/637524 IBC SUD S.r.l. Via De Gasperi, 3/5 - 73030 TIGGIANO (LE) Tel: 0833/790105 Fax: 0833/533306 TECNOFER S.r.l. Traversa via Tramvia, 2/2 - 70051 BARLETTA (BA) Tel: 0883/346744 Fax: 0883/337150

ATEMI S.r.l. Via Monte Bianco, 2 - 20095 CUSANO MILANINO (MI) Tel: 02/6198256 Fax: 02/6133611 BIGNARDI S.r.l. Via del Sebino, 44/46 - 25126 BRESCIA Tel: 030/294169 Fax: 030/3771178 EREDI DI M. FARINA S.r.l. C.so Sempione, 45 - 20025 LEGNANO (MI) Tel: 0331/544311 Fax: 0331/453690 EUROPAIR S.n.c. Via Cesare Battisti, 19 - 20042 ALBIATE BRIANZA (MI) Tel: 0362/915118 Fax: 0362/915141 FLUTEC S.r.l. Via Raso, 5 - 25036 PALAZZOLO SULL’OGLIO (BS) Tel: 030/7402960 Fax: 030/7402961 MICAR S.n.c. Via Rosso di S. Secondo, 15 - 20134 MILANO Tel: 02/7491091 Fax: 02/70126372 SATI AUTOMAZIONE S.a.s. Via Antonio Gramsci, 23/A - 20020 ARESE (MI) Tel: 02/93581351 Fax: 02/93581351 TECNOVOLVENT S.r.l. Via S. Ampellio, 5 - 20141 MILANO Tel: 02/89500419 Fax: 02/89511927 UTECO F.T.I. S.r.l. Via Tranquillo Ercoli, 3 - 26845 CODOGNO (LO) Tel: 0377/30043 Fax: 0377/36730 UTENSILERIA SUZZARESE S.a.s. di LORENZINI FABIO & C. Via Galvani, 1/A - 46029 SUZZARA (MN) Tel: 0376/521321 Fax: 0376/521936 VERZOLLA S.a.s. di MAMBRETTI PAOLO PRIMO Via Brembo, 13/15 - 20052 MONZA (MI) Tel: 039/21661 Fax: 039/2166444-2103010

MARCHE SARO AUTOMAZIONI S.r.l. Zona Ind.le “A” Via Vincenzo Breda - 62012 CIVITANOVA MARCHE (MC) Tel: 0733/897795 Fax: 0733/897887 TECNOFORNITURE S.r.l. Via Pasubio, 106 - 63037 PORTO D’ASCOLI (AP) Tel: 0735/659945 Fax: 0735/655266 TORRESI RAFFAELE & C. S.n.c. Zona Ind.le “A” Via S. Pertini, 51 - 62012 CIVITANOVA MARCHE (MC) Tel: 0733/801120 Fax: 0733/801130

SARDEGNA IDROP S.a.s. Viale Elmas, 142 - 09100 CAGLIARI Tel: 070/240048 Fax: 070/241172 IDROP 2 S.r.l. Zona Ind.le Settore 6 - Via Niger - 07026 OLBIA (SS) Tel: 0789/58195 Fax: 0789/593087

SICILIA CENTRO OLEODINAMICA S.r.l. Via zia Lisa, 253 - 95121 CATANIA Tel: 095/578514 Fax: 095/575826 F.lli FIDERIO S.n.c. Via S. Giuliano, 111/L - 97015 MODICA (RG) Tel: 0932/763014 Fax: 0932/763014 MALTESE MAURIZIO Via Selinunte, 2 - 91026 MAZARA DEL VALLO (TP) Tel: 0923/942665 Fax: 0923/942665

TOSCANA A.T.I. S.a.s. Via Pistoiese, 219 ang. Via Castagnoli n. 1 - 59100 PRATO (PO) Tel: 0574/6961 Fax: 0574/39273

UMBRIA SEA S.r.l. Via Pietrarossa, 1 - 06039 TREVI (PG) Tel: 0742/381296 Fax: 0742/381296

VALLE D’AOSTA A.I.A. S.a.s. Loc. Pont Suaz, 66 - 11020 CHARVENSOD (AO) Tel: 0165/32204 Fax: 0165/32204

PIEMONTE

VENETO E FRIULI VENEZIA GIULIA

CONSOCIATA: WAIRCOM M.B.S. PIEMONTE S.r.l. Via Farinelli, 6 - 10135 TORINO Tel: 011/346008 Fax: 011/346772

FILIALE COMMERCIALE: WAIRFLEX S.a.s. di E. PAPA & C. Viale Italia, 224 - 31015 CONEGLIANO (TV) Tel: 0438/412552 Fax: 0438/41803

ARCISA S.r.l. Via Valpellice, 14/A - 10060 SAN SECONDO PINEROLO (TO) Tel: 0121/500445 Fax: 0121/500370

EMPORIO RICAMBI ROSSI S.r.l. Via Este, 40/2 - 33100 UDINE Tel: 0432/600114 Fax: 0432/520156 FIZNER AUTOMAZIONE S.a.s. Via M. Giuliani Dalmati, 13 - 35129 PADOVA Tel: 049/772700 Fax: 049/8072401 MARCANZIN & MEROTTO S.r.c. V.le della Repubblica, 236 - 31100 TREVISO Tel: 0422/304111 Fax: 0422/306557 NOVELLO S.r.l. Cà Marcello, 73 - 30172 MESTRE (VE) Tel: 041/5311633 Fax: 041/5310125 OLEOMEC S.r.l. Via dell’Artigianato, 8 - 32100 BELLUNO (TV) Tel: 0437/931252 Fax: 0437/33230 O.P.S. S.r.l. Via Travnik, 18/2 - 34018 S. DORLIGO DELLA VALLE (TS) Tel: 040/383808 Fax: 040/382555 PNEUMAC S.r.l. Viale Italia, 254 - 31015 CONEGLIANO (TV) Tel: 0438/35005 Fax: 0438/410211 SO.CI.MA S.a.s. Via Lago Maggiore, 8 - 36077 ALTAVILLA VICENTINA (VI) Tel: 0444/370744 Fax: 0444/370748

BOURSIER S.a.s. C.so Alessandria, 50 - 14100 ASTI Tel: 0141/353933 Fax: 0141/594034 BOURSIER S.r.l. Via Asinari di Bernezzo, 100 - 10146 TORINO Tel: 011/727575 Fax: 011/727579 CENTRO CANAVESANO CUSCINETTI S.a.s. C.so Re Arduino, 9/B - 10086 RIVAROLO CANAVESE (TO) Tel: 0124/26324 Fax: 0124/25762 DOSIO & MUSSO di DOSIO P. & C. S.n.c. C.so Torino, 87/B - 10098 FERRIERA (TO) Tel: 011/9368339 Fax: 011/9367787 NUOVA O.P.E. di DAMIANO PIETRO & C. S.n.c. Via Molino Roero, 6 - 12020 MADONNA DELL’OLMO (CN) Tel: 0171/411977 Fax: 0171/411421 VIEMME TECH di VERDUCI M. Via Tarantelli, 15 - 15033 CASALE MONFERRATO (TO) Tel: 0142/72503 Fax: 0142/451853

XV



CONTENTS Chapter 0 TECHNICAL INFORMATION

Page 0.1

Chapter 1 CYLINDERS

Page 1.1

Chapter 2 VALVES PILOT AND SOLENOID ACTUATED

Page 2.1

Chapter 3 VALVES MANUALLY AND MECHANICALLY ACTUATED AND COMPLEMENTARY VALVES

Page 3.1

Chapter 4 AIR TREATMENT

Page 4.1

Chapter 5 FITTINGS AND TUBES

Page 5.1

The company reserves the right to amend without notice the specifications given in this document

Contents



TECHNICAL INFORMATION

Index chapter 0

Fluid ....................................................................................................................................................................................................... page

0.2

Pressure ............................................................................................................................................................................................. page

0.2

Rated ow rate............................................................................................................................................................................ page

0.3

Protection class for coils with connector .......................................................................................................... page

0.4

Graphic symbols Pipes and connections............................................................................................................................................................................... page Air treatment equipment ............................................................................................................................................................................ page Distribution ................................................................................................................................................................................................. page Controls ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... page Energy conversion (actuators) .................................................................................................................................................................... page Rod and piston unit options....................................................................................................................................................................... page

0.5 0.5 0.6 0.6 0.7 0.7

Comparison of designations for connections ................................................................................................. page

0.8

Multiples and sub-multiples............................................................................................................................................ page

0.8

Consumption of air table ................................................................................................................................................... page

0.8

Peak load and theoretical forces ............................................................................................................................... page

0.9

Cushioning diagram ................................................................................................................................................................ page

0.9

Conversion tables ..................................................................................................................................................................... page

0.10

Threads comparison table

.............................................................................................................................................. page 0.11

Special options table for cylinders ........................................................................................................................... page

0.12

General technical data for cylinders....................................................................................................................... page

0.12

Technical information

0.1


Technical information 0

FLUID Most of WAIRCOM M.B.S. products can be fed with lubricated or unlubricated compressed air, thus means these components are greased on assembly so that they can work even without the use of a lubricator; however for a correct lubrication we advise to use the WAIRSOL grease class ISO 22, studied on purpose for pneumatic circuits, while the use of a filter element with a void fraction of at least 40 µm is essential. The condensate drainage system can be manual, semi-automatic or automatic and it is set up of a cock situated on the bottom of the bowl. The working pressure range for each product is shown on every single relevant technical sheet and it is generally included between 1 to 10 bar.

PRESSURE DEFINITION OF PRESSURE It is the ratio between a force and the surface on which it acts; it is dimensionally expressed in force units per surface units. P(Pa) = F(N) / S(m2) ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE It is the pressure exerted on a surface of 1 cm2 at sea level, at a temperature of 20 °C and with a relative humidity of 65%; it is equivalent to a column of water of 10,33 m or to 760 mmHg. ABSOLUTE PRESSURE It is the pressure of a fluid respect to the absolute vacuum and it is obtainable adding the atmospheric pressure to the gauge one. GAUGE PRESSURE It is the differential pressure of a fluid above and below the atmospheric pressure normally read on the pressure gauges. UPSTREAM PRESSURE Pressure of the compressed air at the inlet of the pneumatic component. DOWNSTREAM PRESSURE Pressure of the compressed air at the outlet of the pneumatic component. DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE ( P) It is the difference between upstream and downstream pressure. BOYLE-MARIOTTE’S LAW The volume of a closed quantity of gas with constant temperature is inversely proportional to the absolute pressure, thus means that for a given quantity of gas the product between the absolute pressure and the volume is a constant value: P1 · V1 = P2 · V2 = Constant. GAY - LUSSAC’S LAW The volume of a quantity of gas with constant pressure is proportional to its temperature: V1 / V2 = T1 / T2 or even, with constant volume, the pressure of a quantity of gas is proportional to its temperature. P1 / P2 = T1 / T2 Then we obtain the General Equation of Gases: P·V=n·R·T where: P = pressure (atm) V = volume (Nl) n = gram molecules of gas contained in the volume (mol) R = perfect gas constant (0,0821 Nl · atm · K-1 · mol-1) T = absolute temperature in Kelvin (273 K = 0 °C) NORMAL CONDITIONS OF AIR In the design of industrial pneumatic circuits are employed measures that refer to the "Normal conditions of air". As "normal cubic meter of air" (1Nm3) we refer to 1 m3 of air at a temperature of 273 K (0 °C) and at a pressure of 1,0013 bar (pressure of the normal air at the sea level): 1 Nm3 = 1000 Nl.

0.2

Technical information


Technical information RATED FLOW RATE It is the volume of fluid passing through a given section of measurement in a unit of time with an upstream gauge pressure P1=6 bar (7 absolute bar) and with a pressure drop P=1 bar (thus means a downstream gauge pressure P2=5 bar, 6 absolute bar) with a fluid temperature of +20 °C. The rated flow rate, generally expressed in normal liters per minute (Nl/m), can give some indications on the performances of the valves if the working conditions are the ones just described. Herebelow are the circuits used in our company to test the flow rate measurements of products in according to the UNI ISO 6358 standard.

circuit for components input/output connections CircuitoTesting di prova per componenti con with connessioni di entrata e di uscita.

Testing for components withscarico direct exhaust in the atmosphere Circuito di circuit prova per componenti con diretto nell’atmosfera.

A – Filter and supply unit B – Adjustable pressure regulator C – Shut-off valve D – Tube for temperature measurement E – Device for the measure of temperature F – Tube for upstream pressure measurement G – Component on trial H – Tube for downstream pressure measurement I – Device for the measure of upstream pressure J – Device for the measure of differential pressure K – Flow regulator valve L – Device for the measure of flow rate

Technical information

0.3

0


Technical information 0

PROTECTION CLASS FOR COILS WITH CONNECTOR For protection class, we mean the intrinsic ability of live electrical equipment to protect and to protect itself against casual contatcts and penetration of solid particles and water. It is defined with the abbreviation “I.P.” followed by 2 figures: the first, 0 to 6, defines the protection against casual contacts and penetration of foreign particles; the second, 0 to 8, the protection against water. The tables shown below describe the various degrees. Protection class against casual contacts and penetration of foreign particles First Denomination figure

Explanation

0

No protection.

No special protection for people against casual contacts with live parts or moving parts. No protection of the equipment against the penetration of foreign solid particles.

1

Protection against the penetration of large-sized solid particles.

Protection against casual contacts of large surfaces with live parts or moving parts inside the equipment, for example contacts with hands, but no protection against the voluntary access to these parts. Protection of the equipment against the penetration of solid particles with a diameter larger than 50 mm.

2

Protection against the penetration of fluid-sized solid particles.

Protection against contacts of fingers with live parts or moving parts inside the equipment. Protection against the penetration of solid particles with a diameter larger than 12 mm, such as fingers.

3

Protection against the penetration of small-sized solid particles.

Protection against contacts of tools, wires or the like, thicker than 2.5 mm with live parts of moving parts inside the equipment. Protection against the penetration of solid particles with a diameter larger than 2.5 mm, such as tools, wires, and so on.

4

Protection against the penetration of very small-sized solid particles.

Protection against contacts of tools, wires or the like, thicker than 1 mm with live parts or moving parts inside the equipment. Protection against the penetration of solid particles with a diameter larger than1 mm, such as thin tools and wires and so on.

5

Protection against dust deposits.

Full protection against contacts with means of any kind with live parts or moving parts inside the equipment. Protection against dust deposits. The penetration of dust is not fully eliminated, but it is reduced to such an extent as to assure the good operation of the equipment.

6

Protection against dust penetration.

Full protection against contacts with means of any kind with live parts or moving parts inside the equipment. Protection against dust deposits. Full protection against the penetration of dust.

Protection class against penetration of water Second Denomination figure

Explanation

0 1

No protection.

No special protection.

Protection against water drops falling perpendicularly.

Water drops that fall perpendicularly must not cause harmful effect.

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Protection against water drops falling slantwise.

Water drops that fall at a slanted angle of up to 15° to the perpendicular direction must not cause harmful effect.

Protection against water dripping.

Water that falls at a slanted angle of up to 60° to the perpendicular direction must not cause harmful effect.

Protection against water sprays.

Water sprayed against the equipment from any direction must not cause harmful effect.

Protection against water jets.

Water jets fired against the equipment from any direction must not cause harmful effect.

Protection against inondation.

The water penetrating into the equipment due to a temporary flood, for example during rough sea conditions, must not cause harmful effect.

Protection against immersion.

Water must not penetrate in such a quantity as to damage the equipment, should the equipment itself be immersed for pre-established times and at pre-defined pressure.

Protection against submersion.

Water must not penetrate in such a quantity as to damage the equipment, should the equipment itself be submerged at pre-defined pressure and for an undetermined period of time.

0.4

Technical information


Technical information 0

GRAPHIC SYMBOLS Air treatment equipment

Pipes and connections Designation

Explanation

Symbol

Designation

Explanation

Pressure line

Line for the energy transfer

Air filter

Device for removing impurity

Control line

Line for the transfer of the control energy (including regulation)

Condensate separator

With manual draining

With automatic draining

Exhaust or leakage line Line connection

Fixed connection, e.g. welded,saldered, screwed (including fittings)

Crossover

Crossing of unconnected lines

Flexible line

Connectors of mobile parts

Air drier

Device in which the air is dried

Electric line

Line for transmitting electrical energy

Lubricator

Device in which small quantities of oil are added to the air flowing through it

Pneumatic pressure source

Sequence valve

Valve which, by opening the outlet against the spring force, makes connection with further units

Discharge point or vent

Pressure reducer (valve which to a large extent holds the outlet pressure at a constant level, even with altered inlet pressure)

Without exhaust valve

Air exhaust

With not threaded connection

Filter with condensate separator

With plug

With connecting line

Quick-acting couplings

Connected, without check valve

Connected, with check valve

Uncoupled with open end

Uncoupled, end blocked by check valve Rotating joint (device that allows a rotating movement)

With manual draining

With automatic draining

With exhaust valve (Relieving) Piloted pressure reducer with exhaust valve (Relieving)

With threaded connection

Compressed air pick-up point

Symbol

Pneumoelectric transducer Pressure switch

Device converting an input pneumatic signal into an output electrical signal Device switching at an adjustable fixed pressure

Filter - pressure reducer lubricator group (Detailed symbol) Filter - pressure reducer lubricator group (Simplified symbol) Filter - pressure reducer group Soft - start valve

Pneumatic actuated

1-way

Solenoid actuated

3-way

Silencer

Pneumatic accumulator (capacity)

Pressure gauge Thermometer Flowmeter Totalizator flowmeter Optical tester

Technical information

Device indicating the presence of pressure by means of an optical reflector

0.5


Technical information 0

GRAPHIC SYMBOLS Controls

Distribution Designation 2/2 port valve

Explanation Two positions at rest, normally closed (N.C.)

Symbol

Designation Manual actuation

Explanation General (without specifying the type of control)

Two positions at rest, normally open (N.O.)

By push-button

Two positions at rest, normally closed (N.C.)

By lever

Two positions at rest, normally open (N.O.)

By pedal

4/2 port valve

With two positions and one exhaust

By pedal with safety device

3/3 port valve

With three positions and closed the neutral one

5/2 port valve

With two positions and two exhausts

By spring

5/3 port valve

Open centre

By roller lever

Pressure centre

By unidirectional roller lever

3/2 port valve

Closed centre

Check valve

Mechanical actuation

Pneumatic actuation

Direct action by application of pressure

Unloaded (without spring)

Direct action by pressure relief

Spring-loaded

Differential (i.e. pressure dominant pilot)

Controlled check valve Pilot operated to close check valve

Indirect actuation by application of pressure to the pilot valve

Pilot operated to open check valve Shuttle valve (OR type) The inner port with the higher pressure is automatically connected to the outlet port, while the other inlet port is closed When the inlet port is not supplied Quick-exhaust valve with air, the outlet port is exhausted directly into the atmosphere Flow regulator

By stem or key

Indirect actuation by relieving of pressure on the pilot valve Electrical actuation

By solenoid with two in-phase windings

Bidirectional

Unidirectional fixed

By solenoid with one winding

By solenoid with two opposing windings Combined actuation

Unidirectional adjustable

By solenoid with one pilot valve

By solenoid pilot assisted

Flow divider

The flow is divided in two quite similar parts that are indipendent from the variations of pressure

Detent

Device for maintaining a given position

Shut-off valve

Two port

Release unit

Device for preventing the equipment from blocking at a dead spot

Three port

Two pressure valve (AND type)

0.6

The outlet port is pressurized only when pressure is supplied to both of the inlet ports

Technical information

Symbol


Technical information 0

GRAPHIC SYMBOLS Energy conversion (actuators) Designation Compressor

Explanation With constant displacement volume (only one direction of rotation)

Rod and piston unit options Symbol

Designation Rod and piston unit

Explanation

With adjustable cushioning at one end

Pneumatic motor with With one direction of rotation constant displacement volume With two directions of rotation

With adjustable cushioning at both ends

With one direction of rotation

With magnetic piston

With two directions of rotation

With magnetic piston and adjustable cushioning at one end

Pneumatic rotary cylinder

With rotary drive limited range of oscillation

With magnetic piston and adjustable cushioning at both ends

Single acting cylinder

Front spring

With non-rotating piston rod device

Rear spring

With piston rod locking unit

Pneumatic motor with variable displacement volume

Symbol

Standard

Double acting cylinder

Double acting cylinder through rod Tandem cylinder

Opposed

Double push

Double stroke

Telescopic cylinder

Single acting

Double acting

Pressure multiplier

For fluids with the same characteristics For fluids with different characteristics

Technical information

0.7


Technical information 0

COMPARISON OF DESIGNATIONS FOR CONNECTIONS Port Supply/inlet port Working or outlet line Exhaust line Working or outlet line Exhaust line Pilot line that reset the output signal Pilot line Pilot line Pre-pilot exhaust line Pre-pilot exhaust line

ISO 5599 1 2 3 4 5 10

Letter designations P B S A R Z

12 14 82 84

Y Z — —

MULTIPLES AND SUB-MULTIPLES Prefix yotta zetta exa peta tera giga mega kilo etto deca* deci centi milli micro nano pico femto atto zepto yocto

Symbol Y Z E P T G M k h da d c m µ n p f a z y

Factor 1024 1021 1018 1015 1012 109 106 103 102 10 10-1 10-2 10-3 10-6 10-9 10-12 10-15 10-18 10-21 10-24

* In the U.S.A. this prefix is commonly defined “deka”

CONSUPTION OF AIR TABLE Cylinder bore D (mm) 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

Piston rod diameter Motion Useful area Consumption of air in thrust and in traction expressed in Nl per cm of stroke as a function of the operating pressure P expressed in bar, at 20°C d (mm) cm2 1 bar 2 bar 3 bar 4 bar 5 bar 6 bar 7 bar 8 bar 9 bar 10 bar 4 Thrust 1,13 0,0023 0,0034 0,0045 0,0057 0,0068 0,0079 0,009 0,0102 0,0113 0,0124 Traction 1 0,002 0,003 0,004 0,005 0,006 0,007 0,008 0,009 0,01 0,011 6 Thrust 2,01 0,004 0,006 0,008 0,01 0,0121 0,0141 0,0161 0,0181 0,0202 0,0221 Traction 1,73 0,0035 0,0052 0,0069 0,0086 0,0104 0,0121 0,0138 0,0156 0,0173 0,019 8 Thrust 3,14 0,0063 0,0094 0,0126 0,0157 0,0188 0,022 0,0251 0,0283 0,0314 0,0346 Traction 2,64 0,0053 0,0079 0,0106 0,0132 0,0158 0,0185 0,0211 0,0238 0,0264 0,029 12 Thrust 4,91 0,0098 0,0147 0,0196 0,0245 0,0295 0,0344 0,0393 0,0442 0,0491 0,054 Traction 3,78 0,0076 0,0113 0,0151 0,0189 0,0227 0,0264 0,0302 0,034 0,0378 0,0415 12 Thrust 8,04 0,016 0,024 0,032 0,04 0,048 0,056 0,064 0,072 0,08 0,088 Traction 6,91 0,014 0,021 0,028 0,035 0,042 0,049 0,058 0,063 0,07 0,076 16 Thrust 12,56 0,025 0,038 0,05 0,063 0,076 0,088 0,1 0,113 0,126 0,138 Traction 10,55 0,021 0,032 0,042 0,053 0,063 0,074 0,088 0,095 0,106 0,116 20 Thrust 19,63 0,039 0,059 0,079 0,098 0,118 0,137 0,157 0,177 0,196 0,216 Traction 16,49 0,033 0,05 0,066 0,082 0,099 0,115 0,132 0,149 0,165 0,181 20 Thrust 31,16 0,062 0,093 0,125 0,156 0,187 0,218 0,249 0,28 0,312 0,343 Traction 28,02 0,056 0,084 0,112 0,14 0,168 0,196 0,224 0,252 0,28 0,308 25 Thrust 50,24 0,1 0,15 0,2 0,25 0,301 0,351 0,402 0,452 0,502 0,552 Traction 45,36 0,091 0,138 0,181 0,227 0,272 0,318 0,363 0,408 0,454 0,5 32 Thrust 78,54 0,157 0,238 0,314 0,382 0,471 0,549 0,628 0,706 0,785 0,862 Traction 70,5 0,141 0,211 0,282 0,352 0,423 0,493 0,564 0,635 0,705 0,775 32 Thrust 122,66 0,245 0,368 0,49 0,613 0,736 0,859 0,981 1,104 1,226 1,349 Traction 114,67 0,229 0,344 0,459 0,573 0,688 0,803 0,917 1,032 1,147 1,262 40 Thrust 201,06 0,402 0,603 0,804 1,005 1,206 1,407 1,608 1,809 2,01 2,211 Traction 188,49 0,377 0,565 0,754 0,942 1,13 1,319 1,508 1,696 1,884 2,673 40 Thrust 314,15 0,628 0,942 0,257 1,571 1,885 2,199 2,513 2,827 3,145 3,456 Traction 301,59 0,603 0,905 1,506 1,508 1,81 2,111 2,413 2,714 3,016 3,318

The following formula is used to determinate the consumption of air: Q = H x (S+T) x N where: Q = consumption of air (Nl/min) H = cylinder stroke (cm) S = consumption of air per 1 cm of stroke in thrust T = consumption of air per 1 cm of stroke in traction N = number of cycles per minute

0.8

Technical information


Technical information 0

PEAK LOAD AND THEORETICAL FORCES

er

nd

li Cy

In particular applications the piston rod of the cylinder may be subjected to the peak load; it is then important to control the piston rod diameter in relation to the stroke that should be made, the force developed by the cylinder, the working pressure and the fixings. The diagram shown has been realized considering the worst condition, consisting in a rear hinge fixing on the cylinder body (in vertical position with the load charging the rod end) and fork on the piston rod. Given the stroke, the relevant horizontal line is followed until the relevant line to the piston rod diameter (cylinder bore) is crossed; from that point, drawing the vertical line till reaching the x-axis, is obtainable the maximum acceptable peak load. CUSHIONING DIAGRAM In order not to compromise the correct fuctioning of the cylinders with harmful impacts, it is necessary to cushion the moving mass to gradually reduce its kinetic energy. The maximum absorbable mass depends on the speed of traslation and on the absorption capacity of the pneumatic damper. This diagram gives the speed and the maximum absorbable mass at a pressure of 6 bar for various bores.

Technical information

0.9


Technical information 0

CONVERSION TABLES Torque

Length inchounce (ozf·in)

1 inchounce = 1 inchpound = 1 footpound = 1 kilogrammetro = 1 Newtonmetro =

16 192 1388,7 141,6

inchpound (lbf·in) 0,0625

footpound kilogrammetro Newtonmetro (lbf·ft) (kgf·m) (N·m) 0,0052 7,2·10-4 7,06·10-3 0,0833 1,152·10-2 0,113 0,1383 1,356 7,233 9,80665 0,7375 0,102

12 86,796 8,85

Inch (in) 1 inch = 1 foot = 1 yard = 1 millimeter = 1 meter =

foot (ft) 0,0833

12 36 0,03937 39,37

3 0,0033 3,2808

millimeter (mm) 25,4 304,8 914,4

0,00109 1,0936

meter (m) 0,0254 0,304 0,9144 0,001

1000

Force

Area inch2 (in2) 1 inch2 = 1 foot2 = 1 yard2 = 1 millimetro2 = 1 meter2 =

144 1296 0,0016 1550

foot2 (ft2) 0,0069

yard2 (yd2) 0,00077 0,111

9 1,0764·10-5 10,764

1,196·10-6 1,196

Newton (N)

square millimeter square meter (mm2) (m2) 645,16 6,45·10-4 92903 0,0929 836100 0,8361 10-6 106

Density

1 Newton = 1 kilopound = 1 poundforce =

9,80665 4,4482

kilopound (kp) 0,10197

poundforce (lbf) 0,22481 2,20463

0,45359

Mass ounce / inch pound / foot (ozf / in3) (lbf / ft3) 108 0,0092 0,578 62,43 3

1 ounce / inch3 = 1 pound / foot3 = 1 gram / centimeter3 =

3

grams / centimeter (g/cm3) 1,73 0,016

ounce (oz)

3

1 ounce = 1 pound = 1 Kilogram =

Speed

16 35,274

pound (lb) 0,0625

Kilogram (kg) 0,0283 0,4536

2,2046

Temperature

foot/second foot/minute (ft/s) (ft/min) 1 foot/second = 60 1 foot/minute = 0,017 1 mile/hour = 1,4667 88 1 meter/second = 3,28 196,848 1 Kilometer/hour = 0,9113 54,68

mile/hour (mi/h) 0,6818 0,0114 2,237 0,6214

meter/second Kilometers/hour (m/s) (km/h) 0,3048 1,097 0,00508 0,01829 0,447 1,609 3,6 0,278

Kelvin (K) 1K= 1 °C = °C + 273,15 1 °F = 5/9 · (°F - 32) + 273,15

Volume inch3 (in3) 1 inch = 1 US quart = 1Imperial gallon = 1 foot3 = 1 US gallon = 1 liter = 3

57,75 277 1728 231 61,024

US quart (liq qt) 0,0173 4,8 29922 4 1,0567

Imperial gallon (UK) (Imp gall) 0,0036 0,2082 6,23 0,8327 0,22

foot3 (cu ft) 0,00058 0,0334 0,1604 0,1337 0,0353

US gallon (gal) 0,0043 0,25 1,2 7,48

liter (l) 0,0164 0,9464 4,546 28,317 3,785

0,264

Pressure inch Hg 1 inch Hg = 1 psi = 1 atmosphere = 1 torr = 1 mm Hg = 1bar = 1 Mpa = 1 kg/cm2 =

0.10

yard (yd) 0,0278 0,333

2,036 29,921 0,0394 0,0394 29,53 295,3 28,95

psi 0,491 14,696 0,0193 0,0193 14,504 145,04 14,22

atmosphere 0,0334 0,068 0,0013 0,0013 0,987 9,869 0,968

torr 25,4 51,715 760 1 749,87 7498,7 735,35

mm Hg 25,4 51,715 760 1 749,87 7498,7 735,35

bar 0,0339 0,0689 1,0133 0,0013 0,0013 10 0,98

Mpa 0,00339 0,00689 0,10133 0,00013 0,00013 0,1 0,098

Technical information

kg/cm2 0,0345 0,0703 1,0332 0,00136 0,00136 1,02 10,2

Celsius degree (°C) K - 273,15 (°F - 32) · 5/9

Fahrenheit degree (°F) K · 9/5 - 459,67 °C · 9/5 + 32


Technical information 0

THREADS COMPARISON TABLE Ø external (mm) 3,8 ÷ 3,9 4 ÷ 4,2 4,6 ÷ 4,8 4,8 ÷ 4,9 5,7 ÷ 5,9 7,7 ÷ 7,9 7,7 ÷ 7,9 7,7 ÷ 7,9 maximum 7,9 9,5 ÷ 9,7 9,7 ÷ 9,9 9,7 ÷ 9,9 9,7 ÷ 9,9 maximum10,3 10,9 ÷ 11,1 11,7 ÷ 11,9 11,7 ÷ 11,9 11,6 ÷ 11,9 12,5 ÷ 12,7 12,9 ÷ 13,2 13,6 ÷ 13,9 maximum 13,7 15,7 ÷ 15,9 15,6 ÷ 15,9 15,7 ÷ 15,9 16,4 ÷ 16,7 maximum 17,1 17,6 ÷ 17,9 18,8 ÷ 19,1 19,7 ÷ 19,9 19,7 ÷ 19,9 19,6 ÷ 19,9 20,7 ÷ 20,9 maximum21,3 21,7 ÷ 21,9 21,9 ÷ 22,6 23,7 ÷ 23,9 23,6 ÷ 23,9 25,1 ÷ 25,4 26,2 ÷ 26,4 26,6 ÷ 26,9 maximum 26,7 28,3 ÷ 28,6 29,7 ÷ 29,9 31,5 ÷ 31,7 32,9 ÷ 33,2 maximum 33,4 35,7 ÷ 35,9 35,6 ÷ 35,9 37,7 ÷ 37,9 37,8 ÷ 38,1 41,6 ÷ 41,9 41,7 ÷ 41,9 41,6 ÷ 41,9 maximum 42,2 44,7 ÷ 44,9 47,9 ÷ 47,8 47,6 ÷ 47,9 maximum 48,3 59,3 ÷ 59,6 59,7 ÷ 59,9 maximum 60,3 79,7 ÷ 79,9 * for metric screw thread

Ø core (mm) 3,2 ÷ 3,4 3,4 ÷ 3,6 4,0 ÷ 4,2 4,1 ÷ 4,3 4,9 ÷5,2 6,9 ÷ 7,2 6,6 ÷ 6,9 6,8 ÷ 7,1 minimum 6 8,5 ÷ 8,8 8,9 ÷ 9,2 8,6 ÷ 8,9 8,4 ÷ 8,7 minimum 8,3 9,7 ÷ 10 10,6 ÷ 10,9 10,4 ÷ 10,7 10,1 ÷ 10,4 11,3 ÷ 11,7 11,4 ÷ 11,9 11,8 ÷ 12,2 minimum 10,7 14,4 ÷ 14,7 13,8 ÷ 14,2 14,4 ÷ 14,7 14,9 ÷ 15,4 minimum 14,2 15,3 ÷ 15,7 17,3 ÷ 17,8 18,9 ÷ 19,2 18,4 ÷ 18,7 17,3 ÷ 17,7 18,6 ÷ 19,2 minimum 17,4 20,4 ÷ 20,7 20,3 ÷ 20,8 22,4 ÷ 22,7 20,8 ÷ 21,3 23,1 ÷ 23,6 24,1 ÷ 24,7 24,8 ÷ 25,2 minimum 22,5 26,3 ÷ 26,8 28,4 ÷ 28,7 29,5 ÷ 30 30,3 ÷ 30,9 minimum 28,5 34,4 ÷ 34,7 33,8 ÷ 34,2 36,4 ÷ 36,7 35,8 ÷ 36,4 38,9 ÷ 39,6 40,4 ÷ 40,7 39,8 ÷ 40,2 minimum 37 43,4 ÷ 43,7 44,8 ÷ 45,5 45,8 ÷ 46,2 minimum 43,5 56,7 ÷ 57,3 58,4 ÷ 58,7 minimum 55 78,4 ÷ 78,7

lead* - turns/inch metric coarse pitch metric fine pitch 0,7 M4 36 32 0,8 M5 1 M6 1 M8x1 1,25 M8 24 27 28 1 M 10 x 1 1,25 M 10 x 1,25 1,5 M 10 27 20 1,25 M 12 x 1,25 1,5 M 12 x 1,5 1,75 M 12 20 19 2 M 14 18 1,5 M 16 x 1,5 2 M 16 16 19 18 2,5 M 18 16 1 M 20 x 1 1,5 M 20 x 1,5 2,5 M 20 14 14 1,5 M 22 x 1,5 14 1,5 M 24 x 1,5 3 M 24 12 14 2 M 27 x 2 14 12 1,5 M 30 x 1,5 12 11 11 1/2 1,5 M 36 x 1,5 2 M 36 x 2 1,5 M 38 x 1,5 12 11 1,5 M 42 x 1,5 2 M 42 x 2 11 1/2 1,5 M 45 x 1,5 11 2 M 48 x 2 11 1/2 11 1,5 M 60 x 1,5 11 1/2 1,5 M 80 x 1,5

BSP, G

NPT

UNF No. 8-36 No.10-32

5/16

x 24

7/16

x 20

1/16 1/8

1/8

½ x 20 ¼ ¼

5/8

x 16

3/8 3/8

¾ x 16

½ ½ 7/8

x 14

1 x 12 ¾ ¾ 1 1/8 x 12 1 ¼ x 12 1 1

1 ½ x 12 1¼

1¼ 1½ 1½ 2 2

metric = metric screw thread (coarse pitch = MA; fine pitch = MB) G = Gas thread (“BSP” according to ISO standard) NPT = tapered gas thread (used in the U.S.A.) UNF = fine pitch thread (used in the Anglo-Saxon countries)

Technical information

0.11


Technical information 0

SPECIAL OPTIONS TABLE FOR CYLINDERS U

P

UP

X

CPUI

CPA

CX

CPU

BU

B

BG

HB

Z

WR

S S1 S2 S3

As standard As standard

S4 S5

As standard As standard

As standard

S6

Ø 125÷200

Ø 32÷200 Ø 32÷100

As standard

S7 S8 S9

As standard As standard As standard As standard As standard

S10

As standard As standard

As standard As standard As standard As standard As standard As standard

As standard

S10A S10B

S- WAIRCOM M.B.S. drawing

S4 - Nuts and tie rods made of AISI 303 stainless steel

S9 - Piston rod with plane working for key

S1- Oil proof seal (only scraper ring)

S5 - Female threaded tie rods

S10 - Without cushioning

S2- Scraper ring for high temperatures

S6 - Completed threaded and galvanized tie rods

S10A - With front cushioning

S7 - Linear sliding

S10B - With rear cushioning

S3- Female threaded piston rod (dimension AF = 1,5 KF)

Feasible Not feasible

S8 - Through rod with different piston rod for side “B” and/or “C”

Example: Cylinder to ISO and VDMA standards Ø 63, through rod, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type with different piston rod on side “B” with dimensions: KK=M20x1,5 AM=45 and WH=60: 63R150 CPUI/M S8 B KK=M20x1,5 AM=45 WH=60

GENERAL TECHNICAL DATA FOR CYLINDERS OPERATING LIFE The life cycle of cylinders is affected by manifold factors including: loads (axial and radial), speeds and frequencies of use, average working temperatures, shocks, tolerances of the acceptable pneumatic leakage. Due to the variability of all the factors above mentioned it’s not possible to give indications on the life of cylinders that would not be purely theoretical data. The intent of these indications is only to supply a reference value that could help the end user to planning properly during the implementation phase of any installation, and not binding or guaranteed towards the customer. In consideration of all the above, we can give the following values (without radial loads): 15,000 km for cylinders with polyurethane seals; 8,000 km for cylinders with NBR seals; 5,000 km for rodless cylinders. STROKE TOLERANCES The actual stroke of the cylinders has a tolerance with respect to the nominal stroke but always in compliance with the applicable standards, if any, or anyway within the following tolerances: -0/+1.5 mm for cylinders to ISO 6432 Ø 8 ÷ 25; -0.5/+1.5 mm for round cylinders Ø 32 ÷ 63; -0/+2 mm for cylinders to ISO 15552 Ø 32 ÷ 50; -0/+2.5 mm for cylinders to ISO 15552 Ø 63 ÷ 200; -0/+2.5 mm for compact cylinders to AFNOR Ø 20 ÷ 100; -0/+1 mm for compact cylinders Ø 12 ÷ 100; -0/+2.5 mm for rodless cylinders Ø 18 ÷ 63.

STROKES EXCEEDING THE MAXIMUM VALUE INDICATED IN THE CATALOGUE Customer can address our commercial office even the “Demand for Feasibility” of cylinders having strokes exceeding the maximum value indicated in the catalogue. By and large Waircom will always be able to supply these cylinders, obviously with the physical limitations of the production technologies, but it will be care and responsibility of only the end user to realize proper solutions (e.g. guiding the piston rod, avoiding peaks loads, etc.) so that these cylinders with non-standard strokes could work properly and securely. MAGNETIC SENSORS The intensity and the shape of the magnetic fields generated by permanents magnets housed in the piston assembly depend on the presence of magnetic metal masses in the vicinity of the cylinders that could create mutual magnetic inductance. Therefore these masses may prevent the sensors from switching correctly, in which case non-magnetic materials should be used as, for instance, convenient stainless steel.

0.12

Technical information


0.13



Index chapter 1

CYLINDERS

Series U Cylinders to ISO 6432 standard ................................................................................................................................................................. page Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page Accessories: piston rod locking unit series WBZ ...................................................................................................................................... page Accessories: guide units series WUG ........................................................................................................................................................ page

1.3 1.6 1.7 1.8

Series P Round cylinders ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.12 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.14

Series UP Stainless steel round cylinders with techno-polymer end caps (to ISO 6432 standard for Ø 16 ÷ 25) ..................................................... page 1.15 Accessories: AISI 304 stainless steel fixings for round cylinders to ISO 6432 standard Ø 16 ÷ 25 .......................................................... page 1.17 Accessories: AISI 304 stainless steel fixings for round cylinders Ø 32 ÷ 50 .............................................................................................. page 1.19

Series X “Clean profile” cylinders to ISO 15552 standard ....................................................................................................................................... page Accessories: cover strips and fixing brackets ........................................................................................................................................... page Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page Accessories: piston rod locking unit for cylinder series WBZ ................................................................................................................... page Accessories: guide unit for cylinder series WUG ...................................................................................................................................... page

1.21 1.24 1.28 1.33 1.34

Series CPUI Tie rods cylinders to ISO 15552 standard ................................................................................................................................................. page Accessories: cover strips and fixing brackets ........................................................................................................................................... page Accessories: piston rod locking unit for cylinder series WBZ ................................................................................................................... page Accessories: guide unit for cylinder series WUG ...................................................................................................................................... page

1.25 1.28 1.33 1.34

Series CPA Twin rod cylinders ...................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.38 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.40

Series CX Cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard ......................................................................................................................... page 1.41 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.44

Series CPU Cylinders to ex CETOP RP 43 P standard................................................................................................................................................. page 1.47 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.49

Series BU Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards............................................................................................ page 1.51 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.57

Series B Compact cylinders ..................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.59 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.66

Series BG Compact guided cylinders ......................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.67 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.68

Series HB Screwed-head cylinders ............................................................................................................................................................................ page 1.69

Series Z Rodless cylinders ....................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.75 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.79

Series HS Hydraulic speed regulators ........................................................................................................................................................................ page 1.81 Accessories: fixings ................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.86

Series WR Rotary cylinders ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page 1.88

Series F Cylinders piston rod attachments .............................................................................................................................................................. page 1.90

Series FM Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM100 - FM101 - FM157 - FM158 ............................................................................................... page 1.93

Cylinders

1.1


Waircom cylinders: overview Waircom offers an extensive range

All the series foresee, when not

of cylinders that can satisfy the most

already included in the initial designs

disparate demands and industrial

of the cylinders, even the application

applications. We are able to propose

of convenient accessories or

linear (with or without piston rod),

magnetic sensors that allow an even

guided, compact, non-rotating and

wider possibility of exploitation.

rotary actuators, that comply with

As usual all these can work

the most common international

thanks to a production driven by a

standards or with our own designs

management of the quality system

and that point at the optimisation

that complies all the demands

of the quality/price rate, without

included in the reference standard

neglecting the always present care

UNI EN ISO 9001:2000.

to the continuous innovation.

1.2

Cylinders


U

Cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “U” comply with ISO 6432 standard. The basic version is available for every diameter, while the rear axial feed, the magnetic piston and the adjustable cushions versions are produced from Ø 16 to Ø 25.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature

1 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperatures (-10 °C with dry air) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod; Flat rear cap (rear axial feed). Bore Ø 8, 10, 12, 16, 20, 25 Port size Ø 8 ÷ 16 = M5 Ø 20 - 25 = G1/8 Standard strokes (mm) 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 120, 125, 140, 150, 160, 180, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 500 Decelerators length Ø 16 20 25 mm 17 18 18.5 Maximum strokes (mm) Ø 8 - 10 = 150; Ø 12 - 16 = 250; Ø 20 - 25 = 1000 Max. strokes single acting (mm) Ø 8 ÷ 12 = 20; Ø 16 ÷ 25 = 50

SPRING THEORETICAL TRACTIVE FORCE

MATERIALS

Decelerators ogives Piston rod bearing Piston Piston seals Springs

Anodized aluminium alloy Extruded tube, AISI 304 stainless steel Irreversible calking with dual-seal system, mechanical and pneumatic AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Steel Stainless steel (supplied upon request) Brass Self-lubricating sintered bronze Aluminium alloy with acetal resin piston bearing (supplied with and without magnet) NBR rubber - Viton® Springs steel

Spring tractive force (N)

End caps Cylinder barrel Barrel-end cover fixing type Piston rod Rod and end cap nuts

Stroke (mm)

ORDER KEY S•

U

VERSION 1

/ H

Basic cylinder

R

Through rod

Y

Single acting rear spring*

E

Magnetic

A

With non-rotating hexagonal piston rod***

Flat rear cup (rear axial feed)

VERSION 2

D S

Double acting Single acting front spring

PISTON TYPE

Bore

C

Version 1

Non-magnetic

OPTION 1

Stroke Series

X

Version 2

OPTION 2

Cushioned**

Piston Type

Z

Option 1

OPTION 3

Option 2

2

Option 3 Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM100 - FM157 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page. 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

* ** *** ****

Fit for piston rod locking unit***

Seals for high temperatures****

Dimensions “XC” for version “YE” is increased of 10 mm Supplied from Ø 16 to Ø 25 Supplied for Ø 20 and Ø 25 Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type and standard piston rod

ORDER EXAMPLES Basic cylinder Ø16, 50 mm stroke, double acting, non-magnetic piston type 16/50 UDC Basic cylinder Ø20, 50 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, cushioned 20/50 UDEX

Cylinder Ø25, through rod, 100 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, cushioned 25R100 UDEX Basic cylinder Ø25, 40 mm stroke, single acting rear spring, non-magnetic piston type, seals for high temperatures 25/40 UYC2

Cylinders series U

1.3


U

Cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

U BASIC CYLINDER

1

XC+STROKE

P.S.: End cap nut and rod nut supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø AM* B 8 10 12 16 20 25

12 12 16 16 20 22

3 3 4 4 5 6

BE*

C

CD* Ch* Ch2 H9 M12x1,25 15 4 7 M12x1,25 15 4 7 M16x1,5 18 6 5 10 M16x1,5 18 6 5 10 M22x1,5 25 8 7 13 M22x1,5 28,5 8 9 17

D*

EE*

ES

16 M5 16 M5 19 M5 21 M5 26 G 1/8 30 G 1/8

8 10

EW* d13 8 8 12 12 16 16

KK

KV KW* L*

M4 M4 M6 M6 M8 M10x1,25

19 19 24 24 30 30

6 6 8 8 10 10

LB

6 60 6 60 9 70 9 77 12 91 12 100

M1 M2

MM MR*

N

WB

WF*

14 14 19 18 19 23

4 4 6 6 8 10

8 8 12 12 13 15

71 73

16 16 22 22 24 28

* STANDARD DIMENSIONS Dimension “XC” for version “YE” is increased of 10 mm

THROUGH ROD WF+STROKE

P.S.: End cap nuts and rod nuts supplied as standard

FLAT END CAP (REAR AXIAL FEED NOT INDICATED IN THE ISO 6432 STANDARD) LB+STROKE

P.S.: End cap nut and rod nut supplied as standard

1.4

Cylinders series U

12 12 19 18 20 22

9 9 12 12 15 18

XC* WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 10 mm 64 28,3 2 64 29,2 2,3 75 55,3 3,7 82 63 4,2 95 138 9,1 104 188,5 12,5


U

Cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

NON-ROTATING HEXAGON PISTON ROD

1

P.S.: End cap nut and rod nut supplied as standard

FIT FOR PISTON ROD LOCKING UNIT

P.S.: End cap nut and rod nut supplied as standard

END CAP NUT - STEEL - UDT Ø Ø

DI

CH

S

8-10 12-16 20-25

M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M22x1,5

19 24 30

6 8 10

WEIGHT (g) 7 16 25

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.17)

Cylinders series U

1.5


U

Accessories Fixings for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

FLANGE - STEEL - UF Ø Ø

1

8-10 12-16 20 25

FB H13 4,5 5,5 6,6 6,6

LW

S

13 18 19 23

3 4 5 5

TF JS13 30 40 50 50

UF

UR

39 54 64 64

19 30 36 36

WEIGHT (g) 5 10 20 20

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.17)

FOOT - STEEL - UP Ø Ø 8-10 12-16 20 25

AB H13 4,5 5,5 6,6 6,6

Ø

S

8-10 12-16 20 25

1,5 2 2,5 2,5

AU

LA

LB

LC

NH

R

9,5 12 13 13

14 19 21,5 21,5

64 74-81 91 95

28 28-35 45,5 49,5

16 20 25 25

9,5 13 18 18

TR JS13 25 32 40 40

US

XS

XT

34 46 54 54

24 32 35 39

6,5 10 11 15

WEIGHT (g) 10 25 40 40

LC+STROKE

LB+STROKE

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.17)

REAR HINGE - STEEL - USC Ø Ø

D H13 4,5 5,5 5,5 6,6 6,6

H

LA

8-10 12 16 20 25

CD f8 4 6 6 8 8

24 27 27 30 30

20 25 25 32 32

Ø

LE

LX

R

S

8-10 12 16 20 25

17 25 25 29,5 29,5

62,75 73 80 91 100

5 7 7 10 10

2,5 3 3 4 4

LB JS13 12,5 15 15 20 20

LC E9 8,1 12,1 12,1 16,1 16,1

LD 3,75 5 5 6 6

WEIGHT (g) 20 36 36 78 78

LX+STROKE

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.17)

FLOATING HINGE - STEEL - UCT Ø Ø

LA

LB

TD

TL

TM

UW

8-10 12-16 20 25

13 14 20 24

64 76-83 93 101

4 6 6 6

6 10 10 10

26 38 46 46

20 25 30 30

WEIGHT (g) 17 35 45 45

LX+STROKE

1.6

Cylinders series U


WBZ

Accessories Piston rod locking unit for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

DESCRIPTION Piston rod locking unit series “WBZ” is a mechanical device to fit on ISO 6432 cylinders (series “U” and “UP”); its function is to lock the piston rod in any position. This solution allows to lock the cylinder stroke each time that there’s a pressure fall. Locking force is, in any case, higher than the force given off by the cylinder fed at 10 bar. It has static operation (cylinder piston rod not moving); it’s necessary to preliminary stop the cylinder piston rod before proceeding with mechanical locking. Piston rod locking unit series “WBZ” must not be considered as a safety device.

TECNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Size Port size Locking Type Release Condition in absence of pressure Locking force with static load

1

MATERIALS 3 ÷ 6 bar with cylinder feed pressure 0 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-5 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air 20, 25 20 - 25 = M5 Mechanical - Only axial (bi-directional) Through pneumatic control Locked Size N

20 490

Body Blades Pistons Seals Springs

Anodized alluminium alloy Brass Acetal resin NBR rubber Steel

25 490

ORDER KEY OPTION

WBZ

G

Fit for assembly with guide units series “WUG”*

* Feeding is rotated of 90°

Series Size Option

ORDER EXAMPLES Piston rod locking unit, size 20 WBZ20 Piston rod locking unit, size 25 + cylinder series “U” Ø25, fit for piston rod locking unit, 150 mm stroke, double acting, non-magnetic piston type, ASSEMBLED: WBZ25 + 25/150 UDCZ + M/WBZ

ASSEMBLY “WBZ” + cylinders series “U” or “UP”, “Z” version

M/WBZ

SPARE PARTS BLADES KIT

Size /PM/WBZ

PISTON KIT

Size /SG/WBZ

TECHNICAL INFORMATION “WBZ” operation is based on the action of two opposed blades. When these blades are opened up by suitably loaded springs, they oppose the sliding movement of the piston rod passing through them. It is advisable to balance the pressure in the cylinder chambers during piston rod locking phase in order to increase its working life with a 5/3 pressure centre valve (see the schemes here below`). PNEUMATIC CONTROL

ELECTROPNEUMATIC CONTROL

WBZ PISTON ROD LOCKING UNIT

SIZE 20 25

WB 71 73

WEIGHT 190 g

Cylinders series U

1.7


WUG

Accessories Guide units for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

DESCRIPTION

1

Guide units series “WUG” for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard act as devices against rotation of the piston rod in the presence of torques and they are used to carry out multi-axis systems where high movement precision is required. Guide units are available in single and double version, and are supplied with self-lubricating bushings (for low speeds or heavy loads), or with recirculating ball bearing sleeves (for high speeds). P.S.: Cylinders series “U” (Ø 12 ÷ 25) and “UP” (Ø 16 ÷ 25) in the magnetic version, assembled with these guide units, can accept exclusively magnetic sensors type FM157 (see from page 1.97).

TECHNICAL DATA Size Standard strokes (mm) Versions

MATERIALS 12 - 16, 20 - 25 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500 Single unit Double unit

Body Self-aligning radial joint Adjustable mechanical stop as standard End flanges Guide bars Bushings Sleeves Clamp

Anodized aluminium alloy Steel Brass Single unit: galvanized steel Double unit: anodized aluminium alloy C45 chromium-plated steel (sliding type on bushings) Hardened steel (sliding type with sleeves) Self-lubricating sintered bronze with wiper ring Recirculating ball bearings with wiper ring Brass

ORDER KEY WUG

VERSION

/

Singler unit

D

Double unit

M

With sleeves*

SLIDING TYPE

B

On bushings

* Supplied only with size 20 - 25

Series Version Sliding type Size Stroke

ORDER EXAMPLES Single guide unit, size 20 - 25, 150 mm stroke, with sleeves + cylinder series ”UP” Ø 25, 150 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, ASSEMBLED WUGM 20 - 25/150 + 25/150 UPDE + M/WUG

ASSEMBLY “WUG” + cylinders series “U” or “UP” (Ø 16 ÷ 25)

Single guide unit, size 12 - 16, 100 mm stroke, on bushings WUGB 12 - 16/100 Double guide unit, size 20 - 25, 100 mm stroke, with sleeves WUGDM 20 - 25/100

1.8

Cylinders series U

M/WUG


WUG

Accessories Guide units for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

TECHNICAL INFORMATION

WUG SINGLE GUIDE UNIT

WUGD DOUBLE GUIDE UNIT

1

L = (LT - 2LH) + STROKE

Maximum payload F (N)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUGD VERSION B

Maximum payload F (N)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUG VERSION B

Projection XL (mm)

Maximum payload F (N)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUGD VERSION M

Maximum payload F (N)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUG VERSION M

Total lenght (L) with load laid in L/2 (mm)

Projection XL (mm)

Total lenght (L) with load laid in L/2 (mm)

Cylinders series U

1.9


WUG

Accessories Guide units for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

WUG SINGLE GUIDE UNIT LT + STROKE

1

No.4 THROUGH HOLES DC

No.4 SLOTS HC

No.4+4 HOLES DD

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS SIZE

DA

DB

DC

DD

FA

FB

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

HM

LA

LB

LC

LD

LE

LF

LG

LH

12-16 20 25

10 B12 M10 B12 M10

5,2 6,5 6,5

M4 M4 M4

M5 M5 M5

M6 BM8 MM6 BM8 MM6

M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5

65 83 83

60 77 77

6 7 7

47 55 55

24 30,5 30,5

32,5 32,5 32,5

25 27 32

28 44 50

60 69 69

47 52 52

40 45 45

35 40 40

7 7 7

10 10 10

SIZE

LK

LL

LM

LN

LT

PB

SA

TD

TG

12-16 20 25

19 10 10

16 30 30

22 19,5 19,5

6,5 10 10

100 115 115

12 12 12

Ch.14 Ch.21 Ch.21

8,5 10 10

22 32,5 32,5

WEIGHT INCREM. (g) (g) every 10 mm 690 12 B890 M830 B17 M12 B890 M830 B17 M12

B - Bushings M - Sleeves

1.10

Cylinders series U


WUG

Accessories Guide units for cylinders to ISO 6432 standard

series

WUGD DOUBLE GUIDE UNIT LT + STROKE

1 No.6 HOLES FA No.4 HOLES DC

No.6 HOLES FA No.2 THROUGH HOLES DB

No.4 SLOTS HC

No.4+4 HOLES DD

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS SIZE

DA

DB

DC

DD

FA

FB

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

HF

HG

HH

HL

HM

LA

LB

LC

LD

LE

12-16 20 25

10 B12 M10 B12 M10

5,2 6,5 6,5

M4 M4 M4

M5 M5 M5

M4 M4 M4

M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5

65 83 83

18 21,5 21,5

6 7 7

47 55 55

24 30,5 30,5

1,3 2,5 2,5

30,5 40,5 40,5

1 1 1

18 20,5 20,5

32,5 32,5 32,5

30 33 39

43 50 56

60 69 69

47 52 52

40 45 45

TG

SIZE

LF

LG

LH

LK

LL

LM

LN

LO

LP

LT

SA

TA

TB

TC

TD

12-16 20 25

40 45 45

7 7 7

15 15 15

19 10 10

16 30 30

22 19,5 19,5

6,5 10 10

22,5 25 25

19 22,15 22,15

120 135 135

Ch.14 Ch.21 Ch.21

17,5 20 20

17,5 19,5 19,5

5 5,5 5,5

8,5 10 10

WEIGHT (g) 22 740 32,5 B1170 M1110 32,5 B1170 M1110

INCREM. (g) every 10 mm 12 B18 M12 B18 M12

B - Bushings M - Sleeves

CLAMP FOR DECELERATOR WUGCD SIZE SIZE 12-16 20-25

FA M12x1,5 M16x1,5

FB M8x1 M8x1

L 35 40

WEIGHT (g) 20 50

CLAMP FOR MAGNETIC PROXIMITY WUGCP SIZE SIZE 12-16 20-25

FA M12x1,5 M16x1,5

FB M8x1 M8x1

L 25 25

WEIGHT (g) 12 31

Cylinders series U

1.11


P

Round cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature

1÷10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperature (-10 °C with dry air) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod; Flat rear cap (rear axial feed); Reduced flat rear cap Bore Ø 32, 40, 50, 63 Port size Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 = G 3/8 Standard strokes (mm) 10, 25, 50, 75, 80, 100, 125, 150, 160, 175, 200, 250, 300, 320, 350, 400, 450, 500 Decelerators lenght Ø 32 40 50 63 mm 29 35 40 40 Max strokes (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 63 = 1000 Max strokes single act. (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 63 = 50

SPRING THEORETICAL TRACTIVE FORCE

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Barrel-end cover fixing type Piston rod Rod nut and ring nut Decelerator ogives Piston rod bearing Piston Piston seals Springs

Anodized alluminium alloy Extruded tube, AISI 304 stainless steel Irreversible calking with dual-seal system, mechanical and pneumatic C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainles steel Steel Stainless steel (supplied upon request for the ring nut) Anodized alluminium alloy Self lubricating sintered bronze Alluminium alloy with acetal resin piston bearing (supplied with and without magnet) Polyurethane - Viton® Spring steel

Spring tractive force (N)

1

Cylinders series “P” are produced with a round profile design from Ø 32 to Ø 63. They are available in the basic version, with rear axial feed, with adjustable cushions and fitted for the use with magnetic sensors.

Stroke (mm)

ORDER KEY P

S•

VERSION 1

/ H

Basic cylinder Flat rear cap (rear axial feed)

R C

Through rod

Y

Single acting rear spring**

E

Magnetic

3

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut, and seals for high temperature***

Reduced flat rear cap*

VERSION 2

D S

Bore

Double acting Single acting front spring

Version 1

PISTON TYPE

Stroke

C

Series

OPTION 1

Version 2

X

Piston type

OPTION 2

Option 1

1 2

Option 2 Special options (supplied upon request) N.B.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM157 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

Non-magnetic

Cushioned

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut Seals for high temperature***

* Not available in the option “X” ** Different dimensions from the versions “D” and “S”; contact the commercial office *** Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type

ORDER EXAMPLES Basic cylinder Ø32, 50 mm stroke, double acting, non magnetic piston type 32/50 PDC Basic cylinder Ø40, 50 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, cushioned 40/50 PDEX

1.12

Cylinder Ø50, through rod, 100 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, cushioned 50R100 PDEX Basic cylinder Ø50, 40 mm stroke, single acting rear spring, non magnetic piston type, seals for high temperature 50/40 PYC2

Cylinders series P


P

Round cylinders

series P BASIC CYLINDER

LA + STROKE

1

LB + STROKE

LD + STROKE

P.S.: End cap ring nut and rod nut supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

AM

BE

C

CH

D

EE

KK

KW

LA

LB

LC

LD

M

MM

N

R

SW

WF

XC

32 40 50 63

20 24 32 32

M30x1,5 M38x1,5 M45x1,5 M45x1,5

36,5 44 55 67,5

17 19 24 24

38 46 57 70

G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5

6 7 8 8

154 182 202 206

96 113 120 124

47 57 62 63

78 89 96 98

30 35 38 38

12 16 20 20

14 16 18 18

M8x1 M10x1 M12x1,5 M14x1,5

10 12 16 24

38 45 50 50

134 158 170 174

XD WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 10 mm 140 386 16 163 690 26 176 1265 34 180 1750 50

THROUGH ROD

WF + STROKE

P.S.: End cap ring nuts and rod nuts supplied as standard

REDUCED FLAT REAR CAP

FLAT END CAP (REAR AXIAL FEED) XD + STROKE

P.S.: End cap ring nut and rod nut supplied as standard

XC + STROKE

P.S.: End cap ring nut and rod nut supplied as standard

Cylinders series P

1.13


P

Accessories Fixings

series

RING NUT - STEEL - PG Ø

1

Ø

d

D

S

32 40 50-63

M30x1,5 M38x1,5 M45x1,5

42 50 60

8 10 10

WEIGHT (g) 43 80 122

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.19)

FLANGE/FOOT - STEEL - PFP Ø Ø

AB

AU

HA

HB

HC

LA

LB

LC

32 40 50 63

7 9 9 9

14 20 20 20

14 18 20 20

49 58 70 80

28 30 40 50

21 30 30 30

124 153 160 164

76 83 92 96

Ø

NH

S

TB

TR

TS

XS

XT

32 40 50 63

28 33 40 45

4 5 6 6

14 20 20 20

52 60 70 76

66 88 90 96

48 60 64 64

24 25 30 30

WEIGHT (g) 98 183 276 395

LC + STROKE LB + STROKE

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.19)

REAR HINGE - STEEL - PSC Ø Ø

CH

E

G

H

L

LA

LB

32 40 50 63

13 17 19 19

7 9,5 10 10

20 27 30 34

34 38 44 50

125 146 158 161

20 28 36 42

46,1 56,1 69,1 82,1

Ø

LC

NA

NB

R

S

32 40 50 63

58 70 86 100

24 30 34 35

40 50 54 65

8 9,5 10 10

4 5 6 6

WEIGHT (g) 150 259 403 520

L + STROKE

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.19)

PIVOT (pair) - STEEL - PT Ø Ø

D

H

LA

LB

CH

32 40 50 63

10 12 14 16

51 64 75 90

47 57 62 63

125 146 158 161

6 6 6 8

WEIGHT (g) 10 20 40 65

AISI 304 STAINLESS STEEL SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST (SEE PAGE 1.19)

1.14

Cylinders series P


UP

Stainless steel round cylinders with techno-polymer end caps (to ISO 6432 standard for Ø 16 ÷ 25)

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “UP” are born as technological efficient reply to the always new needs of different industrial fields. They are available from Ø 16 to Ø 50 among which Ø 16 ÷ 25 comply with ISO 6432 standard. These actuators set themselves as a valid yet economic alternative to cylinders completely made in stainless steel, in many “special” applications (as for example food, chemical and pharmaceutical industry...) and/or aggressive environments. In fact, the peculiar feature of this series is represented by the material used for the realization of the end caps: it’s a special techno-polymer that assures adequate mechanical properties.

1 SPRING THEORETICAL TRACTIVE FORCE

1 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +70 °C (- 20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Double acting, Single acting front spring, Single acting rear spring, through rod

Bore Port size

Ø 16, 20, 25, 32, 40, 50 Ø 16 = M5 Ø 20 ÷ 32 = G1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G1/4

Spring tractive force (N)

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Versions

Standard strokes (mm)

10, 25, 50, 75, 80, 100, 125, 150, 160, 175, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500 Max strokes (mm) Ø 16 = 250 Ø 20 ÷ 50 = 1000 Max strokes single act. (mm) Ø 16 ÷ 50 = 50

Stroke (mm)

MATERIALS

Seals Springs

Techno-polymer Extruded tube, AISI 304 stainless steel Irreversible calking with dual-seal system, mechanical and pneumatic AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Stainless steel

Spring tractive force (N)

End caps Cylinder barrel Barrel-end cover fixing type Piston rod Rod, end cap and ring nuts Piston

Alluminium alloy with acetal resin piston bearing (supplied with and without magnet) Polyurethane Steel for springs

Stroke (mm)

ORDER KEY VERSION 1

UP

/

Basic cylinder

Bore

VERSION 2

Version 1

D S

Stroke Series

Double acting

R

Through rod

Y

Single acting rear spring*

E

Magnetic

Single acting front spring

PISTON TYPE

Version 2

C

Piston type

Non-magnetic

OPTION 1

Special options (supplied upon request) N.B.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM157 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93)

Z

Fit for piston rod locking unit**

* Dimension “XC” for version “YE” is increased of 10 mm for Ø 16 ÷ 25; for Ø 32 ÷ 50 contact our commercial office *** Supplied with Ø 20 and Ø 25

• See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Cylinder Ø 20, through rod, 100 mm stroke, double acting, non-magnetic piston type 20R100 UPDC

Basic cylinder Ø 40, 50 mm stroke, single acting front spring, non-magnetic piston type 40/50 UPSC

Cylinders series UP

1.15


UP

Stainless steel round cylinders with techno-polymer end caps to ISO 6432 standard Ø 16 ÷ 25

series

UP BASIC CYLINDER Ø 16 ÷ 25 TO ISO 6432 STANDARD XC + STROKE

1

P.S.: End cap nut and rod nut supplied as standard in AISI 304 stainless steel

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER UP Ø 16 ÷ 25 Ø AM* B 16 20 25

16 20 22

4 5 6

BE* M16x1,5 M22x1,5 M22x1,5

C

CD* Ch* Ch2 H9 18 6 5 10 25 8 7 13 28,5 8 9 17

D* 21 26 30

EE*

ES

M5 G 1/8 G 1/8

8 10

EW* d13 12 16 16

KK* M6 M8 M10x1,25

KV* KW* L* LB

M1 M2

MM MR*

N

WB

WF*

XC*

24 30 30

18 19 23

6 8 10

12 13 15

71 73

22 24 28

82 95 104

8 10 10

9 77 12 91 12 100

* STANDARDIZED DIMENSIONS Dimension “XC” for version “YE” is increased of 10 mm

THROUGH ROD Ø 16 ÷ 25 WF + STROKE

P.S.: End cap nuts and rod nuts supplied as standard in AISI 304 stainless steel

1.16

Cylinders series UP

18 20 22

12 15 18

PESO INCR.(g) (g) x10mm 63 4,2 138 9,1 188,5 12,5


Accessories AISI 304 stainless steel fixings for round cylinders to ISO 6432 standard Ø 16 ÷ 25

UP

series

END CAP NUT - STAINLESS STEEL - UPDT Ø Ø

DI

CH

S

16 20-25

M16x1,5 M22x1,5

24 30

8 10

WEIGHT (g) 16 25

1

FLANGE - STAINLESS STEEL - UPF Ø Ø 16 20 25

FB H13 5,5 6,6 6,6

LW

S

18 19 23

4 5 5

TF JS13 40 50 50

UF 54 64 64

UR WEIGHT PESO g. (g) 30 10 36 20 36 20

FOOT - STAINLESS STEEL - UPP Ø Ø

AU LW

LA S

16 20 25

AB FB H13 5,5 6,6 6,6

LB LC TF UF JS13 74-81 40 28-35 54 91 45,5 50 64 95 45,5 50 64

12 18 13 19 13 23

19 4 21,5 5 21,5 5

Ø

S

TR

US

XS

XT

16 20 25

2 2,5 2,5

32 40 40

46 54 54

32 35 39

10 11 15

NH UR 20 30 25 36 25 36

R PESO g. 13 10 18 20 18 20

WEIGHT (g) 25 40 40

LC + STROKE

LB + STROKE

REAR HINGE - STAINLESS STEEL - UPSC Ø Ø 16 20 25

CD FB f8 H13 6 5,5 8 6,6 8 6,6

D LW H13 5,5 18 6,6 19 6,6 23

Ø

LE

16 20 25

25 29,5 29,5

H S

LB UF

27 4 30 5 30 5

LA TF JS13 25 40 32 50 32 50

LX

R

S

80 91 100

7 10 10

3 4 4

WEIGHT (g) 36 78 78

15 54 20 64 20 64

LC UR E9 12,1 30 16,1 36 16,1 36

LD PESO g. 5 10 6 20 6 20

LX + STROKE

OTHER ACCESSORIES - Piston rod locking unit series “WBZ” (see page 1.7) - Guide unit series “WUG” (see page 1.8)

Cylinders series UP

1.17


UP

Stainless steel round cylinders with techno-polymer end caps Ø 32 ÷ 50

series

UP BASIC CYLINDER Ø 32 ÷ 50 LA + STROKE

1

LB + STROKE

LD + STROKE

P.S.: End cap ring nut and rod nut supplied as standard in AISI 304 stainless steel

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER UP Ø 32 ÷ 50 Ø

AM

BE

C

CH

D

EE

KK

KW

LA

LB

LC

LD

M

MM

N

R

SW

WF

XC

32 40 50

20 24 32

M30x1,5 M38x1,5 M45x1,5

36,5 44 55

17 19 24

38 46 57

G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5

6 7 8

154 182 202

96 113 120

47 57 62

78 89 96

30 35 38

12 16 20

14 16 18

M8x1 M10x1 M12x1,5

10 12 16

38 45 50

134 158 170

THROUGH ROD Ø 32 ÷ 50

WF + STROKE

P.S.: End cap ring nuts and rod nuts supplied as standard in AISI 304 stainless steel

1.18

Cylinders series UP

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 10 mm 386 16 690 26 1265 34


Accessories AISI 304 stainless steel fixings for round cylinders Ø 32 ÷ 50

series

UP

RING NUT - STAINLESS STEEL - UPG Ø Ø

d

D

S

32 40 50

M30x1,5 M38x1,5 M45x1,5

45 50 58

7 8 9

WEIGHT (g) 43 80 122

1

FLANGE/FOOT - STAINLESS STEEL - UPFP Ø Ø

AB

AU

HA

HB

HC

LA

LB

LC

32 40 50

7 9 9

14 20 20

14 18 20

49 58 70

28 30 40

21 30 30

124 153 160

76 83 92

Ø

NH

S

TB

TR

TS

XS

XT

32 40 50

28 33 40

4 5 6

14 20 20

52 60 70

66 88 90

48 60 64

24 25 30

WEIGHT (g) 98 183 276

LC + STROKE LB + STROKE

REAR HINGE - STAINLESS STEEL - UPSC Ø Ø

CH

E

G

H

L

LA

LB

32 40 50

13 17 19

7 9,5 10

20 27 30

35 40 45

125 146 158

20 28 36

46,1 56,1 69,1

Ø

LC

NA

NB

R

S

32 40 50

58 70 86

24 30 34

40 50 54

8 9,5 10

4 5 6

WEIGHT (g) 150 259 403

L + STROKE

PIVOT (pair) - STAINLESS STEEL - UPT Ø Ø

D

H

LA

LB

CH

32 40 50

10 12 14

51 61 75

47 57 62

125 146 158

5 6 6

WEIGHT (g) 10 20 40

Cylinders series UP

1.19


1

1.20


X

“Clean profile” cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

DESCRIPTION Pneumatic cylinders series “X” comply with ISO 15552 standard, being in this way completely interchangeable with the well-known cylinders to ISO 6431 standard, defining the dimensions of both the “nude” cylinder than assembled with fixings. They’re available in the bores from Ø 32 to Ø 100 and the cylinder barrel, made in extruded aluminium alloy, has some pits (“T”-shaped slots) on three sides where it’s possible to mount directly the new magnetic sensors series FM100. This peculiarity allows to leave the dimensions of the cylinders unchanged, keeping the mentioned sensors, completely embedded and granting them a better protection. The dynamic seals are made in high performances polyurethane with standard working temperature between -35°C and +80°C. Among all the available versions, a special mention deserves the non-rotating piston rod one with a particular section, made of AISI 304 stainless steel supplied as standard. The compact and advanced design makes the series “X” a product aesthetically appealing yet useful. In fact, thanks to proper cover strips that give the cylinders a really “clean profile”, the cylinders are not subject to receive dirt and so they result suitable also for “difficult” environments like the food one. A further feature is the possibility to assemble some series of valves directly on the cylinder barrel thanks to the brackets type “X/P/M..” (see page 1.24).

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Screws Piston rod Rod nut Piston rod bearing Piston Seals Cover strips

Painted die-cast aluminium alloy Extruded profile, 20 µm anodized aluminium alloy Steel (self-forming) C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Steel Stainless steel Bronze-iron 20%, sintered, self-lubricating Techno-polymer (supplied with and without magnet) Aluminium alloy for high temperatures Polyurethane Viton® Polyvinyl chloride

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature

1÷10 bar 0 ÷ +80°C (with dry air –35°C) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperature (with dry air –10°C) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod; Double push tandem; Double stroke tandem; Opposed tandem Bore Ø 32,40,50,63,80,100 Port size Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 - 80 = G 3/8 Ø 100 = G 1/2 Standard strokes (mm) 25, 50, 75, 80, 100, 125, 150, 160, 200, 250, 300, 400 320, 350, 500, 550, 600, 650, 700, 800, 900, 1000 Decelerators lenght Ø 32 40 50 60 80 100 mm 24 29 29 35 35 40 Maximum stroke (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 100 = 3000 Max. stroke single acting (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 100 = 50

ORDER KEY X/

S•

VERSION

/ S Y R

Double acting Single acting front spring Single acting rear spring

T P V

Double push tandem

M

Magnetic

A

Stainless steel non-rotating piston rod

3

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut and seals for high temperatures**

Double stroke tandem Opposed tandem

Through rod

PISTON TYPE Bore

N

Version

OPTION 1

Stroke

Z

Series

Non-magnetic

Fit for piston rod locking unit

OPTION 2

Piston type

1 2

Option 1 Option 2

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut* Seals for high temperatures**

OPTION 3

Option 3

4

Special option (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM100-FM157-FM158 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Cylinder Ø 50, double acting, 100 mm stroke, non-magnetic piston type, fit for piston rod locking unit 50/100 X/NZ Cylinder Ø 63, through rod, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type, stainless steel piston rod with cover strips 63R150 X/M14 Cylinder Ø 80, double stroke tandem, 50 mm stroke 1 + 100 mm stroke 2, magnetic piston type 80P50+100 X/M

Cover strips for magnetic sensors slots***

* Supplied as standard with option “A” (non-rotating piston rod) ** Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type and standard piston rod *** Supplied as standard for big slot

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Polyurethane Through rod polyurethane For high temperatures Through rod for high temperatures

Cylinders series X

Ø/SG/X Ø/SG/R/X Ø/SG/X2 Ø/SG/R/X2

1.21


X

“Clean profile” cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

X BASIC CYLINDER STROKE

1

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A*

32 40 50 63 80 100

22 24 32 32 40 40

BA* B* 30 35 40 45 45 55

BG*

CH

RT*

E*

EE*

G

D

KK*

16 16 16 16 16 16

17 19 24 24 30 30

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

47 52 63 75 93 113

G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2

27 31 30 35,5 36 39

12 16 20 20 25 25

M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M20x1,5

l l 2* l 8* 160 185 172 197 216 234

20 22 26 27 29 35

94 105 106 121 128 138

O

PL*

R

6 7 8 8 9 9

18 20,5 19 22 23 24

9 9 9 9 9 9

* STANDARDIZED DIMENSIONS

THROUGH ROD WH + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

NON-ROTATING PISTON ROD PISTON ROD SECTION

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

1.22

Cylinders series X

SW* TG* 10 13 17 17 22 22

VA* VD* 32,5 3 38 3 46,5 3 56,5 4 72 4 89 4

WB 86 100 127 127 156 161

WH* WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) every 10 mm 26 690 30 30 900 45 37 1240 60 37 1750 80 46 3580 100 51 5270 120


X

“Clean profile” cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

DOUBLE PUSH TANDEM

STROKE1 + STROKE2

1

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DOUBLE STROKE TANDEM STROKE1 + STROKE2

STROKE1 STROKE2

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

OPPOSED TANDEM STROKE1

STROKE2

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

FIT FOR PISTON ROD LOCKING UNIT

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

Cylinders series X

1.23


X

series

Accessories Cover strips and fixing brackets for “clean profile” cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

SMALL SLOT COVER STRIP - X/CP

1

BIG SLOT COVER STRIP - X/CG

FIXING BRACKETS FOR “T” SLOTS - X/P/M..

EXAMPLE OF ASSEMBLING OF VALVES MEV-MEK/CYLINDER TYPE X/P/M3 X/P/M4

A M3 M4

TECHNICAL INFORMATION FIXING BRACKETS These brackets, with vertical insertion, allow to assembling directly on the cylinder barrel some series of valves and can be used even as reference point for the replacement of magnetic sensors.

1.24

Cylinders series X


CPUI

Tie rods cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “CPUI” comply with ISO 15552 standard, being in this way completely interchangeable with the well-known cylinders to ISO 6431 standard. They’re available from Ø 32 to Ø 200. These cylinders are supplied cushioned as standard and, in the version with magnetic piston type can be supplied with magnetic sensors.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operatin pressure Working temperature

1 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperatures (-10 °C with dry air) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Trough rod; Double push tandem; Double stroke tandem; Opposed tandem Bore Ø 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100, 125, 160, 200 Port size Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 - 80 = G 3/8 Ø 100 - 125 = G 1/2 Ø 160 - 200 = G 3/4 Standard strokes (mm) 25, 50, 75, 80, 100, 125, 150, 160, 175, 200, 250, 300, 320, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 600, 650, 700, 800, 900, 1000 Decelerators lenght Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200 mm 21 23 26 30 33 37 37 40 40 Max strokes (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 200 = 3000 Max strokes single act. (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 63 = 50; Ø 80 - 100 = 100

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel

Alluminium alloy, cataphoresis-treated Ø 32 ÷ 125: extruded profile, 20 µm anodized allumium alloy Ø 125 ÷ 200: extruded tube, 20 µm anodized allumium alloy Tie rods, tie and rod nuts Steel Stainless steel (supplied upon request for tie rods and tie nuts) Piston rod C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainles steel Piston rod bearing Bronze-Iron 20%, sintered, self-lubricating Decelerator ogives Alluminium alloy Piston NBR rubber block (supplied with and without magnet) Viton® (supplied only without non-magnetic piston) Seals NBR rubber Viton®

ORDER KEY CPUI/

S•

VERSION

/ S Y R

Double acting Single acting front spring Single acting rear spring

T P V

Double push tandem

M

Magnetic

3

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut and seals for high temperatures**

Double stroke tandem Opposed tandem

Through rod

PISTON TYPE

N

Non-magnetic

Bore

OPTION 1

Version

Z

Stroke

Fit for piston rod locking unit *

OPTION 2

Series

1 2

Piston type Option 1

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut Seals for high temperatures**

OPTION 3

Option 2

5

Option 3

Extruded profile barrel (only for Ø 125)

*** Supplied from Ø 32 al Ø 125 *** Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type

Special option (supplied upon request) N.B.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM157 - FM158 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Cylinder Ø50, double acting, 100 mm stroke, magnetic piston type, fit for piston rod locking unit 50/100 CPUI/MZ

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Non-magnetic piston type

Cylinder Ø63, through rod, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type, stainless steel piston rod 63R150 CPUI/M1 Cylinder Ø80, double push tandem, 50 mm stroke, magnetic piston type 80T50 CPUI/M

Magnetic piston type

Cylinder Ø80, double stroke tandem, 50 mm stroke 1 + 100 mm stroke 2, magnetic piston type 80P50+100 CPUI/M

NBR Through rod, NBR For high temperature Through rod for high temperature NBR Through rod, NBR

Ø/SG/CPUI/N Ø/SG/R/CPUI/N Ø/SG/CPUI/N2 Ø/SG/R/CPUI/N2 Ø/SG/CPUI/M Ø/SG/R/CPUI/M

Cylinder Ø80, opposed tandem, 50 mm stroke 1 + 50 mm stroke 2, magnetic piston type, stainless steel piston rod 80V50+50 CPUI/M1

Cylinders series CPUI

1.25


CPUI

Tie rods cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

CPUI BASIC CYLINDER

STROKE

1

Detail of the front centering Ø 200

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A*

BA* BG* B*

CH

RT*

E*

EE*

G

D

KK*

l

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

22 24 32 32 40 40 54 72 72

30 35 40 45 45 55 60 65 75

17 19 24 24 30 30 41 55 55

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10 M12 M16 M16

47 54 65 75 95 114 140 180 220

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 3/8 G 1/2 G 1/2 G 3/4 G 3/4

27 30 32,5 37 37 40 46 50 48

12 16 20 20 25 25 32 40 40

M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M36x2 M36x2

160 185 172 197 216 234 268 310 310

16 16 16 16 16 16 20 24 24

l 2* l 8* 15 20 24 24 32 36 50 60 60

94 105 106 121 128 138 160 180 180

O

PL*

R

SW*

TG*

VA*

6 7 8 8 9 9 12 15 15

18 20 22,5 23,5 23 24,5 24 24 24

7 7 7 9 9 9 -

10 13 17 17 22 22 27 36 36

32,5 38 46,5 56,5 72 89 110 140 175

3 3 3 4 4 4 6 6 6

* STANDARDIZED DIMENSIONS

THROUGH ROD

STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

1.26

Cylinders series CPUI

WB WH* WEIGHT INCREMENT (g) (g) every 10 mm 86 100 127 127 156 161 205 -

26 30 37 37 46 51 65 80 95

520 810 1235 1790 2900 4080 6070 13100 18200

28 36 55 58 80 104 126 210 290


CPUI

Tie rods cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

DOUBLE PUSH TANDEM

1

STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DOUBLE STROKE TANDEM

STROKE

STROKE

STROKE STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

OPPOSED TANDEM STROKE 1

STROKE 2

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

FIT FOR PISTON ROD LOCKING UNIT

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

Cylinders series CPUI

1.27


CPUI

series

Accessories Fixings for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

FLANGE - STEEL - CPUI/F Ø (supplied with screws) Ø

1

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

D H11 30 35 40 45 45 55 60 65 75

FB H13 7 9 9 9 12 14 16 18 22

Ø

W

ZF

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

16 20 25 25 30 35 45 60 70

130 145 155 170 190 205 245 280 300

E

MF JS14 10 10 12 12 16 16 20 20 25

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

R JS14 32 36 45 50 63 75 90 115 135

TF JS14 64 72 90 100 126 150 180 230 270

UF 80 90 110 120 150 170 205 260 300

ZF + STROKE

WEIGHT (g) 190 246 478 622 1430 1986 3750 6350 11350

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 100, SCREWS EXCLUDED

FOOT - STEEL - CPUI/PB Ø (supplied with screws) Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200 Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

AB H14 7 9 9 9 12 14 16 18 22

AH JS15 32 36 45 50 63 71 90 115 135

AT

AU

E

F

SA

4 4 5 5 6 6 8 10 12

24 28 32 32 41 41 45 60 70

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

35 36 47 45 55 57 70 75 100

142 161 170 185 210 220 250 300 320

TR JS14 32 36 45 50 63 75 90 115 135

XA

WEIGHT (g) 66 78 168 190 382 452 1090 1188 3450

144 163 175 190 215 230 270 320 345

XA + STROKE

SA + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 100, SCREWS EXCLUDED

FRONT FEMALE HINGE - NOT CONFORM TO ISO STANDARD - ALUMINIUM - CPUI/CFA Ø (supplied with screws) Ø

CB

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

26 28 32 40 60 70 90 90 110

1.28

CD H9 10 12 12 16 16 20 25 30 30

E

FL

L

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

22 25 27 32 36 41 50 55 60

13 16 16 21 22 27 30 35 35

UB h14 45 52 60 70 90 110 130 170 170

WEIGHT (g) 48 75 124 192 380 620 1180 1780 2900

Cylinders series X and CPUI


Accessories Fixings for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard REAR FEMALE HINGE (Supplied with screws) Ø

CPUI

series

- ALUMINIUM - CPUI/CF Ø - ALUMINIUM WITH BUSHINGS - CPUI/CF Ø B - STEEL - CPUI/CF Ø AC

CD H9 10 12 12 16 16 20 25 30 30

E

FL

L

L4

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

CB H14 26 28 32 40 50 60 70 90 90

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

22 25 27 32 36 41 50 55 60

13 16 16 21 22 27 30 35 35

5,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 10 10 10 10 11

Ø

XD

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

142 160 170 190 210 230 275 315 335

WEIGHT ALL. (g) 48 75 124 192 380 620 1180 1780 2900

WEIGHT STEEL (g) 138 230 338 540 1000 1700 3350 5750 8900

1

UB h14 45 52 60 70 90 110 130 170 170

XD + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125, SCREWS EXCLUDED

PIVOT FOR REAR FEMALE HINGE (ALUMINIUM) - STEEL - CPU/CPUI/SEC Ø (STEEL) - GALVANIZED NITRIDED STEEL - CPUI/SEC Ø AC Ø

BU

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

53 60 68 78 98 118 139 178 178

EK f7 10 12 12 16 16 20 25 30 30

EL

WEIGHT (g) 46 32 53 52 61 60 71 122 91 152 111 290 132 530 171,5 978 171,5 978

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125

MALE HINGE (Supplied with screws) Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200 Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

CD H9 10 12 12 16 16 20 25 30 30

- ALUMINIUM - CPUI/CM Ø - ALUMINIUM WITH BUSHINGS - CPUI/CM Ø B - STEEL - CPUI/CM Ø AC

E

EW

FL

L

L4

XD

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

26 28 32 40 50 60 70 90 90

22 25 27 32 36 41 50 55 60

13 16 16 21 22 27 30 35 35

5,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 10 10 10 10 11

142 160 170 190 210 230 275 315 335

WEIGHT WEIGHT ALL. (g) STEEL (g) 54 176 76 274 124 368 212 682 420 1196 666 2100 1264 3740 1846 5890 8470 2950

XD + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125, SCREWS EXCLUDED

Cylinders series X and CPUI

1.29


CPUI

series SQUARE JOINT Ø

1

Accessories Fixings for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

- ALUMINIUM - CPUI/AS Ø - STEEL - CPUI/AS Ø AC (FOR Ø 32 ÷ 125)

CK H9 10 12 12 16 16 20 25 30 30

EM

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

PH JS15 32 36 45 50 63 71 90 115 135

Ø

BR

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

10 11 13 15 15 19 22,5 31,5 31,5

S5 H13 6,6 6,6 9 9 11 11 14 14 18

K1 JS14 38 41 50 52 66 76 94 118 122

26 28 32 40 50 60 70 90 90

GL JS14 21 24 33 37 47 55 70 97 105

RA JS14 18 22 30 35 40 50 60 88 90

K2

XD

51 54 65 67 86 96 124 156 162

142 160 170 190 210 230 275 315 335

UR

BT

L5

31 35 45 50 60 70 90 126 130

8 10 12 14 14 17 20 25 30

1,6 1,6 1,6 1,6 2,5 2,5 3,2 4 4

WEIGHT ALL. (g) 56 139 142 200 312 656 826 2600 3250

WEIGHT STEEL (g) 158 238 418 526 1055 1360 -

XD + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125

NARROW REAR FEMALE HINGE - ALUMINIUM - CPUI/CFS Ø - STEEL - CPUI/CFS Ø AC (FOR Ø 32 ÷ 125) (Supplied with screws) Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

CG D10 14 16 21 21 25 25 37 43 43

CP d12 34 40 45 51 65 75 97 122 122

Ø

L4

XD

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

5,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 10 10 10 10 11

142 160 170 190 210 230 275 315 335

B3

Ø CF F7 10 12 16 16 20 20 30 35 35

3,3 4,3 4,3 4,3 4,3 6,3 6,3 6,3 6,3

E

FM

L10

L11

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

22 25 27 32 36 41 50 55 60

9 9 11 11 14 14 20 20 25

16,5 18 22 22 26 26 39 44 44

WEIGHT WEIGHT ALL. (g) STEEL (g) 42 140 70 230 112 336 194 546 382 1190 610 1840 1100 3550 2000 3300 -

XD + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125, SCREWS EXCLUDED

NON-ROTATING PIVOT FOR NARROW REAR FEMALE HINGE - GALVANIZED NITRIDED STEEL - CPUI/SEC Ø AT Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

d4 H12 3 4 4 4 4 4 6 6 6

ØJK f7 10 12 16 16 20 20 30 35 35

L8

ES

L9

L5

G

14 16 20 20 24 24 36 41 41

32,5 38 43 49 63 73 94 119 119

4,5 6 6 6 6 6 9 9 9

41 48 54 60 75 85 110 135 135

4 4 5 5 6 6 7 7 7

WEIGHT (g) 26 42 84 94 184 208 606 974 974

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125

1.30

Cylinders series X and CPUI


Accessories Fixings for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard NARROW MALE HINGE WITH ARTICULATED HEAD (ISO 12240) (Supplied with screws) Ø

E

EN

MS

EU

G

DL

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

ØCX H7 10 12 16 16 20 20 30 35 35

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

14 16 21 21 25 25 37 43 43

16 19 21 24 28,5 30 40 45 48

10,5 12 15 15 18 18 25 28 28

9 9 11 11 14 14 20 20 25

22 25 27 32 36 41 50 55 60

Ø

L4

XD

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

5,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 10 10 10 10 11

142 160 170 190 210 230 275 315 335

WEIGHT ALL. (g) 62 100 180 244 476 646 1410 2385 3860

WEIGHT ACC. (g) 158 254 360 588 1118 1810 3500 -

series

CPUI

- ALUMINIUM - CPUI/CMSS Ø - STEEL - CPUI/CMSS Ø AC (FOR Ø 32 ÷ 125)

1

XD + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125, SCREWS EXCLUDED

SQUARE JOINT WITH ARTICULATED HEAD (ISO 12240) - STEEL- CPUI/ASSS Ø AC Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125

CA JS15 32 36 45 50 63 71 90 K1 JS14 38 41 50 52 66 76 94

BQ

EM

10,5 12 15 15 18 18 25

CK H7 10 12 16 16 20 20 30

K2

L5

R

51 54 65 67 86 96 124

1,6 1,6 1,6 1,6 2,5 2,5 3,2

15 18 20 23 27 30 40

14 16 21 21 25 25 37

G1 JS14 21 24 33 37 47 55 70

G2 JS14 18 22 30 35 40 50 60

G3

H6

31 35 45 50 60 70 90

10 10 12 12 14 15 20

S5 H13 6,6 6,6 9 9 11 11 13,5

XD

WEIGHT (g) 178 268 458 550 970 1326 3000

142 160 170 190 210 230 275

XD + STROKE

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 125

FLOATING HINGE - STEEL - CPUI/CTA Ø (Supplied with screws) Ø

L1

LA

LB

32 40 50 63 80 100

14 19 19 24 24 29

19 20,5 27,5 25 34 37,6

127 144,5 152,5 170 186 203,5

TD e9 12 16 16 20 20 25

TL h14 12 16 16 20 20 25

TM h14 50 63 75 90 110 132

UW 46 59 69 84 102 125

WEIGHT (g) 137 385 513 1041 1563 3000

LB + STROKE

Cylinders series X and CPUI

1.31


CPUI

series

Accessories Fixings for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

INTERMEDIATE HINGE - STEEL - EXTRUDED PROFILE - CPUI/CT Ø (Supplied with dowels) Ø

1

32 40 50 63 80 100 125

M N TD TK ± 0,3 ± 0,3 e9 max

TL h14

TM UW XV XV WEIGHT h14 max min max (g)

13,5 19 24,5 28 36,5 42,5 59,5

12 16 16 20 20 25 25

50 63 75 90 110 132 160

7 8 8 12 12 15 15

12 16 16 20 20 25 25

18 20 20 26 26 32 33

48,5 62 84 130 59 70 95 238 71 79,5 100,5 318 85 87 108 608 105 96 124 928 129 107 133 1562 154 127,5 163 2600

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 100, SCREWS EXCLUDED P.S.: ADJUSTABLE POSITION (fixing through dowels) XV max + STROKE

ASSEMBLY: CPUI/CT Ø + cylinder series “CPUI” type M/CPUI/CT Ø

INTERMEDIATE HINGE - STEEL - “CLEAN PROFILE” - X/CT Ø (Supplied with dowels) Ø

TK

TD TL TM UW1 UW2 e9 h14 0 /- 0,3

XV min

XV max

WEIGHT (g)

32 40 50 63 80 100

18 20 20 25 25 30

12 16 16 20 20 25

56 63 66 75 78,5 89

85 95 96 108,5 115,5 123

250 410 530 775 1430 1950

12 16 16 20 20 25

50 63 75 90 110 132

70 78 91 94 130 145

50 62 74 88 109 130

AVAILABLE IN AISI 316 STAINLESS STEEL FROM Ø 32 TO Ø 100 P.S.: ADJUSTABLE POSITION (fixing through dowels) XV max + STROKE

ASSEMBLY: X/CT Ø + cylinder series “X” type M/X/CT Ø

INTERMEDIATE HINGE - STEEL - EXTRUDED TUBE WITH TIE RODS - CX/CPUI/CT Ø (Supplied with dowels) Ø

TK

M

125 160 200

32 40 40

12,25 16,25 16,25

Ø

XV max 163 190 207

WEIGHT (g) 2600 4300 7450

125 160 200

TD e9 25 32 32

TL h14 25 32 32

TM h14 160 200 250

UW

XV min 127 150 163

155 190 240

P.S.: - FIXED POSITION (specify dimension “XV”, fixed on cylinder with completed threaded and galvanized tie rods type “S6”, see on page 0.12) - ADJUSTABLE POSITION (fixing through dowels)

XV max + STROKE

ASSEMBLY (FIXED): CX/CPUI/CT Ø + cylinders series “CPUI S6” type MF/CX/CPUI/CT Ø

SUPPORT FOR INTERMEDIATE HINGE - STEEL - CPUI/SCT Ø Ø

A

B1

B2

C

32 40-50 63-80 100-125 160-200

32 36 42 50 60

46 55 65 75 92

18 21 23 28,5 40

10,5 12 13 16 22,5

Ø

XA

d1 F7 12 16 20 25 32

d2 H13 6,6 9 11 14 18

FN 30 36 40 50 60

WEIGHT (g) 32 71 100 40-50 87-99 150 63-80 116-136 234 100-125 164-192 435 160-200 245-295 850

1.32

Cylinders series X and CPUI


Accessories Piston rod locking unit for cylinders to ISO 15552 standard

series

WBZ

DESCRIPTION Piston rod locking unit series “WBZ” is a mechanical device to fit on ISO 15552 cylinders (series X and CPUI); its function is to lock the piston rod in any position. This solution allows to lock the cylinder stroke each time that there’s a pressure fall. Locking force is, in any case, higher than the force given off by the cylinder fed at 10 bar. It has static operation (cylinder piston rod not moving); it’s necessary to preliminary stop the cylinder piston rod before proceeding with mechanical locking. Piston rod locking unit series “WBZ” must not be considered as a safety device.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Release pressure Working temperature Fluid Size Port size Locking type Release Condition in absence of pressure Locking force with static load

3 ÷ 6 bar with cylinder feed pressure 0 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-5 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100, 125 Ø 32 ÷ 63 = G 1/8 Ø 80 ÷ 125 = G 1/4 Mechanical – Only axial (bi-directional) Through pneumatic control Locked Size N

32 790

40 1240

50 1930

63 3060

80 5400

100 7700

MATERIALS

125 12040

Body Blades Pistons Seals Springs

Anodized aluminium alloy Brass Acetal resin NBR rubber Steel

ORDER EXAMPLES Piston rod locking unit, size 50 WBZ50 Piston rod locking unit, size 80 + cylinder series “CPUI” Ø80, 150 mm stroke, fit for piston rod locking unit, non-magnetic piston type, ASSEMBLED: WBZ80 + 80/150 CPUI/NZ + M/WBZ

ORDER KEY WBZ

Series Size

SPARE PARTS ASSEMBLY “WBZ” + cylinder series “X” or “CPUI”, “Z” version

BLADES KIT PISTON KIT

M/WBZ

Size/PM/WBZ Size/SG/WBZ

WBZ PISTON ROD LOCKING UNIT

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS SIZE

B

BE

E

DA

DD

HD

L3

LA

LB

LC

LD

TG

WB

WH

32 40 50 63 80 100 125

30 34,9 40 45 45 55 60

8 8 12 12 16 16 20

47 54 65 75 95 114 138

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10 M12

9 9 12,5 17,5 17,5 20 19

67,5 80 100 100 120 120 156

60 70 90 90 110 110 140

20 20 24 24 32 32 45

6 6 8 8 12 12 20

33,25 42,5 58 59 69 69 84,5

32,5 38 46,5 56,5 72 89 110

86 100 127 127 156 161 205

26 30 37 37 46 51 65

WEIGHT (g) 400 600 1100 1500 2600 3500 6500

P.S.: TECHNICAL INFORMATION (see the same ones for cylinders series “U” on page 1.7)

Cylinders series X and CPUI

1.33


series

WUG

Accessories Guide unit for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

DESCRIPTION

1

Guide unit series “WUG” for cylinders to ISO 15552 standard (series “X “ and “CPUI”) act as devices against rotation of the piston rod in the presence of torques and they are used to carry out multi-axis systems where high movement precision is required. Guide units are available in single and double version, and are supplied with self-lubricating bushings (for low speeds or heavy loads), or with recirculating ball bearing sleeves (for high speeds). P.S.: Cylinders series “X” and “CPUI” (Ø 32 ÷ 63) in the magnetic version, assembled with these guide units, can accept rispectively magnetic sensors types FM100 and FM157 only (see from page 1.93).

TECHNICAL DATA Size Standard strokes (mm) Versions

MATERIALS 32, 40, 50, 63 25, 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 500 Single unit Double unit

Body Self-aligning radial joint Adjustable mechanical stop as standard End flanges Guide bars Bushings Sleeves Clamp

Anodized aluminium alloy Steel Brass Single unit: galvanized steel Double unit: anodized aluminium alloy C45 chromium-plated steel (sliding type on bushings); Hardened steel (sliding type with sleeves) Self-lubricating sintered bronze with wiper ring Recirculating ball bearings with wiper ring Brass

ORDER KEY WUG

VERSION

/

Single unit

D

Double unit

M

With sleeves

SLIDING TYPE

B

On bushings

Series Version Sliding type Size Stroke

ORDER EXAMPLES Single guide unit, size 63, 150 mm stroke, with sleeves plus cylinder series “X” Ø 63, double acting, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type, ASSEMBLED WUGM 63/150 + 63/150 X/M + M/WUG Single guide unit, WUGM 40/250

ASSEMBLY ”WUG“ + cylinders series “X” or ”CPUI“

size 40, 250 mm stroke, with sleeves

Double guide unit, size 50, 100 mm stroke, with bushings WUGDB 50/100

1.34

Cylinders series X and CPUI

M/WUG


Accessories Guide unit for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

WUG

series

TECHNICAL INFORMATION

WUG SINGLE GUIDE UNIT

WUGD DOUBLE GUIDE UNIT

1

L = (LT - 2LH) + STROKE

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUGD VERSION B

Maximum payload F (N)

Maximum payload F (N)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUG VERSION B

Projection XL (mm)

Total lenght (L) with load laid in L/2 (mm)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUGD VERSION M

Maximum payload F (N)

Maximum payload F (N)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE LOAD-WUG VERSION M

Total lenght (L) with load laid in L/2 (mm)

Projection XL (mm)

Cylinders series X and CPUI

1.35


series

WUG

Accessories Guide unit for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

WUG SINGLE GUIDE UNIT LT + STROKE

1 N째.4+4 HOLES DD

N째.4 THROUGH HOLES DD

N째.4 SLOTS

N째.4+4 HOLES DD

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS SIZE

DA

DD

FA

FB

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

LA

LB

LC

LD

LE

LF

LG

LH

32 40 50 63

16 20 25 25

M6 M6 M8 M8

M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5

M18x1,5 M20x1,5 M24x2 M27x2

112 125 150 162

100 115 144 155

7 7 7 7

79 90 108 119

61 69 85 100

20 21 25 27

50 60 70 73

120 135 150 180

70 75 80 107

50 60 70 80

45 55 65 75

8 9 10 12

12 12 15 15

SIZE

LJ

LK

LL

LM

LN

LT

PA

PB

SA

SB

TD

TG

32 40 50 63

22 27 32 32

38 44 47 49,5

50 50 50 50

34,5 42,5 50 65

25 30 35 35

157 172 190 225

6 8 8 9,5

15 20 25 25

Ch.23 Ch.26 Ch.30 Ch.36

Ch.17 Ch.20 Ch.20 Ch.20

12 15 17,5 17

32,5 38 46,5 56,5

CLAMP FOR DECELERATOR - WUGCD SIZE SIZE

FA

FB

L

WEIGHT (g)

32

M18x1,5

M12x1

40

50

40

M20x1,5

M14x1,5

45

60

50

M24x2

M16x1,5

50

105

63

M27x2

M20x1,5

60

130

CLAMP FOR MAGNETIC PROXIMITY SWITCH - WUGCP SIZE SIZE

FA

FB

L

WEIGHT (g)

32

M18x1,5

M12x1

40

47

40

M20x1,5

M12x1

40

67

50

M24x2

M12x1

45

128

63

M27x2

M12x1

45

173

1.36

Cylinders series X and CPUI

WEIGHT INCREM. (g) WEIGHT WUGB (g) every 10 mm WUGM (g) 2060 29 1815 2905 45 2760 4780 65 4525 6315 65 5950

INCREM. (g) every 10 mm 31 50 76 87


Accessories Guide unit for cylinders series X and series CPUI to ISO 15552 standard

series

WUG

WUGD DOUBLE GUIDE UNIT LT + STROKE

1 No.6 HOLES FA N°.4+4 HOLES DD

N°.4 HOLES DD

N°.6 HOLES FA

N°.4 SLOTS

N°.4+4 HOLES DD

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS SIZE

DA

DD

FA

FB

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

HF

HG

HH

LA

LB

LC

LD

LE

32 40 50 63

16 20 25 25

M6 M6 M8 M8

M5 M6 M8 M8

M18x1,5 M20x1,5 M24x2 M27x2

112 125 150 162

60 68 79 89

7 7 7 7

79 90 108 119

61 69 85 100

1 2,5 1 1

57 63,5 76 82

1 1 1 1

28,5 31,5 37,5 39,5

50 60 70 73

120 135 150 180

70 75 80 107

50 60 70 80

SIZE

LF

LG

LH

LJ

LK

LL

LM

LN

LO

LP

LQ

LT

PA

PB

SA

SB

TA

32 40 50 63

58 65 78,5 93

8 9 10 12

18 20 25 25

22 27 32 32

38 44 47 49,5

50 50 50 50

34,5 42,5 50 65

25 30 35 35

34 37,5 44,5 54

25 30 35 40

9 10 12,5 12,5

181 200 225 260

6 8 8 9,5

10 10 12 12

Ch.23 Ch.26 Ch.30 Ch.36

Ch.17 Ch.20 Ch.20 Ch.20

24 26 33,5 40

SIZE

TB

TC

TD

TE

TG

32 40 50 63

24,5 30 33 41

9,5 9 12 12

9,5 11,5 13 17

14 15,5 19 19

32,5 38 46,5 56,5

WEIGHT INCREM. (g) WEIGHT INCREM. (g) WUGDB (g) every 10 mm WUGDM (g) every 10 mm 2320 29 2250 31 3480 45 3340 50 5750 65 5480 76 6445 65 6065 87

Cylinders series X and CPUI

1.37


CPA

Twin rod cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Versions Bore Port size

1÷10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Double acting; Through ISO rod Ø 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 - 80 = G 3/8 Ø 100 = G 1/2 Standard strokes (mm) 25, 50, 75, 80, 100, 125, 150, 160, 175, 200, 250, 300, 320, 350, 400, 500 Decelerators length Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 mm 25 25 25 30 35 35 Maximum strokes (mm) Ø 32 - 40 = 200; Ø 50 - 63 = 350; Ø 80 - 100 = 500

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Tie rods and nuts Flange Piston rod Rod nut Piston rod bearing Decelerators ogives Piston Seals

Anodized aluminium alloy Extruded profile, 20µm anodized aluminium alloy Steel Anodized aluminium alloy C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Steel Stainless steel Bronze, sintered, self-lubricating Aluminium alloy Aluminium alloy, Derling with magnet Polyurethane

ORDER KEY CPA/

S•

VERSION

/

Double acting

RA

Through ISO rod

M

Magnetic

PISTON TYPE Bore

Version

OPTION

Stroke

1

Stainless steel piston rods and rod nut

Series Piston type

SPARE PARTS

Option

SEALS KIT

Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM100-FM157–FM158 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

Polyurethane Through ISO rod, polyurethane

Ø/SG/CPA/M Ø/SG/RA/CPA/M

TECHNICAL INFORMATION

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE TORQUE

Maximum torque M (Nm)

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE TRANSVERSE FORCE

Maximum payload F (N)

1

Twin rod cylinders series “CPA” act as devices against rotation in the presence of torques. They have been designed to be interchangeable with cylinders that comply with ISO 15552 standard (series “X” and “CPUI”) and so they can be used with the standardized rear mountings of those cylinders. The cylinders series “CPA” are cushioned at both ends and with magnetic piston type as standard.

Stroke (mm)

1.38

Stroke (mm)

Cylinders series CPA


CPA

Twin rod cylinders

series CPA BASIC CYLINDER

1

L8 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

B

BG

C

D

E

EE

F

F1

G

H

K

L8

M

S

T

TG

V

VA

Z

32 40 50 63 80 100

30 35 40 45 45 55

16 16 16 16 16 16

26 30 37 37 46 51

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

47 53 65 75 95 115

G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2

4 4 5 5 5 5

48 54 69 69 86 91

28 31,5 31,5 35 36 41

15 15 18 22 22 22

M6 M8 M8 M10 M12 M12

94 105 106 121 128 138

19 22,5 30 38 50 70

35 45 55 70 85 105

8 10 12 16 20 20

32,5 38 46,5 56,5 72 89

32 40 50 63 80 100

4 4 4 4 4 4

18 22 26 35 40 50

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 10 mm 770 30 980 43 1570 70 2320 128 3830 132 5600 139

THROUGH ISO ROD

L8 + STROKE

F1 + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

Cylinders series CPA

1.39


CPA

Accessories Fixings

series

FLANGE - STEEL (Supplied with screws) Ø

1

32 40 50 63 80 100

FB H13 7 9 9 9 12 14

Ø

ZF

32 40 50 63 80 100

130 145 155 170 190 205

E 45 52 65 75 95 115

MF JS14 10 10 12 12 16 16

- Ø 32 ÷ 50 - CPUI/F Ø - Ø 63 ÷ 100 - CPA/F Ø R JS14 32 36 45 50 63 75

TF JS14 64 72 90 100 126 150

W

80 90 110 120 150 170

16 20 25 25 30 35

ZF+ STROKE

WEIGHT (g) 190 246 478 622 1430 1986

FOOT - STEEL (Supplied with screws) Ø

UF

- Ø 32 ÷ 50 - CPUI/PB Ø - Ø 63 ÷ 100 - CPA/PB Ø

AH JS15 32 36 45 50 63 71

AT

AU

E

F

SA

32 40 50 63 80 100

AB H14 7 9 9 9 12 14

4 4 5 5 6 6

24 28 32 32 41 41

45 52 65 75 95 115

35 36 47 45 55 57

142 161 170 185 210 220

Ø

SB

32 40 50 63 80 100

144 163 175 190 215 230

TR JS14 32 36 45 50 63 75

WEIGHT (g) 66 78 168 190 382 452

SA+ STROKE SB+ STROKE

P.S.: REAR MOUNTINGS ACCESSORIES SAME OF THE CYLINDERS SERIES “X” AND “CPUI” (see from page 1.29)

1.40

Cylinders series CPA


CX

Cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “CX” comply with AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard and so they result interchangeable. Cylinders series “CX” with magnetic piston type can be supplied with magnetic sensors.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature

1 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperatures (-20 °C with dry air) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod; Double push tandem; Double stroke tandem; Opposed tandem Bore Ø 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100, 125, 160, 200 Port size Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 - 80 = G 3/8 Ø 100 - 125 = G 1/2 Ø 160 - 200 = G 3/4 Standard strokes (mm) 25, 50, 75, 100, 125, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 500, 600, 700, 800, 900, 1000 Decelerators length Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200 mm 25 30 30 35 35 40 40 50 50 Maximum strokes (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 200 = 3000 Max. strokes single acting (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 100 = 50

MATERIALS End caps Anodized aluminium alloy Cylinder barrel Extruded tube, anodized aluminium alloy Tie rods, tie and rod nuts Steel Stainless steel (supplied upon request for tie rods and tie nuts) Piston rod C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Piston rod bearing Bronze-iron 20%, sintered, self-lubricating Decelerators ogives Aluminium alloy Piston NBR rubber block (supplied with and without magnet) Viton® (supplied only with non-magnetic piston type) Seals NBR rubber Viton®

ORDER KEY CX

S•

VERSION

/ S Y R

Double acting Single acting front spring Single acting rear spring

T P V

Double push tandem

/FM

Magnetic

3

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut and seals for high temperatures*

6

Inner chromium-plated steel cylinder barrel**

Double stroke tandem Opposed tandem

Through rod

PISTON TYPE Bore

Non-magnetic

Version

OPTION 1

Stroke Series

1 2

Piston type

OPTION 2

Option 1

4

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut Seals for high temperatures**

Brass cylinder barrel**

Option 2 Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM157 - FM158 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93)

* Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type ** Supplied from Ø 32 to Ø 100

• See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Cylinder Ø50, double acting, 100 mm stroke, non-magnetic piston type 50/100 CX

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Non-magnetic piston type

Cylinder Ø63, through rod, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type, stainless steel piston rod 63R150 CX/FM1 Cylinder Ø80, double push tandem, 50 mm stroke, magnetic piston type 80T50 CX/FM

Magnetic piston type

Cylinder Ø80, double stroke tandem, 50 mm stroke 1 + 100 mm stroke 2, magnetic piston type 80P50+100 CX/FM

NBR Through rod, NBR For high temperatures Through rod, for high temperatures NBR Through rod, NBR

Ø/SG/CX Ø/SG/R/CX Ø/SG/CX2 Ø/SG/R/CX2 Ø/SG/CX/FM Ø/SG/R/CX/FM

Cylinder Ø80, opposed tandem, 50 mm stroke 1 + 50 mm stroke 2, magnetic piston type, brass cylinder barrel 80V50+50 CX/FM4

Cylinders series CX

1.41


CX

Cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard

series

CX BASIC CYLINDER

1 L + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A

B

C

D

E

F

G

H

K

L

L1

M

N

O

P

R

S

T

V

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

12 18 18 22 22 30 30 40 40

M10 M16x1,5 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M27x2 M36x2 M36x2

25 32 32 45 45 55 55 65 65

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10 M12 M16 M16

25 34 34 39 39 47 47 50 50

20 36 36 46 46 63 63 85 85

15 15 15 20 20 20 20 25 25

134 191 191 216 215 251 248 310 310

17 17 23 23 28 28 34 42 42

80 110 110 125 125 145 145 180 180

90 129 129 143 143 164 164 200 200

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

33 40 49 59 75 90 110 140 175

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 3/8 G 1/2 G 1/2 G 3/4 G 3/4

10 16 16 20 20 27 27 36 36

7 7 7 9 9 9 9 13 13

5 8 8 10 10 13,5 13,5 18 18

17 24 24 30 30 41 41 55 55

26 29 29 34 35 39 42 50 50

THROUGH ROD

E + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

1.42

Cylinders series CX

WEIGHT INCREMENT (g) (g) every 10 mm 482 23 907 35 1170 46 1817 59 2680 66 4422 93 6630 110 13820 210 18840 290


CX

Cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard

series

DOUBLE PUSH TANDEM

1

H + 2 STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DOUBLE STROKE TANDEM

H + 2 STROKE 1 + STROKE 2

STROKE 1 STROKE 2

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

OPPOSED TANDEM

L + STROKE 1

L + STROKE 2

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

Cylinders series CX

1.43


CX

Accessories Fixings for cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard

series

FLANGE - STEEL - CX/F Ø

1

Ø

A

B

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

68 78 94 104 130 150 180 228 268

80 90 110 120 150 170 205 260 300

Ø

M

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

WEIGHT (g) 158 206 424 504 1046 1480 3000 6300 9300

D H13 9 9 11 11 14 14 18 22 22

E

G

LE

LF

33 40 49 59 75 90 110 140 170

8 8 10 10 12 12 16 20 20

17 26 24 29 27 35 31 30 30

113 152 154 174 176 204 208 250 250

LF + STROKE

HIGH FOOT - ALUMINIUM - CX/P Ø Ø

A

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

28 36 45 55 70 90 100 130 170

D H13 9 9 11 11 14 14 18 22 22

Ø

M

O

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

27 27 35 35 43 43 52 62 62

F

G

H

LA

LW

32 36 45 50 63 73 91 115 135

8 8 10 10 12 12 16 20 20

35 35 45 45 55 55 68 82 92

134 164 180 195 211 231 249 304 304

132 171 179 199 207 235 244 292 292

LW + STROKE

WEIGHT (g) 54 70 150 170 354 470 918 2300 3450

LA + STROKE

LARGE HIGH FOOT - ALUMINIUM - CX/PL Ø Ø

A

B

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

65 72 90 100 126 148 180 230 270

Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

1.44

F

G

H

LC

82 90 110 120 154 180 216 275 318

D H13 9 9 11 11 14 14 18 22 22

32 36 45 50 63 73 91 115 135

8 8 10 10 12 12 16 20 20

35 35 45 45 55 55 67,5 80 80

116 146 154 169 181 201 209 260 260

LD

LP

LQ

M

O

P

60 90 86 101 93 113 113 140 140

95 134 132 152 148 176 176 210 210

123 162 166 186 192 220 224 270 270

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

18 18 22 22 28 28 32 40 40

54,5 62 77,5 87,5 110 130 161 206 246

WEIGHT (g) 76 90 188 206 410 576 1058 2350 3100

LQ + STROKE LP + STROKE

LD + STROKE LC + STROKE

Cylinders series CX


Accessories Fixings for cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard

CX

series

LOW FOOT - STEEL - CX/PB Ø Ø

A

D

E

F

H

LA

LW

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

28 36 45 55 70 90 100 130 170

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

15,5 16 20,5 20,5 25,5 27 36 45 47

32 36 45 50 63 73 91 115 135

35 36 45 45 55 56 70 75 100

134 164 180 195 211 231 249 304 304

132 171 179 199 207 235 244 292 292

Ø

M H13 4,5 4,5 5,5 5,5 7 7 9 11 11

O

S

27 27 35 35 43 43 52 62 62

4 4 5 5 6 6 8 10 12

WEIGHT (g) 66 78 168 190 382 452 1090 1180 3450

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

1

LW + STROKE

LA + STROKE

FEMALE HINGE - ALUMINIUM - CX/CF Ø Ø

G

K

LY

M

O

R

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

8 8 10 10 12 12 16 20 20

18 24 26 30 32 37 41 55 55

123 168 170 194 196 229 233 285 285

45 52 65 75 95 115 140 180 220

26 33 33 47 47 57 57 72 72

8 12 12 16 16 20 21 25 25

Ø

WEIGHT (g) 38 58 118 146 324 492 978 1872 2800

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

S H9 8 12 12 16 16 20 20 25 25

LY + STROKE

PIVOT FOR REAR FEMALE HINGE - STEEL - CX/SEC Ø Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

EK f7 8 12 12 16 16 20 20 25 25

EL

BU

46 53 66 76 96 117 142 182 222

53 60 73 83 103 124 149 189 229

WEIGHT (g) 21 52 64 130 160 304 364 720 872

Cylinders series CX

1.45


CX

Accessories Fixings for cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-001 (ex CNOMO) standard

series

NORMAL ARTICULATED JOINT - ALUMINIUM - CX/AN Ø

1

Ø

A

B

D

E

F

H

LY

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

25 32 32 46 46 56 56 71 71

0 16 16 25 25 32 32 43 43

40 52 52 75 75 115 115 180 180

28 38 38 54 54 90 90 150 150

7 9 9 11 11 14 14 18 18

26 38 38 52 52 61 61 80 80

123 168 170 194 196 229 233 285 285

Ø

P

T

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

18 26 26 34 34 41 41 55 55

S H9 8 12 12 16 16 20 20 25 25

WEIGHT (g) 26 56 56 176 176 376 376 924 924

8 10 10 12 12 16 16 20 20

LY + STROKE

SQUARE JOINT - ALUMINIUM - CX/AS Ø/SQ Ø

A

B

BG

D

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

25 32 32 46 46 56 56 70 70

25 32 32 40 40 50 50 63 63

20 32 32 50 50 70 70 110 110

37 54 54 75 75 103 103 154 154

F H13 7 9 9 11 11 14 14 18 18

Ø

P

R

T

V

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

32 45 45 63 63 90 90 140 140

19,5 26 26 32 32 42 42 54 54

S H9 8 12 12 16 16 20 20 25 25

8 10 10 13 13 17 17 20 20

41 52 52 63 63 80 80 111 111

INTERMEDIATE HINGE (Supplied with dowels) Ø

A

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

46 59 69 84 102 125 155 190 240

Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125 160 200

1.46

B h14 50 63 73 90 108 131 160 200 250

D e9 12 16 16 20 20 25 25 32 32

H

LY

18 25 25 32 32 40 40 50 50

123 168 170 194 196 229 233 285 285

WEIGHT (g) 58 144 144 300 300 649 649 1922 1922

LY + STROKE

- Ø 32 ÷ 100 - Ø 125 ÷ 200 E h14 12 16 16 20 20 25 25 32 32

G

M

15 20 20 25 25 30 32 40 40

6,25 6,25 8,25 8,25 10,25 10,25 12,25 16,25 16,25

- STEEL - CX/CPU/CT Ø - STEEL - CX/CPUI/CT Ø

Q min 58,5 73 73 85,5 86,5 101 105 120 120

Q WEIGHT P.S.: - ADJUSTABLE POSITION (fixing through dowels) max (g) 71,5 130 ASSEMBLY: 105 306 CX/CPU/CT Ø + cylinder CX type M/CX/CPU/CT Ø 105 370 - FIXED POSITION 117,5 702 (specify dimension “Q”; fixed on cylinder with completed threaded and galvanized 116,5 894 tie rods type “S6”, see on page 0.12) 138 1590 134 2600 ASSEMBLY: 160 4300 CX/CPU/CT Ø or CX/CPUI/CT Ø 160 7450 + cylinder CX S6 type MF/CX/CPUI/CT Ø

Q max + STROKE

Cylinders series CX


CPU

Cylinders to ex CETOP RP 43 P standard

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “CPU” comply with ex CETOP RP 43 P standard. The versions with magnetic piston type can be supplied with magnetic sensors.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature

1 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperatures (-10 °C with dry air) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod Bore Ø 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Port size Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 - 80 = G 3/8 Ø 100 = G 1/2 Standard strokes (mm) 25, 50, 75, 100, 125, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 500, 600, 700, 800, 900, 1000 Decelerators length Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 mm 25 30 30 35 35 40 Maximum strokes (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 100 = 3000 Max. strokes single acting (mm) Ø 32 ÷ 100 = 50

MATERIALS End caps Anodized aluminium alloy Cylinder barrel Extruded tube, anodized aluminium alloy Tie rods, tie and rod nuts Steel Stainless steel (supplied upon request for tie rods and tie nuts) Piston rod C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Piston rod bearing Bronze-iron 20%, sintered, self-lubricating Decelerators ogives Aluminium alloy Piston NBR rubber block (supplied with and without magnet) Viton® (supplied only with non-magnetic piston) Seals NBR rubber Viton®

ORDER KEY CPU

S•

VERSION

/ S

Duoble acting Single acting front spring

Y R

Single acting rear spring

/FM

Magnetic

3

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut and seals for high temperatures*

Through rod

PISTON TYPE Non-magnetic

OPTIONS

1 2

Bore Version

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut Seals for high temperatures*

* Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type

Stroke Series Piston type Options Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM157 - FM158 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Cylinder Ø50, double acting, 100 mm stroke, non-magnetic piston type 50/100 CPU

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Non-magnetic piston type

Cylinder Ø63, through rod, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type, stainless steel piston rod 63R150 CPU/FM1 Magnetic piston type

Cylinders series CPU

NBR Through rod, NBR For high temperatures Through rod, for high temperatures NBR Through rod, NBR

Ø/SG/CPU Ø/SG/R/CPU Ø/SG/CPU2 Ø/SG/R/CPU2 Ø/SG/CPU/FM Ø/SG/R/CPU/FM

1.47


CPU

Cylinders to ex CETOP RP 43 P standard

series

CPU BASIC CYLINDER

1

L + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

C

d

D

DD

E

F

G

J

L

M

N

P

R

S

T

V

32 40 50 63 80 100

M30x1,5 M35x1,5 M40x1,5 M40x1,5 M45x1,5 M55x2

M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M20x1,5

12 18 18 22 22 25

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

20 24 32 32 40 40

10 13 16 17 20 22

15 18 20 20 20 28

24 28 35 35 42 47

98 110 110 125 136 145

45 52 65 75 95 115

33 40 49 59 75 90

14 14 15 15 16 16

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 3/8 G 1/2

6 7 8 8 9 9

17 19 24 24 30 30

26 29 29 34 35 39

THROUGH ROD

L + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

1.48

Cylinders series CPU

WEIGHT (g) 517 810 1210 1727 2590 3970

INCR. (g) x 10 mm 21 36 44 61 64 76


Cylinders to ex CETOP RP 43 P standard

CPU

series

FLANGE - STEEL - CPU/F Ø (Supplied with screws) Ø

A

B

C

F

G

Q

M

32 40 50 63 80 100

32 36 45 50 63 75

80 90 110 120 150 170

45 52 65 75 95 115

7 9 9 9 12 14

8 8 10 10 12 12

16 20 25 25 30 35

130 146 155 170 190 204

Ø

O

32 40 50 63 80 100

64 72 90 100 126 150

WEIGHT (g) 145 195 390 530 1045 1450

1

M + STROKE

HIGH FOOT - ALUMINIUM - CPU/P Ø (Supplied with screws) Ø

A

B

C

32 40 50 63 80 100

32 36 45 50 63 75

144 164 173 190 215 229

142 162 166 185 210 219

Ø

M

S

32 40 50 63 80 100

45 52 65 75 95 115

8 8 10 10 12 12

WEIGHT (g) 55 65 140 190 370 500

F H13 7 9 9 9 12 14

G

H

L

32 36 45 50 63 71

35 35 43 45 55 55

22 26 28 30 37 37

B + STROKE

C + STROKE

REAR FEMALE HINGE - ALUMINIUM - CPU/CF Ø (Supplied with screws) Ø

F

I

H

32 40 50 63 80 100

9 12 12 17 17 21

12 15 17 20 20 25

142 161 172 190 210 229

Ø

X

32 40 50 63 80 100

20 23 27 30 32 37

WEIGHT (g) 35 55 105 170 300 455

J H9 10 12 12 16 16 20

k

L

M

26 28 32 40 50 60

45 52 60 70 90 110

45 52 65 75 95 115

P.S.: This hinge can be used also with square joint of series “X” and “CPUI” (see page 1.30)

H + STROKE

Cylinders series CPU

1.49


CPU

Accessories Fixings for cylinders to ex CETOP RP 43 P standard

series

PIVOT FOR REAR FEMALE HINGE - STEEL - CPU/CPUI/SEC Ø

1

Ø

BU

32 40 50 63 80 100

53 60 68 78 98 118

EK f7 10 12 12 16 16 20

EL 46 53 61 71 91 111

WEIGHT (g) 32 52 60 122 152 290

MALE HINGE - ALUMINIUM - CPU/CM Ø Ø

F

I

H

32 40 50 63 80 100

10 12 12 16 16 20

12 15 17 20 20 25

142 161 172 190 210 229

Ø

WEIGHT (g) 50 70 140 210 350 565

32 40 50 63 80 100

J H9 10 12 12 16 16 20

M

O

X

45 52 65 75 95 115

26 28 32 40 50 60

20 23 27 30 32 37

H + STROKE

INTERMEDIATE HINGE - STEEL - CX/CPU/CT Ø (Supplied with dowels) Ø

A

32 40 50 63 80 100

46 59 69 84 102 125

Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100

B h14 50 63 73 90 108 131

D e9 12 16 16 20 20 25

E h14 12 16 16 20 20 25

G

M

15 20 20 25 25 30

6,25 6,25 8,25 8,25 10,25 10,25

Q WEIGHT P.S.: max (g) - ADJUSTABLE POSITION (fixing through dowels) 88,5 130 ASSEMBLY: 99 306 CX/CPU/CT Ø + cylinder series CPU type M/CX/CPU/CT Ø 106 370 - FIXED POSITION 113,5 702 (specify dimension ”Q“; fixed on cylinder 130,5 894 with completed threaded and galvanized 138 1590 tie rods type “S6”, see on page 0.12)

ASSEMBLY: CX/CPU/CT Ø + cylinder series CPU S6 type MF/CX/CPU/CT Ø

1.50

Q min 57,5 67 74 81,5 89,5 101

Q max + STROKE

Cylinders series CPU


BU

Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “BU” are available from Ø 20 to Ø 100 and, complying with AFNOR NF E49004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards, they’re interchangeable also without using anchorages. Besides from Ø 32 to Ø 100 they are available even with end caps distance between centers to ISO 15552 standard. Cylinder series “BU” with magnetic piston type can be supplied with magnetic sensors inserted in the slots arranged on the extruded profile.

1

TECHNICAL DATA

Fluid Versions

Bore Port size Standard strokes (mm) Maximum strokes (mm) Max. strokes single acting (mm) Max. strokes hollow through rod (mm) Max. strokes non-rotating (mm)

Single acting: 2 ÷ 10 bar; Double acting: 1 ÷10 bar. 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +130 °C with seals for high temperatures (-10°C with dry air; for single acting versions: max 100°C) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod; Double push tandem; Double stroke tandem; Opposed tandem; Non-rotating piston rod device; Hollow through rod; Distance between centers to ISO standard Ø 20, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Ø 20 - 25 = M 5; Ø 32 ÷ 100 = G 1/8 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 100, 125, 150, 160, 200, 250, 300, 320, 350, 400 Ø 20 - 25 = 200; Ø 32 ÷ 63 = 300; Ø 80 - 100 = 400 Ø 20 ÷ 100 = 25 Ø 20 ÷ 32 = 40; Ø 40 ÷ 63 = 60; Ø 80 - 100 = 80 Ø 20 - 25 = 40; Ø 32 ÷ 100 = 80

SPRING THEORETICAL TRACTIVE FORCE

Spring tractive force (N)

Operating pressure Working temperature

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Screws Piston rod Rod nut Piston rod bearing Piston Seals Springs

Extruded profile, anodized aluminium alloy Extruded profile, 20 µm anodized aluminium alloy Steel Ø 20 - 25 = AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Ø 32 ÷ 100 = C45 chromium-plated steel Steel Stainless steel Self-lubricating sintered bronze Ø 20 - 25 = galvanized steel (supplied with and without magnet) Ø 32 ÷ 100 = aluminium alloy (supplied with and without magnet) Polyurethane Springs steel

Stroke (mm)

VERSION 1

/ R F

Basic cylinder Through rod Hollow through rod

T P V

Double push tandem

Y

Single acting rear spring

Double stroke tandem Opposed tandem

VERSION 2

ORDER KEY S•

BU

D S

Double acting Single acting front spring

VERSION 3

I

Bore Version 1 Stroke Version 2 Series Version 3 Version 4 Piston type Option 1 Option 2 Special options (supplied upon request)

End caps distance between centers to ISO 15552 standard*

VERSION 4

A

Non-rotating piston rod device (supplied only with female threaded piston rod option)

PISTON TYPE Non-magnetic

/M

Magnetic

3

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut and seals for high temperatures***

8

Female threaded piston rod

OPTION 1

1 2

Stainless steel piston rod and rod nut** Seals for high temperatures***

OPTION 2

7

P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Basic cylinder Ø50, 50 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, female threaded piston rod 50/50 DBU/M8 Cylinder Ø63, through rod, 80 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type, stainless steel and male threaded piston rod 63R80 DBU/M17 Cylinder Ø80, double stroke tandem, 50 mm stroke 1 + 100 mm stroke 2, double acting, magnetic piston type, female threaded piston rod 80P50+100 DBU/M8

Male threaded piston rod

* Supplied only from Ø 32 to Ø 100 For versions “T”, “P” and “V” contact our commercial office ** Supplied as standard for Ø 20 and Ø 25 *** Supplied only with non-magnetic piston type

P.S.: End caps mountings accessories of Version No. 3 (end caps distance between centers to ISO standard) are the same of the cylinders series “X” and “CPUI” (see from page 1.28)

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Polyurethane

Ø/SG/BU Through rod, polyurethane

Ø/SG/R/BU

For high temperatures Ø/SG/BU2 Through rod, for high temperatures Ø/SG/R/BU2

Cylinders series BU

1.51


BU

Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

DISPOSITION OF THE SLOTS FOR MAGNETIC SENSORS

1

Ø

K1

K2

20

3,4

-

25

4

-

32

4

-

40

8,4

1,4

50

7,6

3,2

63

6

-

80

8

-

100

8

-

BU BASIC CYLINDER, FEMALE THREADED PISTON ROD

ZA + STROKE ZJ + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER FEMALE THREADED PISTON ROD Ø

AF

BG*

D

20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

11,5 11,5 13 13 16,5 16,5 21 24,5

12 13 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5 16,5 19,5

3,8 3,8 4,5 4,5 6 6 8 10

D1 H11 12 12 14 14 18 18 23 28

DT H13 8 8 10,5 10,5 11 11 15 15

E

EE

KF

LB

LD

L1

MM

PL

RR

RT

SW

36 40 50 60 68 84 102 123

M5 M5 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10 M12 M16

4,4 4,4 5,4 5,4 1,7 1,7 1 3,5

4,5 5,5 5 9,5 8,5 -17,5 -21 -25

2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 3 3

10 10 12 12 16 16 20 25

7 8 7,5 7,5 7,5 7,5 8,5 10

4,3 4,3 5,3 5,3 6,4 6,4 8,4 8,4

M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

8 8 10 10 13 13 16 21

* IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P, V), DIMENSION (BG - LB) IS REDUCED OF 5 mm ** A - AFNOR I - ISO

1.52

Cylinders series BU

TG** WH A I 22 6 26 6 32 32,5 7 42 38 7 50 46,5 8 62 56,5 8 82 72 8 103 89 10

ZA

ZB

37 39 44 45 45 50 56 67

62 65 73,5 75,5 75,5 85,5 95,5 114,5

Z J WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 5 mm 43 130 10 45 160 11 51 215 16 52 330 20 53 470 25 58 710 37 64 1295 50 77 2250 70


BU

Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

SINGLE ACTING, REAR SPRING, FEMALE THREADED PISTON ROD

FEMALE THREADED THROUGH ROD AND SINGLE ACTING, FEMALE THREADED THROUGH ROD

1

WH + STROKE ZA + STROKE

HOLLOW FEMALE THREADED THROUGH ROD AND SINGLE ACTING, HOLLOW FEMALE THREADED THROUGH ROD

WH + STROKE

DOUBLE PUSH TANDEM, FEMALE THREADED PISTON ROD

WH + STROKE

ZB + 2 STROKE

ZA + STROKE

DOUBLE STROKE TANDEM, FEMALE THREADED PISTON ROD

OPPOSED TANDEM, FEMALE THREADED PISTON ROD

STROKE 2 STROKE 1

2ZA + STROKE 1 + STROKE 2

ZB + 2 STROKE + STROKE 2

Cylinders series BU

1.53


BU

Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

BU BASIC CYLINDER, MALE THREADED PISTON ROD

1

ZA + STROKE ZJ + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER MALE THREADED PISTON ROD Ø

AM

BG*

Ch

D

20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

22 22 22 22 24 24 32 40

12 13 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5 16,5 19,5

17 17 17 17 19 19 24 30

3,8 3,8 4,5 4,5 6 6 8 10

D1 H11 12 12 14 14 18 18 23 28

DT H13 8 8 10,5 10,5 11 11 15 15

E

EE

KK

LB

LD

36 40 50 60 68 84 102 123

M5 M5 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

M10x1,25 M10x1,25 M10x1,25 M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5

4,4 4,4 5,4 5,4 1,7 1,7 1 3,5

4,5 5,5 5 9,5 8,5 -17,5 -21 -25

L1 MM

O

PL

RR

RT

SW

2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 3 3

6 6 6 6 7 7 8 9

7 8 7,5 7,5 7,5 7,5 8,5 10

4,3 4,3 5,3 5,3 6,4 6,4 8,4 8,4

M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

8 8 10 10 13 13 16 21

10 10 12 12 16 16 20 25

TG** WH A I 22 6 26 6 32 32,5 7 42 38 7 50 46,5 8 62 56,5 8 82 72 8 103 89 10

ZA 37 39 44 45 45 50 56 67

ZB

Z J WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 5 mm 62 43 150 10 65 45 180 11 73,5 51 240 16 75,5 52 355 20 75,5 53 505 25 85,5 58 745 37 95,5 64 1360 50 114,5 77 2390 70

* IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P, V), DIMENSION (BG - LB) IS REDUCED OF 5 mm ** A - AFNOR I - ISO

SINGLE ACTING, REAR SPRING, MALE THREADED PISTON ROD

MALE THREADED THROUGH ROD AND SINGLE ACTING, MALE THREADED THROUGH ROD

ZA + STROKE

ZA + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

1.54

ZA + STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

Cylinders series BU


BU

Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

HOLLOW MALE THREADED THROUGH ROD AND SINGLE ACTING, HOLLOW MALE THREADED THROUGH ROD

DOUBLE PUSH TANDEM, MALE THREADED PISTON ROD

1

WH + STROKE ZA + STROKE

ZB + 2STROKE

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

DOUBLE STROKE TANDEM, MALE THREADED PISTON ROD

OPPOSED TANDEM, MALE THREADED PISTON ROD

STROKE2 STROKE1

ZB + 2STROKE1 + STROKE2

P.S.: Rod nut supplied as standard

2ZA + STROKE1 + STROKE2

P.S.: Rod nuts supplied as standard

Cylinders series BU

1.55


BU

Compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

BU NON-ROTATING BASIC CYLINDER

1 2 HOLES DA 2 HOLES DB

ZA + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS

MAX. PERMISSIBLE LOAD - NON-ROTATING BU

Ø

DA

DB

DC

E

L

L2

L3

20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

4 5 5 5 6 6 8 10

M4 M5 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M10

6 6 8 8 10 10 12 12

36 40 50 60 68 84 102 123

12 15,6 19,8 23,3 29,7 35,4 46 56,6

14 14 17 17 20 20 22 24

8 8 10 10 12 12 14 14

TG** A 22 26 32 42 50 62 82 103

ZA I 32,5 38 46,5 56,5 72 89

37 39 44 45 45 50 56 67

WEIGHT INCR. (g) x 5 mm (g) 170 15 210 16 300 25 440 30 610 40 930 55 1690 75 2950 105

Payload F (N)

** A - AFNOR I - ISO

Projection X (mm)

1.56

Cylinders series BU


BU

Accessories Fixings for compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards FLANGE Ø 20 - 25 (Supplied with screws)

- ALUMINIUM - BU/F Ø - STEEL - BU/F Ø AC

series

FLANGE Ø 32 ÷ 100 (Supplied with screws)

- ALUMINIUM - BU/F Ø - STEEL - BU/F Ø AC ZF + STROKE

1

ZF + STROKE

ZP + STROKE ZP + STROKE

Ø

d1 H11 12 12 14 14 18 18 23 28

20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

E

FB H13 6,6 6,6 7 9 9 9 12 14

36 40 50 60 68 87 107 128

MF

P

R

TF

UF

ZF

ZP

10 10 10 10 12 15 15 15

4 4 3 3 4 7 7 5

32 36 45 50 63 75

55 60 65 82 90 110 135 163

70 76 80 102 110 130 160 190

53 55 61 62 65 73 79 92

47 49 54 55 57 65 71 82

WEIGHT ALL. (g) 70 80 100 160 240 450 690 980

WEIGHT STEEL (g) 160 200 260 420 600 1200 1800 2550

IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P, V), ADD THE READING “TANDEM” TO THE CODE. EXAMPLE: BU/F Ø TANDEM

LOW FOOT - STEEL - BU/PB Ø Ø 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

AB H13 6,6 6,6 6,6 9 9 11 11 13,5

AH

AU

AT

E

F

SA

27 30 32 42,5 47 59,5 65,5 78,5

16 16 18 20 24 27 30 33

4 4 5 5 6 6 8 8

36 40 50 60 68 84 102 123

22 22 26 28 32 39 42 45

69 71 80 85 93 104 116 133

TR WEIGHT (g) 22 32 26 38 32 66 42 100 50 150 62 250 82 380 103 500

IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P, V), ADD THE READING “TANDEM” TO THE CODE. EXAMPLE: BU/PB Ø TANDEM SA + STROKE

REAR MALE HINGE (Supplied with screws) Ø

CD

E

H9

20 25

8 8

EW

- ALUMINIUM - BU/CM Ø - STEEL - BU/CM Ø AC

FL

L

L2

20 20

14 14

2,6 2,6

h14

34 38

16 16

XD WEIGHT WEIGHT ALL. (g) STEEL (g) 63 21 80 65 27 85

XD + STROKE

P.S.: THIS MOUNTING CAN BE USED WITH THE REAR HINGE MOUNTING OF CYLINDERS SERIES “U” (SEE ON PAGE 1.6) IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P), ADD THE READING “TANDEM” TO THE CODE. EXAMPLE: BU/CM Ø AC TANDEM

Cylinders series BU

1.57


BU

Accessories Fixings for compact cylinders to AFNOR NF E49-004-1 and NF E49-004-2 standards

series

REAR FEMALE HINGE (Supplied with screws) Ø

1

32 40 50 63 80 100

CB

CD

H14

H9

26 28 32 40 50 60

10 12 12 16 16 20

E

FL

- ALUMINIUM - BU/CF Ø - STEEL - BU/CF Ø AC L

L2

UB

XD WEIGHT WEIGHT

h14

48 58 66 83 102 123

22 25 27 32 36 41

13 16 16 21 23 26

5,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 10 10

45 52 60 70 90 110

ALL. (g) ACC. (g)

73 77 80 90 100 118

60 170 104 270 142 378 240 645 420 1070 721 1730

XD + STROKE

P.S.: THIS HINGE CAN BE USED ALSO WITH PIVOT AND MALE HINGE OR SQUARE JOINT OF SERIES “X” AND “CPUI” (SEE FROM PAGE 1.29) IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P, V), ADD THE READING “TANDEM” TO THE CODE. EXAMPLE: BU/CF Ø TANDEM

FLOATING HINGE - STEEL - BU/CTA Ø (Supplied with screws) Ø

L1

P

20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

14 14 14 19 19 24 24 29

8 8 7 12 11 16 16 19

TD e9 12 12 12 16 16 20 20 25

TL h14 12 12 12 16 16 20 20 25

TM h14 38 42 52 63 75 90 110 132

UW

XV

WEIGHT (g)

35 39 46 59 69 84 102 125

57 59 65 71 72 82 88 106

100 114 132 278 362 624 765 1464

XV + STROKE

IN THE TANDEM VERSIONS (T, P, V), ADD THE READING “TANDEM” TO THE CODE. EXAMPLE: BU/CTA Ø TANDEM

ACCESSORIES FOR CYLINDERS WITH END CAPS DISTANCE BETWEEN CENTERS TO ISO 15552 STANDARD The accessories of Version No. 3 (end caps distance between centers to ISO standard) are the same of the cylinders series “X” and “CPUI” to ISO 15552 standard (see from page 1.28)

1.58

Cylinders series BU


B

Compact cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “B” are widely used in locking applications thanks to compact design and to easy mounting through holes on cylinder body. In the version with magnetic piston type, cylinders series “B” are supplied with magnetic sensors.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Versions Bore Port size Standard strokes

1÷10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperatures (-10 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod; Non-rotating piston rod device. Ø 12, 16, 20, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Ø 12 ÷ 20 = M5 Ø 25 ÷ 63 = G 1/8 Ø 80 - 100 = G 1/4 See tables

SPRING THEORETICAL TRACTIVE FORCE

MATERIALS Rear end cap Cylinder barrel Piston rod Piston rod bearing Piston Seals Cushioning washer Spring

Ø 12 ÷ 25: Brass Ø 32 ÷ 100: Aluminium Anodized aluminium alloy Extruded profile, 15 µm anodized aluminium alloy AISI 303 stainless steel Bronze + PTFE Ø 12 ÷ 32: Delrin (supplied with and without magnet) Ø 40 ÷ 100: Aluminium (supplied with and without magnet) Ø 12 ÷ 32: NBR rubber Ø 40 ÷ 100: Polyurethane Ø 12 ÷ 100: Viton® Vulkollan AISI 303 stainless steel

Spring tractive force (N)

Front end cap

Stroke (mm)

ORDER KEY S•

B

VERSION 1

/

Basic cylinder

R

Through rod

Y

Single acting rear spring

/M

Magnetic

VERSION 2

D S

Double acting Single acting front spring

VERSION 3

Bore

A

Version 1

Non-rotating piston rod device*

PISTON TYPE

Stroke

Non-magnetic

Version 2

OPTION 1

Series

1

Version 3

Male hinge mounting

OPTION 2

Piston type

2

Option 1

Seals for high temperatures

* Supplied only from Ø 20 to Ø 100

Option 2 Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Basic cylinder Ø16, 50 mm stroke, double acting, non-magnetic piston type 16/50 DB

SPARE PARTS Contact the commercial office

Basic cylinder Ø20, 60 mm stroke, double acting, non-magnetic piston type, seals for high temperatures 20/60 DB2 Cylinder Ø32, through rod, 80 mm stroke, double acting, magnetic piston type 32R80 DB/M

Cylinders series B

1.59


B

Compact cylinders

series

SINGLE AND DOUBLE ACTING

1

Ø 12

Ø 16 ÷ 25

Ø 32 ÷100

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

A

B

D

D1

D3

D4

D7

D8

E

F

F1

12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

25 34 40 44,5 51 58 70 86 105 131

25 30 36 40 46 55 65 80 100 124

6 8 10 10 12 12 16 16 20 25

M3 M4 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M12

3,7 4,7 5,8 5,8 5,8 5,8 6,8 9 9 11

5,6 7,5 9 9 9 9 11 14 14 17,2

3,7 5,8 5,8 -

5,6 9 9 -

19 22 24,5 27 30,5 37,5 46 55 69

4,7 7 7 9 9 9,5 12,5 15 14 17,5

5 5,2 6 -

“H” DIMENSION-SINGLE ACTING Ø 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

1.60

5 22 32 32 33,5 34,5 34,5 -

10 27 37 37 38,5 39,5 39,5 44,5 47 56 66

STROKE (mm) 15 20 42 47 42 47 43,5 48,5 44,5 49,5 44,5 49,5 49,5 54,5 52 57 61 66 71 76

G

H3

I1

M5 5,5 M5 8 M5 8 G 1/8 10,5 G 1/8 11,5 36 G 1/8 11 42 G 1/8 11,5 50 G 1/8 11 62 G 1/4 14 82 G 1/4 16 103

I2

I3

18 20 26 32 42 50 62 82 103

12 15 15,5 -

I5

I6

20 10 25,5 12,7 28 14 -

K

L

L1

M

N

P

W

5 6 8 8 10 10 13 13 17 22

3,5 4,6 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 6,8 8,8 9 11

3,5 5,7 5,7 -

4,7 4 5,7 4,5 4 4 4 5 6 7,5

32 38,5 42 48 55 65 80 100 124

6 8 10 10 12 12 12 14 15 20

3,5 4,5 5 5,5 6 6 7,5 7 8 10

30 59,5 59,5 64,5 67 76 86

INCR. (g)

x10 mm 11,5 16,5 24,5 32 36 40 63 70 105 160

“H” DIMENSION-DOUBLE ACTING Ø

25 52 52 53,5 54,5 54,5 59,5 62 71 81

WEIGHT (g) 33,5 74 106 145 172 225 359 552 1072 1920

12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

5 22 32 32 33,5 34,5 34,5 -

Cylinders series B

10 27 37 37 38,5 39,5 39,5 44,5 47 56 66

15 32 42 42 43,5 44,5 44,5 49,5 52 61 71

20 37 47 47 48,5 49,5 49,5 54,5 57 66 76

STROKE (mm) 25 30 40 42 47 57 52 58 68 52 58 68 53,5 58,5 69,5 54,5 59,5 69,5 54,5 59,5 69,5 59,5 64,5 74,5 62 67 77 71 76 86 81 86 96

50 78 78 79,5 79,5 79,5 84,5 87 96 106

60 89,5 89,5 94,5 97 106 116

80 100 109,5 129,5 109,5 129,5 114,5 134,5 117 137 126 146 136 156


B

Compact cylinders

series

SINGLE ACTING MAGNETIC

1

Ø 12

Ø 16 ÷ 25

Ø 32 ÷100

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

A

B

D

D1

D3

D4

D7

D8

E

F

F1

12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

25 34 40 44,5 51 58 70 86 105 131

25 30 36 40 46 55 65 80 100 124

6 8 10 10 12 12 16 16 20 25

M3 M4 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M12

3,7 4,7 5,8 5,8 5,8 5,8 6,8 9 9 11

5,6 7,5 9 9 9 9 11 14 14 17,2

3,7 5,8 5,8 -

5,6 9 9 -

19 22 24,5 27 30,5 37,5 46 55 69

4,7 7 7 9 9 9,5 12,5 15 14 17,5

5 5,2 6 -

G

H3

I1

M5 5,5 M5 8 M5 8 G 1/8 10,5 G 1/8 11,5 36 G 1/8 11 42 G 1/8 11,5 50 G 1/8 11 62 G 1/4 14 82 G 1/4 16 103

I2

I3

18 20 26 32 42 50 62 82 103

12 15 15,5 -

I5

I6

20 10 25,5 12,7 28 14 -

K

L

L1

M

N

P

5 6 8 8 10 10 13 13 17 22

3,5 4,6 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 6,8 8,8 9 11

3,5 5,7 5,7 -

4,7 4 5,7 4,5 4 4 4 5 6 7,5

32 38,5 42 48 55 65 80 100 124

6 8 10 10 12 12 12 14 15 20

W

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 3,5 33,5 11,5 4,5 74 16,5 5 106 24,5 5,5 145 32 6 172 36 6 225 40 7,5 359 63 7 552 70 8 1072 105 10 1920 160

“H” DIMENSION Ø 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

4 36 36 -

5 32 37 37 43,5 44,5 44,5 -

STROKE (mm) 10 15 20 37 42 47 52 42 47 52 48,5 53,5 58,5 49,5 54,5 59,5 49,5 54,5 59,5 49,5 54,5 59,5 52 57 62 56 61 66 66 71 76

25 63 63 64,5 64,5 64,5 64,5 67 71 81

30 69,5 69,5 69,5 72 76 86

Cylinders series B

1.61


B

Compact cylinders

series

DOUBLE ACTING MAGNETIC

1

Ø 12

Ø 16 ÷ 25

Ø 32 ÷100

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

A

B

12 25 25 16 34 30 20 40 36 25 44,5 40 32 51 46 40 58 55 50 70 65 63 86 80 80 105 100 100 131 124

D

D1

D2

D3

D4

D7

D8

6 8 10 10 12 12 16 16 20 25

M3 M4 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M12

24,5 28 34 38,5 44 56

3,7 4,7 5,8 5,8 5,8 5,8 6,8 9 9 11

5,6 7,5 9 9 9 9 11 14 14 17,2

3,7 5,8 5,8 -

5,6 9 9 -

E

F

4,7 19 7 22 7 24,5 9 27 9 30,5 9,5 37,5 12,5 46 15 55 14 69 17,5

F1

G

5 5,2 6 -

M5 M5 M5 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4

H3

I1

5,5 8 8 10,5 11,5 36 11 42 11,5 50 11 62 14 82 16 103

I2

I3

I5

I6

18 12 20 10 20 15 25,5 12,7 26 15,5 28 14 32 42 50 62 82 103 -

K

L

L1

M

5 6 8 8 10 10 13 13 17 22

3,5 4,6 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 6,8 8,8 9 11

3,5 5,7 5,7 -

4,7 4 32 5,7 38,5 4,5 42 4 48 4 55 4 65 5 80 6 100 7,5 124

“H” DIMENSION Ø 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

1.62

5 32 37 37 43,5 44,5 44,5 -

10 37 42 42 48,5 49,5 49,5 49,5 52 56 66

15 42 47 47 53,5 54,5 54,5 54,5 57 61 71

20 47 52 52 58,5 59,5 59,5 59,5 62 66 76

25 52 63 63 64,5 64,5 64,5 64,5 67 71 81

30 57 68 68 69,5 69,5 69,5 69,5 72 76 86

STROKE (mm) 40 50 60 78 88 98 78 88 98 79,5 89,5 99,5 79,5 89,5 99,5 79,5 89,5 99,5 79,5 89,5 99,5 82 92 102 86 96 106 96 106 116

80 118 118 119,5 119,5 119,5 119,5 122 126 136

100 138 138 139,5 139,5 139,5 139,5 142 146 156

125 163 164,5 164,5 164,5 164,5 167 171 181

Cylinders series B

160 199,5 199,5 199,5 202 206 216

200 239,5 242 246 256

250 296 306

N

P

S

W

6 8 10 10 12 12 12 14 15 20

5 6 6 7 8 10

3,5 4,5 5 5,5 11 12,5 13,5 15 18 20,5

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 33,5 11,5 74 16,5 106 24,5 145 32 172 36 225 40 359 63 552 70 1072 105 1920 160


B

Compact cylinders

series

SINGLE ACTING, EXTENDED ROD AND SINGLE ACTING MAGNETIC, EXTENDED ROD

1

Ø 12

Ø 16 ÷ 25

Ø 32 ÷100

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

A

B

D

D1

D2

D3

D4

D7

D8

12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63

25 34 40 44,5 51 58 70 86

25 30 36 40 46 55 65 80

6 8 10 10 12 12 16 16

M3 M4 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8

24,5 28 34 38,5

3,7 4,7 5,8 5,8 5,8 5,8 6,8 9

5,6 7,5 9 9 9 9 11 14

3,7 5,8 5,8 -

5,6 9 9 -

E

F

4,7 19 7 22 7 24,5 9 27 9 30,5 9,5 37,5 12,5 46 15

F1 5 5,2 6 -

G

H3

I1

I2

M5 5,5 M5 8 M5 8 G 1/8 10,5 G 1/8 11,5 G 1/8 11 G 1/8 11,5 G 1/8 11

36 42 50 62

18 20 26 32 42 50 62

I3

I5

I6

K

5 12 20 10 6 15 25,5 12,7 8 15,5 28 14 8 10 10 13 13 -

L

L1

M

N

P

S

3,5 4,6 3,5 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 6,8 8,8 -

4,7 4 5,7 4,5 4 4 4 5

32 38,5 42 48 55 65 80

6 8 10 10 12 12 12 14

5 6 6 8

W

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 3,5 33,5 11,5 4,5 74 16,5 4,5 106 24,5 5,5 145 32 11 172 36 12,5 225 40 13,5 359 63 15 552 70

“H” DIMENSION Ø 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63

12 magn 16 magn 20 magn 25 magn 32 magn 40 magn 50 magn 63 magn

5 22 32 37 37 43,5 44,5 -

STROKE (mm) 10 15 20 27 37 42 47 42 47 63 48,5 53,5 64,5 49,5 54,5 64,5 49,5 54,5 59,5 49,5 54,5 59,5 52 57 62

25 68 69,5 69,5 64,5 64,5 67

30 79,5 69,5 69,5 72

Cylinders series B

1.63


B

Compact cylinders

series

DOUBLE ACTING, THROUGH ROD AND DOUBLE ACTING MAGNETIC, THROUGH ROD

1

Ø 16 ÷ 25

Ø 32 ÷100

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

A

B

D

D1

D2

D3

D4

D7

D8

E

16 34 30 8 20 40 36 10 25 44,5 40 10 32 51 46 12 40 58 55 12 50 70 65 16 63 86 80 16 80 105 100 20 100 131 124 25

M4 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M12

24,5 28 34 38,5 44 56

4,7 7,5 5,8 9 5,8 9 5,8 9 5,8 9 6,8 11 9 14 9 14 11 17,2

3,7 5,8 5,8 -

5,6 9 9 -

19 22 24,5 27 30,5 37,5 46 55 69

F

F1

7 5 7 5,2 9 6 9 9,5 12,5 15 14 17,5 -

G

H3

M5 M5 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4

8 8 10,5 11,5 11 11,5 11 14 16

I1

I2

I3

I5

I6

K

18 12 20 10 6 20 15 25,5 12,7 8 26 15,5 28 14 8 36 32 - 10 42 42 - 10 50 50 - 13 62 62 - 13 82 82 - 17 103 103 - 22

L

L1

M

4,6 5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 6,8 8,8 9 11

3,5 5,7 5,7 -

4 32 8 5,7 38,5 10 4,5 42 10 4 48 12 4 55 12 4 65 12 5 80 14 6 100 15 7,5 124 20

“H” DIMENSION Ø 16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

1.64

5 37 37 43,5 44,5 44,5 -

10 42 42 48,5 49,5 49,5 49,5 52 56 66

15 47 47 53,5 54,5 54,5 54,5 57 61 71

20 52 52 58,5 59,5 59,5 59,5 62 66 76

25 63 63 64,5 64,5 64,5 64,5 67 71 81

30 68 68 69,5 69,5 69,5 69,5 72 76 86

STROKE (mm) 40 50 60 78 88 98 78 88 98 79,5 89,5 99,5 79,5 89,5 99,5 79,5 89,5 99,5 79,5 89,5 99,5 82 92 102 86 96 106 96 106 116

80 118 118 119,5 119,5 119,5 119,5 122 126 136

100 138 138 139,5 139,5 139,5 139,5 142 146 156

125 163 164,5 164,5 164,5 164,5 167 171 181

Cylinders series B

160 199,5 199,5 199,5 202 206 216

200 239,5 242 246 256

250 296 306

N

P

S

W

4,5 4,5 5,5 5 11 6 12,5 6 13,5 8 15 10 18 10,5 20,5

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x 10 mm 130 19 150 28 185 35,5 282 39,5 366 43,5 521 68 717 75 1434 114 2435 174


B

Compact cylinders

series

NON ROTATING DOUBLE ACTING AND NON ROTATING DOUBLE ACTING MAGNETIC

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

A

B

20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

40 44,5 51 58 70 86 105 131

36 40 46 55 65 80 100 124

45° 45° 41,5° 45° 45° 45° 45° 45°

D

D2

D3

D4

D5

D6

E

F

G

H3

I1

I2

I4

L

M

N

S

S1

T

10 10 12 12 16 16 20 25

24,5 28 34 38,5 44 56

5,8 5,8 5,8 5,8 6,8 9 9 11

9,2 9,2 9,2 9,2 11 14 14 17,2

M4 M4 M5 M5 M6 M6 M8 M10

11 11 17 17 22 22 28 30

22 24,5 27 30,5 37,5 46 55 69

9,3 10,5 9 9,5 12,5 15 14 17,5

M5 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4

8 11 11,5 11,5 11,5 12 14 16

25,5 28 36 42 50 62 82 103

25,5 28 32 42 50 62 82 103

20 22 28 33 42 50 65 80

5,7 5,7 5,7 5,7 6,8 8,8 9 11

5,7 4,5 4 4 4 5 6 7,5

38,5 42 48 55 65 80 100 124

5 6 6 8 10 10,5

8 8 10 10 12 12 14 14

15 15 20 20 30 30 50 50

15 47 53,5 54,5 54,5 54,5 57 61 71

20 52 58,5 59,5 59,5 59,5 62 66 76

H5

Z

B1

12 16 16 20 24 24 32 32 40

7 9 9 14 16 17 22 22 26

14 18 18 23 27 27 35 35 43

W

WEIGHT (g) 4,5 150 5,5 185 11 282 12,5 366 13,5 521 15 717 18 1434 20,5 2435

INCR. (g) x10 mm 28 35,5 39,5 43,5 68 75 114 174

“H” DIMENSION Ø 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

5 37 43,5 44,5 44,5 -

10 42 48,5 49,5 49,5 49,5 52 56 66

MALE HINGE MOUNTING

25 63 64,5 64,5 64,5 64,5 67 71 81

STROKE (mm) 30 40 50 68 78 88 69,5 79,5 89,5 69,5 79,5 89,5 69,5 79,5 89,5 69,5 79,5 89,5 72 82 92 76 86 96 86 96 106

60 98 99,5 99,5 99,5 99,5 102 106 116

80 118 119,5 119,5 119,5 119,5 122 126 136

100 138 139,5 139,5 139,5 139,5 142 146 156

125 164,5 167 171 181

160 202 206 216

DIMENSIONS Ø

A1

B

16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

8 10 10 13 15 15 19 19 23

6 8 8 10 12 12 16 16 20

Cylinders series B

E2 H8 6 8 8 10 12 12 16 16 20

1.65


B

Accessories Fixings

series

FEET (pair) - ALUMINIUM - B/PB Ø

1

Ø

A2

B2

C

D9

E1

F2

I6

16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

5 5 6 6 6 7,5 7,5 10 10

10 10 12 12 12 15 15 20 20

10 10 12 12 12 15 15 20 20

3,5 3,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 6,5 8,5 8,5 10,5

17 18 20 24 27,5 32,5 40 50 62

5 5 7,5 5 5 5 7,5 20 22

30 40 45 50 60 70 85 60 80

Ø

L2

M1

N1

R

16 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100

H*+10 H*+10 H*+12 H*+12 H*+12 H*+15 H*+15 H*+20 H*+20

2,4 4 4 4 4 5 6,5 6,5 8

40 50 60 60 70 80 100 100 124

M3 M5 M5 M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10

WEIGHT (g) 10 10,1 20,4 20,4 24,7 44,7 53 99 120

*DIMENSION “H” IS OBTAINABLE FROM THE TABLES OF THE SINGLE VERSION

ROD NIPPLE WITH THREAD TO ISO STANDARD - STEEL - NB Ø Ø 12 16 20-25 32-40 50-63 G50-63 80 100

1.66

D

D1

M6 M3 M6 M4 M8 M5 M10x1,25 M6 M12x1,25 M8 M16x1,5 M8 M16x1,5 M10 M20x1,5 M12

A

B

C

16 15 20 22 24 32 32 40

6,5 8 10 12 14 14 15 20

22,5 23 30 34 38 46 47 60

WEIGHT (g) 3 3,2 7,2 13,1 23 47,6 50,5 101

Cylinders series B


BG

Compact guided cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION Compact guided cylinders series “BG” have reduced dimensions and high precision movement. These cylinders assure great strenght to transversal forces thanks to stout bars guided on bushings or sleeves. Cylinders series “BG” are double acting and they have the magnetic piston type and the steel plate as standard, so they can be supplied with magnetic sensors.

1÷10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Ø 16, 20, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63 Ø 16 = M 5 Ø 20 ÷ 40 = G 1/8 Ø 50 = G 1/4 Ø 16 = 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 75, 100 Ø 20 = 20, 30, 40, 50, 75, 100, 125, 150, 175, 200 Ø 25 = 20, 25, 30, 40, 50, 75, 100, 125, 150, 175, 200 Ø 32 ÷ 63 = 25, 50, 75, 100, 125, 150, 175, 200

Standard strokes (mm)

MATERIALS End caps Body Piston rod

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Bore Port size

1 Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy Ø 16 ÷ 25 : AISI 303 stainless steel Ø 32 ÷ 63 : C45 chromium-plated steel Aluminium alloy with magnet C45 chromium-plated steel (bushings sliding type) Hardened steel (recirculating ball bearing sleeves sliding type) Nickel-plated steel Anodized aluminium alloy Self-lubricating sintered bronze with wiper ring No.2 pcs. for strokes 20 ÷ 50 mm; No.4 pcs. for strokes 75 ÷ 200 mm Recirculating ball bearings with wiper ring No.2 pcs. for strokes 20 ÷ 50 mm; No.4 pcs. for strokes 75 ÷ 200 mm Polyurethane

Piston Guide bars Plate Bushings Sleeves Seals

ORDER KEY VERSION

S•

BG

/

D

Double acting

SLIDING TYPE

B

On bushing

M

With sleeves

D L

Double steel plate

OPTION

Bore

Single steel plate

Stroke

S

Version

Single aluminium plate

Double aluminium plate

ORDER EXAMPLE Cylinder Ø 50, double acting, 50 mm stroke, with sleeves, double steel plate 50/50 DBGMD

Series Sliding type Option Special options (supplied upon request)

SPARE PARTS

P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93)

SEALS KIT

• See technical data on page 0.12

Polyurethane

Ø/SG/BG

TECHNICAL DATA

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE TRANSVERSE FORCE F (N) Ø 16 20 25 32 40 50 63

Sliding type B M B M B M B M B M B M B M

10 41 44 -

20 32 34 53 62 93 94 -

25 168 84 168 92 240 117 250 117

STROKE (mm) 30 40 26 23 27 23 45 38 50 42 78 68 79 68 -

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE TORQUE M (Nm) Ø

50 20 21 34 36 60 60 131 58 131 64 189 81 190 81

75 27 27 52 53 81 59 163 270 163 270 243 370 265 370

100 22 22 42 44 67 51 138 213 138 213 208 312 227 312

16 20 25 32 40 50 63

Sliding type B M B M B M B M B M B M B M

10 0,65 0,83 -

20 0,51 0,65 0,99 1,20 1,98 2,00 -

Cylinders series BG

STROKE (mm) 25 30 40 50 0,42 0,36 0,32 0,52 0,44 0,40 0,84 0,71 0,64 0,96 0,81 0,69 1,67 1,45 1,28 1,69 1,45 1,28 4,10 3,19 2,04 1,41 4,51 3,51 2,47 1,72 6,60 5,19 3,22 2,22 6,60 5,19 3,22 2,22

75 0,97 1,02 1,73 1,26 3,97 6,58 4,38 7,25 6,68 10,17 6,68 10,17

ANTI-ROLL ACCURACY 100 0,78 0,85 1,43 1,09 3,36 5,19 3,70 5,72 5,72 8,58 5,72 8,58

Ø 16 20 25 32 40 50 63

Sliding type B M ±0,08° ±0,10° ±0,07° ±0,09° ±0,07° ±0,09° ±0,06° ±0,08° ±0,06° ±0,08° ±0,05° ±0,06° ±0,05° ±0,06°

B - Bushing M - Sleeves

1.67


BG

Compact guided cylinders

series

BG COMPACT GUIDED CYLINDER

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A (STROKES mm)

16 46 (10 ÷ 50) 20 53 (20 ÷ 50) 25 53,5 (20 ÷ 50) 32 97 (25 ÷ 50) 40 97 (25 ÷ 50) 50 106,5 (25 ÷ 50)* 63 106,5 (25 ÷ 50)*

64,5 (75 ÷ 100) 84,5 (75 ÷ 200) 84,5 (75 ÷ 200) 107 (75 ÷ 200) 107 (75 ÷ 200) 118 (75 ÷ 200) 118 (75 ÷ 200)

Ø

PW

Q

S

T

16 20 25 32 40 50 63

19 20,5 28,5 34 28,5 47 55

16 54 18 70 26 78 30 96 30 104 40 130 50 130

25 30 38 44 44 60 70

62 81 91 110 118 146 158

R

U

B

C

DA

DB

46 53 54 60 66 72 77

33 37 37,5 37,5 44 44 49

8 10 10 12 12 16 16

10 12 16 20 20 25 25

V

E (STROKES mm) 0 (10 ÷ 50) 0 (20 ÷ 50) 0 (20 ÷ 50) 37,5 (25 ÷ 50) 31 (25 ÷ 50) 34,5 (25 ÷ 50)* 29,5 (25 ÷ 50)*

18,5 (75 ÷ 100) 31,5 (75 ÷ 200) 31,5 (75 ÷ 200) 42,5 (75 ÷ 200) 36 (75 ÷ 200) 46 (75 ÷ 200) 41 (75 ÷ 200)

W (STROKES mm)

46 56 24 (10 ÷ 30) 54 72 24 (20 - 30) 64 82 24 (20 - 30) 78 98 24 (25) 86 106 24 (25) 110 130 24 (25) 124 142 28 (25)

44 (40 ÷ 100) 44 (40 ÷ 100) 44 (40 ÷ 100) 48 (50 ÷ 100) 48 (50 ÷ 100) 48 (50 ÷ 100) 52 (50 ÷ 100)

F

120 (125 ÷ 200) 120 (125 ÷ 200) 124 (125 ÷ 200) 124 (125 ÷ 200) 124 (125 ÷ 200) 128 (125 ÷ 200)

8 10 10 12 12 16 16

GA

GB

GC

11 8 8 10,5 8,5 24,5 11,5 9 25 12,5 9 30,5 14 10 31 14 11 35 16,5 13,5 35

Ø

A

B

C

D

CH

16 20 - 25 32 - 40 50 - 63

7 8 10 13

10 15 20 25

M4 M5 M6 M8

3,5 4 5 7

1,5 2 2,5 3

1.68

J

64 5 83 7,5 93 7,5 112 9 120 9 148 10,5 162 11

L

K

MM

ML

NN

P

22 24 30 34 40 46 58

30 36 42 48 54 64 78

M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

12 13 15 20 20 22 22

M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 *

WEIGHT (g) for STROKES (mm) with aluminium plate

X

YE YH

YI

YL YY

Z

24 28 34 42 50 66 80

8 9,5 9,5 11 11 14 14

4,3 5,6 5,6 6,6 6,6 8,6 8,6

10 12 12 16 16 20 20

10 20 25 30 40 50 75 100 5 300 350 400 450 500 700 850 17 - 640 720 800 880 1200 1400 17 - 850 950 1050 1150 1600 1850 21 - 1500 1850 2500 2850 22 - 1700 2100 2650 3050 22 - 2700 3300 4100 4700 24 - 3100 4218 4936 5655

4,5 5,5 5,5 7,5 7,5 9 9

M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

* With sleeves: dimension “A” (stroke 50) = 114 for Ø 50 and 63; dimension “E” (stroke 50) = 42 for Ø 50 and 37 for Ø 63

SLOTS FIXING PLATE - STEEL - BG/PF Ø

H

FIXING EXAMPLE

WEIGHT (g) 2 3,5 7,5 17

Cylinders series BG


HB

Screwed-head cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION Cylinders series “HB” are manufactured to be fixed on machine edges without the use of mountings. The end cap acts as a mounting device in the versions: hinge-mounted, screw-mounted, feet-mounted, front flange-mounted, rear flange-mounted. The double acting hinge-mounted versions and rear flange-mounted are available with reduced end caps. Cylinders series “HB” cannot be supplied with magnetic sensors.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature

1,5 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) 0 ÷ +150 °C with seals for high temperatures (-20 °C with dry air) Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Versions Double acting; Single acting front spring; Single acting rear spring; Through rod Bore Ø 20, 27, 35, 40, 50, 58, 70, 85, 100 Port size Ø 20 ÷ 50 = G 1/8 Ø 58 ÷ 100 = G 1/4 Standard strokes (mm) 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 150, 200, 250 Max. strokes double acting (mm) Ø 20 - 27 = 1000; Ø 35 ÷ 50 = 1500; Ø 58 ÷ 100 = 2000 Maximum strokes Ø 20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100 single acting mm 20 25 35 60 70 60 70 90 100 Maximum strokes single acting Ø 20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100 (version “S”) with spacers mm 60 75 105 180 210 180 210 270 300

SPRING THEORETICAL TRACTIVE FORCE

MATERIALS

Piston rod End cap nut Piston rod bearing Piston guide shoe Piston Seals Springs

Aluminium alloy Ø 20 ÷ 100: Extruded tube, anodized aluminium alloy; Extruded tube, brass (supplied upon request) C45 chromium-plated steel AISI 303 rolled stainless steel Steel Bronze-iron 20%, sintered, self-lubricating Acetal resin Aluminium alloy NBR rubber Viton® Springs steel

Spring tractive force (N)

End caps Cylinder barrel

Stroke (mm)

ORDER KEY S•

VERSION 1

/

Basic cylinder

R

Through rod*

Y

Single acting front spring**

VERSION 2

D S

Bore Version 1 Stroke

Double acting Single acting front spring

SERIES

CB Hinge-mounted VB Screw-mounted PB Feet-mounted

Version 2 Series Option 1

FAB Front flange-mounted FPB Rear flange-mounted

OPTION 1

Option 2

C

Option 3

Reduced end cap***

OPTION 2

Option 4

1 2

Special options (supplied upon request)

Stainless steel piston rod Seals for high temperatures

3

Stainless steel piston rod and seals for high temperatures

OPTION 3

• See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Basic cylinder Ø27, 25 mm stroke, single acting front spring, feet-mounted 27/25 SPB Cylinder Ø20, through rod, 100 mm stroke, double acting, feet-mounted 20R100 DPB Basic cylinder Ø58, 50 mm stroke, double acting, hinge-mounted, stainless steel piston rod, brass cylinder barrel 58/50 DVB 1 4 Basic cylinder Ø35, 70 mm stroke, double acting, hinge-mounted, reduced end cap 35/70 DCBC

4

Brass cylinder barrel

OPTION 4

5

Rod wipers

* Series “FPB” excluded ** Dimensions are different from the versions “D” and “S” *** Supplied only with series “DCB”, “YCB”, “DFPB”, “YFPB” and with the version “R” of series “DFAB” and “DVB”

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT NBR

Ø/SG/HB

Through rod, NBR

Ø/SG/R/HB Through rod, for high temperatures Ø/SG/R/HB2

Cylinders series HB

For high temperatures

Ø/SG/HB2

1.69


HB

Screwed-head cylinders

series

BASIC CYLINDER HINGE-MOUNTED - CB H + STROKE

1

REDUCED END CAP H2 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER CB Ø

D

D1

E

F1

H

H2

I

J H8

K1 0/+0,2

K2 0/-0,2

L

M

N

Q1

Q3

R

S

Y

Y2

20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

M6 M8 M10 M10 M12 M14 M16 M18 M20

9 12 15 15 18 21 24 27 30

3 4 4 4 5 5 5 6 6

85 96 106 121 130 140 151 168 191

72 76 84 90 101 110 122 128 142

10 21 23 26 28 33 35 36 45

5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20

8 9 12 18 25 26 35 40 40

22 25 32 40 49 54 67 76 80

30 35 45 50 61 70 82 98 114

16 20 24 32 32 32 35 44,5 50

6 7 9 10 12 14 16 18 20

24 30 36 44 46 48 53 64,5 74

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

24 28 32 36 42 45 50 60 70

10 9,5 9,5 10 10 12 14 12,5 14

11,5 11,5 10 10 10 14 16 14 19

WEIGHT INCREM. (g) (g) every 10 mm

ACCESSORIES PIVOT FOR FEMALE REAR HINGE - STEEL - HB/SEC Ø Ø

BU

20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100

28 31 38 47 56 62 75 84 88

1.70

EK f7 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20

EL 23 26 33 41 50 55 68 77 81

WEIGHT (g) 4,5 7 15 29 50 76 118 168 217

Cylinders series HB

200 289 396 503 793 1181 1474 2033 3250

15 20 32 35 44 53 64 89 110


HB

Screwed-head cylinders

series

BASIC CYLINDER SCREW-MOUNTED - VB

F3 + STROKE

1

P.S.: End cap nut (HB/DT Ø) supplied as standard. Contact the commercial office for further nuts.

THROUGH ROD H1 + STROKE

Q1 + STROKE

P.S.: End cap nut (HB/DT Ø) supplied as standard. Contact the commercial office for further nuts.

THROUGH ROD, REDUCED END CAP

H3 + STROKE

Q3 + STROKE

P.S.: End cap nut (HB/DT Ø) supplied as standard. Contact the commercial office for further nuts.

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER VB Ø

B2

CH2

D

D1

E

F1

F3

H1

H3

I2

L

M

Q1

Q3

R

S

S5

20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100

5 6 7 8 10 10 10 12 14

32 35 40 45 50 55 60 70 85

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

M6 M8 M10 M10 M12 M14 M16 M18 M20

9 12 15 15 18 21 24 27 30

3 4 4 4 5 5 5 6 6

41 45,5 47,5 51 56 59 63 67,5 72

58 60,5 61,5 68 70 75 80 84 89

61 62,5 63,5 69 73 77 86 88,5 90

3,5 3,5 3,5 3 3 4 4 4 4

30 35 45 50 61 70 82 98 114

16 20 24 32 32 32 35 44,5 50

24 30 36 44 46 48 53 64,5 74

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

24 28 32 36 42 45 50 60 70

14 14 18 24 26 30 30 40 40

S7

Y

Y2

WEIGHT INCREM. (g) (g) every 10 mm

Cylinders series HB

M24x2 10 M28x2 9,5 M32x2 9,5 M36x3 10 M42x3 10 M45x3 12 M50x3 14 M60x4 12,5 M70x4 14

11,5 11,5 10 10 10 14 16 14 19

129 160 299,5 416 691 1028 1388 2024 3060

15 20 32 35 44 53 64 89 110

1.71


HB

Screwed-head cylinders

series

BASIC CYLINDER FEET-MOUNTED - PB

1 N° 4 HOLES F4 W3 + STROKE W4 + STROKE

THROUGH ROD W4 + 2STROKE

W3 + STROKE W4 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER PB Ø

A

D

D1

E

F1

F4

G

L1

N2

Q2

R

S1

W3

W4

WEIGHT (g)

20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100

42 45 57 64 77 86 100 118 136

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

M6 M8 M10 M10 M12 M14 M16 M18 M20

9 12 15 15 18 21 24 27 30

3 4 4 4 5 5 5 6 6

4,25 4,5 5,5 5,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 8,5 8,5

17 19,5 22,5 25 30,5 35 41 49 57

52 55 69 78 93 102 118 138 158

13 17 17 22 22 25 26 27 28

36 40 44 56 54 56 61 72 76

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

8 10 12 14 16 16 18 20 22

18 20 21 20 26 27 28 30 33

62 70 77 88 94 99 107 122 133

181 269 359 502 743 996 1363 2043 3019

1.72

Cylinders series HB

INCREMENT (g) every 10 mm 15 20 32 35 44 53 64 89 110


HB

Screwed-head cylinders

series

BASIC CYLINDER FRONT FLANGE-MOUNTED - FAB W1 + STROKE

1

N° 4 HOLES F

THROUGH ROD W2 + STROKE

Q1 + STROKE

THROUGH ROD, REDUCED END CAP Q3 + STROKE

W5 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER - FAB Ø

D

D1

E

F

F1

I

I2

L

M

O

P

Q

Q1

Q3

R

S

S2

S3

S5

20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

M6 M8 M10 M10 M12 M14 M16 M18 M20

9 12 15 15 18 21 24 27 30

4,2 4,5 5,5 6,5 6,5 6,5 8,5 10,5 10,5

3 4 4 4 5 5 5 6 6

2 2 2 3 3 3 4 4 4

3,5 3,5 3,5 3 3 4 4 4 4

30 35 45 50 61 70 82 98 114

16 20 24 32 32 32 35 44,5 50

39 48 54 57 75 82 100 120 137

50 58 66 69 87 100 119 140 160

10 12 14 15 17 19 22 24 28

24 30 36 44 46 48 53 64,5 74

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

24 28 32 36 42 45 50 60 70

23 30 36 40 54 60 70 80 88

4 6 6 7 7 8 10 11 12

14 55 72 14 63,5 78,5 18 69,5 83,5 24 80 97 26 85 99 30 88 104 30 94 111 40 103 119,5 40 118 135

W1

W2

W5

Y

Y2

WEIGHT INCREM. (g) (g) every 10 mm

Cylinders series HB

75 10 11,5 80,5 9,5 11,5 85,5 9,5 10 98 10 10 102 10 10 106 12 14 117 14 16 124 12,5 14 136 14 19

91 178 317 427 689 915 1244 2113 3200

15 20 32 35 44 53 64 89 110

1.73


HB

Screwed-head cylinders

series

BASIC CYLINDER REAR FLANGE-MOUNTED - FPB F2 + STROKE

1

N° 4 HOLES F6

REDUCED END CAP F5 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS BASIC CYLINDER FPB Ø

D

D1

E

F1

F2

F5

F6

I1

L

M

O

P

Q1

Q3

R

S

S4

S6

Y

20 27 35 40 50 58 70 85 100

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

M6 M8 M10 M10 M12 M14 M16 M18 M20

9 12 15 15 18 21 24 27 30

3 4 4 4 5 5 5 6 6

78 89 97 109 113 122 131 147 164

65 69 75 78 84 92 102 107 115

4,2 4,5 5,5 5,5 6,5 8,5 8,5 10,5 10,5

2 2 2 3 3 3 4 4 4

30 35 45 50 61 70 82 98 114

16 20 24 32 32 32 35 44,5 50

39 48 59 62 75 86 100 120 137

50 58 69 74 87 100 119 140 160

24 30 36 44 46 48 53 64,5 74

8 10 12 12 14 16 18 20 24

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

24 28 32 36 42 45 50 60 70

23 30 38 40 50 62 72 80 88

18 19 19 21 21 24 22 25 28

10 9,5 9,5 10 10 12 14 12,5 14

1.74

Cylinders series HB

Y1

Y2

11 11,5 11,5 11,5 11,5 10 13,5 10 13,5 10 15 14 15 16 16,5 14 18 19

WEIGHT (g) 91 178 317 427 689 915 1244 2113 3200

INCREM. (g) every 10 mm 15 20 32 35 44 53 64 89 110


Z

Rodless cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION Rodless cylinders series “Z” are suitable for applications where long strokes are required, as they have been designed with reduced overall dimensions if compared to the standard cylinders with external rod. The short cylinder (version “K”) has a basic length (0-stroke) up to 40% shorter than the “S” standard version. The guided versions (options “F” & “FF”) allow the translation of non-guided loads and offer great resistance to transversal forces. Cylinders series “Z” have the magnetic piston type as standard and so they can be supplied with magnetic sensors.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Versions Bore Port size

2 ÷ 8 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Standard yoke; Short yoke Ø 18, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63 Ø 18 = M 5 Ø 25 - 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 = G 3/8 Decelerators length Ø 18 25 32 40 50 63 mm 15 18 24 34 40 49 Maximum strokes (mm) Ø 18 ÷ 63 = 6000

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Sealing strip Cover strip Head wiper Piston Yoke Decelerators ogives Seals

Anodized aluminium alloy Extruded profile, anodized aluminium alloy Polyamide AISI 304 stainless steel Acetal resin Aluminium alloy with piston seal in acetal resin Anodized aluminium alloy Brass Polyurethane

ORDER KEY /

Z

S•

VERSION

S

Standard yoke

K

Short yoke

FF

Double guide*

2

Bottom ported**

OPTION 1

F

Single guide

OPTION 2

1

One side ported**

** Supplied only for “S” version ** Supplied from Ø 25 to Ø 63

Bore Stroke Series Version Option 1 Option 2 Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM 101 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Rodless cylinder Ø50, 500 mm stroke, with standard yoke and ports 50/500 ZS Rodless cylinder Ø50, 1000 mm stroke, short yoke, single guide, one side ports 50/1000 ZKF1

SPARE PARTS Seals kit - Polyurethane

Ø/SG/Z

Sealing strip (min. 500 mm)

Ø/BP/Z/mm

Cover strip (min. 500 mm)

Ø/BM/Z/mm

Cylinders series Z

1.75


Z

Rodless cylinders

series

TECHNICAL INFORMATION

Ø 18 25 32 40 50 63

ZS 140 270 440 680 1060 1680

F x in (N) a 6 bar - speed ZK ZSF 140 140 270 270 440 440 680 680 1060 1060 1680 1680

0,35 m/s ZSFF 140 270 440 680 1060 1680

ZKF 140 270 440 680 1060 1680

ZS 300 480 650 800 1060 1680

F z in (N) - speed 0,35 m/s ZK ZSF ZSFF 140 370 550 230 800 1200 320 1200 1800 400 1600 2400 480 2100 3200 590 2800 4200

ZKF 150 250 450 600 900 1100

ZS 80 110 165 225 325 435

F y in (N) - speed 0,35 m/s ZK ZSF ZSFF 40 370 550 55 800 1200 70 1200 1800 100 1600 2400 140 2100 3200 180 2800 4200

ZKF 150 250 450 600 900 1100

Resultant Force Ft (N) Speed = 0,75 m/s

Ø 18 25 32 40 50 63

ZS 80 155 280 500 790 1500

ZK 40 90 200 420 750 1500

ZSF 100 280 510 1000 1500 2500

N.B.: ∑ F = Resultant force = Ft = √F

Speed = 1 m/s

ZSFF 150 420 750 1500 2200 3700

ZKF 50 100 250 480 800 1500

Speed = 1,5 m/s

ZS 40 90 155 290 420 850

ZK 25 50 110 240 440 850

ZSF 58 160 300 550 850 1400

ZSFF 80 210 400 750 1150 1900

ZKF 30 60 135 280 480 950

ZS 20 40 70 125 195 370

ZK 10 25 45 110 190 380

ZSF 26 65 140 250 380 610

ZSFF 20 80 170 300 460 740

ZKF 12 30 65 140 220 400

ZS 3 13 25 40 65 100

ZK 1,7 2,7 5 8,5 13 18

M z in (Nm) ZSF 6 20 45 75 150 250

ZSFF 9 30 67 110 220 370

ZKF 1,8 4 10 16 30 45

ZS 3 13 25 40 65 100

ZK 1,7 2,7 5 8,5 13 18

M y in (Nm) ZSF 6 20 45 75 150 250

ZSFF 9 30 67 110 220 370

ZKF 1,8 4 10 16 30 45

x2 + F z2 + F y2

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE TORQUE

Ø 18 25 32 40 50 63

ZS 1 2 3,5 5,5 10 16

ZK 0,4 0,7 1 2 3,5 5

M x in (Nm) ZSF 3,5 10 25 40 80 110

ZSFF 5,2 15 37 60 120 170

ZKF 1,8 4 10 16 30 45

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE FORCE “Fz” (as a function of the distance “L” between supports and of the deflection request)

Fz (N) at deflection of 1 mm

Fz (N) at deflection of 0,5 mm

1

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE FORCES

Distance L (mm)

1.76

Cylinders series Z

Distance L (mm)


Z

Rodless cylinders

series

ZS BASIC CYLINDER WITH STANDARD YOKE 2A + STROKE

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS ZS BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A

AF

AM

18 25 32 40 50 63

80 100 120 150 180 215

50 70 100 140 180 230

10 13 16 22 29 40

B

C

16,5 6,5 20 8,5 20 8,5 24 11 24 11 30 14,5

CA

CB

D

7 7 9,5 9,5 11

13 13 14,5 14,5 18,5

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

DA

DB

17,5 25,5 14 32 17,5 37,5 20 47,5 26 59,5 30

DC

DD

E

15 103 28 21 131 34,5 26 171 42 31,5 220 52 39 280 62 46,5 333

F

G

J

M

N

O

S

T

U

75 100 140 180 220 280

50 70 90 110 140

3 3,5 4,5 5 6,5 8

15,5 20 25 33 42 54

M3x6 M4x7 M5x9 M6x10 M8x12,5 M8x15

3,5 4,5 5,5 7 7 9

23,5 33 41 51 63 78

M3x7 M4x9 M5x10 M6x12 M8x12 M8x12

30 42 52 63 78 93

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 39 300 15 53 600 26 65 1100 36 79 1800 48 96 3200 74 113,5 5600 100 W

ZK BASIC CYLINDER WITH SHORT YOKE 2A + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS ZK BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A

AM

B

C

CA

CB

D

DA

DB

DC

DD

E

F

J

M

N

O

S

T

U

18 25 32 40 50 63

57,5 67,5 77,5 95 105 125

10 13 16 22 29 40

16,5 20 20 24 24 30

6,5 8,5 8,5 11 11 14,5

7 7 9,5 9,5 11

13 13 14,5 14,5 18,5

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

17,5 25,5 32 37,5 47,5 59,5

14 17,5 20 26 30

28 34,5 42 52 62

15 21 26 31,5 39 46,5

58 66 86 110 130 153

30 35 55 70 70 100

3 3,5 4,5 5 6,5 8

15,5 20 25 33 42 54

M3x6 M4x7 M5x9 M6x10 M8x12,5 M8x15

3,5 4,5 5,5 7 7 9

23,5 33 41 51 63 78

M3x7 M4x9 M5x10 M6x12 M8x12 M8x12

30 42 52 63 78 93

Cylinders series Z

W

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 39 200 15 53 400 26 65 700 36 79 1200 48 96 2000 74 113,5 3200 100

1.77


Z

Rodless cylinders

series

ZSF BASIC CYLINDER WITH STANDARD YOKE AND SINGLE GUIDE 2A + STROKE

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS ZSF BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A

AM

B

BM

C

CA

CB

D

DA

DB

DC

DD

FE

FF

FG

FM

18 25 32 40 50 63

80 100 120 150 180 215

10 13 16 22 29 40

16,5 20 20 24 24 30

35 45 55 70 85 105

6,5 8,5 8,5 11 11 14,5

7 7 9,5 9,5 11

13 13 14,5 14,5 18,5

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

17,5 25,5 32 37,5 47,5 59,5

14 17,5 20 26 30

28 34,5 42 52 62

15 21 26 31,5 39 46,5

103 131 171 220 280 333

75 100 140 180 220 280

50 70 90 110 140

50 66 80 97 116 136

FW

N

39 M4x7,5 53 M4x8 65 M5x10 79 M6x12 96 M8x16 113,5 M8x16

S

T

U

23,5 33 41 51 63 78

M3x7 M4x9 M5x10 M6x12 M8x12 M8x12

30 42 52 63 78 93

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 400 15 900 26 1500 36 2800 48 4900 74 8000 100

ZSFF BASIC CYLINDER WITH STANDARD YOKE AND DOUBLE GUIDE 2A + STROKE

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS ZSFF BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A

AM

B

BM

C

CA

CB

D

DA

DB

DC

DD

FE

FF

FG

FM

FW

N

S

T

U

18 25 32 40 50 63

80 100 120 150 180 215

10 13 16 22 29 40

16,5 20 20 24 24 30

35 45 55 70 85 105

6,5 8,5 8,5 11 11 14,5

7 7 9,5 9,5 11

13 13 14,5 14,5 18,5

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

17,5 25,5 32 37,5 47,5 59,5

14 17,5 20 26 30

28 34,5 42 52 62

15 21 26 31,5 39 46,5

103 131 171 220 280 333

75 100 140 180 220 280

50 70 90 110 140

50 66 80 97 116 136

50 64 78 95 114 134

M4x7,5 M4x8 M5x10 M6x12 M8x16 M8x16

23,5 33 41 51 63 78

M3x7 M4x9 M5x10 M6x12 M8x12 M8x12

30 42 52 63 78 93

1.78

Cylinders series Z

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 500 15 1200 26 1900 36 3800 48 6600 74 10400 100


Z

Accessories Fixings

series

ZKF BASIC CYLINDER WITH SHORT YOKE AND SINGLE GUIDE 2A + STROKE

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS ZKF BASIC CYLINDER Ø

A

AM

B

BM

C

CA

CB

D

DA

DB

DC

DD

E

F

FM

FW

N

S

T

U

18 25 32 40 50 63

57,5 67,5 77,5 95 105 125

10 13 16 22 29 40

16,5 20 20 24 24 30

35 45 55 70 85 105

6,5 8,5 8,5 11 11 14,5

7 7 9,5 9,5 11

13 13 14,5 14,5 18,5

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

17,5 25,5 32 37,5 47,5 59,5

14 17,5 20 26 30

28 34,5 42 52 62

15 21 26 31,5 39 46,5

58 66 86 110 130 153

30 35 55 70 70 100

50 66 80 97 116 136

39 53 65 79 96 113,5

M4x7,5 M4x8 M5x10 M6x12 M8x16 M8x16

23,5 33 41 51 63 78

M3x7 M4x9 M5x10 M6x12 M8x12 M8x12

30 42 52 63 78 93

WEIGHT INCR. (g) (g) x10 mm 300 15 600 26 1150 36 2000 48 3200 74 6400 100

FEET (pair) - ALUMINIUM - ZPB Ø Ø

AA

AB

AC

AD

AE

AH

18 25 32 40 50 63

15 18 20 25 28 30

2 2 2,5 2,5 3 3

10 12,5 13,5 17,5 20 21

20 30 40 50 60 75

6 6 7 9 9 11

2 2 3 3 3 4,5

WEIGHT (g) 35 40 75 115 225 280

Cylinders series Z

1.79


Z

Accessories Fixings

series

MIDDLE SUPPORTS (pair) - ALUMINIUM - ZTI Ø

1

Ø

AE

AH

BA

BB

BC

BD

BE

18 25 32 40 50 63

6 6 7 9 9 11

2 2 3 3 3 4,5

56 70 85 105 122 144

46 60 73 90 106 125

36,5 50 61,5 75 91 107

23 28 33 38 43 48

2,5 3,5 4 4,5 5 6

BF

WEIGHT (g) 8,25 10 11 15 13,8 30 16 45 19 60 22 80

NARROW SWINGING BRIDGE - ALUMINIUM - ZCS Ø Ø

CA

CB

CC

CD

CE

CF

CG

CK

18 25 32 40 50 63

50 60 70 80 90 100

25,5 30 37 47 56 73

30 40 50 60 70 80

9 14 16 22 30 40

M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10

54 70 86 107 123 145,5

2,5 3 3,5 4,5 4,5 5

M4 M4 M5 M6 M6 M8

Ø

CJ

CH

18 25 32 40 50 63

4 4 6 8 8 8

4 4 6 8 8 8

WEIGHT (g) 45 60 115 220 275 470

LARGE SWINGING BRIDGE - ALUMINIUM - ZCL Ø Ø

CA

CB

CC

CD

CE

CF

CG

CK

18 25 32 40 50 63

50 60 70 80 90 100

41,5 50 60 80 95 120

30 40 50 60 70 80

34 38 48 60 70 80

M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10

54 70 86 107 123 145,5

2,5 3 3,5 4,5 4,5 5

M4 M4 M5 M6 M6 M8

Ø

CJ

CH

18 25 32 40 50 63

4 4 6 8 8 8

4 4 6 8 8 8

WEIGHT (g) 50 80 145 275 350 575

1.80

Cylinders series Z


HS

Hydraulic speed regulators

series

DESCRIPTION Hydraulic regulators series “HS” assure a constant speed of pneumatic cylinders during their working cycle. In fact in the control of tools, that during their movements meet different resistances (i.e. violent impacts and vibrations) with the consequent variation of speed due to the use of only pneumatic control, you could obtain coarse finishes of the tooling till reach the breaking of the same tool. The hydraulic speed regulators exploit the oil incompressibility that, passing from a chamber to another one through an externally adjustable flow regulator, manages to uniform the speed and, with the use of control valves, avoids dead times warranting perfectly repeatable stops independently from the applied load. The adjustment can be made during the piston rod thrust phase, retract phase or both. The stop valve (STOP), mounted in-line on the circuit, and the acceleration valves (SKIP), mounted in-parallel, can be inserted in both the phases. These are poppet valves, two port, pneumatically actuated and therefore they have to be operated to make the STOP valve insert and to cut out the SKIP one.

1

TECHNICAL DATA Working temperature Fluid Versions

0 ÷ +70 °C (-10 °C with dry air) Hydraulic oil (WAIRSOL HS: contact our commercial office for details) In-line tank, piston rod thrust adjustment; In-parallel tank, piston rod thrust adjustment; In-parallel tank, piston rod retract adjustment; In-parallel tank, double adjustment Bore Ø 40 Standard strokes (mm) 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500 Maximum stroke (mm) 1000 Maximum adjustable load 6000 N Minimum/Maximum Without valves: 60 ÷ 10.000 permissible speed (mm/min) With valves: 0 ÷ 6.000

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Piston rod Piston Piston seal Piston rod seal Tie rods Adjusting groups Oil lever stick

Anodized aluminium alloy Drawn steel C45 chromium-plated steel Anodized aluminium alloy NBR rubber Polyurethane Steel Nickel-plated brass Anodized aluminium alloy

ORDER KEY VERSIONS

HS

LU In-line tank, piston rod thrust adjustment PU In-parallel tank, piston rod thrust adjustment PR In-parallel tank, piston rod retract adjustment PD In-parallel tank, double adjustment OPTIONS

1 2 3 4

Series Stroke Version Option

ORDER EXAMPLES Hydraulic regulator HS, 100 mm stroke, in-parallel tank, stop valve thrust adjustment HS100 PU2

Standard adjustment STOP valve adjustment SKIP valve adjustment SKIP and STOP valves adjustment

ASSEMBLY “HS”+ cylinders series “X” or “CPUI”

M/HS

Hydraulic regulator HS, 150 mm stroke, in-parallel tank, skip valve double adjustment + cylinder series “CPUI” Ø63, 150 mm stroke, magnetic piston type + fixing plate + connection bridle + nipple + threaded bar, ASSEMBLED: HS150 PD3, 63/150 CPUI/M, HS/PT 63, HS/BR 50/63, HS/NP 50/63, HS/BF Ø M/HS

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS

1.81


HS

Hydraulic speed regulators

series

IN-LINE TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT - HS..LU1 WEIGHT: 2200 g (0 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE

1

167 + STROKE

LU1 80 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS WITH IN-LINE TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT STROKES (mm) ≤ 75 76 ÷ 150 151 ÷ 250 251 ÷ 350 351 ÷ 500

A 75 90 142 171 222

B (max) 25 39 65 87 125

IN-LINE TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT - HS..LU2 - HS..LU3 WEIGHT LU2: 2700 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm) WEIGHT LU3: 2300 g (0 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

LU2

LU3 80 + STROKE 109 + STROKE

IN-LINE TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT - HS..LU4 WEIGHT: 2800 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

LU4

80 + STROKE 109 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS WITH IN-LINE TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT STROKES (mm) ≤ 75 76 ÷ 150 151 ÷ 250 251 ÷ 350 351 ÷ 500

1.82

A 60 75 127 156 205

B (max) 25 39 65 87 125

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS


HS

Hydraulic speed regulators

series

IN-PARALLEL TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT - HS..PU1 WEIGHT: 2200 g (0 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE

1 PU1 80 + STROKE 167 + STROKE

IN-PARALLEL TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT - HS..PU2 - HS..PU3 WEIGHT PU2: 2700 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm) WEIGHT PU3: 2300 g (0 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

PU2

PU3

80 + STROKE 164 + STROKE

IN-PARALLEL TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT - HS..PU4 WEIGHT: 2800 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

PU4

80 + STROKE 164 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS WITH IN-PARALLEL TANK-THRUST ADJUSTMENT STROKES (mm) 75 76 รท 150 151 รท 250 251 รท 350 351 รท 500

A 75 90 142 171 222

B (max) 25 39 65 87 125

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS

1.83


HS

Hydraulic speed regulators

series

IN-PARALLEL TANK-RETRACT ADJUSTMENT - HS..PR1 WEIGHT: 2200 g (0 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE

1 PR1 80 + STROKE 167 + STROKE

IN-PARALLEL TANK-RETRACT ADJUSTMENT - HS..PR2 - HS..PR3 WEIGHT PR2: 2700 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm) WEIGHT PR3: 2300 g (0 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

PR2

PR3

80 + STROKE 164 + STROKE

IN-PARALLEL TANK-RETRACT ADJUSTMENT - HS..PR4 WEIGHT: 2800 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

PR4

80 + STROKE 164 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS WITH IN-PARALLEL TANK-RETRACT ADJUSTMENT STROKES (mm) โ ค 75 76 รท 150 151 รท 250 251 รท 350 351 รท 500

1.84

A 75 90 142 171 222

B (max) 25 39 65 87 125

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS


HS

Hydraulic speed regulators

series

IN-PARALLEL TANK-DOUBLE ADJUSTMENT HS..PD1 WEIGHT: 2900 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

1

PD1

80 + STROKE 120 + STROKE

IN-PARALLEL TANK-DOUBLE ADJUSTMENT HS..PD2 - HS..PD3 WEIGHT PD2: 4100 g (150 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 150 mm) WEIGHT PD3: 3100 g (50 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 50 mm)

PD2

PD3

80 + STROKE 120 + STROKE

DIMENSIONS WITH IN-PARALLEL TANK-DOUBLE ADJUSTMENT STROKES (mm) 50 ÷ 75 76 ÷ 150 151 ÷ 250

A 75 90 142

B (max) 25 39 65

STROKES (mm) 251 ÷ 350 351 ÷ 500

A 171 222

B (max) 87 125

IN-PARALLEL TANK-DOUBLE ADJUSTMENT HS..PD4 WEIGHT: 4300 g (150 mm-STROKE) + 61 g EVERY 10 mm OF STROKE (MIN. STROKE 150 mm)

G1/8 N° 2 HOLES

G1/8 N°. 2 HOLES

80 + STROKE 120 + STROKE

PD4

DIMENSIONS WITH IN-PARALLEL TANK-DOUBLE ADJUSTMENT STROKES (mm) 150 ÷ 250 251 ÷ 350 351 ÷ 500

A 142 171 222

B (max) 65 87 125

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS

1.85


HS

Accessories Fixings

series

FIXING PLATE HYDRAULIC REGULATOR/CYLINDERS SERIES “X” and “CPUI” - HS/PT Ø

1

Ø 40 50 63 80 100

B 35 40 45 45 55

DA 32 32 32 32 32

DB 6,5 6,5 6,5 6,5 6,5

DC 6,5 8,5 8,5 10,5 10,5

HA 55 65 75 95 115

Ø 40 50 63 80 100

LG 27 32,5 37,5 47,5 57

LH 40 40 40 40 40

LI 10 10 12 12 15

TG 38 46,5 56,5 72 89

WEIGHT (g) 315 430 666 1080 1879

LD 111 122 132 152 171

LF 56,5 62 67 77 86,5

N° 4 HOLES DB

N° 4 HOLES DC

CONNECTION BRIDLE HYDRAULIC REGULATOR/CYLINDERS SERIES “X” and “CPUI” PISTON RODS - HS/BR Ø Ø 40 50 - 63 80 -100

HB 80 90 117

HC 25 -

HD 25 -

Ø 40 50 - 63 80 -100

LN 8 -

LM 5 -

TA 12 11,5 18

KK M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 TB 56 62 77

LJ 40 40 50

LK 12 12 12

LL 20 15 20

WEIGHT (g) 351 369 818

CYLINDERS SERIES “X” and “CPUI” RESTORATION THREAD NIPPLE- HS/NP Ø Ø 40 50 - 63 80 -100

AM 24 32 40

CH 19 24 30

KK M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5

LO 47 65 78

PA 14 19 24

WEIGHT (g) 59 131 245

THREADED BAR - HS/BF Ø Ø 40 50 ÷ 100

LP 6 8

WEIGHT (g) 166 178

P.S.: THREADED BAR IS SUPPLIED WITH 5 NUTS AND 2 WASHERS

1.86

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS


HS

Accessories Fixings

series

FIXING PLATE HYDRAULIC REGULATOR/CYLINDERS SERIES “X” and “CPUI”

1

Ø 40 ÷ 63 80 100

1 X

2 X X X

3 X X

P.S.: DO NOT TIGHTEN THE BRIDLE - THREADED BAR COUPLING

REINSTATEMENT PROCEDURE OF THE OIL LEVEL HYDRAULIC SPEED REGULATORS ARE CLOSED CIRCUIT SYSTEMS SUPPLIED WITH A TANK FOR THE COMPENSATION OF THE ROD VOLUME. THIS TANK IS DESIGNED TO FACE LITTLE FLUID LOSSES DURING THE WORKING. IN THE EVENIENCE THAT DURING THE WORKING THE LEAKAGE OF OIL OVERCOME THE QUANTITY OF OIL IN EXCESS IN THE TANK, THE REGULATOR MUST BE REFILLED. THIS OPERATION MUST BE DONE WHEN THE INDICATOR NOTCH SITUATED ON THE DIP-STICK IN THE COMPENSATOR TANK IS NO MORE VISIBLE WHEN THE MAIN ROD IS COMPLETELY EXTENDED. TO REFILL THE HYDRAULIC SPEED REGULATOR USE A STANDARD GREASING SYRINGE, THAT CAN BE EASILY FOUND IN THE MARKET. THIS SYRINGE HAS TO BE CHARGED WITH “WAIRSOL HS” OIL.

REFILLING OPERATION: 1) PUT THE HYDRAULIC REGULATOR IN VERTICAL POSITION WITH THE FILLING VALVE, SITUATED ON THE REAR END CAP, THAT HAS TO BE HIGH-FACING. 2) EXTEND COMPLETELY THE HYDRAULIC REGULATOR PISTON ROD. 3) APPLY THE SYRINGE, FILLED WITH OIL, TO THE CONICAL SLOT OF THE FILLING VALVE ABOVE MENTIONED. 4) PUMP THE OIL IN THE REGULATOR WITH THE SYRINGE PAYING ATTENTION THAT THE SAME SHOULDN’T GO COMPLETELY EMPTY DURING THE RECHARGE (IF THIS OCCURS, STOP AND TOPPING UP THE SYRINGE). 5) CHARGE TILL THE MINIMUM NOTCH DOESN’T EXCEED THE LEVEL OF THE COMPENSATOR DIP-STICK PLUG OF 5 ÷ 8 mm. 6) OPERATE MORE TIMES THE REGULATOR MAIN PISTON ROD, TAKING CARE OF REGULATING THE CUSHIONINGS TO OBTAIN THE MAXIMUM SPEED. 7) WITH THE PISTON ROD COMPLETELY RETRACTED AND WITH THE CYLINDER ALWAYS IN VERTICAL POSITION, OPERATE THE CLOSING MUSHROOM OF THE FILLING VALVE WITH A SPIKY TOOL SO THAT POSSIBLE AIR BUBBLES CAN BLEED . 8) REPEAT THE OPERATIONS FROM POINT No. 2 TO POINT No. 7 TILL THE AIR IN THE CIRCUIT WILL BE COMPLETELY ELIMINATED.

Hydraulic speed regulators series HS

1.87


WR

Rotary cylinders

series

DESCRIPTION

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Versions Bore Port size

Standard rotation Rotation angle adjustment

1 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Male pinion Female pinion Ø 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100, 125 Ø 32 = G 1/8 Ø 40 - 50 = G 1/4 Ø 63 - 80 = G 3/8 Ø 100 - 125 = G 1/2 90°, 180°, 270°; 360° ± 5°

MATERIALS End caps Cylinder barrel Central body Pinion bearing Rack Rack guide shoe Decelerators ogives Piston Seals

Aluminium alloy, cataphoresis-treated Extruded profile, 20 µm anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy Ø 32: bronze-teflon bearings Ø 40 ÷ 125: ball bearings Normalized steel, square section Acetal resin Aluminium alloy NBR rubber block with magnet NBR rubber

ORDER KEY WR

/

S•

PINION TYPE

M

F

Male pinion

Female pinion

ROTATION ANGLE 90°, 180°, 270°, 360°

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Series

Following table shows the torques of different rotary cylinders sizes, at the pressure of 1 bar. This value has to be multiplied for the utilization bars to set the effective torque.

Pinion type Bore Rotation angle Special options (supplied upon request) P.S.: Magnetic sensors FM 100 - FM 157 - FM 158 (see chapter magnetic sensors from page 1.93) • See technical data on page 0.12

ORDER EXAMPLES Cylinder Ø50, 180° rotation angle, female pinion WRF 50/180 Cylinder Ø40, 270° rotation angle, male pinion WRM 40/270

Ø Torque at 1 bar (Nm) Max. axial load F1 with F=0 (N)

32 1,73

40 3,08

50 5,4

63 10,5

80 21,8

100 35,3

125 71

100

100

120

120

200

250

300

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT NBR

WR ROTARY CYLINDER

Ø/SG/WR

MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE TRANSVERSE FORCE

Maximum payload F (N)

1

Rotary cylinders series “WR” are fit to transform the piston straightaway motion into rotative motion by means of the coupling between rack and pinion. In the standard version, rotary cylinders series “WR” can be supplied with magnetic sensors and with rotation angle adjustment.

Projection S (mm)

1.88

Rotary cylinders series WR


WR

Rotary cylinders

series

WR ROTARY CYLINDER

1

N°4+4 HOLES FB

N°4 HOLES FB DEPTH PA

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS Ø

DA

32 40 50 63 80 100 125 Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125

Ø 32 40 50 63 80 100 125

DC

25 25 30 30 45 50 60

DB g6 14 14 19 24 28 38 38

LB

LC

25 25 35 35 45 45 45

18 22 25 35 50 60 70

E

EE

FB

FC

HA

HB

25 25 30 30 45 50 60

DE H7 14 14 19 19 24 28 28

47 54 65 75 95 114 140

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 3/8 G 1/2 G 1/2

M6 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10 M12

M5 M5 M6 M8 M8 M10 M10

71,5 82 94 110 142 156,5 188

46,5 54,5 60,5 70,8 93,5 99 118

LE

LF

LG

LH

LI

LJ

LK

50 60 70 75 99 115 125

90° ROTATION ANGLE PINION MALE FEMALE LT WEIGHT WEIGHT (g) (g) 227,5 1300 1200 269 2010 1900 282 3070 2840 348 4990 4640 404 9840 9220 428 13650 12680 519 23370 22220

5 5 6 8 8 10 10

16,3 16,3 21,8 21,8 27,3 31,3 31,3

5 5 6 6 8 8 8

180° ROTATION ANGLE PINION MALE FEMALE LT WEIGHT WEIGHT (g) (g) 274,5 1420 1320 326 2210 2900 344,5 3340 3110 422,5 5500 5170 503 10840 10230 534,5 14860 13870 651 25720 24520

2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5

1 1 1 1 1 1 1

1 1 1 1 1 1 1

270° ROTATION ANGLE PINION MALE FEMALE LT WEIGHT WEIGHT (g) (g) 321,5 1540 1440 382,5 2390 2280 407,5 3610 3380 497 6010 5700 602 11840 11240 641,5 16070 15060 783 28070 26820

Rotary cylinders series WR

HC 25 30 32,5 37 50 54 60 LL

min 11 11 11 11 11 11 11

max 17 16 15 19 18 15 35

HE

HF

LA

51 61 66 76 100 116 141

50 60 65 75 99 115 140

30 30 40 40 50 50 50

LM

PA

33 40 50 60 80 80 90

8 9 12 12 15 15 20

360° ROTATION ANGLE PINION MALE FEMALE LT WEIGHT WEIGHT (g) (g) 368,5 1660 1560 439 2580 2470 470 3880 3650 571,5 6520 6230 701 12840 12250 748 17280 16250 915 30420 29120

1.89


F

Cylinders piston rod attachments

series

DESCRIPTION

1

Piston rod attachments, produced according to standards that regulate cylinders manufacturing, allow the cylinder piston rod to couple with the corresponding system that has to be enlivened.

FEMALE PISTON ROD CLEVIS WITH CLIPS TO ISO 8140 STEEL - M4 ÷ M20 X 1,5

FEMALE PISTON ROD CLEVIS WITH PIN AND SNAP RING TO ISO 8140 - STEEL - M4 ÷ M36 X 2

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DA

DB

DE

F

G

HA

HB

L

B12 M4 M6 M8 M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M36x2

8 10 14 18 20 26 34 48 60

4 6 8 10 12 16 20 30 35

4 6 8 10 12 16 20 30 35

8 12 16 20 24 32 40 55 70

8 12 16 20 24 32 40 54 72

16 24 32 40 48 64 80 110 144

21 31 42 52 62 83 105 148 188

WEIGHT CYLINDER SERIES and Ø (g) U-UP P-UP BU7 CPU-X CPUI 10 8-10 18 12-16 42 20 90 25 32 20÷40 32 130 40 50-63 40 330 50-63 80 50-63 650 100 80-100 2100 3900

TYPE

TYPE

WITH CLIPS WITH CLIPS

FF4 FF6 FF8 32 FF10x1,25 40 FF10x1,25 50-63 FF16x1,5 80-100 FF20x1,5 125 160-200 -

FFP6* FFP8* FFP10x1,25* FFP12x1,25*

FFP16x1,5* FFP20x1,5* FFP27x2 FFP36x2

* AISI 303 STAINLESS STEEL (SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST) SELF-LUBRICATING PISTON ROD EYE TO DIN ISO 12240 STANDARD - STEEL

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DA

DB

M4 M6 M8 M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M36x2

11 13 16 19 22 27 34 50 58

DC DE F G H7 18 5 6 8 20 6 6,75 9 24 8 9 12 28 10 10,5 14 32 12 12 16 42 16 15 21 50 20 18 25 70 30 25 37 80 35 28 43

HA

HB

L

W

10 12 16 20 22 28 33 51 56

27 30 36 43 50 64 77 110 125

36 40 48 57 66 85 102 145 165

9 11 14 17 19 22 30 41 50

13 13 14 13 13 15 14 17 16

WEIGHT CYLINDER SERIES and Ø (g) U-UP P-UP BU7 CPU-X CPUI 18 8-10 26 12-16 46 20 76 25 32 20÷40 32 32 110 40 50-63 40 40 220 50-63 80 50-63 50-63 409 100 80-100 80-100 1200 125 1600 160-200

* AISI 303 STAINLESS STEEL (SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST)

1.90

Cylinders piston rod attachments series F

TYPE FF4/SS* FF6/SS* FF8/SS* FF10x1,25/SS* FF12x1,25/SS* FF16x1,25/SS* FF16x1,25/SS* FF27x2/SS FF36x2/SS


F

Accessories Cylinder piston rod attachments

series

SELF-ALIGNING ROD COUPLER - GALVANIZED STEEL

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DA

C

M6 M8 M10x1,25 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M27X2

10 20 20 24 32 40 54

CH 5 7 12 12 20 20 24

CH1 7 11 19 19 30 30 54

D 3,5 4 5 5 8 8 10

DB 8,5 12,5 22 22 32 32 57

DD 6 8 14 14 22 22 32

E

H

17,5 28,5 35 35 54 54 60

14,5 19 32 32 45 45 70

HA 10 20 20 20 32 40 40

I 13 17 30 30 41 41 65

L 35 57 71 75 103 119 147

M 1 2 2 2 2 2 2

WEIGHT (g) 10 10 10 10 10 10 8

25 60 220 230 660 700 1000

U-UP 12-16 20 25

P-UP

32 40 50-63

CYLINDER SERIES and Ø BU7 CPU-X CPUI

20÷40 50-63 80 100

32 40 50-63 80-100

32 40 50-63 80-100 125

TYPE FF6/SA FF8/SA FF10x1,25/SA FF12x1,25/SA FF16x1,5/SA FF20x1,5/SA FF27x2/SA

FEMALE PISTON ROD CLEVIS WITH CLIPS TO DIN 71752 STANDARD - STEEL

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DA M6 M8 M10 M12 M14 M16 M18 M20

DB 10 14 18 20 24 26 26 34

DE 6 8 10 12 14 16 16 20

F B12

G

6 8 10 12 14 16 16 20

12 16 20 24 27 32 32 40

HA 12 16 20 24 28 32 32 40

HB 24 32 40 48 56 64 64 80

L 31 42 52 62 72 83 83 105

WEIGHT CYLINDER SERIES HB

TYPE

(g)

Ø

WITH CLIPS

18 42 90 130 230 330 330 650

20 27 35-40 50 58 70 85 100

FF6 FF8 HB/FF10 HB/FF12 HB/FF14 HB/FF16 HB/FF18 HB/FF20

Cylinders piston rod attachments series F

1.91


F

Accessories Cylinder piston rod attachments

series

FEMALE PISTON ROD CLEVIS WITH CLIPS TO ex CNOMO 06 07 14 STANDARD - STEEL - M 10 ÷ M 27 x 2

FEMALE PISTON ROD CLEVIS WITH PIN AND SNAP RING TO ex CNOMO 06 07 14 STANDARD - STEEL - M 10 ÷ M 36 x 2

1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DA

DB

DE

F

G

HA

HB

L

B12 M10 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M36x2

18 26 34 42 50

8 12 16 20 25

11 18 22 30 40

22 36 45 63 80

20 26 30 45 75

36 51 63 85 115

45 64 80 105 140

WEIGHT CYLINDER SERIES CX

TYPE

TYPE

(g)

Ø

WITH CLIPS

WITH PIN

80 210 440 910 1800

32 40-50 63-80 100-125 160-200

CX/FF10 CX/FF16x1,5 CX/FF20x1,5 CX/FF27x2 -

CX/FFP10 CX/FFP16x1,5 CX/FFP20x1,5 CX/FFP27x2 CX/FFP36x2

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS

MALE PISTON ROD CLEVIS TO ex CNOMO 06 07 15 STANDARD - STEEL

C 22 32 36 45 63

ROD NUT

M10 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M36x2

DE

E

H8

f8

8 12 16 20 25

11 18 22 30 40

HA

HB

HC

L

WEIGHT CYLINDER SERIES CX

H13 20 30 36 50 70

36 51 63 85 115

25 34 41 58 81

45 64 80 105 140

(g)

Ø

30 100 140 320 870

32 40-50 63-80 100-125 160-200

TYPE CX/FM10 CX/FM16x1,5 CX/FM20x1,5 CX/FM27x2 CX/FM36x2

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DI M4 M6 M8 M10x1,25 M10 M12x1,25 M16x1,5 M20x1,5 M27x2 M36x2

1.92

DA

CH 7 10 13 17 17 19 24 30 41 55

S 3 4 5 6 6 7 8 9 12 15

WEIGHT (g) U-UP P-UP

CYLINDER SERIES and Ø BU7 CX CPU-X CPUI

TYPE B+NIPPLE

STEEL

TYPE STAINLESS STEEL

0,8 8-10 DST4 DSTI4 1,48 12-16 12-16 DST6 DSTI6 4 20 20-25 DST8 DSTI8 8,6 25 32 20÷40 32 32 32-40 DST10x1,25 DSTI10x1,25 8,6 32 DST10 DSTI10 12,1 40 50-63 40 40 50-63 DST12x1,25 DSTI12x1,25 20,1 50-63 80 40-50 50-63 50-63 G50÷80 DST16x1,5 UPDT16 100 DST20x1,5 DSTI20x1,5 36,3 100 63-80 80-100 80-100 90 100-125 125 DST27x2 DSTI27x2 190 160-200 160-200 DST36x2 DSTI36x2

Cylinder piston rod attachments series F


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders

series FM100 - FM101 - FM157 - FM158

DESCRIPTION

series NOTICE

Magnetic sensors series "FM" allow to detect the magnetic piston position inside pneumatic cylinders. The magnetic field generated in the cylinder is used to signal electrical circuits as required. It's possible to choice between the two types of switches currently available: - Reed switch (this electromechanical switch can work with both AC or DC circuits) - Hall effect switch (electronic switch suitable for DC circuits only) Magnetic sensors have a LED that signals the insertion as standard.

The magnetic sensor is a switch that has to be assembled in series with a load (inductive, resistive or capacitive). Use the shortest possible connection cable to reduce self-capacitance to a minimum. In borderline cases, measures should be taken to cancel the effect of cable capacitance using a repetition relay (4 W) in series. Avoid close proximity to external magnetic fields such as electric motors or large iron masses, as they could effect the switch. The sensors are able to detect a magnetic signal at speeds of the piston up to 1 m/s.

MAGNETIC SENSORS SERIES FM100 TECHNICAL DATA TYPE

FM100 FM100R FM100N FM100E FM100EN FM100/C FM100R/C FM100N/C FM100E/C FM100EN/C

Working temperature Protection class Model Contacts Voltage AC/DC Max voltage drop Max exchange current Max power Operating frequency

-10 ÷ +70 °C IP 67 REED SWITCH N.O. N.C. 5 ÷ 220 V 10 ÷ 30 V DC 5 ÷ 110 V 3V 0.1 V 3V 100 mA 10 W 200 Hz

HALL EFFECT PNP NPN 10 ÷ 30 V DC 2V 3W 1000 Hz

MATERIALS Body Cable Connector Contacts Contact carrier Ring nut

FM100/C - FM100R/C - FM100N/C - FM100E/C - FM100EN/C Polyamide Polyurethane Polypropylene Gold-plated brass Nickel-plated brass Brass

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR

FM100 - FM100R - FM100N - FM100E - FM100EN

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) 3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK

DESCRIPTION N.O. reed switch with LED and 2 wires cable 3 m length N.O. reed switch with LED and 3 wires cable 3 m length N.C. reed switch with LED and 2 wires cable 3 m length Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires cable 3 m length Hall effect switch version NPN with LED and 3 wires cable 3 m length

WEIGHT (g) 33 33 33 37 37

TYPE FM100 FM100R FM100N FM100E FM100EN

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR

DESCRIPTION N.O. reed switch with LED and 2 wires ring nut connector M8 N.O. reed switch with LED and 3 wires ring nut connector M8 N.C. reed switch with LED and 2 wires ring nut connector M8 Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires ring nut connector M8 Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires ring nut connector M8

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

WEIGHT (g) TYPE 45

FM100/C

45

FM100R/C

45

FM100N/C

49

FM100E/C

49

FM100EN/C

1.93

1


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM100

series

ELECTRIC CIRCUITS REED SWITCH

FM100

1

EXTENSION WITH FEMALE CONNECTOR M8

FM100R

FM100N BROWN

BROWN

BROWN

BLACK

LOAD

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE BLACK (-)

LOAD

LOAD

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK

BLUE

BLUE

BLUE

DESCRIPTION Extension 3 m length with female connector M8 Extension 5 m length with female connector M8

ELECTRIC CIRCUITS HALL EFFECT SWITCH

FM100E

WEIGHT (g) L (m) TYPE 40 3 CNT3 60 5 CNT5

FM100EN BROWN

BROWN LOAD

LOAD

BLUE

BLUE

FIXING ADAPTER - PLASTIC - SQB12 - SQB SQB12

FIXING ADAPTER - PLASTIC- FG

SQB

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDER SERIES “B”

1.94

H

L

27 32 37 49 58 68 81 101 124

36 41 53 61 73 89 107 132

Ø CYLINDER 12 16 20 32 40 50 63 80 100

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS

TYPE

H

L

SQB12

20 22 23 26 27 36 44 52 62 76

22 24 25 28 29 38 46 54 64 78

SQB

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

CYLINDER SERIES and Ø U P UP 8 10 12 16 16 20 20 25 25 32 32 40 40 50 50 63 -

TYPE FG8 FG10 FG12 FG16 FG20 FG25 FG32 FG40 FG50 FG63


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM100

series

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS - ALUMINIUM - FS

EXAMPLE OF SENSOR MOUNTING ON CYLINDERS SERIES “BU”

1 EXAMPLE OF SENSOR MOUNTING ON CYLINDERS SERIES “BG”

EXAMPLE OF SENSOR MOUNTING ON CYLINDERS SERIES “X” MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS H

L

50 57 69 79 97 113 140

51 57 69 79 96 113 141

CYLINDER SERIES and Ø CPUI CPA WR 32 32 32 40 40 40 50 50 50 63 63 63 80 80 100 100 125 125

TYPE FS34 FS56 FS81 FS125

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS WITH TIE RODS - ALUMINIUM - FS

SENSOR FIXING BRACKET - ALUMINIUM - SQZ

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS SERIES “Z”

H

L

45 52 61 76 92 106 144 170 225

46 53 62 75 91 105 141 173 223

SERIES CYLINDERS and Ø WR CPUI CPU CX 32 32 40 40 50 50 63 63 80 80 100 100 125 125 125 160 160 200 200

TYPE FS345 FS681 FS112

H

L

Ø CYLINDER

36,5 48,5 58,5 69,5 84,5 99,5

36,6 48,6 58,6 69,6 84,6 99,6

18 25 32 40 50 63

TYPE

SQZ

P.S.: Sensor fixing bracket “SQZ” can not be fixed on the same side of the guides on the versions “ZSF”- “ZSFF” - “ZKF”; for this need use the “hidden” series FM101 (see page 1.96)

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

1.95


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM101

series

MAGNETIC SENSORS SERIES FM101 TECHNICAL DATA

1

TYPE Working temperature Protection class Model Contacts Voltage AC/DC Max voltage drop Max exchange current Max power Operating frequency

FM101 - FM101/C

FM101E - FM101E/C -10 ÷ +70 °C IP 67 REED SWITCH HALL EFFECT N.O. PNP 5 ÷ 30 V DC 5 ÷ 220 V 3V 0.5 V 100 mA 200 mA 6W 200 Hz 1000 Hz

FM101/C - FM101E/C

MATERIALS Body Cable Connector Contacts Contact carrier Ring nut

Polyamide Polyurethane Polypropylene Gold-plated brass Nickel-plated brass Brass

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR

FM101 - FM101E 2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) 3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR

DESCRIPTION N.O. reed switch with LED and 2 wires ring nut connector M8 Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires ring nut connector M8

WEIGHT (g) TYPE 40

FM101/C

40

FM101E/C

EXTENSION WITH FEMALE CONNECTOR M8 2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE BLACK (-)

DESCRIPTION WEIGHT (g) TYPE N.O. reed switch with LED and 2 wires cable 3 m length 28 FM101 Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires cable 3 m lenght 28 FM101E

EXAMPLE OF SENSOR MOUNTING ON CYLINDERS SERIES “Z”

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK DESCRIPTION Extension 3 m length with female connector M8 Extension 5 m length with female connector M8

WEIGHT (g) L (m) TYPE 40 3 CNT3 60 5 CNT5

ELECTRIC CIRCUITS REED SWITCH - HALL EFFECT SWITCH FM101

FM101E BROWN

BROWN

LOAD LOAD

BLUE

P.S.: For bore Ø 18, mount the sensors series “FM100” (page 1.93) with sensor fixing bracket “SQZ” (page 1.95)

1.96

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

BLUE


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM157

series

MAGNETIC SENSORS SERIES FM157 TECHNICAL DATA TYPE Working temperature Protection class Model Contacts Voltage AC/DC Max voltage drop Max exchange current Max power Operating frequency

FM157 - FM157/C FM157E/C -20 ÷ +80 °C IP65 REED SWITCH HALL EFFECT N.O. 3 ÷ 230 V 6 ÷ 30 V 3V 0,7 V 500 mA 250 mA 10 VA 6W 200 Hz 1000 Hz

MATERIALS Body Cable Connector Contact carrier

1

FM157/C - FM157E/C Polyamide Polyvinyl chloride Polyvinyl chloride Polyamide

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE BLACK (-)

FM157 - FM157E

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) 3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK DESCRIPTION Reed switch with LED and 2 wires cable 2,5 m lenght Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires cable 2,5 m lenght

WEIGHT (g) TYPE 55 FM157 58 FM157E

* DIMENSION OF THE COUPLED PARTS

DESCRIPTION Reed switch with LED, connector M8 and 2 wires cable 2,5 m length Hall effect switch version PNP with LED, connector M8 and 3 wires cable 2,5 m length

WEIGHT (g)

TYPE

58

FM157/C

61

FM157E/C

ELECTRIC CIRCUIT HALL EFFECT SWITCH

ELECTRIC CIRCUIT REED SWITCH

BROWN BLUE

LOAD BLACK

BROWN BLUE

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

1.97


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM157

series

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS - PLASTIC - FG FM 157

FM 157/C

1

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS - ALUMINIUM - ST

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS - ALUMINIUM - ST

1.98

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS H1

H

L

26 28 31 33 38 43 51 60 70 84

38 40 42 45 52 58 65 73 83 97

23 28 27 28,5 32 32 32 32 32,5 32,5

SERIES CYLINDER and Ø U P 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 63

TYPE FG/050 FG/051 FG/052 FG/053 FG/054 FG/055 FG/056 FG/057 FG/058 FG/059

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS SERIES “CPUI” H

L

Ø CYLINDER

55 65 77 87 102 120 147

63 60 72 82 101 117 131

32 40 50 63 80 100 125

TYPE ST34 ST56 ST80 ST102

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS H

L

33 37,5 40 49 57 61 71 92 120

33 33 35 39 48 54 69 90 118

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

SERIES CYLINDER and Ø CPUI CPU CX 32 32 40 40 50 50 63 63 80 80 100 100 125 125 160 160 200 200

TYPE

ST3456 SQ32-40/A SQ125/A SQ80-100/A


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM158

series

MAGNETIC SENSORS SERIES FM158 TECHNICAL DATA TYPE Working temperature Protection class Model Contacts Voltage AC/DC Max voltage drop Max exchange current Max power Operating frequency

FM158 - FM158/C FM158E - FM158E/C -20 ÷ + 80 °C IP65 REED SWITCH HALL EFFECT N.O. 3 ÷ 115 V 6 ÷ 30 V 3V 0,7 V 500 mA 250 mA 10 VA 6W 200 Hz 1000 Hz

1

MATERIALS Body Cable Connector Contact carrier Ring nut

Polyamide Polyvinyl chloride Polyvinyl chloride Polyamide Brass

FM158/C - FM158E/C FM158 - FM158E 2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-)

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSOR BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK DESCRIPTION Reed switch with LED and 2 wires cable 2,5 m lenght Hall effect switch version PNP with LED and 3 wires cable 2,5 m lenght

WEIGHT (g) TYPE 36 FM158 40 FM158E

ELECTRIC CIRCUIT REED SWITCH

2 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE BLACK (-)

3 WIRES MAGNETIC SENSORS BROWN (+) BLUE (-) BLACK

DESCRIPTION Reed switch with LED, connector M8 and 2 wires cable 2,5 m length Hall effect switch version PNP with LED, connector M8 and 3 wires cable 2,5 m length

WEIGHT (g)

TYPE

48

FM158/C

51

FM158E/C

ELECTRIC CIRCUIT HALL EFFECT SWITCH

BROWN LOAD

BLUE BLACK

BROWN

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

BLUE

1.99


FM

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM158

serie

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS - ALUMINIUM - SQ

SENSOR FIXING BRACKETS - ALUMINIUM - ST

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS SERIES CPUI

MAXIMUM DIMENSIONS WITH CYLINDERS

1

H

L

Ø CYLINDER

51,5 59 70 81,5 98,5 115

50 56 69 80 96 113

32 40 50 63 80 100

1.100

TYPE SQ32-40/A SQ50-63/A SQ80-100/A

H

L

33 37,5 40 49 57 61 71 92 120

33 33 35 39 48 54 69 90 118

Magnetic sensors for cylinders series FM

CYLINDER SERIES and Ø CPUI CPU CX 32 32 40 40 50 50 63 63 80 80 100 100 125 125 160 160 200 200

TYPE

ST3456 SQ32-40/A SQ125/A SQ80-100/A


1

1.101



VALVES

Index chapter 2

pilot and solenoid actuated

Series UM General features - Direct acting solenoid valves side 15 mm .............................................................................................................page Accessories: bases ...............................................................................................................................................................................page

2.3 2.4

Series UL General features - Direct acting solenoid valves side 32 mm ..............................................................................................................page Accessories: bases ...............................................................................................................................................................................page

2.5 2.7

Series C/ 2.9 General features - Direct acting solenoid valves with sleeve Ø 9 mm .................................................................................................page Accessories: bases ...............................................................................................................................................................................page 2.11-12

Series USB - USBG General features - Coils for solenoid valves .........................................................................................................................................page

2.14

Series MEK192/N - USR102/N9 - ULR1B General features - Connectors for solenoid valves ..............................................................................................................................page

2.15

Series MEV General features ....................................................................................................................................................................................page Spool compact valves pilot and solenoid actuated 5 port - G 1/8 ......................................................................................................page Spool compact valves solenoid actuated for single use or multi-pin plug connector 5 port - G 1/8 ................................................page Accessories: bases G 1/8 .....................................................................................................................................................................page Spool compact valves to VDMA 24563 standard pilot and solenoid actuated 5 port size 02 ............................................................page Spool compact valves to VDMA 24563 standard solenoid actuated for single use or multi-pin plug connector 5 port size 02 ........page Accessories: single and manifold bases to VDMA 24563 standard size 02 ........................................................................................page Accessories: multi-pin connection with solenoid valves versions MEVX 8 and MEVX 18 ...................................................................page Assembling examples: multi-pin connection with solenoid valves versions MEVX 8 and MEVX 18 ...................................................page

2.16 2.17 2.20 2.21 2.22 2.25 2.26 2.28 2.30

Series MEK General features ....................................................................................................................................................................................page Spool compact valves pilot and solenoid actuated 5 port - G 1/8 ......................................................................................................page Accessories: bases G 1/8 .....................................................................................................................................................................page Spool compact valves pilot and solenoid actuated 5 port - G 1/4 ......................................................................................................page Accessories: bases G 1/4 .....................................................................................................................................................................page

2.32 2.33 2.36 2.37 2.42

Series EK General features ....................................................................................................................................................................................page Spool valves pilot and solenoid actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/8 ...........................................................................................................page Accessories: bases and supply rail for valves G 1/8 ............................................................................................................................page Spool valves pilot and solenoid actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/4 ...........................................................................................................page Spool valves pilot actuated 5 port, “Namur” port pattern - G 1/4 .......................................................................................................page Spool valves solenoid actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/4 ..........................................................................................................................page Spool valves solenoid actuated 5 port, “Namur” port pattern - G 1/4 ................................................................................................page Accessories: bases and supply rail for valves G 1/4 ............................................................................................................................page Spool valves pilot and solenoid actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/2 ...........................................................................................................page 90° Solenoid actuated valves - Mounting bracket for solenoid valves series EK with cylinders series CPUI.....................................page

2.43 2.44 2.48 2.49 2.51 2.52 2.54 2.55 2.56 2.59

Series UK General features ....................................................................................................................................................................................page Poppet valves pilot and solenoid actuated 2, 3 and 5 port - G 1/8 .....................................................................................................page Accessories: bases G 1/8 .....................................................................................................................................................................page Poppet valves pilot and solenoid actuated 2, 3 and 5 port - G 1/4 .....................................................................................................page Accessories: bases G 1/4 .....................................................................................................................................................................page Poppet valves pilot and solenoid actuated 2, 3 and 5 port - G 1/2 .....................................................................................................page Accessories: bases G 1/2 .....................................................................................................................................................................page Poppet valves pilot and solenoid actuated 2, 3 and 5 port - G 1 ........................................................................................................page

2.60 2.62 2.65 2.66 2.68 2.69 2.71 2.72

Series UDS ISO General features ....................................................................................................................................................................................page Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard pilot and solenoid actuated size 1 ......................................................................................................page Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard pilot and solenoid actuated size 2 ......................................................................................................page Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard pilot and solenoid actuated size 3 ......................................................................................................page Accessories: bases to ISO 5599/1 standard sizes 1 - 2 - 3 .................................................................................................................page

2.74 2.75 2.77 2.79 2.81

Series UDS CETOP General features ....................................................................................................................................................................................page Valves to ex CETOP RP 32 P standard pilot and solenoid actuated size 05 - 12 - 35 .......................................................................page Accessories: bases to ex CETOP RP 32 P standard sizes 05 - 12 - 35 ..............................................................................................page

2.86 2.87 2.89

Series W General features - Solenoid valves for media - G 1/8 ÷ G 2 ................................................................................................................page Accessories: coils type WE ...................................................................................................................................................................page

2.91 2.93

Series EV General features - Vacuum valves solenoid (pilot assisted) actuated - G 1/8 ÷ G 2 ...........................................................................page

2.94

Series VM General features - Vacuum generators - G 1/8 ÷ G 1 ..........................................................................................................................page

Valves pilot and solenoid actuated

2.96

2.1


Waircom valves and solenoid valves: overview Waircom valves and solenoid valves

Even some series of this chapter

have been created according to

comply with the international

different production philosophies

reference standards, and beside

in order to adapt to the different

these, as usual we present a range

contexts in which they could be

of valves completely designed

used. Thus, together with the

by ourselves, in according to

historical poppet valves, have been

the market needs. It’s important

manufactured throughout the ages

to remember that some series

different families of valves with spool

of this valves can create the vacuum

construction, to be used individually,

or work with this uid, so that we

in manifold mounting or with

can cover another share of the

multi-pin plug connector.

industrial market. Finally, even for the items belonging to this family exist some accessories like bases, coils, connectors and cables.

2.2

Valves pilot and solenoid actuated


UM

Direct acting solenoid valves side 15 mm

series

DESCRIPTION The direct acting solenoid valves series "UM" are produced in conformity with the Directives EC 89/336, EC 92/31, EC 93/68, EC 73/23 in the 3/2 N.O. and 3/2 N.C. pneumatic functions. They are used as power valves if mounted on single and multi-station base, or as control valves if mounted, in the 3/2 pneumatic function, on body valve series "MEV" (see from page 2.16) and "MEK" (see from page 2.32). The multi-station bases support both the 3/2 N.O. than the 3/2 N.C. solenoid valves. The wrapping could be rotated of 180° to have an opposite electric connection respect the manual override.

2

TECHNICAL DATA Operatin pressure

FLOW CHART - UM

Flow rate (Nl/min)

0 ÷ 7 bar N.O. 0 ÷10 bar N.C. Working temperature -5° ÷ +50° C Fluid Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Nominal diameter 1.1 mm N.C. - N.O. Max. operating frequency ≤13 Hz Coil Integrated in the body Voltages DC: 12 - 24 V AC: 24 - 110 - 220 V Power consumption DC: 2.3 W AC: 2.8 VA (inrush) - 2.5 VA (holding) Voltage tolerance -5% +10% Protection class IP 65 with connector MEK 192/N with VDR Solenoid rating F (155°C) Electric connector MEK192/N - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

MATERIALS Core Body and manual override Springs Seals

Stainless steel AISI 430F Polyester thermoplastic Stainless steel AISI 302 NBR rubber

Operating pressure (bar)

3 PORT WITH INTERFACE Controls Symbol

Function

Flow rate (NI/min)

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

26

Monostable push botton

40

UMASV/

30

Monostable push botton

40

UMCSV/

Pilot

Return

Pilot

Return

at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

17

20

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

13

23

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER E.G.: UMCSV/02400

UMASV - UMCSV

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

11050-60 = 110 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC

SINGLE BASE M5 - UMP5/1

Direct acting solenoid valves series UM

2.3


UM

Accessories Bases

series

MULTI-STATION BASE M5 - UMPM5

MULTI-STATION BASE WITH CARTRIDGE Ø 4 mm - UMP4-2

2

CARTDRIGE 04

2 LA 39 LB 47 Weight (g) 70 TYPE UMPM5/2 Weight (g) 75 TYPE UMP4-2/2

N°of stations

3 55 63 95 UMPM5/3 100 UMP4-2/3

4 71 79 120 UMPM5/4 125 UMP4-2/4

5 87 95 145 UMPM5/5 150 UMP4-2/5

6 103 111 170 UMPM5/6 175 UMP4-2/6

7 119 127 195 UMPM5/7 200 UMP4-2/7

8 135 143 220 UMPM5/8 225 UMP4-2/8

9 10 151 167 159 175 245 270 UMPM5/9 UMPM5/10 250 275 UMP4-2/9 UMP4-2/10

REVERSAL PLATE - KIT/PC/UM

2.4

Direct acting solenoid valves series UM


UL

Direct acting solenoid valves side 32 mm

series

DESCRIPTION The direct acting solenoid valves series "UL" are produced in conformity with the Directives EC 89/336, EC 92/31, EC 93/68, EC 73/23 in the 3/2 N.O. (with feed from the exhaust "3") and 3/2 N.C. pneumatic functions. The function 2/2 is obtainable closing exhaust "3". Besides are available the versions with ports G 1/8, suitable for single use, and with interface for multi-station base mounting or for mounting on poppet and to ex CETOP RP 32 P (with fixed position) valve bodies.

2

TECHNICAL DATA

Apparent power Voltage tolerance Protection class Insulation class Solenoid rating Electric connector

0 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air 2 mm ≤13 Hz Intergrated in the body DC: 24 V AC: 24 - 110 - 220 V DC: 7 W AC: 17 VA (inrush) - 10 VA (holding) -15% +15% IP 65 F ED 100% ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

FLOW CHART - UL

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Nominal diameter Max. operating frequency Coil Voltages

MATERIALS Core Body ported G 1/8 Body with interface Springs Seals Manual override

IMRE Zamak Glass stiffened polyamide (zamak upon request) Stainless steel Viton® Acetal resin

Operating pressure (bar)

3 PORT G 1/8 SIDE 32 mm Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

80

-

240

ULARG/R

20

80

-

240

ULCRG/R

15

20

80

Manual bistable

240

ULARV/R

15

20

80

Manual bistable

240

ULCRV/R

Pilot

Return

Pilot

Return

at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

3/2 N.O.**

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

15

20

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

15

3/2 N.O.**

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER E.G.: ULARG/R02450-60

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

11050-60 = 110 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC

** For version N.O. arrange the connections as indicated: 1 = EXHAUST 2 = OUTPUT 3 = INPUT

Direct acting solenoid valves series UL

2.5


UL

Direct acting solenoid valves side 32 mm

series 3 PORT G 1/8

2

3 PORT WITH INTERFACE FOR MULTI-STATION BASES AND POPPET / ex CETOP VALVES (WITH FIXED POSITION) Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

80

-

200

ULASG/R

20

80

-

200

ULCSG/R

15

20

80

Manual bistable

200

ULASV/R

15

20

80

Manual bistable

200

ULCSV/R

Pilot

Return

Pilot

Return

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

15

20

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

15

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER 02400 = 24 V DC 11050-60 = 110 V AC E.G.: ULARG/R02450-60 02450-60 = 24 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC

3 PORT WITH PLASTIC INTERFACE STRIP

2.6

Flow rate at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

P.S. 1: For body valve in zamak add the letter “A” to the type. E.G.: 3/2 N.C. with manual override, body in zamak ULCSV/RA + voltage. P.S. 2: For body valve in plastic and universal interface strip change the letter “R” of the type with the letter “U”. E.G.: 3/2 N.C. with manual override, body in plastic ULCSV/U + voltage.

3 PORT WITH ZAMAK INTERFACE STRIP

Direct acting solenoid valves series UL


UL

Accessories Bases

series

MULTI-STATION BOTTOM PORTED BASE G 1/8 - ULP8B N째 of stations

LA LB LC Weight (g) TYPE

2 68 59 85 ULP8B/2

3 102 93 34 130 ULP8B/3

5 170 161 34 220 ULP8B/5

2 68 59 85 ULP8S/2

3 102 93 130 ULP8S/3

5 170 161 220 ULP8S/5

G1/8 DEPTH 6

G1/8 DEPTH 6

MULTI-STATION SIDE PORTED BASE G 1/8 - ULP8S N째 of stations

LA LB Weight (g) TYPE

G1/8 DEPTH 6 G1/8 DEPTH 6

Direct acting solenoid valves series UL

2.7

2


UL

Accessories Bases

series

BLANKING PLATE - KIT/PC/UL

SINGLE BASE G 1/8 - XVB

2 WEIGHT 40 g

EXAMPLE OF BASES ASSEMBLY

P.S.: The connection nipple is supplied as standard with the multi-station base

2.8

Direct acting solenoid valves series UL

WEIGHT 10 g


C/

Direct acting solenoid valves with sleeve Ø 9 mm

series

DESCRIPTION The direct acting solenoid valves series "C/" are produced in conformity with the Directives EC 89/336, EC 92/31, EC 93/68, EC 73/23 in the 3/2 N.O. and 3/2 N.C. pneumatic functions. Using the same mechanic, it s possible to obtain four standard versions: side 22 mm - body ported, side 22 mm - body with interface, side 30 mm - body with ex CNOMO interface and body with interface for mounting on poppet and ex CETOP (with fixed position and rotatable coil) valves. All the solenoid valves with interface can be mounted on single modular bases. The version side 30 mm with ex CNOMO interface, in the 3/2 N.C. pneumatic function, has two different manual overrides as standard: bistable screwdriver and monostable push button.

TECHNICAL DATA Working temperature Fluid Sleeve Nominal diameter Max. operating frequency Coils Electric connectors

FLOW CHART - C/ 0 ÷ 10 bar N.C. 0 ÷ 8 bar N.O. 0 ÷ +50 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Ø 9 mm 1,1 mm 13 Hz USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 USBG - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 USR102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 Flow rate (Nl/min)

Operating pressure

2

MATERIALS Core Body ported G 1/8 - G 1/4 Body and manual override Springs Seals

IMRE Aluminium Acetal resin Stainless steel Viton®

Operating pressure (bar)

3 PORT G 1/8 - G 1/4 SIDE 22 mm Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate at 6 bar Manual ΔP = 1 bar override (NI/min)

Size

Weight (g)

TYPE*

G 1/8

-

46

C8/USASGG

48

G 1/4

-

46

C4/USASGG

20

36

G 1/8

-

65

C8/USCSGG

20

36

G 1/4

-

80

C4/USCSGG

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

20

48

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

20

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

Direct acting solenoid valves series C/

2.9


C/

Direct acting solenoid valves with sleeve Ø 9 mm

series

No. 2 holes Ø6

3 PORT G 1/4

No. 2 holes Ø6

3 PORT G 1/8

2

MANIFOLD BASE OF SOLENOID VALVES SIDE PORTED G 1/8 N.C. - C8/USCP AND N.O. - C8/USAP 4 6 8 LA 115 165 215 LB 105 155 205 Weight (g) 172 258 344 TYPE N.C. C8/USCP/4 C8/USCP/6 C8/USCP/8 TYPE N.O. C8/USAP/4 C8/USAP/6 C8/USAP/8 N°of stations

P.S.: MANIFOLD BASES OF SOLENOID VALVES WITH “MIXED” OPERATION (N.O./N.C.) ARE SUPPLIED UPON REQUEST

2.10

Direct acting solenoid valves series C/


C/

Direct acting solenoid valves with sleeve Ø 9 mm - bases

series

3 PORT WITH INTERFACE FOR MODULAR BASES AND SPOOL VALVES SIDE 22 mm Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

25

36

Manual monostable

45

C/USASVP

3/2 N.O.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

25

36

-

30

C/USASGP

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

25

36

Manual monostable

30

C/USCSVP

3/2 N.C.

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

25

36

-

30

C/USCSGP

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

C/USCSVP

C/USASVP - C/USASGP HA TYPE

57 55,5 C/USASVP C/USASGP

MODULAR BASE SIDE PORTED G 1/8 - ELPP8S

M3 DEPTH 8

24 x No. of stations

HOW TO ORDER A SOLENOID VALVE COMPLETE OF COIL AND BASE

Example: 3/2 N.C. solenoid valve base mounted (with manual override) + coil 24 V D.C. ELPP8S/P/USB/02400

WEIGHT 50 g

DESCRIPTION 3/2 N.O. + base + coil (with manual override) 3/2 N.O. + base + coil (without manual override) 3/2 N.C. + base + coil (with manual override)

Direct acting solenoid valves series C/

TYPE ELPP8S/PAV/USB/voltage ELPP8S/PAG/USB/voltage ELPP8S/P/USB/voltage

2.11

2


C/

Direct acting solenoid valves with sleeve Ø 9 mm - bases

series

3 PORT WITH ex CNOMO INTERFACE FOR MODULAR BASES AND VALVES TO ISO 5599/1 Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O.

2

3/2 N.O.

3/2 N.C.

3/2 N.C.

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

36

Manual monostable

60

C/UEASVB

23

36

-

45

C/UEASGB

10

25

36

Bistable screw driver slot

45

C/UECSVB

10

25

36

Monostable push button

45

C/UECSPB

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

13

23

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

13

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

C/UECSVB - C/UECSPB

C/UEASVB - C/UEASGB HA 65 61 TYPE C/UEASVB C/UEASGB

ex CNOMO MODULAR BASE SIDE PORTED G 1/8 - ELPG8S

32 x No. of stations

WEIGHT 45 g

HOW TO ORDER A SOLENOID VALVE COMPLETE OF COIL AND BASE DESCRIPTION 3/2 N.O. + base + coil (with manual override) 3/2 N.O. + base + coil (without manual override) 3/2 N.C. + base + coil (with manual override) 3/2 N.C. + base + coil (with push button manual override)

TYPE ELPG8S/BAV/USBG/voltage ELPG8S/BAG/USBG/voltage ELPG8S/B/USBG/voltage ELPG8S/BP/USBG/voltage

Example: 3/2 N.O. solenoid valve base mounted (with manual override) + coil 24 V D.C. ELPG8S/BAV/USBG/02400

2.12

Direct acting solenoid valves series C/


C/

Direct acting solenoid valves with sleeve Ø 9 mm

series

3 PORT WITH INTERFACE FOR POPPET AND ex CETOP (WITH FIXED POSITION AND ROTATABLE COIL) VALVES Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.C.

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

25

36

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

Manual bistable

30

C/USCSVG

2

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

C/USCSVG

3 PORT BODY PORTED G 1/8 FOR DIRECT MOUNTING This solenoid valve has been specifically designed to pilot single acting small cylinders and pneumatic valves. The input connection is M5 while the output has a male thread G1/8 that allows the direct assembling of the solenoid valve on the component. Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.C.

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

20

36

Manual override

Weight (g)

TYPE*

-

46

C/ELP8M

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

C/ELP8M

Direct acting solenoid valves series C/

2.13


USB

Coils for solenoid valves side 22 mm with sleeve Ø 9 mm

series

TECHNICAL DATA

USB

Voltages

2

DC: 24 V AC: 24 V - 110 V - 220 V Working temperature -30 ÷ +40 °C basic version -30 ÷ +70 °C low absorption version Power consumption Basic version DC: 5 W AC : 11 VA (inrush) Low absorption version DC: 2,5 W AC: 5,6 VA (inrush) Standard frequencies AC 50 - 60 Hz Voltage tolerance ± 10% of rated voltage Coil insulation class F Solenoid rating 100% ED Electrical connection Fit for connector to DIN 46244 standard See chapter Connectors series USR on page 2.15 Protection class IP 65 with connector

MATERIALS Body Coil winding

Glass stiffened polyamide Copper wire

USBG

series

TECHNICAL DATA

WEIGHT 50 g

DESCRIPTION Coil 22 mm 24 V DC Coil 22 mm 24 V AC Coil 22 mm 110 V AC Coil 22 mm 220 V AC Coil 22 mm 24 V DC - low absorption Coil 22 mm 24 V AC - low absorption Coil 22 mm 110 V AC - low absorption Coil 22 mm 220 V AC - low absorption OTHER VOLTAGES

TYPE USB/02400 USB/02450-60 USB/11050-60 USB/22050-60 USB-BA/02400 USB-BA/02450-60 USB-BA/11050-60 USB-BA/22050-60 USB/...

Coils for solenoid valves side 30 mm with sleeve Ø 9 mm to ex CNOMO standards USBG

Voltages

DC: 24 V AC: 24 V - 110 V - 220 V Working temperature -30 ÷ +40 °C basic version -30 ÷ +70 °C low absorption version Power consumption Basic version DC: 5 W AC : 11 VA (inrush) Low absorption version DC: 2,5 W AC: 5,6 VA (inrush) Standard frequencies AC 50 - 60 Hz Voltage tolerance ± 10% of rated voltage Coil insulation class H Solenoid rating 100% ED Electrical connection Fit for connector to DIN 43650 standard, shape “A” See chapter Connectors series ULR on page 2.13 Protection class IP 65 with connector

MATERIALS Body Coil winding

2.14

Glass stiffened polyamide Copper wire

WEIGHT 105 g

DESCRIPTION Coil 30 mm 24 V DC Coil 30 mm 24 V AC Coil 30 mm 110 V AC Coil 30 mm 220 V AC Coil 30 mm 24 V DC - low absorption Coil 30 mm 24 V AC - low absorption Coil 30 mm 110 V AC - low absorption Coil 30 mm 220 V AC - low absorption OTHER VOLTAGES

Coils for solenoid valves

TYPE USBG/02400 USBG/02450-60 USBG/11050-60 USBG/22050-60 USBG-BA/02400 USBG-BA/02450-60 USBG-BA/11050-60 USBG-BA/22050-60 USBG/...


MEK192/N

Connectors for solenoid valves side 15 mm series UM

series

MEK192/N

TECHNICAL DATA Voltages

DC: MAX. 300 V AC: MAX. 250 V Working temperature -40 ÷ + 90 °C Versions Basic With indicator light (LED) With indicator light (LED) and varistat (VDR) as electrical protection Number of pins 2 + earthed Nominal current 6A Maximum current 10 A Contacts resistance ≤ 4 mOhm Protection class IP 65 EN 60529 Connector insulation class IEC 664 / VDE 0110-1/89

Connectors DIN 46244 for coils side 22 mm series USB and series WE (3A)

WEIGHT 10 g

DESCRIPTION Basic connector Connector with led + VDR as protection 24 V DC/AC Connector with led + VDR as protection 110 V DC/AC Connector with led + VDR as protection 220 V DC/AC Connector with led 24 V DC/AC Connector with led 110/220 V DC/AC

TYPE MEK192/N MEK192/NVD 24V CC/CA MEK192/NVD 110V CC/CA MEK192/NVD 220V CC/CA MEK192/NLED 24V CC/CA MEK192/NLED 110/220VCC/CA

USR102/N9

series

USR102/N9

TECHNICAL DATA Voltages

DC: MAX. 300 V AC: MAX. 250 V Working temperature -40 ÷ +90 °C Versions Basic With indicator light (LED) With indicator light (LED) and varistat (VDR) as electrical protection Number of pins 2 + earthed Nominal current 10 A Maximum current 16 A Contacts resistance ≤ 4 mOhm Protection class IP 65 EN 60529 Connector insulation class IEC 664 / VDE 0110-1/89

WEIGHT 20 g

DESCRIPTION Basic connector Connector with led + VDR as protection 24 V DC/AC Connector with led + VDR as protection 110 V DC/AC Connector with led + VDR as protection 220 V DC/AC Connector with led 24 V DC/AC Connector with led 110/220 V DC/AC

Connectors DIN 43650 - form “A” for solenoid valves side 30 mm series UL and coils series USBG and series WE (2A, 5A)

Working temperature Versions Number of pins Nominal current Maximum current Contacts resistance Protection class Connector insulation class

ULR1B

series ULR1B

TECHNICAL DATA Voltages

TYPE USR102/N9 USR102/N9VD 24 V CC/CA USR102/N9VD 110 V CC/CA USR102/N9VD 220 V CC/CA USR102/N9LED 24 V CC/CA USR102/N9LED 110/220 V CC/CA

DC: MAX. 300V AC: MAX. 250V -40 ÷ + 90 °C Basic With indicator light (LED) With indicator light (LED) and varistat (VDR) as electrical protection 2 + earthed 6A 10 A ≤ 4 mOhm IP 65 EN 60529 IEC 664 / VDE 0110-1/89

WEIGHT 25 g

DESCRIPTION Basic connector Connector with led + VDR as protection 24 V DC/AC Connector with led + VDR as protection 110 V DC/AC Connector with led + VDR as protection 220 V DC/AC Connector with led 24 V DC/AC Connector with led 110/220 V DC/AC

Connectors for solenoid valves

TYPE ULR1B ULR1B/VD 24 V CC/CA ULR1B/VD 110 V CC/CA ULR1B/VD 220 V CC/CA ULR1B/LED 24 V CC/CA ULR1B/LED 110/220 V CC/CA

2.15

2


MEV

series

Spool compact valves pilot and solenoid actuated G 1/8 and to VDMA 24563 standards size 02

DESCRIPTION

MATERIALS

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumatic piloting port size Nominal diameter Piloting solenoid valve Electric connectors

Monostable 1,8 ÷ 8 bar Bistable 1 ÷ 8 bar 0 ÷ +60 °C (-10 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 Size 02 = Interface to VDMA 24563 standard G 1/8 = M5 Size 02 = Interface to VDMA 24563 standard 5 mm UMCSV - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves page 2.3 MEK 192/N - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 See Multi-pin connection on page 2.28

Plastic Anodized aluminium alloy treated with PTFE Stainless steel NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT 5/2 monostable and bistable 5/3 closed centre 5/3 open centre 5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic spring

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - MEV/18

Operating pressure (bar)

2.16

MEV/SG MEV/CC/SG MEV/CA/SG MEV/CP/SG

PILOTING CHART - MEV/8 - MEV/18

Piloting pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - MEV/8

Bottoms Body Springs Seals Spool Piston

Flow rate (Nl/min)

2

Valves series "MEV" have been designed to satisfy the need of integration between pneumatics and electronics. Their main feature is the possibility to offer valve islands complete with the electrical connection. This series, realized in the 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions, is composed of two types of valves: “MEV 8”, body ported G 1/8, prearranged for both single use and for mounting on multiple base with fixed stations; “MEV 18” (size 02), to VDMA 24563 (UNI 10528) standards, prearranged for mounting on both single and manifold bases. Both the multiple bases (that convey the exhausts port of the solenoid actuated electropilots) and the manifold ones are fit for mounting onto rails according to DIN 46277/3. For the 24 V AC/DC solenoid actuated valves with coils toward the bottom (versions “MEVX”), are available modules with two or four stations to carry out a multi-pin connection through a 25-pin plug with protection class “IP 65” (see technical information on page 0.4).

Spool compact valves series MEV


MEV

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - MEV 8 Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate

Weight (g)

TYPE

650

100

MEV8 KR/ZR

20

650

100

MEV8 KR/TQ

10

10

650

100

MEV8 KR/KR

Mechanical spring

10

10

510

100

MEV8 SR/SR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

10

510

100

MEV8 AR/AR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

10

650

100

MEV8 PR/PR

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

10

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

12

5/2 bistable

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

5/3 closed center

Solenoid

5/3 open center 5/3 pressure center

5/2 monostable

5 PORT - MONOSTABLE

5 PORT - BISTABLE

2 HOLES Ø3.2

2 HOLES Ø3.2

2 HOLES Ø3.2

2 HOLES Ø3.2

5 PORT - 3 POSITIONS

2 HOLES Ø3.2

2 HOLES Ø3.2

Spool compact valves series MEV

2.17

2


MEV

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - MEV 8 Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

30

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

10

20

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

10

30

Solenoid

Solenoid

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

MEV8 KUC/ZR

650

130

MEV8 KUC/TQ

MEV8 KUR/ZR

MEV8 KUC/KUC 10

10

650

160

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEV8 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEV8 SUC/SUC 10

25

510

160

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEV8 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEV8 AUC/AUC 10

25

510

160

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEV8 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEV8 PUC/PUC 10

Solenoid pilot assisted

25

650

160

Mechanical spring

MEV8 PUR/PUR

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER - E.G.: MEV8 KUC/ZR 02400 TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3)

5 PORT - MONOSTABLE

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

5 PORT - BISTABLE

2 HOLES Ø3,2

2 HOLES Ø3,2

2 HOLES Ø3,2 2 HOLES Ø3,2

N.B.: Dado stelo di serie

2.18

TYPE*

Spool compact valves series MEV

11050-60 = 110 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC


MEV

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series 5 PORT - 3 POSITIONS

2 HOLES Ø3,2

2 2 HOLES Ø3,2

Spool compact valves series MEV

2.19


MEV

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH COILS TOWARD THE BOTTOM G 1/8 - MEVX 8 SUITABLE FOR SINGLE USE OR MULTI-PIN PLUG CONNECTOR Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

30

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

10

20

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

10

30

Solenoid

Solenoid

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEVX8 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEVX8 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEVX8 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEVX8 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEVX8 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEVX8 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

10

10

10

10

5 PORT - MONOSTABLE

MEVX8 KUC/ZR

650

130

MEVX8 KUC/TQ

MEVX8 KUR/ZR

MEVX8 KUC/KUC 10

25

25

25

650

510

510

650

175

175

175

175 MEVX8 PUR/PUR

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER - E.G.: MEVX8 KUC/ZR 02400 (TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3)

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

5 PORT - BISTABLE AND 5 PORT - 3 POSITIONS

2 HOLES Ø3,2 2 HOLES Ø3,2

2 HOLES Ø3,2

2.20

TYPE*

Pilot

2 HOLES Ø3,2

Spool compact valves series MEV


MEV

Accessories Bases G 1/8

series

BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/8 - KB/MEV8 - Fit for mounting onto DIN 46277/3 rail

2

No. of stations 2 A 67 Weight (g) 324 TYPE* KB/MEV8/2

3 87 421 KB/MEV8/3

4 107 518 KB/MEV8/4

5 127 615 KB/MEV8/5

6 147 712 KB/MEV8/6

8 10 12 14 16 18 20 187 227 267 307 347 387 427 905 1098 1292 1486 1680 1873 2067 KB/MEV8/8 KB/MEV8/10 KB/MEV8/12 KB/MEV8/14 KB/MEV8/16 KB/MEV8/18 KB/MEV8/20

* BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

FIXING PLATE FOR DIN 46277/3 RAIL - MEV8/PF

BLANKING PLATE - MEV8/PC

WEIGHT 20 g

BLANKING PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

WEIGHT 7 g

FIXING PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS

Spool compact valves series MEV

2.21


MEV

Size 02

series

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES TO VDMA 24563 STANDARD SIZE 02 - MEV 18 Controls Symbol

Function

TYPE

Return

Energized

De-energized

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

12

50

510

100

MEV18 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

35

510

100

MEV18 KR/TQ

5/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

12

12

510

100

MEV18 KR/KR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

15

15

420

100

MEV18 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

15

15

420

100

MEV18 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

15

15

500

100

MEV18 PR/PR

5 PORT - MONOSTABLE

5 PORT - BISTABLE

5 PORT - 3 POSITIONS

2.22

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Pilot

5/2 monostable

2

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Spool compact valves series MEV


MEV

Size 02

series SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO VDMA 24563 STANDARD SIZE 02 - MEV 18 Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

50

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

12

35

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

10

50

Solenoid

Solenoid

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEV18 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEV18 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEV18 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEV18 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEV18 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEV18 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEV18 KUC/ZR

510

130

MEV18 KUC/TQ

MEV18 KUR/ZR

MEV18 KUC/KUC 10

10

10

10

10

30

30

30

510

420

420

500

160

160

160

160 MEV18 PUR/PUR

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER - E.G.: MEV18 KUC/ZR 02400 (TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” – SEE ON PAGE 2.3)

5 PORT - MONOSTABLE

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar ΔP = 1 bar (NI/min)

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

11050-60 = 110 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC

5 PORT - BISTABLE

Spool compact valves series MEV

2.23

2


MEV

series

5 PORT - 3 POSITION

2

2.24

Spool compact valves series MEV

Size 02


MEV

Size 02

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH COILS TOWARD THE BOTTOM TO VDMA 24563 STANDARD SIZE 02 - MEVX 18 SUITABLE FOR SINGLE USE OR MULTI-PIN PLUG CONNECTOR Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

50

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

12

35

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

10

50

Solenoid

Solenoid

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEVX18 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEVX18 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEVX18 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEVX18 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEVX18 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEVX18 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEVX18 KUC/ZR

510

130

MEVX18 KUC/TQ

MEVX18 KUR/ZR

MEVX18 KUC/KUC 10

10

10

10

10

30

30

30

510

420

420

500

175

175

175

175 MEVX18 PUR/PUR

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER - E.G.: MEVX18 KUC/ZR 02400 (TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3)

5 PORT - MONOSTABLE

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

5 PORT - BISTABLE AND 5 PORT - 3 POSITIONS

Spool compact valves series MEV

2.25

2


MEV

series

Accessories Single and manifold bases to VDMA 24563 standard size 02

INPUT PLATES (pair) - MEV18PE

2

END-PLATE, LEFT HAND WEIGHT 200 G

END-PLATE, RIGHT HAND WEIGHT 200 G

INPUT PLATES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

MANIFOLD BASE, SIDE PORTED - MEV18BM

INTERMEDIATE PLATE, TOP PORTED - MEV18PUS

WEIGHT 200 g

MANIFOLD BASE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

SINGLE BASE SIDE PORTED - MEV18S BS

WEIGHT 200 g

INTERMEDIATE PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

BLANKING PLATE - MEV18PC

WEIGHT 20 g

BLANKING PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

DIAPHRAGM - MEV18DG (No.3 PCS)

WEIGHT 100 g

2.26

Spool compact valves series MEV

DIAPHRAGM - MEV18DP (No.2 PCS)


MEV

Accessories Bases

series

EXAMPLE OF ASSEMBLY - MEV 8 - MEVX 8

4 HOLES M5

2

27 + (20 x N째. of stations)

EXAMPLE OF ASSEMBLY - MEV 18 - MEVX 18

40 + (20 x No. of stations)

* WITH THE PILOT ACTUATED VALVES USE THE TWO DIAPHRAGMS (TYPE MEV18DP) TO EXCLUDE THE PILOTING EXHAUST (SEE ON PAGE 2.26)

Spool compact valves series MEV

2.27


MEV

Accessories Multi-pin connection with solenoid valves versions MEVX 8 and MEVX 18

series

25-PIN PLUG, SINGLE - MEV/C1

25-PIN PLUG, DOUBLE - MEV/C2

2

WEIGHT 35 g

TWO STATIONS MODULE, LEFT - MEV/M2S/AC or DC (24 V)

SUPPLIED WITH A PLATE TYPE MEV/P

WEIGHT 25 g

FOUR STATIONS MODULE, LEFT - MEV/M4S/AC or DC (24 V)

WEIGHT 45 g

SUPPLIED WITH A PLATE TYPE MEV/P

BLANKING CAP - MEV/C

FIXING PLATE - MEV/P

WEIGHT 80 g

TWO STATIONS MODULE, RIGHT - MEV/M2D/AC or DC

SUPPLIED WITH A PLATE TYPE MEV/P

WEIGHT 25 g

FOUR STATIONS MODULE, RIGHT - MEV/M4D/AC or DC (24 V)

SUPPLIED WITH A PLATE TYPE MEV/P

WEIGHT 45 g

PRE-ASSEMBLED MULTI-PIN CABLE “X” METERS LONG WITH 25-PIN SUB-D PLUG MEV/CF “X” (X= 3, 5, OR 10 m)

WEIGHT 10 g

BLANKING PLATE - MEV/PM

SUPPLIED WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

2.28

WEIGHT 4 g

SUPPLIED WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

WEIGHT 30 g

Multi-pin connection valves series MEV

WEIGHT 3 m = 170 g; 5 m = 410 g; 10 m = 760 g


MEV

Accessories Multi-pin connection with solenoid valves versions MEVX 8 and MEVX 18

series

TECHNICAL INFORMATION CONNECTION WITH ONE DOUBLE 25-PIN SUB-D PLUG, FOR 2 รท 11 STATIONS VALVE ISLANDS Valve Pilot coil

1

2

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

11

14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx)

PIN Number

1

12

2

Color

brown

green white

red

Valve Pilot coil

3

13

3

green orange chiaro

-

14

4

15

red black

yellow

5

orange green black

16

6

yellow black

blue

17

7

green purple black

18

8

19

grey black

grey

9

black white sky blue

20

10

21

11

22

rose black

black

brown black

rose

ornage white

-

GND* GND* GND*

-

PIN Number

23

24

25

-

Color

yellow green

sky blue

grey green

-

*Common cable P.S.: For monostable solenoid valves use left modules

SX

DX

CONNECTION WITH TWO SINGLE 25-PIN SUB-D PLUGS, FOR 2 รท 16 STATIONS VALVE ISLANDS Valve Pilot coil PIN Number

1

2

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

11

14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 1

1

Color

brown brown

Valve

12

Pilot coil

3

2

2

red

red

3

3

4

4

orange orange yellow yellow

13

14

5

5

6

6

green

green

blue

blue

15

16

7

7

purple purple

-

12

12

13

13

14

14

Color

green white

green white

green chiaro

green chiaro

red black

red black

15

15

16

16

orange orange yellow yellow black black black black

17 green black

8

9

9

10

10

11

11

grey

grey

white

white

black

black

red

red

-

-

14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) 14(sx) 12(dx) GND* GND* GND* GND*

PIN Number

8

18

19

20

green black rose black sky blue black

-

-

NC

NC

NC

NC

NC

-

21

22

23

24

25

-

brown orange yellow grey sky blue black white green green

-

*Common cable

Multi-pin connection valves series MEV

2.29

2


MEV

series

MEVX 8 WITH DOUBLE 25-PIN SUB-D PLUG

Assembling examples Multi-pin connection with solenoid valves versions MEVX 8 and MEVX 18 MEVX 8 WITH SINGLE 25-PIN SUB-D PLUG

2

33.5 + (20 x N째 of stations)

31.5 + (20 x N째 of stations)

MEVX 18 WITH DOUBLE 25-PIN SUB-D PLUG

MEVX 18 SINGLE 25-PIN SUB-D PLUG

40 + (20 x N째 of stations)

40 + (20 x N째 of stations)

2.30

Multi-pin connection valves series MEV


Assembling examples Multi-pin connection with solenoid valves versions MEVX 8 and MEVX 18 Solenoid valves versions MEVX allow a multi-pin plug connection with the possibility of creating islands of pre-assembled solenoid valves with a number of positions chosen by the user during the assembling of the components.

MEV

series

The replacement of the solenoid valves can be easily made in every moment. Connection modules are at 2 or 4 positions that can operate with 24 V AC or DC voltage.

2 MEV/PM MEV/C2 Double 25-pin sub-d plug for batteries of bistable solenoid valves.

MEV/M4S/AC or DC (24 V) MEV/C

MEV/P

MEV8/PC

MEV/M2D/AC or DC (24 V)

KB/MEV8

Manifold base to VDMA 24563 size 02 MEV18BM

The bases are ďŹ t for mounting onto rails according to DIN 46277/3

MEV18PE

Possibility of assembling till No. 4 modules of 4 positions each, for a total of 16 solenoid valves and the 2 positions module as ďŹ nal element for manifolds of 2, 6, 10, 14 positions.

Multi-pin connection valves series MEV

MEV/C1 Single 25-pin sub-d plug for manifolds of monostable solenoid valves

2.31


MEK

Spool compact valves pilot and solenoid actuated G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure

MATERIALS

Monostable: 2 ÷ 8 bar Bistable: 1,5 ÷ 8 bar 0 ÷ +60 °C (-10 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 M5

Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumatic piloting port size Nominal diameter G 1/8 = 5 mm; G 1/4 = 6,5 mm Piloting solenoid valve UMCSV for G 1/8 and G 1/4 – see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.3; C/USCSVP for G 1/4 – see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.11 Coil USB for G 1/4 – see chapter Coils on page 2.14 Electric connectors MEK192/N for G 1/8 and G1/4 with UMCSV; USR102/N9 for G 1/4 with C/USCSVP See chapter Connectors on page 2.15

FLOW CHART - MEK G 1/8 - 5/2

Bottoms Body Springs Seals Spool Piston

Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy Stainless steel NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy

SPARE PARTS Contact the commercial office

PILOTING CHART - MEK G 1/8

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring

FLOW CHART - MEK G 1/4 - 5/2

Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOTING CHART - MEK G 1/4

Piloting pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring

Flow rate (Nl/min)

2

Valves series "MEK", in the 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions, have been realized with compact overall dimensions yet assuring high flow. The kind of construction is based on a balanced spool with dynamic seal thanks to antiglueing mix seals positioned on the same spool. In the solenoid control version, size G 1/8 supports 15 mm low absorption direct acting solenoid valve type UMCSV, while size G 1/4 supports both 15 than 22 mm direct acting solenoid valve type C/USCSVP with sleeve Ø 9 mm. This series of valves is prearranged for manifold mounting with fixed stations and with conveyed inlet and exhausts, by means of frontal screws. The bases are fit for mounting onto rails according to DIN 46277/3.

Operating pressure (bar)

2.32

Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Spool compact valves series MEK


MEK

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

5

10

530

110

MEKCA8 KR/ZQ

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

7

5

530

110

MEKCA8 KR/TQ

5/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

3

3

530

120

MEKCA8 KR/KR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

4

8

450

135

MEKCA8 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

4

8

450

135

MEKCA8 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

4

8

450

135

MEKCA8 PR/PR

5/2 monostable

MEKCA8 KR/TQ

MEKCA8 KR/ZQ

2 HOLES Ø3,5

2 HOLES Ø3,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

MEKCA8 KR/KR

MEKCA8 SR/SR - MEKCA8 AR/AR - MEKCA8 PR/PR

2 HOLES Ø3,5

2 HOLES Ø3,5 N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

Spool compact valves series MEK

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

2.33

2


MEK

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Weight (g)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Pneumomechanical spring

12

15

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

12

15

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

10

20

Solenoid

Solenoid

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEKCA8 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA8 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA8 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA8 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA8 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA8 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA8 KUC/ZQ

530

150

MEKCA8 KUC/TQ

MEKCA8 KUR/ZQ

MEKCA8 KUC/KUC 9

10

10

10

9

25

25

25

530

450

450

450

195

210

210

210 MEKCA8 PUR/PUR

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER - E.G.: MEKCA8 KUC/ZQ 02400 (TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3)

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

11050-60 = 110 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC

MEKCA8 KUC/TQ

MEKCA8 KUC/ZQ

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5 N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

2.34

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Spool compact valves series MEK

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2


MEK

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series MEKCA8 KUR/ZQ

MEKCA8 KUC/KUC

2 N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

MEKCA8 KUR/KUR

MEKCA8 SUC/SUC - MEKCA8 AUC/AUC - MEKCA8 PUC/PUC

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5 N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

MEKCA8 SUR/SUR - MEKCA8 AUR/AUR - MEKCA8 PUR/PUR

N° 2 HOLES Ø3,5 N° 2 HOLES Ø3,2

Spool compact valves series MEK

2.35


MEK

Accessories Bases G 1/8

series

BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/8 - KB/MEK8 - Fit for mounting onto DIN 46277/3 rail

NO. 4 HOLES M5

2

N° of stations 2 L 66 Weight (g) 175 TYPE* KB/MEK8/2

3 85 220 KB/MEK8/3

4 104 265 KB/MEK8/4

5 123 310 KB/MEK8/5

6 142 355 KB/MEK8/6

8 10 12 14 16 18 20 180 218 256 294 332 370 408 445 535 625 715 805 895 985 KB/MEK8/8 KB/MEK8/10 KB/MEK8/12 KB/MEK8/14 KB/MEK8/16 KB/MEK8/18 KB/MEK8/20

* BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

BLANKING PLATE - KIT/PC/MEK8

PLATE WITH PUSH-IN FITTING FOR PIPE Ø 6 mm - KIT/IR/MEK8

CARTRIDGE Ø6

BLANKING PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

2.36

WEIGHT 15 g

Spool compact valves series MEK

WEIGHT 45 g


MEK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 Controls Symbol

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

5/2 monostable

Pneumatic

Pneumomechanical spring

7

3

900

190

MEKCA4 KR/ZQ

5/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

5

5

900

215

MEKCA4 KR/KR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

5

15

600

240

MEKCA4 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

5

15

600

240

MEKCA4 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

5

15

600

240

MEKCA4 PR/PR

Function

MEKCA4 KR/ZQ

Weight (g)

TYPE

MEKCA4 KR/KR

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5 N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

MEKCA4 SR/SR - MEKCA4 AR/AR - MEKCA4 PR/PR

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5 N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

Spool compact valves series MEK

2.37

2


MEK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH COIL SIZE 15 mm G 1/4 Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

2

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms) Energized

De-energized

TYPE*

Pilot

Solenoid

Pneumomechanical spring

Solenoid pilot assisted

Pneumomechanical spring pilot assisted

MEKCA4 KUR/ZQ

Solenoid

Solenoid

MEKCA4 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEKCA4 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 KUC/ZQ 15

10

15

12

10

20

10

30

30

30

900

900

600

600

600

225

290

315

315

315 MEKCA4 PUR/PUR

02400 = 24 V DC 02450-60 = 24 V AC

MEKCA4 KUR/ZQ

MEKCA4 KUC/ZQ

Weight (g)

Pilot

* SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER - E.G.: MEKCA4 KUC/ZQ 02450-60 TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3)

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

2.38

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Spool compact valves series MEK

11050-60 = 110 V AC 22050-60 = 220 V AC


MEK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series MEKCA4 KUR/KUR

MEKCA4 KUC/KUC

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

MEKCA4 SUC/SUC - MEKCA4 AUC/AUC - MEKCA4 PUC/PUC

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

2

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

MEKCA4 SUR/SUR - MEKCA4 AUR/AUR - MEKCA4 PUR/PUR

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

Spool compact valves series MEK

2.39


MEK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SLEEVE Ø 9 mm G 1/4 Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

2

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms) Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Weight (g)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Solenoid

Pneumomechanical spring

Solenoid pilot assisted

Pneumomechanical spring pilot assisted

MEKCA4 KURG/ZQ

Solenoid

Solenoid

MEKCA4 KUCG/KUCG

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

MEKCA4 KURG/KURG

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 SUCG/SUCG

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 SURG/SURG

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 AUCG/AUCG

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 AURG/AURG

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 PUCG/PUCG

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

MEKCA4 KUCG/ZQ 22

16

21

18

15

24

16

30

30

30

900

900

600

600

600

210

260

280

280

280 MEKCA4 PURG/PURG

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

MEKCA4 KURG/ZQ

MEKCA4 KUCG/ZQ

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

2.40

Spool compact valves series MEK

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3


MEK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series MEKCA4 KURG/KURG

MEKCA4 KUCG/KUCG

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

2

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

MEKCA4 SUCG/SUCG - MEKCA4 PUCG/PUCG - MEKCA4 AUCG/AUCG

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

MEKCA4 SURG/SURG - MEKCA4 PURG/PURG - MEKCA4 AURG/AURG

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,5

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

Spool compact valves series MEK

N° 2 HOLES Ø4,3

2.41


MEK

Accessories Bases G 1/4

series

BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/4 - KB/MEK4 - Fit for mounting onto DIN 46277/3 rail

NO. 4 HOLES M5

2

N° of stations 2 L 82 Weight (g) 370 TYPE* KB/MEK4/2

3 108 475 KB/MEK4/3

4 134 580 KB/MEK4/4

5 160 685 KB/MEK4/5

6 186 790 KB/MEK4/6

8 10 12 14 16 18 20 238 290 342 394 446 498 550 1000 1210 1220 1630 1840 2050 2260 KB/MEK4/8 KB/MEK4/10 KB/MEK4/12 KB/MEK4/14 KB/MEK4/16 KB/MEK4/18 KB/MEK4/20

* BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

BLANKING PLATE - KIT/PC /MEK4

PLATE WITH PUSH-IN FITTING FOR PIPE Ø 8 mm - KIT/IR/MEK4

CARTRIDGE Ø8

BLANKING PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

2.42

WEIGHT 50 g

Spool compact valves series MEK

WEIGHT 90 g


EK

Spool valves pilot and solenoid actuated G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2

series

DESCRIPTION Valves series "EK" are produced in the 3/2, 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions. The piloting solenoid valve can be assembled perpendicular respect the body valve, thanks to a suitable bracket. The kind of construction is based on a balanced spool with static seal, being the seals supported by distance rings integral to the body. This series of valves, in the size G 1/8 and G 1/4, is prearranged for both manifold mounting (conveyed inlet and exhausts), or supply rail mounting (conveyed inlet), by means of rear notch screws. The versions size G 1/4 - 5 port are available even with “Namur” port pattern.

2 MATERIALS

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumatic piloting port size Nominal diameter Piloting solenoid valve Coils Electric connectors

Monostable: 2,5 ÷ 10 bar Bistable: 2 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +70 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 G 1/8 G 1/8 = 5 mm; G 1/4 = 7 mm; G 1/2 = 12 mm C/USCSVP - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.11 USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 USBG - see chapter Coils on page 2.14* USR 102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15*

*Only for single valve (coil and connector overcome the overall dimensions of the valves)

FLOW CHART - EK G 1/8 - 5/2

Bottoms Body Distance rings

Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy G 1/8 - G 1/4: Acetal resin G 1/2: Brass Galvanized steel NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy

Springs Seals Spools Piston

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT 3 port G 1/8 3 port G 1/4 3 port G 1/2 5 port G 1/8 5 port G 1/4 5 port G 1/2 5 port G 1/4 Namur

EK/SG/8 EK/SG/4 EK/SG/2 EKCA/SG/8 EKCA/SG/4 EKCA/SG/2 ENCA/SG/4

PILOTING CHART - EK G 1/8

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring

Operating pressure (bar)

Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOTING CHART - EK G 1/4

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - EK G 1/4 - 5/2

Mechanical spring

Operating pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring Mechanical spring Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Spool valves series EK

2.43


EK

G 1/8 - 3 PORT

series

FLOW CHART - EK G 1/2 - 5/2

PILOTING CHART - EK G 1/2

Mechanical spring Double pneumatic control

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

2

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - 3 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Weight (g)

TYPE

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

18

10

550

220

EKA8 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

26

16

550

215

EKA8 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

14

8

550

220

EKC8 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

30

28

550

215

EKC8 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

10

10

550

215

EK8 KR/KR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

10

15

550

215

EK8 KR/TR

3/2 N.A. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 bistable

3 PORT

3 HOLES Ă˜5.2

2.44

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

10

550

270

EKCA8 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

25

15

550

260

EKCA8 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

10

10

550

230

EKCA8 KR/KR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

12

15

550

230

EKCA8 KR/TR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

25

425

285

EKCA8 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

25

500

285

EKCA8 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

15

20

425

285

EKCA8 PR/PR

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

Weight (g)

TYPE

5 PORT

4 HOLES Ă˜5.2

Spool valves series EK

2.45

2


EK

G 1/8 - 3 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - 3 PORT Controls Symbol

2

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 bistable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Weight (g)

TYPE*

550

250

EKA8 KUC/ZR

27

550

245

EKA8 KUC/TQ

24

28

550

250

EKA8 KUR/ZR

Mechanical spring

32

31

550

250

EKC8 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

22

28

550

245

EKC8 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

32

31

550

250

EKC8 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Solenoid

21

21

550

290

EK8 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

21

21

550

290

EK8 KUR/KUR

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

28

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

18

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

Solenoid

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKC8 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKC8 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

3 PORT MONOSTABLE

3 PORT BISTABLE

3 HOLES Ø5.2

2.46

3 HOLES Ø5.2

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/8 - 5 PORT

series SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

30

550

300

EKCA8 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

27

39

550

300

EKCA8 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

20

30

550

300

EKCA8 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Solenoid

18

18

550

325

EKCA8 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

18

18

550

325

EKCA8 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

23

37

425

335

EKCA8 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

23

37

425

335

EKCA8 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

23

37

500

345

EKCA8 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

23

37

500

345

EKCA8 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

35

425

335

EKCA8 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

20

25

425

335

EKCA8 PUR/PUR

Weight (g)

TYPE*

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKCA8 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKCA8 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

5 PORT MONOSTABLE

5 PORT AND 3 POSITION BISTABLE

4 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

Spool valves series EK

2.47

2


EK

Accessories Bases G 1/8

series

BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/8 - KB/EK8

4 HOLES Ø4.2

2

No. of stations 2 L 74 Weight (g) 220 TYPE* KB/EK8/2

3 97 285 KB/EK8/3

4 120 350 KB/EK8/4

5 143 415 KB/EK8/5

6 166 480 KB/EK8/6

8 212 610 KB/EK8/8

10 12 14 16 18 20 258 304 350 396 442 488 740 870 1000 1130 1260 1390 KB/EK8/10 KB/EK8/12 KB/EK8/14 KB/EK8/16 KB/EK8/18 KB/EK8/20

* BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS AND SEALS

SUPPLY RAIL FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/8 - CEK8

BLANKING PLATE - KIT /PC/EK8

WEIGHT 40 g

No. of stations 2 3 5 LA 83 105 150 LB 101 123 168 Weight (g) 135 170 240 TYPE* CEK8/2 CEK8/3 CEK8/5 * SUPPLY RAILS ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS, SEALS AND FIXING BRACKETS

2.48

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/4 - 3 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 - 3 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

21

14

950

335

EKA4 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

28

10

950

325

EKA4 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

21

14

950

335

EKC4 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

25

11

950

325

EKC4 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

11

11

950

330

EK4 KR/KR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

10

18

950

330

EK4 KR/TR

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 bistable

Weight (g)

TYPE

3 PORT

3 HOLES Ă˜5.2

Spool valves series EK

2.49

2


EK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

900

385

EKCA4 KR/ZR

11

900

370

EKCA4 KR/TQ

11

11

900

370

EKCA4 KR/KR

Pneumatic differential

10

20

900

370

EKCA4 KR/TR

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

14

510

420

EKCA4 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

14

850

415

EKCA4 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

14

690

415

EKCA4 PR/PR

Return

Energized

De-energized

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

14

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

25

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

5/3 closed centre

5/2 bistable

5 PORT

4 HOLES Ă˜5.2

2.50

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE

Pilot

5/2 monostable

2

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Weight (g)

Function

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES “NAMUR” PORT PATTERN - G 1/4 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

14

900

390

ENCA4 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

25

11

900

375

ENCA4 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

11

11

900

375

ENCA4 KR/KR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

10

20

900

375

ENCA4 KR/TR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

14

510

425

ENCA4 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

14

850

420

ENCA4 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

14

690

420

ENCA4 PR/PR

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

Weight (g)

TYPE

“NAMUR” PORT PATTERN - 5 PORT

Ø5.5 DEPTH 5

2 THROUGH HOLES Ø5.5

Spool valves series EK

2.51

2


EK

G 1/4 - 3 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 - 3 PORT Controls Symbol

2

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 bistable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

22

60

950

385

EKA4 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

24

50

950

370

EKA4 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

22

60

950

385

EKA4 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

22

60

950

385

EKC4 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

24

50

950

370

EKC4 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

22

60

950

385

EKC4 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Solenoid

23

23

950

405

EK4 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

23

23

950

405

EK4 KUR/KUR

Weight (g)

TYPE*

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKC4 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKC4 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

3 PORT MONOSTABLE

3 PORT BISTABLE

4 HOLES Ø5.2

2.52

Spool valves series EK

4 HOLES Ø5.2


EK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

32

65

900

430

EKCA4 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

32

65

900

415

EKCA4 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

32

65

900

430

EKCA4 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Solenoid

21

21

900

475

EKCA4 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

21

21

900

475

EKCA4 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

50

510

490

EKCA4 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

50

510

490

EKCA4 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

50

850

485

EKCA4 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

50

850

485

EKCA4 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

50

690

490

EKCA4 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

50

690

490

EKCA4 PUR/PUR

Weight (g)

TYPE*

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKCA4 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKCA4 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

5 PORT MONOSTABLE

5 PORT AND 3 POSITION BISTABLE

4 HOLES Ø5.2

Spool valves series EK

4 HOLES Ø5.2

2.53

2


EK

G 1/4 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES “NAMUR” PORT PATTERN - G 1/4 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

32

65

900

440

ENCA4 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

32

65

900

425

ENCA4 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

32

65

900

440

ENCA4 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Solenoid

21

21

900

485

ENCA4 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

21

21

900

485

ENCA4 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

50

510

500

ENCA4 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

50

510

500

ENCA4 SUR/SUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

50

850

495

ENCA4 AUC/AUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

50

850

495

ENCA4 AUR/AUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

50

690

500

ENCA4 PUC/PUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

50

690

500

ENCA4 PUR/PUR

Weight (g)

TYPE*

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: ENCA4 KUC/TQ BECOMES ENCA4 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

“NAMUR” PORT PATTERN - 5 PORT MONOSTABLE

“NAMUR” PORT PATTERN - 5 PORT AND 3 POSITION BISTABLE

Ø5.5 DEPTH 5 2 THROUGH HOLES Ø5.5

Ø5.5 DEPTH 5 2 THROUGH HOLES Ø5.5

2.54

Spool valves series EK


EK

Accessories Bases G 1/4

series

BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/4 - KB/EK4

4 HOLES Ø5.5

2

No. of stations

2

L 83 Weight (g) 460 TYPE* KB/EK4/2

3

4

5

6

8

109 590 KB/EK4/3

135 720 KB/EK4/4

161 850 KB/EK4/5

187 980 KB/EK4/6

239 1240 KB/EK4/8

10

12

14

16

18

20

291 343 395 447 499 551 1500 1760 2020 2280 2540 2800 KB/EK4/10 KB/EK4/12 KB/EK4/14 KB/EK4/16 KB/EK4/18 KB/EK4/20

* BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS AND SEALS

SUPPLY RAIL FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/4 - CEK4

BLANKING PLATE - KIT/PC/EK4

WEIGHT 65 g

No. of stations 2 3 5 LA 99 125 176 LB 119 145 196 Weight (g) 310 390 550 TYPE* CEK4/2 CEK4/3 CEK4/5

* SUPPLY RAILS ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS, SEALS AND FIXING BRACKETS

Spool valves series EK

2.55


EK

G 1/2 - 3 and 5 PORT

series

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES G 1/2 - 3 PORT Controls Symbol

2

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

3/2 N.O. monostable

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

21

27

2400

770

EKA2 KR/ZR

3/2 N.O. monostable

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

21

27

2400

760

EKA2 KR/TQ

3/2 N.C. monostable

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

21

27

2200

770

EKC2 KR/ZR

3/2 N.C. monostable

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

21

27

2200

760

EKC2 KR/TQ

3/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

20

20

2200

790

EK2 KR/KR

Weight (g)

TYPE

Function

Weight (g)

TYPE

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/2 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

21

27

2800

1010

EKCA2 KR/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

21

27

2800

1000

EKCA2 KR/TQ

5/2 bistable

Solenoid

Solenoid

20

20

2800

1000

EKCA2 KR/KR

5/3 closed centre

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

25

1700

1020

EKCA2 SR/SR

Function

5/2 monostable

3 PORT BISTABLE

5 PORT BISTABLE

4 HOLES Ø6,5

3 HOLES Ø6,5

2.56

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/2 - 3 PORT

series SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/2 - 3 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 bistable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

90

2400

800

EKA2 KUC/ZR

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

30

90

2400

800

EKA2 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

90

2400

790

EKA2 KUC/TQ

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

90

2200

800

EKC2 KUC/ZR

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

30

90

2200

800

EKC2 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

90

2200

790

EKC2 KUC/TQ

Solenoid

Solenoid

25

25

2200

850

EK2 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

25

25

2200

850

EK2 KUR/KUR

Weight (g)

TYPE*

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKA2 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKA2 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

3 PORT MONOSTABLE

3 PORT BISTABLE

3 HOLES Ø6.5

3 HOLES Ø6.5

Spool valves series EK

2.57

2


EK

G 1/2 - 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/2 - 5 PORT Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

90

2800

1025

EKCA2 KUC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

30

90

2800

1015

EKCA2 KUC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

30

90

2800

1025

EKCA2 KUR/ZR

Solenoid

Solenoid

25

25

2800

1075

EKCA2 KUC/KUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

25

25

2800

1075

EKCA2 KUR/KUR

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

25

80

1700

1085

EKCA2 SUC/SUC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

25

80

1700

1085

EKCA2 SUR/SUR

5/3 closed centre

Weight (g)

TYPE*

P.S.: SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKCA2 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKCA2 KLC/TQ (SEE ON PAGE 2.59 FOR THE MISSING DIMENSIONS) *THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

5 VIE MONOSTABLE

5 VIE BISTABLE

NO. 4 HOLES Ø 6.5

2.58

Spool valves series EK


EK

90° solenoid actuated valves

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “U” WITH THE LETTER “L” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES WITH SOLENOID AT 90° RESPECT THE BODY OF THE VALVE. E.G.: EKCA2 KUC/TQ BECOMES EKCA2 KLC/TQ

G 1/8

G 1/4

G 1/2

2

ACCESSORIES MOUNTING BRACKET FOR PILOT AND SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TYPES EK 4 - EK 8 ON CYLINDER SERIES “CPUI” (see from page 1.25)

Ø CYLINDER 32 40 50 63 80 100

L 50,5 57,5 69 79,5 95,5 113

TYPE* SQ32-40/EK

* BRACKETS ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH DOWELS AND SCREWS P.S.: PLEASE CHECK BEFORE ORDERING THE COUPLED DIMENSIONS OF THE CYLINDER WITH THE VALVE

SQ50-63/EK SQ80-100/EK

Spool valves series EK

2.59


UK

Poppet valves pilot and solenoid actuated G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 - G 1

series

DESCRIPTION

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumatic piloting port size Nominal diameter

MATERIALS Solenoid actuated: 1,5 ÷ 10 bar Pilot actuated: 1,5 ÷ 12 bar 0 ÷ +70 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or lubricated compressed air - vacuum G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 1/8

Control rod Body Springs Seals Bush rod Piston Terminal strip Washer End plug Clamping screws

Hardened and nickel-plated steel Anodized aluminium alloy Stainless steel NBR rubber Brass Acetal resin Acetal resin Brass Nickel-plated brass Steel

PILOTING CHART - UK G 1/8

Piloting pressure (bar)

G 1/8 = 6 mm; G 1/4 = 8,5 mm; G 1/2 = 12 mm; G 1 = 23 mm Piloting solenoid valves UMCSV - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.3 ULCSV/R - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.6 C/USCSVG - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.13 Pneumatic piloting XVF4 - see chapter Complementary valves valve on page 3.37 Coils USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 (only for C/USCSVG) USBG - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 Electric connectors USR 102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 MEK 192/N - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOTING CHART - UK G1/4

Piloting pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - UK G 1/8 - 5/2

Flow rate (Nl/min)

2

Valves series "UK" are produced in the 2/2, 3/2 and 5/2 monostable pneumatic functions. In the 3 port solenoid control version with small pilot system, sizes G 1/8 and G 1/4, support the 15 mm direct acting solenoid valve (type UMCSV with fixed position). All the other electric versions can support the 32 mm direct acting solenoid valve, type ULCSV/R (with fixed position), type C/USCSVG with sleeve Ø 9 mm (with fixed position and rotatable coils series USB and USBG) or the amplifier valve XVF4 for a sensible pneumatic piloting (see page 3.36). The 3/2 N.C. pilot actuated valves can also be used to switch vacuum thanks to a suitably reinforced spring. The poppet design assures high flow and high life. This series of valves, in the sizes G 1/8, G 1/4 and G 1/2, is prearranged for base mounting with conveyed inlet by means of rear notch screws.

Operating pressure (bar)

2.60

Operating pressure (bar)

Poppet valves series UK


UK

G 1/8 - G1/4 - G 1/2 - G 1

series PILOTING CHART - UK G 1/2

2

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - UK G 1/4 - 5/2

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART UK - G 1/2 - 5/2

PILOTING CHART - UK G 1

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - UK G 1 - 5/2

Operating pressure (bar)

SPARE PARTS

Flow rate (Nl/min)

SEALS KIT

Operating pressure (bar)

3/2 N.O. G 1/8 small pilot system 3/2 N.C. G 1/8 small pilot system 3/2 N.O. G 1/8 big pilot system 3/2 N.C. G 1/8 big pilot system 5/2 G 1/8 3/2 N.O. G 1/4 small pilot system 3/2 N.C. G 1/4 small pilot system 3/2 N.O. G 1/4 big pilot system 3/2 N.C. G 1/4 big pilot system 5/2 G 1/4 3/2 N.O. G 1/2 small pilot system 3/2 N.C. G 1/2 small pilot system 3/2 N.O. G 1/2 big pilot system 3/2 N.C. G 1/2 big pilot system 5/2 G 1/2 3/2 N.O. G 1 3/2 N.C. G 1

Poppet valves series UK

UKA/12/SG/8 UKC/12/SG/8 UKA/25/SG/8 UKC/25/SG/8 UKCA/SG/8 UKA/16/SG/4 UKC/16/SG/4 UKA/32/SG/4 UKC/32/SG/4 UKCA/SG/4 UKA/20/SG/2 UKC/20/SG/2 UKA/40/SG/2 UKC/40/SG/2 UKCA/SG/2 UKA/SG/1 UKC/SG/1

2.61


UK

G 1/8 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES* G 1/8 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

2 3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

5/2 monostable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

34

700

115

UKA 8/12

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

29

700

115

UKC 8/12

Servo fed small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

29

700

115

UKC 8/12/SA

Adjustable small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

700

180

UKC 8/12/T

Big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

38

700

135

UKA 8/25

Big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

38

700

135

UKC 8/25**

Servo fed big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

18

38

700

135

UKC 8/25/SA

Adjustable big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

700

200

UKC 8/25/T

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

19

40

650

195

UKCA8

Servo fed pneumatic

Mechanical spring

19

40

650

195

UKCA8/SA

Weight (g)

TYPE*

* FOR THE PILOT ACTUATED VALVES OBTAINABLE WITH XVF4 SEE THE TABLE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES ON PAGE 2.64 ** IF THE TYPE INCLUDES THE SUFFIX “/MR,” THIS VALVE CAN BE USED TO SWITCH VACUUM P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 8/12; UKHC 8/25

3 PORT SMALL PNEUMATIC

3 PORT BIG PNEUMATIC

2 HOLES Ø4.3

2 HOLES Ø4.3

FUNCTION 3/2 N.O. 3/2 N.C.

2.62

L 23 18

Poppet valves series UK


UK

G 1/8 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series UKC 8/12/T

UKC 8/25/T

2 2 HOLES Ø4.3

SPRING CALIBRATION UKC8/12/T

2 HOLES Ø4.3

SPRING CALIBRATION UKC8/25/T Operating pressure (bar)

Turns of the needle

Turns of the needle

Operating pressure (bar)

Piloting pressure (bar)

5 PORT

Piloting pressure (bar)

5 PORT WITH XVF4

2 HOLES Ø4.3

2 HOLES Ø4.3

Poppet valves series UK

2.63


UK

G 1/8 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Controls Symbol

2

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

type

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

28

700

108

UKA 8/12/U*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

28

700

108

UKC 8/12/U*

3/2 N.O. monostable

Big solenoid

Mechanical spring

18

38

700

135

UKA 8/25/U**

3/2 N.C. monostable

Big solenoid

Mechanical spring

18

38

700

135

UKC 8/25/U**

5/2 monostable

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

19

40

650

203

UKCA 8/U**

* TYPES OF THESE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3 (SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER) ** TYPES OF THESE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES (SEE ON PAGE 2.6 FOR “ULCSV/R” AND ON PAGE 2.13 FOR “C/USCSVG”) WHEREAS USING AS PILOT THE VALVE “XVF4” THE RESULT IS A LOW PRESSURE PILOT ACTUATED VALVE (FOR “XVF4” - SEE ON PAGE 3.37) P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 8/12/U; UKHC 8/25/U

3 PORT SMALL SOLENOID

3 PORT BIG SOLENOID WITH ULCSV/R

2 HOLES Ø4.3 2 HOLES Ø4.3

3 PORT BIG SOLENOID WITH C/USCSVG

FUNCTION 3/2 N.O. 3/2 N.C.

2 HOLES Ø4.3

2.64

Poppet valves series UK

L 23 18


UK

Accessories Bases G 1/8

series

5 PORT WITH ULCSV/R

5 PORT WITH C/USCSVG

2 2 HOLES Ø4.3

2 HOLES Ø4.3

4 HOLES Ø4.5

FIXED LENGHT BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/8 - CK8

No. of stations L Weight(g) TYPE*

2 86 140 CK8/2

3 119 200 CK8/3

5 183 320 CK8/5

* FIXED LENGHT BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS AND SEALS

Poppet valves series UK

2.65


UK

G 1/4 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES* G 1/4 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

2 3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

5/2 monostable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

30

950

225

UKA 4/16

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

30

1100

225

UKC 4/16

Servo fed small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

16

30

1100

225

UKC 4/16/SA

Big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

30

950

280

UKA 4/32

Big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

30

1100

280

UKC 4/32**

Servo fed big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

28

1100

280

UKC 4/32/SA

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

45

1000

415

UKCA 4

Servo fed pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

45

1000

415

UKCA 4/SA

* FOR THE PILOT ACTUATED VALVES OBTAINABLE WITH “XVF4” SEE THE TABLE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES ON PAGE 2.67 ** IF THE TYPE INCLUDES THE SUFFIX “/MR,” THIS VALVE CAN BE USED TO SWITCH VACUUM P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 4/16; UKHC 4/32

3 PORT SMALL PNEUMATIC

3 PORT BIG PNEUMATIC

2 HOLES Ø5.3 2 HOLES Ø5.3

FUNCTION 3/2 N.O. 3/2 N.C.

2.66

L 30 25,5

Poppet valves series UK


UK

G 1/4 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series 5 PORT

5 PORT WITH XVF4

2 2 HOLES Ø5.3

2 HOLES Ø5.3

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

28

950

225

UKA 4/16/U*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

10

28

1100

230

UKC 4/16/U*

3/2 N.O. monostable

Big solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

30

950

280

UKA 4/32/U**

3/2 N.C. monostable

Big solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

30

1100

280

UKC 4/32/U**

5/2 monostable

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

45

1000

415

UKCA 4/U**

* TYPES OF THESE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3 (SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER) ** TYPES OF THESE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES (SEE ON PAGE 2.6 FOR “ULCSV/R” AND ON PAGE 2.13 FOR “C/USCSVG”) WHEREAS USING AS PILOT THE VALVE “XVF4” THE RESULT IS A LOW PRESSURE PILOT ACTUATED VALVE (FOR “XVF4” - SEE ON PAGE 3.37) P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 4/16/U; UKHC 4/32/U

3 PORT SMALL SOLENOID

3 PORT BIG SOLENOID WITH ULCSV/R

2 HOLES Ø5.3 2 HOLES Ø5.3

Poppet valves series UK

2.67


UK

G 1/4 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Bases

series

3 PORT BIG SOLENOID WITH C/USCSVG

5 PORT WITH ULCSV/R

2 2 HOLES Ø5.3

2 HOLES Ø5.3

FUNCTION 3/2 N.O. 3/2 N.C.

5 PORT WITH C/USCSVG

L 30 25,5

2 HOLES Ø5.3

4 HOLES Ø5.5

FIXED LENGHT BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/4 - CK4

No. of stations 2 L 104 Weight (g) 335 TYPE* CK4/2

3 145 475 CK4/3

4 185 615 CK4/4

5 8 225 345 755 1175 CK4/5 CK4/8

* FIXED LENGHT BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS AND SEALS

2.68

Poppet valves series UK


UK

G 1/4 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series PILOT ACTUATED VALVES* G 1/2 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable

3/2 N.C. monostable

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

32

1900

420

UKA 2/20

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

32

2100

420

UKC 2/20

Servo fed small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

25

32

2100

520

UKC 2/20/SA

Big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

32

1900

520

UKA 2/40

Big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

32

2100

520

UKC 2/40**

Servo fed big pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

30

2100

520

UKC 2/40/SA

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

40

2000

800

UKCA 2

Servo fed pneumatic

Mechanical spring

24

40

2000

800

UKCA 2/SA

5/2 monostable

* FOR THE PILOT ACTUATED VALVES OBTAINABLE WITH “XVF4” SEE THE TABLE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES ON PAGE 2.70 ** IF THE TYPE INCLUDES THE SUFFIX “/MR,” THIS VALVE CAN BE USED TO SWITCH VACUUM P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 2/20; UKHC 2/20

3 PORT SMALL PNEUMATIC

3 PORT BIG PNEUMATIC

2 HOLES Ø5.3

2 HOLES Ø5.3

FUNCTION 3/2 N.O. 3/2 N.C.

L 40 30

Poppet valves series UK

2.69

2


UK

G 1/2 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

5 PORT WITH XVF4

5 PORT

2 2 HOLES Ø5.3

2 HOLES Ø5.3

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1/2 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

32

1900

430

UKA 2/20/U*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

32

2100

440

UKC 2/20/U*

3/2 N.O. monostable

Big solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

32

1900

530

UKA 2/40/U**

3/2 N.C. monostable

Big solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

32

2100

540

UKC 2/40/U**

5/2 monostable

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

24

32

2000

810

UKCA 2/U**

* TYPES OF THESE SOLENOID VALVES INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES “UMCSV” - SEE ON PAGE 2.3 (SPECIFY THE VOLTAGE IN THE ORDER) ** TYPES OF THESE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES (SEE ON PAGE 2.6 FOR “ULCSV/R” AND ON PAGE 2.13 FOR “C/USCSVG”) WHEREAS USING AS PILOT THE VALVE “XVF4” THE RESULT IS A LOW PRESSURE PILOT ACTUATED VALVE (FOR “XVF4” - SEE ON PAGE 3.37) P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES.

3 PORT SMALL SOLENOID

3 PORT BIG SOLENOID WITH ULCSV/R

2 HOLES Ø5.3 2 HOLES Ø5.3

2.70

Poppet valves series UK


UK

G 1/2 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT Bases

series

3 PORT BIG SOLENOID WITH C/USCSVG

5 PORT WITH ULCSV/R

2 2 HOLES Ø5.3 2 HOLES Ø5.3

FUNCTION 3/2 N.O. 3/2 N.C.

5 PORT WITH C/USCSVG

L 40 30

2 HOLES Ø5.3

4 HOLES Ø5.5

FIXED LENGHT BASE FOR MANIFOLD MOUNTING OF VALVES G 1/2 - CK2

No. of stations 2 L 132 Weight(g) 810 TYPE* CK2/2

3 183 1160 CK2/3

5 283 1860 CK2/5

* FIXED LENGHT BASES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH NOTCH SCREWS AND SEALS

Poppet valves series UK

2.71


UK

G 1 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES* G 1 - 2, 3 AND 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

2

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Weight (g)

TYPE

11300

2550

UKA 1

65

7800

2550

UKC 1**

70

8050

5160

UKCA 1

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O. monostable

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

40

65

3/2 N.C. monostable

Small pneumatic

Mechanical spring

40

5/2 monostable

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

40

* FOR THE PILOT ACTUATED VALVES OBTAINABLE WITH “XVF4” SEE THE TABLE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES ON PAGE 2.73 ** IF THE TYPE INCLUDES THE SUFFIX “/MR,” THIS VALVE CAN BE USED TO SWITCH VACUUM P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 1; UKHC 1

UKA 1 - UKC 1

UKCA 1

2 HOLES Ø10

3 PORT WITH XVF4

2 HOLES Ø10

5 PORT WITH XVF4

2 HOLES Ø10

2.72

2 HOLES Ø10

Poppet valves series UK


UK

G 1 - 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES G 1 - 2, 3 AND 5 PORT Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

3/2 N.O. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

40

65

11300

2600

UKA 1/U

3/2 N.C. monostable

Small solenoid

Mechanical spring

40

65

7800

2550

UKC 1/U

5/2 monostable

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

40

70

8050

5100

UKCA 1/U

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES (SEE ON PAGE 2.6 FOR “ULCSV/R” AND ON PAGE 2.13 FOR “C/ USCSVG”) WHEREAS USING AS PILOT THE VALVE “XVF4” THE RESULT IS A LOW PRESSURE PILOT ACTUATED VALVE (FOR “XVF4” - SEE ON PAGE 3.37) P.S.: ADD AT THE TYPE OF THE VALVES 3/2 THE LETTER “H” BETWEEN THE LETTERS “K” AND “A” (OR “C”) TO ORDER 2/2 N.O. (OR 2/2 N.C.) VALVES. E.G.: UKHA 1/U; UKHC 1/U

3 PORT WITH ULCSV/R

3 PORT WITH C/USCSVG

2 HOLES Ø10

5 PORT WITH ULCSV/R

2 HOLES Ø10

5 PORT WITH C/USCSVG

2 HOLES Ø10

2 HOLES Ø10

Poppet valves series UK

2.73

2


UDS ISO

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard pilot and solenoid actuated sizes 1 - 2 - 3

series

DESCRIPTION Valves series “UDS ISO” are produced in the 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions according to the interface to ISO 5599/1 standard and they are mounted onto single or manifold bases, bottom or side ported. The ex CNOMO solenoid valve, with manual override (screwdriver type C/UECSVB or button type C/UECSPB), in the solenoid actuated version is mounted with coil type USBG side 30 mm (that allows a greater yield) or type USB side 22 mm.

2 TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumatic piloting port size Piloting solenoid valves Coils Electric connectors

MATERIALS Monostable: 2,5 ÷ 10 bar Bistable: 1,5 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Interface to ISO 5599/1 Interface to ISO 5599/1 C/UECSVB - C/UECSPB - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves series ex CNOMO on page 2.12 USBG - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 USR102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

FLOW CHART SIZE 1

Bottoms

Size 1 - 2: Techno-polymer Size 3: Aluminium alloy Size 1 -2: Techno-polymer Size 3: Aluminium alloy Acetal resin Galvanized steel NBR rubber + steel insert Aluminium alloy Aluminium alloy

Body Distance rings Springs Seals Spool Piston

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Size 1 Size 2 Size 3

UDS/SG/105 UDS/SG/212 UDSI/SG/3

PILOTING CHART SIZE 1

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART SIZE 2

Mechanical spring Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOTING CHART SIZE 2

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring

Operating pressure (bar)

2.74

Mechanical spring Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO


UDS ISO

Size 1

series

PILOTING CHART SIZE 3

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART SIZE 3

Operating pressure (bar)

2

Pneumatic spring Mechanical spring Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES SIZE 1 Controls Symbol

Function

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE

Actuation

Return

Energized

De-energized

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

30

960

230

UDS 105 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

20

14

960

230

UDS 105 KR/TQ

5/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

15

15

960

230

UDS 105 KR/KR

5/2 bistable with override on body valve

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

15

15

960

250

UDS 105 KRP/KRP

5/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

15

20

960

230

UDS 105 KR/TR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

25

580

275

UDS 105 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

25

800

275

UDS 105 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

20

25

1100

275

UDS 105 PR/PR

5/2 monostable

5 PORT SIZE 1

Response times at 6 bar (ms)

5 PORT SIZE 1 WITH MANUAL OVERRIDE ON BODY VALVE

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

2.75


Size 1

UDS ISO

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES SIZE 1 Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

30

960

305

UDS 105 KUEC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

20

30

960

305

UDS 105 KUEC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

20

30

960

305

UDS 105 KUER/ZR

Solenoid

Small pneumatic

20

25

960

310

UDS 105 KUEC/TR

Solenoid pilot assisted

Small pneumatic

20

25

960

310

UDS 105 KUER/TR

Solenoid

Solenoid

15

15

960

375

UDS 105 KUEC/KUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

15

15

960

375

UDS 105 KUER/KUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

25

580

425

UDS 105 SUEC/SUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

20

25

580

425

UDS 105 SUER/SUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

25

800

425

UDS 105 AUEC/AUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

20

25

800

425

UDS 105 AUER/AUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

20

25

1100

425

UDS 105 PUEC/PUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

20

25

1100

425

UDS 105 PUER/PUER

* - SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “E” WITH THE LETTER “P” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO ISO STANDARD WITH MANUAL OVERRIDE (MONOSTABLE BUTTON) ON THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES, E.G.: UDS 105 KUEC/TR BECOMES UDS 105 KUPC/TR - UDS 105 KUEC/KUEC BECOMES UDS 105 KUPC/KUPC - CANCEL THE LETTER “E” FROM THE TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO ISO STANDARD WITHOUT THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES, E.G.: UDS 105 KUEC/ZR BECOMES UDS 105 KUC/ZR - THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

2.76

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO


Size 2

UDS ISO

series 5 PORT SIZE 1 MONOSTABLE

5 PORT SIZE 1 BISTABLE AND 3 POSITIONS

2

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES SIZE 2 Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

47

50

1500

515

UDS 212 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

47

50

1500

510

UDS 212 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

23

23

1500

515

UDS 212 KR/KR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

20

40

1500

515

UDS 212 KR/TR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

30

35

1000

580

UDS 212 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

30

35

1200

580

UDS 212 AR/AR

5/3 pressure centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

30

35

1300

580

UDS 212 PR/PR

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5 PORT SIZE 2

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

2.77


Size 2

UDS ISO

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES SIZE 2 Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

5/3 pressure centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE*

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

40

45

1500

580

UDS 212 KUEC/ZR

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

47

50

1500

580

UDS 212 KUEC/TQ

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

40

45

1500

580

UDS 212 KUER/ZR

Solenoid

Small pneumatic

40

45

1500

580

UDS 212 KUEC/TR

Solenoid pilot assisted

Small pneumatic

40

45

1500

580

UDS 212 KUER/TR

Solenoid

Solenoid

20

20

1500

635

UDS 212 KUEC/KUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

20

20

1500

635

UDS 212 KUER/KUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

35

1000

720

UDS 212 SUEC/SUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

30

35

1000

720

UDS 212 SUER/SUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

35

1200

720

UDS 212 AUEC/AUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

30

35

1200

720

UDS 212 AUER/AUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

30

35

1300

720

UDS 212 PUEC/PUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

30

35

1300

720

UDS 212 PUER/PUER

* - SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “E” WITH THE LETTER “P” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO ISO STANDARD WITH MANUAL OVERRIDE (MONOSTABLE BUTTON) ON THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES, E.G.: UDS 212 KUEC/TR BECOMES UDS 212 KUPC/TR - UDS 212 KUEC/KUEC BECOMES UDS 212 KUPC/KUPC - CANCEL THE LETTER “E” FROM THE TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO ISO STANDARD WITHOUT THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES, E.G.: UDS 212 KUEC/ZR BECOMES UDS 212 KUC/ZR - THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

2.78

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO


Size 3

UDS ISO

series 5 PORT SIZE 2 MONOSTABLE

5 PORT SIZE 2 BISTABLE AND 3 POSITIONS

2

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES SIZE 3 Controls Symbol

Function

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate Weight (g) at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

38

42

3000

1995

UDSI 3 KR/ZR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

38

42

3000

1985

UDSI 3 KR/TQ

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

28

28

3000

1965

UDSI 3 KR/KR

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

28

35

3000

1965

UDSI 3 KR/TR

5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

27

32

2900

2020

UDSI 3 SR/SR

5/3 open centre

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

27

32

3000

2020

UDSI 3 AR/AR

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5 PORT SIZE 3

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

2.79


UDS ISO

Size 3

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES SIZE 3 Controls Symbol

2

Function

5/2 monostable

5/2 bistable

5/3 closed centre

5/3 open centre

Response time at 6 bar (ms)

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Weight (g)

TYPE*

3100

2120

UDSI 3 KUEC/ZR

42

3100

2120

UDSI 3 KUEC/TQ

40

42

3100

2120

UDSI 3 KUER/ZR

Small pneumatic

40

45

3100

2120

UDSI 3 KUEC/TR

Solenoid pilot assisted

Small pneumatic

40

45

3100

2120

UDSI 3 KUER/TR

Solenoid

Solenoid

28

28

3100

2180

UDSI 3 KUEC/KUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid pilot assisted

28

28

3100

2180

UDSI 3 KUER/KUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

27

32

2900

2180

UDSI 3 SUEC/SUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

27

32

2900

2180

UDSI 3 SUER/SUER

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

27

32

3000

2180

UDSI 3 AUEC/AUEC

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

27

32

3000

2180

UDSI 3 AUER/AUER

Pilot

Return

Energized

De-energized

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

40

42

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

40

Solenoid pilot assisted

Mechanical spring

Solenoid

* - SUBSTITUTE THE LETTER “E” WITH THE LETTER “P” IN EACH SOLENOID CONTROL TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO ISO STANDARD WITH MANUAL OVERRIDE (MONOSTABLE BUTTON) ON THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES, E.G.: UDSI 3 KUEC/TR BECOMES UDSI 3 KUPC/TR - UDS1 3 KUEC/KUEC BECOMES UDSI 3 KUPC/KUPC - CANCEL THE LETTER “E” FROM THE TYPE TO ORDER THE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES TO ISO STANDARD WITHOUT THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES, E.G.: UDSI 3 KUEC/ZR BECOMES UDSI 3 KUC/ZR - THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

5 PORT SIZE 3 MONOSTABLE

2.80

5 PORT SIZE 3 BISTABLE E 3 POSITIONS

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO


Accessories Single bases to ISO 5599/1 standard sizes 1-2-3 obtained from drawn light alloy

UDS ISO

series

SINGLE BASE SIDE PORTED - UDP/ISO SIZE /S

SINGLE BASE BOTTOM PORTED - UDP/ISO SIZE /B

2

TYPE UDP/ISO1/S8 UDP/ISO1/S4 Weight (g) 205 240 SIZE 1 DA 10 10 DB 6 6 FA M5 M5 FB G 1/8 G 1/4 FC G 1/8 G 1/8 HA 40 40 HB 20 25 HC 8 14,5 HD 8 8 LA 105 105 LB 90 90 LC 36 40 LD 18 20 LE 58 58 PA 6,5 6,5 PB 6,5 6,5

UDP/ISO2/S4 UDP/ISO2/S3 485 455 2 12 12 7 7 M6 M6 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 55 55 28 28 13 15 8 8 130 130 110 110 48 52 24 26 68 70 10 10 8 8

UDP/ISO3/S2 1090 3 15 9 M8 G 1/2 G 1/8 70 32 16 8 208 180 64 32 90 10 11

TYPE UDP/ISO1/B8 UDP/ISO1/B4 Weight (g) 200 190 SIZE 1 DA 10 10 DB 6 6 FA M5 M5 FB G 1/8 G 1/4 FC G 1/8 G 1/8 HA 40 40 HB 20 20 HC 16 18 LA 105 105 LB 90 90 LC 36 40 LD 18 20 LE 58 58 PA 8 8 PB 6,5 6,5

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

UDP/ISO2/B4 UDP/ISO2/B3 495 470 2 12 12 7 7 M6 M6 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 55 55 28 28 22 23 130 130 110 110 48 52 24 26 68 70 10 10 8 8

UDP/ISO3/B2 1160 3 15 9 M8 G 1/2 G 1/8 70 32 27 208 180 64 32 90 10 11

2.81


UDS ISO

series

MANIFOLD BASE SIDE PORTED - UDP/ISO SIZE /MS/Q

Accessories Manifold bases to ISO 5599/1 standard sizes 1-2-3 obtained from drawn light alloy

MANIFOLD BASE BOTTOM PORTED - UDP/ISO SIZE M/Q

2

TYPE Weight (g) SIZE FA FB FC HA HB HC HD HE HF LA LB LC LD PA

UDP/ISO1/8MS/Q UDP/ISO1/4MS/Q 320 310 ISO 1 M5 M5 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/8 G 1/8 43 43 30 30 19 19 12 12 14 14 24,5 24,5 105 105 42 42 22 22 10 10 6,5 6,5

UDP/ISO2/3MS/Q 660 ISO 2 M6 G 3/8 G 1/8 55 40 24 17 17,5 30 130 54 30 12,5 8

TYPE Weight (g) SIZE FA FB FC HA HB HC HD HE HF HG LA LB LC LD PA

UDP/ISO1/8M/Q UDP/ISO1/4M/Q 320 315 ISO 1 M5 M5 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/8 G 1/8 43 43 30 30 19 19 12 12 21,5 21,5 12,5 12,5 24,5 24,5 105 105 42 42 60 60 18 18 6,5 6,5

INPUT PLATES (pair) - UDP/ISO SIZE /...M/L

TYPE Weight (g) SIZE DA FA HA HB HC HD HE LA LB LC

2.82

UDP/ISO1/3M/L 280 ISO 1 7 G 3/8 20 30 16 13 10 105 49 93

UDP/ISO2/2M/L 460 ISO 2 7 G 1/2 20 40 22 15 10 130 59 118

UDP/ISO3/1M/L 2355 ISO 3 9 G1 50 50 25 25 25 208 94 180

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

UDP/ISO2/3M/Q 665 ISO 2 M6 G 3/8 G 1/8 55 40 24 17 27,5 16,5 32,5 130 54 74 24 8

UDP/ISO3/2M/Q 1640 ISO 3 M8 G 1/2 G 1/8 70 50 27 27 35 23,5 42,5 208 88 125 42 10


Accessories Manifold bases to ISO 5599/1 standard sizes 1-2-3 obtained from drawn light alloy

UDS ISO

series

BLANKING PLATE ISO 1 - UDP/ISO1/PC

BLANKING PLATE ISO 2 - UDP/ISO2/PC

2 WEIGHT 80 g

WEIGHT 115 g

SIZE ADAPTER ISO 1-2 AND ISO 2-3 - UDP/ISO SIZE TYPE Weight (g) SIZE DA HA HB HC HD HE HF HG LA LB LC LD

KIT ASSEMBLY BASES

UDP/ISO1-2 245 1-2 7 20 40 28 21 10 15 22 130 42 118 54

UDP/ISO2-3 1305 2-3 9 50 50 32 35 25 25 25 208 54 180 88

DIAPHRAGM - UDP/ISO SIZE /T

Kit assembly bases ISO 1 Kit assembly bases ISO 2 Kit assembly bases ISO 3

TYPE SIZE

KIT/UDP/ISO 1 KIT/UDP/ISO 2 KIT/UDP/ISO 3

UDP/ISO1/T 1

UDP/ISO2/T 2

UDP/ISO3/T 3

EXAMPLE OF ASSEMBLY

40 + (55 x No. of stations)

40 + (43 x No. of stations) 100 + (70 x No. of stations)

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

2.83


UDS ISO

series

Accessories Manifold bases to ISO 5599/1 standard size 1 obtained from die-cast light alloy

BLIND TERMINAL PLATE - UDP/ISO1PT

INPUT PLATE - UDP/ISO1PE

2 WEIGHT 80 g

WEIGHT 80 g

INPUT PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

MANIFOLD BASE, SIDE AND BOTTOM PORTED - UDP/ISO1BM

UNIVERSAL PLATE

WEIGHT 150 g

DESCRIPTION Intermediate plate, bottom ported Intermediate plate, side ported Intermediate plate, top ported Intermediate plate with blind holes

A G 3/8 G 3/8

B G 3/8 G 3/8

C G 1/4 G 1/4

TYPE UDP/ISO1PUI UDP/ISO1PUL UDP/ISO1PUS UDP/ISO1PU

WEIGHT 250 g

MANIFOLD BASE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS, SEALS AND PLUGS (USE A FLUID SEAL)

PLATES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

DIAPHRAGM - UDP/ISO1D

DIAPHRAGM - UDP/ISO2D

SIZE ADAPTER ISO 1-2 - UDP/ISODT1-2

WEIGHT 170 g

SIZE ADAPTER IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

2.84

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO


Accessories Manifold bases to ISO 5599/1 standard size 2 obtained from die-cast light alloy

UDS ISO

series

BLIND TERMINAL PLATE - UDP/ISO2PT

INPUT PLATE - UDP/ISO2PE

2 WEIGHT 125 g

WEIGHT 125 g

INPUT PLATE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

MANIFOLD BASE, SIDE AND BOTTOM PORTED - UDP/ISO2BM

UNIVERSAL PLATE

WEIGHT 205 g

DESCRIPTION Intermediate plate, bottom ported Intermediate plate, side ported Intermediate plate, top ported Intermediate plate with blind holes

A G 1/2 G 1/2

B G 1/2 G 1/2

C G 1/4 G 1/4

TYPE UDP/ISO2PUI UDP/ISO2PUL UDP/ISO2PUS UDP/ISO2PU

WEIGHT 315 g

MANIFOLD BASE IS SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS, SEALS AND PLUGS (USE A FLUID SEAL)

PLATES ARE SUPPLIED COMPLETE WITH SCREWS AND SEALS

EXAMPLE OF ASSEMBLY

Valves to ISO 5599/1 standard series UDS ISO

2.85


UDS CETOP

Valves to ex CETOP RP 32 P standard pilot and solenoid actuated sizes 05 - 12 - 35

series

DESCRIPTION Valves series "UDS CETOP" are produced in the 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions according to the interface to ex CETOP RP 32 P standard and they are mounted onto single bases, bottom or side ported, or onto manifold bases, bottom ported. All the solenoid actuated versions support the 32 mm direct acting solenoid valve type ULCSV/R (with fixed position) or the amplifier valve type XVF4 for a sensible pneumatic piloting (see page 3.36).

2 TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumatic piloting port size Piloting solenoid valve Pneumatic piloting valve Electric connector

MATERIALS Monostable: 2,5 ÷ 10 bar Bistable: 2 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +70 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Interface to ex CETOP RP 32 P standard Interface to ex CETOP RP 32 P standard

Bottoms Body Distance rings Springs Seals Spool Piston

Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy Acetal resin Galvanized steel NBR rubber + steel insert Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy

ULCSV/R - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.6 XVF4 - see chapter Complementary valves on page 3.37 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

FLOW CHART SIZE 05

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT Size 05 Size 12 Size 35

UDS/SG/05 UDS/SG/12 UDS/SG/35

PILOTING CHART SIZE 05

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Piloting pressure (bar)

Pneumatic spring

PILOTING CHART SIZE 12

Pneumatic spring

Piloting pressure (bar)

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Operating pressure (bar)

2.86

Double differential pneumatic control Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART SIZE 12

Mechanical spring

Mechanical spring Double differential pneumatic control Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

Valves to ex Cetop RP 32 P standard series UDS CETOP


Sizes 05 - 12 - 35

UDS CETOP

series

PILOTING CHART SIZE 35

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Operating pressure (bar)

2

Pneumatic spring

Piloting pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART SIZE 35

Mechanical spring Double differential pneumatic control Double pneumatic control

Operating pressure (bar)

PILOT ACTUATED VALVES* SIZES 05 - 12 - 35 Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable

Pilot

Return

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

Mechanical spring

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

Pneumatic

5/2 bistable

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential 5/3 closed centre

Pneumatic

Energized

De-energized

29

38

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min) 415

30

48

950

42

41

29

Response times at 6 bar (ms)

Pneumatic

Pneumatic spring

Pneumatic

Pneumatic

Pneumatic differential

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

Weight (g)

Size

310

05

UDS 05 KR/ZR

760

12

UDS 12 KR/ZR

2800

1945

35

UDS 35 KR/ZR

38

415

310

05

UDS 05 ZR/KR

30

48

950

760

12

UDS 12 ZR/KR

42

41

2800

1945

35

UDS 35 ZR/KR

42

34

415

325

05

UDS 05 KR/TQ

44

59

950

770

12

UDS 12 KR/TQ

69

71

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 KR/TQ

42

34

415

325

05

UDS 05 TQ/KR

44

59

950

770

12

UDS 12 TQ/KR

69

71

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 TQ/KR

27

27

415

305

05

UDS 05 KR/KR

28

28

950

745

12

UDS 12 KR/KR

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KR/KR

27

27

415

310

05

UDS 05 KR/TR

28

28

950

770

12

UDS 12 KR/TR

36

36

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 KR/TR

27

27

415

310

05

UDS 05 TR/KR

28

28

950

770

12

UDS 12 TR/KR

36

36

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 TR/KR

30

34

315

325

05

UDS 05 SR/SR

42

33

815

790

12

UDS 12 SR/SR

TYPE

UDS 35 SR/SR 27 31 2650 1980 35 * FOR THE LOW PRESSURE PILOT ACTUATED VALVES OBTAINABLE WITH “XVF4” SEE THE TABLE SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES ON PAGE 2.88

5 PORT SIZE 05 12 35

A 104 130 208

C 38 53 68

D 30 42 52

E 9 11 20

F 26 40 48

Valves to ex Cetop RP 32 P standard series UDS CETOP

G 24 30 54

M M4 M5 M8

2.87


Sizes 05 - 12 - 35

UDS CETOP

series

SOLENOID ACTUATED VALVES SIZES 05 - 12 - 35 Controls Symbol

Function

2

Actuation

Return

Solenoid

Mechanical spring

Mechanical spring

5/2 monostable

Solenoid pilot assisted Mechanical spring

Solenoid

Pneumatic spring

Solenoid

Pneumatic

Solenoid pilot assisted

Pneumatic

Solenoid 5/2 bistable

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid

Small pneumatic Solenoid pilot assisted Small pneumatic

Solenoid 5/3 closed centre

Response times at 6 bar (ms)

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid

Mechanical spring Solenoid pilot assisted Pneumatic spring

Solenoid

Pneumatic

Solenoid

Pneumatic

Solenoid pilot assisted

Solenoid

Solenoid pilot assisted Small pneumatic

Solenoid

Small pneumatic Solenoid pilot assisted Mechanical spring Mechanical spring

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Weight (g)

Size

TYPE*

Energized

De-energized

29

38

415

310

05

UDS 05 KUC/ZR

30

48

950

765

12

UDS 12 KUC/ZR

47

39

2800

1970

35

UDS 35 KUC/ZR

29

38

415

310

05

UDS 05 ZR/KUC

30

48

950

765

12

UDS 12 ZR/KUC

47

39

2800

1970

35

UDS 35 ZR/KUC

29

38

415

310

05

UDS 05 KUR/ZR

30

48

950

765

12

UDS 12 KUR/ZR

47

39

2800

1970

35

UDS 35 KUR/ZR

29

38

415

310

05

UDS 05 ZR/KUR

30

48

950

765

12

UDS 12 ZR/KUR

47

39

2800

1970

35

UDS 35 ZR/KUR

42

34

415

325

05

UDS 05 KUC/TQ

44

59

950

785

12

UDS 12 KUC/TQ

76

49

2800

1940

35

UDS 35 KUC/TQ

42

34

415

325

05

UDS 05 TQ/KUC

44

59

950

785

12

UDS 12 TQ/KUC

76

49

2800

1940

35

UDS 35 TQ/KUC

27

27

415

305

05

UDS 05 KUC/KR

28

28

950

745

12

UDS 12 KUC/KR

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KUC/KR

27

27

415

310

05

UDS 05 KR/KUC

28

28

950

765

12

UDS 12 KR/KUC

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KR/KUC

27

27

415

310

05

UDS 05 KUR/KR

28

28

950

765

12

UDS 12 KUR/KR

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KUR/KR

27

27

415

310

05

UDS 05 KR/KUR

28

28

950

765

12

UDS 12 KR/KUR

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KR/KUR

27

27

415

305

05

UDS 05 KUC/KUC

28

28

950

745

12

UDS 12 KUC/KUC

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KUC/KUC

27

27

415

305

05

UDS 05 KUR/KUR

28

28

950

745

12

UDS 12 KUR/KUR

36

36

2800

1910

35

UDS 35 KUR/KUR

27

27

415

315

05

UDS 05 KUC/TR

28

28

950

775

12

UDS 12 KUC/TR

36

36

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 KUC/TR

27

27

415

315

05

UDS 05 TR/KUC

28

28

950

775

12

UDS 12 TR/KUC

36

36

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 TR/KUC

27

27

415

315

05

UDS 05 KUR/TR

28

28

950

775

12

UDS 12 KUR/TR

36

36

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 KUR/TR

27

27

415

315

05

UDS 05 TR/KUR

28

28

950

775

12

UDS 12 TR/KUR

36

36

2800

1900

35

UDS 35 TR/KUR

30

34

315

325

05

UDS 05 SUC/SUC

42

33

815

795

12

UDS 12 SUC/SUC

34

38

2650

1980

35

UDS 35 SUC/SUC

30

34

315

325

05

UDS 05 SUR/SUR

42

33

815

795

12

UDS 12 SUR/SUR

34

38

2650

1980

35

UDS 35 SUR/SUR

* THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE THE PILOTING SOLENOID VALVES (SEE ON PAGE 2.6 FOR “ULCSV/R”) WHEREAS USING AS PILOT THE VALVE “XVF4” THE RESULT IS A LOW PRESSURE PILOT ACTUATED VALVE (FOR “XVF4” - SEE ON PAGE 3.37)

2.88

Valves to ex Cetop RP 32 P standard series UDS CETOP


Sizes 05 - 12 - 35 and single bases

UDS CETOP

series

5 PORT MONOSTABLE

5 PORT AND 3 POSITIONS BISTABLE

2

SIZE 05 12 35

A 104 130 208

B 105 117 127

C 38 53 68

D 30 42 52

E 9 11 20

F 26 40 58

G 24 30 54

H 135 158 233

H1 120 144 221

SINGLE BASE, BOTTOM PORTED - UDP...B

SIZE Weight (g) UDP8B 170 UDP4B 365 UDP2B 1170

TYPE Weight (g) UDP8S 160 UDP4S 340 UDP2S 1125

SIZE 05 12 35

E 30 39 65

K 40 55 70

M M4 M5 M8

SINGLE BASE, SIDE PORTED - UDP...S

L 105 130 208

N 6 7 9

O 90 110 180

Q G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

R 16 20 32

S 6,5 8 11

T 10 12 15

Valves to ex Cetop RP 32 P standard series UDS CETOP

U G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

2.89


Sizes 05 - 12 - 35 and manifold bases

UDS CETOP

series

MANIFOLD BASES, BOTTOM PORTED - UDP...M/

2

SIZE 05 12 35

A 110 136 210

No. of stations B C Weight (g) TYPE Size 05 B C Weight (g) TYPE Size 12 B C Weight (g) TYPE Size 35

2.90

D 30 40 50

F 130 160 240 2 115 150 1165 UDP8M/2 155 197 2340 UDP4M/2 170 236 5680 UDP2M/2

H 6 7 9

Q G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

3 155 190 1480 UDP8M/3 210 252 3040 UDP4M/3 240 306 7240 UDP2M/3

U G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2 4 195 230 1795 UDP8M/4 265 307 3740 UDP4M/4 310 376 9000 UDP2M/4

V G 1/4 G 1/2 G 3/4 5 235 270 2110 UDP8M/5 320 362 4440 UDP4M/5 380 446 10760 UDP2M/5

6 275 310 2425 UDP8M/6 375 417 5140 UDP4M/6 -

7 315 350 2740 UDP8M/7 430 472 5840 UDP4M/7 -

8 355 390 3055 UDP8M/8 485 527 6540 UDP4M/8 -

9 395 430 3370 UDP8M/9 540 582 7240 UDP4M/9 -

10 435 470 3685 UDP8M/10 595 63 7940 UDP4M/10 -

-

-

-

-

-

Valves to ex Cetop RP 32 P standard series UDS CETOP


Solenoid valves for industrial media G 1/8 ÷ G 2

W

series

DESCRIPTION The solenoid valves series "W" can be directly actuated, servoassisted or with mixed actuation. These solenoid valves, produced in the 2/2 N.C. pneumatic function, are used in several industrial fields, thanks to their compatibility with a large range of fluids.

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure (See tables below) Working temperature range NBR -10 ÷ +90 °C EPDM < +140 °C FPM -10 ÷ +130 °C Fluid (See technical information) Port size G 1/8 ÷ G 2 Coils WE3A - see on page 2.93 WE2A - see on page 2.93 WE5A - see on page 2.93 Electric connectors USR102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

2

TECHNICAL INFORMATION Seal type NBR

MATERIALS Body Sleeve Moving core Springs Seals

EPDM

Brass Brass Stainless steel Stainless steel NBR EPDM FPM

FPM (Viton®)

Duty field Water max. 70 °C, air max. 90 °C, mineral oils and derivates - hydrocarbons (methane, ethane, propane, butane, kerosene and gas oil) Hot water and steam max. 140 °C, detergents, solutions of sodium and potassium, hydraulic fluids and polar solvents (not to be used with mineral oils and grease) For general purpose max. 130 °C

Calculation of the flow rate For liquids

Q = Kv

For gases Kv = Q = m3/h Qn = m3/h P = bar p = bar

Qn = 26 Kv pP Flow coefficient Flow rate Normal flow rate (20 °C and 760 mm Hg) Absolute downstream pressure Pressure drop (differential pressure between the upstream and downstream pressure) Specific gravity (ratio of density of the substance to the density of water at 4°C )

p = Kg/dm3

p

2 PORT G 1/8 - DIRECTLY ACTUATED 2 HOLES M3x5

WEIGHT 70 g

Symbol

Function

2/2 N.C.

Differential pressure (bar) MIN. MAX. 0 0 0 0 0

AC 25 16 12 8 5

DC 25 16 10 5,5 2

Kv

Nominal orifice (mm)

Port size

0,04 0,06 0,09 0,14 0,19

1,2 1,5 2 2,5 3,1

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

TYPE**

W 105 1 * E3A W 105 2 * E3A W 105 3 * E3A W 105 4 * E3A W 105 5 * E3A

* SPECIFY THE SEALING TYPE: B = NBR; V = FPM; E = EPDM ** THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS (SEE “WE3A” ON PAGE 2.93)

Solenoid valves for industrial media series W

2.91


W

G 1/8 ÷ G 2

series

2 PORT G 1/8 - G 1/4 DIRECTLY ACTUATED WEIGHT 300 g

2 HOLES M4x5

Symbol

Function

2 2/2 N.C.

Differential pressure (bar) MIN. MAX. AC DC 0 30 26 0 22 20 0 16 14 0 10 8 0 30 26 0 22 20 0 16 14 0 10 8 0 6,5 3,5 0 4 1,8 0 1

Kv

Nominal orifice (mm)

Port size (GA)

TYPE**

0,07 0,1 0,15 0,32 0,07 0,1 0,15 0,32 0,41 0,47 0,64

1,5 2 2,5 3,5 1,5 2 2,5 3,5 4,5 5,2 6,4

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/4

W106 1 * E2A W106 2 * E2A W 106 3 * E2A W 106 4 * E2A W 106 5 * E2A W 106 6 * E2A W 106 7 * E2A W 106 8 * E2A W 106 9 * E2A W 106 10 * E2A W 106 11 * E2A

* SPECIFY THE SEALING TYPE: B = NBR; V = FPM; E = EPDM ** THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS (SEE “WE2A” ON PAGE 2.93)

2 PORT G 3/8 - G 2 SERVO ASSISTED

Symbol

Function

2/2 N.C.

Differential pressure (bar) MIN. MAX. AC 15 15 13 10 10 10 10

0,15 0,15 0,15 0,15 0,15 0,15 0,15

DC 15 15 13 10 10 10 10

Kv

Nominal orifice (mm)

Port size (GA)

2 2,2 5,2 10,2 18 21 36

12 12 18 24 37 37 50

G 3/8 G 1/2 G 3/4 G1 G 1 1/4 G 1 1/2 G2

TYPE**

W 107 1 * E3A W 107 2 * E3A W 107 3 * E3A W 107 4 * E3A W 107 5 * E2A W 107 6 * E2A W 107 7 * E2A

* SPECIFY THE SEALING TYPE: B = NBR, V = FPM, E = EPDM ** THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS (SEE “WE2A” AND “WE3A” ON PAGE 2.93) THAT HAVE PREFERABLY TO BE MOUNTED TOWARD THE HIGH GA

A

B

C

D

E

F

G

H

I

L

M

N

G 3/8 G 1/2 G 3/4 G1 G 1 1/4 G 1 1/2 G2

60 60 75 96 144 144 152

70 70 74 85 107 107 116,5

14 14 18 20 28 28 35

45 45 55 72 102 102 119

16 16 20 32 45 45 48

6 6 8,5 -

22 22 22 22 30 30 30

27,5 27,5 27,5 27,5 42 42 42

39 39 39 39 39,5 39,5 39,5

102 102 108 120 128 128 159

53,5 53,5 59,5 71,5 79,5 79,5 110,5

62,5 62,5 66 64,5 75,5 75,5 76,5

2.92

WEIGHT (g) 450 450 660 1200 3200 2900 4500

Solenoid valves for industrial media series W


G 1/8 ÷ G 2 - Coils

W

series 2 PORT G 3/8 - G 1 WITH MIXED ACTUATION

Symbol

Function

2/2 N.C.

Differential pressure (bar) MIN. MAX. AC DC 0 10 0 10 0 12 10 0 12 10 0 9 0 7 -

GA

A

B

C

D

G 3/8 G 1/2 G 3/4 G1

59 59 79 96

83 83 90 101

14 14 18 20

G WE2A 39,5 39,5 -

G WE5A 42,5 42,5 42,5 42,5

H WE2A 58,5 58,5 -

H WE5A 58 58 69 82

Kv

Nominal orifice (mm)

Port size (GA)

2 2,2 2 2,2 4,5 8,5

12 12 12 12 18 24

G 3/8 G 1/2 G 3/8 G 1/2 G 3/4 G1

45 45 55 72

E WE2A 30 30 -

E WE5A 36 36 36 36

F WE2A 42 42 -

F WE5A 47,5 47,5 47,5 47,5

I WE2A 106 106 -

I WE5A 105,5 105,5 116,5 129,5

L WE2A 79 79 -

L WEIGHT WE5A (g) 82 580 82 530 89,5 750 100 1200

TYPE**

W 108 1 * E2A W 108 2 * E2A W 108 1 * E5A W 108 2 * E5A W 108 3 * E5A W 108 4 * E5A

* SPECIFY THE SEALING TYPE: B = NBR; V = FPM; E = EPDM ** THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS (SEE “WE2A” AND “WE3A”) THAT HAVE PREFERABLY TO BE MOUNTED TOWARD THE HIGH

COIL TYPE WE3A Power consumption

DC: 5,5 W AC: 11 VA (inrush)

DESCRIPTION COIL 22 mm 24 V DC COIL 22 mm 24 V AC COIL 22 mm 110 V AC COIL 22 mm 220 V AC WEIGHT 50 g

TYPE WE3A/02400 WE3A/02450-60 WE3A/11050-60 WE3A/22050-60

ELECTRIC CONNECTOR “USR 102/N9” (SEE ON PAGE 2.15)

COIL TYPE WE2A Power consumption

DC: 8 W AC: 20 VA (inrush)

DESCRIPTION COIL 30 mm 24 V DC COIL 30 mm 24 V AC COIL 30 mm 110 V AC COIL 30 mm 220 V AC WEIGHT 120 g

TYPE WE2A/02400 WE2A/02450-60 WE2A/11050-60 WE2A/22050-60

ELECTRIC CONNECTOR “ULR1B ” (SEE ON PAGE 2.15)

COIL TYPE WE5A Power consumption

DC: 23 W AC: 40 VA (inrush)

DESCRIPTION COIL 36 mm 24 V DC COIL 36 mm 24 V AC COIL 36 mm 110 V AC COIL 36 mm 220 V AC WEIGHT 210 g

TYPE WE5A/02400 WE5A/02450-60 WE5A/11050-60 WE5A/22050-60

ELECTRIC CONNECTOR “ULR1B ” (SEE ON PAGE 2.15)

Solenoid valves for industrial media series W

2.93

2


EV

Valves for vacuum solenoid pilot assisted actuated G 1/8 ÷ G 2

series

DESCRIPTION Valves for vacuum series "EV" are produced only in the 3/2 N.O. and 3/2 N.C. pneumatic functions with solenoid pilot assisted actuation.

2 TECHNICAL DATA Maximum vacuum Pneumatic piloting pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Coils Electric connectors

755 mm Hg 3 ÷ 10 bar

MATERIALS

-20 ÷ +40°C Vacuum G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 3/4 - G 1 - G 1 ½ - G 2 G 1/8: WE3A - see Coils on page 2.93 G 1/4 - G 3/8: USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 G 1/2 ÷ G 2: WE2A - see Coils on page 2.93 USR102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15 ULR1B - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

Bottoms Body Springs Sleeve Core Piston Diaphragm and plunger

Anodized aluminium Anodized aluminium Stainless steel Nickel-plated brass Stainless steel Aluminium Polyurethane

3 PORT SOLENOID PILOT ASSISTED ACTUATED VALVES Response times at 6 bar (ms)

Controls Symbol

Energized

De-energized

Maximum flow rate pump (m3/h)

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

15

25

1,5

G 1/8

163

EV8

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

18

28

4

G 1/4

462

EV4

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

18

28

10

G 3/8

451

EV3

20

40

20

G 1/2

780

EV2

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

20

40

20

G 3/4

750

EV6

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

20

45

90

G1

1212

EV1

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

60

40

180

G 1½

3300

EV12

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.*

80

50

250

G2

9800

EV16

Function

Actuation

Return

3/2 N.C. - 3/2 N.O.* Solenoid pilot assisted

Size

TYPE**

Mechanical spring

* FOR VERSION N.O. ARRANGE THE CONNECTIONS AS INDICATED: 1 = EXHAUST 2 = OUTPUT 3 = PUMP **THE TYPES OF THE SOLENOID VALVES DO NOT INCLUDE COILS

2.94

Port size

Valves for vacuum series EV


EV

G 1/8 ÷ G 2

series EV8 - EV4 - EV3

EV2 - EV6 - EV1 - EV12 - EV16

2 2 HOLES Ø 4,5

TYPE EV8 EV4 EV3

A 25 32 32

B 11 24 24

C 17.5 23.5 23.5

D 35 59 59

E 19.7 36 36

F 21.7 36 36

GA G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8

H 112.7 136 136

I L M 7 52.7 9.2 - 74.5 24.5 - 74.5 24.5

N 28 40 40

P 65 89 89

TYPE A EV2 75 EV6 75 EV1 94 EV12 138 EV16 183.5

B C D E 47 35 78.5 63 47 35 78.5 63 55 45 101 78 84 59 158 113 113.5 78.5 210 150

Valves for vacuum series EV

F 54.5 54.5 62.5 113 152

GA G 1/2 G 3/4 G1 G 1½ G2

H 152 152 168 240 310

I M 30 21 30 21 38 25.5 68 34 92 48

N O P 41 50.5 85.5 41 50.5 85.5 51 64 95 68 96 92 129 -

2.95


VM

Vacuum generators G 1/8 ÷ G 1

series

DESCRIZIONE Valves series “VM” generate vacuum using the Venturi effect. These valves found a specific employment in the aspiration from single work points with a suction cap.

2 TECHNICAL DATA 1 ÷ 10 bar Vacuum Compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 3/4 - G 1 1,5 mm 0,7 bar Suction (bar)

Operating pressure Fluid Feeding fluid Port size Nominal diameter Max. vacuum capability

SUCTION CHART

MATERIALS Body Nozzle Seals

Anodized aluminium alloy Brass NBR rubber Operating pressure (bar)

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT VM

No. 2 HOLES ØG

1 = FEEDING FLUID 2 = SUCTION 3 = EXHAUST

Symbol

2.96

A

B

C

D

E

F

G

I

H

L

WEIGHT (g)

TYPE

50.5

25

58

30

38

15

19.2

4

4.2

15

G 1/8

G 1/8

50

VM8

38

19.5

23

4

4.2

25

G 1/4

G 1/4

90

71.5

VM4

30

52

18.5

31

4.5

5.2

25

G 3/8

G 3/8

146

VM3

75

35

56

21

33

4.5

5.2

30

G 1/2

G 1/2

203

VM2

90.5

50

61.5

28.5

49.4

4.5

5.2

50

G 3/4

G 1/4

692

VM15

97

50

68

28.5

52.4

4.5

5.2

50

G1

G 1/4

643

VM1

Vacuum generator series VM


2

2.97



Index chapter 3

VALVES

manually and mechanically actuated and complementary valves

Series M General features - Minivalves manually and mechanically actuated ........................................................................................................ page Accessories: actuators for panel mounting ............................................................................................................................................... page

3.3 3.6

Series EK General features ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page Spool valves mechanically actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/8 ........................................................................................................................ page Spool valves manually actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/8.............................................................................................................................. page Spool valves mechanically actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/4 ....................................................................................................................... page Spool valves manually actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/4 ............................................................................................................................... page Spool valves manually actuated 5 port - G 1/2 - G 1/2 ............................................................................................................................ page

3.8 3.9 3.12 3.14 3.16 3.18

Series CA General features ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page Poppet valves mechanically actuated 3 and 5 port - G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 ............................................................................................ page Poppet valves manually actuated 2 and 3 port - G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 ................................................................................................... page Poppet valves manually actuated 3 port / 3 positions and 5 port - G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 ..................................................................... page

3.19 3.20 3.22 3.24

Series PC General features ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page 3.27 Valves pedal actuated 3 and 5 port G 1/8 - G 1/4 .................................................................................................................................... page 3.28

Complementary valves General features ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page 3.30

Series DS

Shuttle valves ............................................................................................................................................................................................. page 3.30

Series D3/

Quick exhaust valves ................................................................................................................................................................................. page 3.30

Series U

Check valves .............................................................................................................................................................................................. page 3.31

Series VC

Slide valves ................................................................................................................................................................................................ page 3.31

Series RX

Distribution frames ..................................................................................................................................................................................... page 3.31

Series EL

General features - Pneumatic logic elements ............................................................................................................................................ page 3.32

Series UR

General features ........................................................................................................................................................................................ page In-line precision flow regulators type URG - URF ..................................................................................................................................... page In-line standard flow regulators type URE ................................................................................................................................................. page Silenced exhaust flow regulators type URS .............................................................................................................................................. page

3.34 3.34 3.35 3.35

Series WB

General features - Block valves ................................................................................................................................................................. page 3.36

Series XVF

General features - Amplifier valves ............................................................................................................................................................ page 3.37

Valves manually and mechanically actuated and complementary valves

3.1


Waircom complementary and manually/mechanically actuated valves: overview As already described in the overview

As inferable by their definition, these

of the previous chapter, even for this

valves can be actuated or by a

series of valves we can find both

mechanical device or by an operator,

poppet and spool construction,

and they can be used together

in order to satisfy the different

with some complementary valves,

applications.

that, in spite of their definition, are of great importance for the proper and efficiency functioning of each pneumatic circuits.

3.2

Valves manually and mechanically actuated and complementary valves


M

Minivalves manually and mechanically actuated

series

DESCRIPTION Minivalves series "M" are produced in the 2/2 and 3/2 pneumatic functions in both side and bottom ported versions, with push-in fittings on body valve for pipe Ø 4 mm or M5 threaded connections; the version G 1/8 bottom ported is also available. Thanks to the suitable adapter types MCS-SA and MCS-SAD these minivalves support the "BRETER" Ø 22 mm actuators for panel mounting. The same actuators can control 1 or 2 minivalves, thus it's possible to obtain the 3/2, 5/2, 5/3 open centre and the 5/3 pressure centre pneumatic functions.

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Nominal diameter Controls Mechanical Manual

2 ÷ 10 bar 0 ÷ +60 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Push-in fittings for pipe Ø 4 mm - M5 - G 1/8 2,5 mm

3

FLOW CHART - M

Plunger; roller lever; unidirectional roller lever Tapper; actuators for panel mounting

MATERIALS Anodized aluminium alloy Nickel - plated brass Stainless steel NBR rubber Nickel - plated brass, plastic material

Flow Flowrate rate(Nl/min) (Nl/min)

Body Bushing and guide Springs Seals Connections Controls Tapper; Swivel Plunger; Roller Lever

Glass stiffened polyamide Nickel - plated brass Steel

Operating pressure (bar) Operating pressure (bar)

2 AND 3 PORT N.C. - N.O. Controls Symbol

Function

Actuation force at 6 bar (N)

Flow rate Weight at 6 bar (g) P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Port size

TYPE

40

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHAS4 MHAS4/L MHASM5 MHASM5/L MHAS1/8

40

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHCS4 MHCS4/L MHCSM5 MHCSM5/L MHCS1/8

40

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MAS4 MAS4/L MASM5 MASM5/L MAS1/8

83

40

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MCS4 MCS4/L MCSM5 MCSM5/L MCS1/8

83

60

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHAP4 MHAP4/L MHAPM5 MHAPM5/L MHAP1/8

83

60

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHCP4 MHCP4/L MHCPM5 MHCPM5/L MHCP1/8

83

60

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MAP4 MAP4/L MAPM5 MAPM5/L MAP1/8

Pilot

Return

2/2 N.O. monostable

Plunger

Mechanical spring

13

83

2/2 N.C. monostable

Plunger

Mechanical spring

13

83

Plunger

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.C. monostable

Plunger

Mechanical spring

13

2/2 N.O. monostable

Plunger for panel mounting

Mechanical spring

13

2/2 N.C. monostable

Plunger for panel mounting

Mechanical spring

13

3/2 N.O. monostable

Plunger for panel mounting

Mechanical spring

13

3/2 N.O. monostable

13

Minivalves series M

83

3.3


M

Minivalves manually and mechanically actuated

series

2 AND 3 PORT N.C. - N.O. Controls Symbol

Function

3.4

Flow rate Weight at 6 bar (g) P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Port size

TYPE

60

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MCP4 MCP4/L MCPM5 MCPM5/L MCP1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported MHALR4 Ø4 side ported MHALR4/L M5 bottom threaded MHALRM5 M5 side threaded MHALRM5/L G 1/8 bottom ported MHALR1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported MHCLR4 Ø4 side ported MHCLR4/L M5 bottom threaded MHCLRM5 M5 side threaded MHCLRM5/L G 1/8 bottom ported MHCLR1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MALR4 MALR4/L MALRM5 MALRM5/L MALR1/8

7

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MCLR4 MCLR4/L MCLRM5 MCLRM5/L MCLR1/8

7

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHALRU4 MHALRU4/L MHALRUM5 MHALRUM5/L MHALRU1/8

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHCLRU4 MHCLRU4/L MHCLRUM5 MHCLRUM5/L MHCLRU1/8

50

Ø4 bottom ported MALRU4 Ø4 side ported MALRU4/L M5 bottom threaded MALRUM5 M5 side threaded MALRUM5/L G 1/8 bottom ported MALRU1/8

50

Ø4 bottom ported MCLRU4 Ø4 side ported MCLRU4/L M5 bottom threaded MCLRUM5 M5 side threaded MCLRUM5/L G 1/8 bottom ported MCLRU1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHAT4 MHAT4/L MHATM5 MHATM5/L MHAT1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MHCT4 MHCT4/L MHCTM5 MHCTM5/L MHCT1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MAT4 MAT4/L MATM5 MATM5/L MAT1/8

83

50

Ø4 bottom ported Ø4 side ported M5 bottom threaded M5 side threaded G 1/8 bottom ported

MCT4 MCT4/L MCTM5 MCTM5/L MCT1/8

Pilot

Return

Plunger for panel mounting

Mechanical spring

2/2 N.O. monostable

Roller lever

Mechanical spring

7

2/2 N.C. monostable

Roller lever

Mechanical spring

7

2/2 N.O. monostable

Roller lever

Mechanical spring

7

3/2 N.C. monostable

Unidiretional Roller lever

Mechanical spring

2/2 N.O. monostable

Unidiretional Roller lever

Mechanical spring

2/2 N.C. monostable

Unidiretional Roller lever

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.O. monostable

Unidiretional Roller lever

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.C. monostable

Unidiretional Roller lever

Mechanical spring

2/2 N.O. monostable

Tapper

Mechanical spring

7

2/2 N.C. monostable

Tapper

Mechanical spring

7

3/2 N.O. monostable

Tapper

Mechanical spring

7

3/2 N.C. monostable

Tapper

Mechanical spring

7

3/2 N.C. monostable

3

Actuation force at 6 bar (N)

13

7

7

7

Minivalves series M

83

83

83

83


M

Minivalves manually and mechanically actuated PLUNGER - Ø 4 mm SIDE AND BOTTOM PORTED

series

PLUNGER - M5 THREADED CONNECTIONS SIDE AND BOTTOM PORTED - G 1/8 BOTTOM PORTED

3

CONTROLS PLUNGER FOR PANEL MOUNTING

ROLLER LEVER

UNIDIRECTIONAL ROLLER LEVER

TAPPER

Minivalves series M

3.5


M

Accessories Actuators for panel mounting

series

ACTUATORS FOR PANEL MOUNTING Symbol

3

Description

Function

TYPE

Symbol

Description

TYPE

Function

Protected monostable push-button BLACK RED GREEN

0← 1

MCS - PMN MCS - PMR MCS - PMV

Red monostable mushroom

0← 1

MCS - FMR

Black monostable short-lever switch, 1→0← 2 3 position with return to the centre

MCS - LCSM

Red bistable mushroom (rotate to unlock)

0

1

MCS - FBR

Black short-lever switch, 3 stable positions

MCS - LCSB

Black monostable short-lever switch

0← 1

MCS - LCM

Bistable key (extractable in both the 2 positions)

0

Black bistable short-lever switch

1

1

0 0

MCS - LCB

2 1

MCS - CB2

ADAPTER TYPE MCS-SA FOR ACTUATORS

DOUBLE ADAPTER TYPE MCS-SAD FOR ACTUATORS

PUSH-BUTTON

MUSHROOM

SHORT-LEVER SWITCH

BISTABLE KEY

3.6

Minivalves series M


3

3.7


EK

Spool valves manually and mechanically actuated G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2

series

DESCRIPTION Valves series "EK" are produced in the 3/2, 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions; the kind of construction is based on a balanced spool. In the mechanically actuated version these valves are available only for the size G 1/8 and G 1/4, while the manually actuated versions are available in the different sizes and they are suitable for panel mounting (except for size G 1/2).

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure

Controls Mechanical Manual

Plunger; roller lever; whisker; released pressure key Drawer; front lever; lateral knob; actuators for panel mounting (see on page 3.6)

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT 3 port G 1/8 5 port G 1/8 3 port G 1/4 5 port G 1/4 5 port G 1/2

EK/M/SG/8 EKCA/M/SG/8 EK/M/SG/4 EKCA/M/SG/4 EKCA/M/SG/2

Steel Stainless steel Anodized aluminium alloy Brass Elastomer Plastic material Ball bearing (plastic material upon request)

FLOW CHART - EK G 1/4 - 5/2

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - EK G 1/2 - 5/2

Operating pressure (bar)

3.8

Front: aluminium alloy or plastic - Rear: aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy Acetal resin Galvanized steel NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Flow rate (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART - EK G 1/8 - 5/2

MATERIALS Bottoms Body Distance rings Springs Seals Spool Controls Lever; Ball Whisker Released pressure key Plunger Bellows Knobs; Handgrips Roller

Flow rate (Nl/min)

3

Working temperature Fluid Port size Nominal diameter

0 ÷10 bar 3 ÷10 bar 0 ÷ +60 °C (con aria secca -20 °C) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 G 1/8 = 5 mm G 1/4 = 8 mm G 1/2 = 12 mm

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/8 - 3 and 5 PORT

series MECHANICALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 Controls Symbol

Flow rate at

Weight (g)

TYPE

390

135

EK8/PS

32

390

140

EK8/PSS

Mechanical spring

32

490

165

EKCA8/PS

Plunger

Plunger

32

490

170

EKCA8/PSS

Roller lever

Mechanical spring

15

390

160

EK8/LR*

3/2 bistable

Roller lever

Roller lever

15

390

200

EK8/LRLR*

5/2 monostable

Roller lever

Mechanical spring

15

490

190

EKCA8/LR*

5/2 bistable

Roller lever

Roller lever

15

490

225

EKCA8/LRLR*

Piloted whisker (sensitive)

Mechanical spring

Function

Actuation force at 6 bar (N)

Pilot

Return

Plunger

Mechanical spring

32

3/2 bistable

Plunger

Plunger

5/2 monostable

Plunger

5/2 bistable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable 5/2 monostable 3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable 5/2 monostable 3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable 5/2 monostable

6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

EKA8/A 1,5

420

230 EKC8/A

Piloted whisker (sensitive)

Mechanical spring

Piloted released pressure key (sensitive)

Mechanical spring

Piloted released pressure key (sensitive)

Mechanical spring

Piloted plunger for panel mounting (sensitive)

Mechanical spring

Piloted plunger for panel mounting (sensitive)

Mechanical spring

1,5

490

260

EKCA8/A

EKA8/TD 1,5

420

210 EKC8/TD

1,5

490

230

EKCA8/TD

EKA8/Q 1,5

420

230 EKC8/Q

1,5

490

260

EKCA8/Q

* - ADD THE LETTER “U” TO THE TYPE TO ORDER THE UNIDIRECTIONAL ROLLER VALVES - E.G.: EKCA8/LRLRU - ADD THE LETTER “N” TO THE TYPE TO ORDER THE VALVES WITH PLASTIC ROLLER - E.G.: EK8/LRN

Spool valves series EK

3.9

3


EK

G 1/8 - 3 and 5 PORT

series EK8/PS

EK8/PSS

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3 EKCA8/PS

EKCA8/PSS

4 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

EK8/LR*

EK8/LRLR*

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

EKCA8/LR*

EKCA8/LRLR*

4 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

* - ADD THE LETTER “U” TO THE TYPE TO ORDER THE UNIDIRECTIONAL ROLLER VALVES - E.G.: EKCA8/LRLRU - ADD THE LETTER “N” TO THE TYPE TO ORDER THE VALVES WITH PLASTIC ROLLER - E.G.: EK8/LRN

3.10

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/8 - 3 and 5 PORT

series EKA8/A - EKC8/A

EKCA8/A

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3

EKA8/TD - EKC8/TD*

EKCA8/TD*

3 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

* IT IS POSSIBLE TO INCREASE THE SENSITIVITY OF THE KEY USING A Ø 3 mm EXTENSION ON THE SAME KEY

EKC8/Q - EKA8/Q

* IT IS POSSIBLE TO INCREASE THE SENSITIVITY OF THE KEY USING A Ø 3 mm EXTENSION ON THE SAME KEY

EKCA8/Q

4 HOLES Ø5.2 3 HOLES Ø5.2

P.S.: SEE ACTUATORS FOR PANEL MOUNTING ON PAGE 3.6

P.S.: SEE ACTUATORS FOR PANEL MOUNTING ON PAGE 3.6

Spool valves series EK

3.11


EK

G 1/8 - 3 and 5 PORT

series

MANUALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 Controls Symbol

Function

TYPE

Return

Drawer

Mechanical spring

480

155

EK8/T

3/2 bistable

Drawer

Drawer

480

155

EK8/TF

5/2 monostable

Drawer

Mechanical spring

480

185

EKCA8/T

5/2 bistable

Drawer

Drawer

480

185

EKCA8/TF

Front lever

Mechanical spring

480

150

EK8/MV

3/2 bistable

Front lever

Front lever

480

150

EK8/MVF

5/2 monostable

Front lever

Mechanical spring

480

185

EKCA8/MV

5/2 bistable

Front lever

Front lever

480

185

EKCA8/MVF

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

480

155

EK8/M

3/2 bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

480

185

EK8/MF

5/2 monostable

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

480

205

EKCA8/M

5/2 bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

480

205

EKCA8/MF

5/3 monostable closed centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

300

205

EKCA8/MS

5/3 stable closed centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

300

205

EKCA8/MSF

5/3 monostable open centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

300

205

EKCA8/MA

5/3 stable open centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

300

205

EKCA8/MAF

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3.12

Weight (g)

Pilot

3/2 N.O. monostable

3

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/8 - 3 and 5 PORT

series EK8/T - EK8/TF

EKCA8/T - EKCA8/TF

NO. 3 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3

EK8/MV - EK8/MVF

EKCA8/MV - EKCA8/MVF

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

EK8/M - EK8/MF

5/2 - 5/3 LATERAL KNOB

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

FUNCTION 5/2 5/3

A 89 92

Spool valves series EK

3.13


EK

G 1/4 - 3 and 5 PORT

series

MECHANICALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 Controls Symbol

TYPE

900

205

EK4/PS

9,5

900

200

EK4/PSS

Mechanical spring

51

900

250

EKCA4/PS

Drawer

Drawer

9,5

900

250

EKCA4/PSS

Front lever

Mechanical spring

21

900

270

EK4/LR*

3/2 bistable

Front lever

Front lever

16

900

325

EK4/LRLR*

5/2 monostable

Front lever

Mechanical spring

21

900

320

EKCA4/LR*

5/2 bistable

Front lever

Front lever

16

900

380

EKCA4/LRLR*

Actuation force at 6 bar (N)

Pilot

Return

Drawer

Mechanical spring

51

3/2 bistable

Drawer

Drawer

5/2 monostable

Drawer

5/2 bistable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3

Flow rate at

Weight (g)

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

* ADD THE LETTER “N“ TO THE TYPE TO ORDER THE VALVES WITH PLASTIC ROLLER - E.G.: EK4/LRN

EK4/PS

EK4/PSS

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3.14

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/4 - 3 and 5 PORT

series EKCA4/PS

EKCA4/PSS

4 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3

EK4/LR*

EK4/LRLR*

3 HOLES Ø5.2

EKCA4/LR*

3 HOLES Ø5.2

EKCA4/LRLR*

4 HOLES Ø5.2

4 HOLES Ø5.2

* ADD THE LETTER “N“ TO THE TYPE TO ORDER THE VALVES WITH PLASTIC ROLLER - E.G.: EK4/LRN

Spool valves series EK

3.15


EK

G 1/4 - 3 and 5 PORT

series

MANUALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/4 Controls Symbol

Function

TYPE

Return

Drawer

Mechanical spring

900

240

EK4/T

3/2 bistable

Drawer

Drawer

900

240

EK4/TF

5/2 monostable

Drawer

Mechanical spring

900

305

EKCA4/T

5/2 bistable

Drawer

Drawer

900

305

EKCA4/TF

Front lever

Mechanical spring

920

230

EK4/MV

3/2 bistable

Front lever

Front lever

920

230

EK4/MVF

5/2 monostable

Front lever

Mechanical spring

920

185

EKCA4/MV

5/2 bistable

Front lever

Front lever

920

185

EKCA4/MVF

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

920

255

EK4/M

3/2 bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

920

250

EK4/MF

5/2 monostable

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

920

310

EKCA4/M

5/2 bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

920

310

EKCA4/MF

5/3 monostable closed centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

780

310

EKCA4/MS

5/3 stable closed centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

780

310

EKCA4/MSF

5/3 monostable open centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

780

310

EKCA4/MA

5/3 stable open centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

780

310

EKCA4/MAF

3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable

3.16

Weight (g)

Pilot

3/2 N.O. monostable

3

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Spool valves series EK


EK

G 1/4 - 3 and 5 PORT

series EK4/T - EK4/TF

EKCA4/T - EKCA4/TF

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

3

EK4/MV - EK4/MVF

EKCA4/MV - EKCA4/MVF

4 HOLES Ø5.2 3 HOLES Ø5.2

EK4/M - EK4/MF

5/2 - 5/3 LATERAL KNOB

4 HOLES Ø5.2

3 HOLES Ø5.2

FUNCTION 5/2 5/3

A 107 110

Spool valves series EK

3.17


EK

G 1/2 - 5 PORT

series

MANUALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/2 Controls Symbol

3

Function

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Weight (g)

TYPE

Pilot

Return

5/2 monostable

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

2250

1200

EKCA2/M

5/2 bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

2250

1200

EKCA2/MF

5/3 monostable closed centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

2000

1200

EKCA2/MS

5/3 stable closed centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

2000

1200

EKCA2/MSF

5/3 monostable open centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

2000

1200

EKCA2/MA

5/3 stable open centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

2000

1200

EKCA2/MAF

5/2 - 5/3 LATERAL KNOB

4 HOLES Ă˜6.5

FUNCTION A 5/2 194,5 5/3 198

3.18

Spool valves series EK


CA

Poppet valves manually and mechanically actuated

series

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 DESCRIPTION

Valves series "CA" are produced in the 2/2, 3/2, 3/3, 5/2 and 5/3 pneumatic functions. The poppet kind of construction and the very rugged control allow the valve to stand high stress. The push-button and mushroom controls are available only in the 3/2 monostable pneumatic functions for the size G 1/8.

Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Nominal diameter Controls Mechanical Manual

3

MATERIALS

TECHNICAL DATA 0 ÷ 12 bar 0 ÷ +70 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 G 1/8 = 6 mm G 1/4 = 8 mm G 1/2 =12 mm Plunger; roller lever; short roller lever; unidirectional roller lever Tapper; push-button; mushroom; vertical knob; lateral knob; lateral hand-wheel

Control rod Body Springs Seals Piston Guide bushing Bottom plug Controls Lever Plunger Knobs; handgrips; push-buttons Roller

Hardened and nickel - plated steel Anodized aluminium alloy Stainless steel NBR rubber Acetal resin Brass Nickel - plated brass Steel Nickel - plated brass Plastic material Ball bearing (plastic material upon request)

FLOW CHART - CA G 1/8 - 5/2

SPARE PARTS SEALS KIT A/SG/8 C/SG/8 CA/SG/8 A/SG/4 C/SG/4 CA/SG/4 A/SG/2 C/SG/2 CA/SG/2

Flow rate (Nl/min)

3/2 N.O. G 1/8 3/2 N.C. G 1/8 5/2 G 1/8 3/2 N.O. G 1/4 3/2 N.C. G 1/4 5/2 G 1/4 3/2 N.O. G 1/2 3/2 N.C. G 1/2 5/2 G 1/2

Operating pressure (bar)

FLOW CHART - CA G 1/4 - 5/2

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Flow rate (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART - CA G 1/2 - 5/2

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

Poppet valves series CA

3.19


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

MECHANICALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable 3/2 N.O. monostable

3

3/2 N.C. monostable 3/2 N.O. monostable

Pilot

Return

Plunger

Mechanical spring

Plunger

Roller lever

Roller lever

Unidirectional roller lever

Mechanical spring Mechanical spring Mechanical spring Mechanical spring

Actuation force at 6 bar (N)

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

38 60

Weight (g)

Port size

TYPE

740

70

G 1/8

AS 8

950

150

G 1/4

AS4

88

2200

300

G 1/2

AS2

36

815

70

G 1/8

CS8

64

950

150

G 1/4

CS4

85

2250

300

G 1/2

CS2

23

740

95

G 1/8

ALR8

35

950

215

G 1/4

ALR4

53

2200

415

G 1/2

ALR2

24

815

95

G 1/8

CLR8

34

950

215

G 1/4

CLR4

52

2250

415

G 1/2

CLR2

30

740

100

G 1/8

ALRU8

53

950

200

G 1/4

ALRU4

64

2200

405

G 1/2

ALRU2

26

815

100

G 1/8

CLRU8

50

950

200

G 1/4

CLRU4

63

2250

405

G 1/2

CLRU2

3/2 N.C. monostable

Unidirectional roller lever

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.O. monostable

Short roller lever

Mechanical spring

35

740

110

G 1/8

AR8

3/2 N.C. monostable

Short roller lever

Mechanical spring

33

815

110

G 1/8

CR8

3/2 N.C. monostable

Mechanical spring

48

815

70

G 1/8

FCS8*

Plunger

162

950

150

G 1/4

FCS4*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Mechanical spring

25

815

95

G 1/8

FCLR8*

Roller lever

70

950

215

G 1/4

FCLR4*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Unidirectional roller lever

Mechanical spring

27

815

95

G 1/8

FCLRU8*

80

950

215

G 1/4

FCLRU4*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Short roller lever

Mechanical spring

69

815

110

G 1/8

FCR8*

5/2 monostable

Mechanical spring

62

650

140

G 1/8

CASS8

Plunger

103

1040

305

G 1/4

CASS4

120

2050

600

G 1/2

CASS2

38

650

190

G 1/8

CALR8

64

1040

405

G 1/4

CALR4

45

2050

765

G 1/2

CALR2

43

650

190

G 1/8

CALRU8

68

1040

405

G 1/4

CALRU4

94

2050

775

G 1/2

CALRU2

5/2 monostable 5/2 monostable

Roller lever

Unidirectional roller lever

Mechanical spring Mechanical spring

P.S.: ADD THE LETTER “N” AFTER THE LETTER “R” IN THE TYPE TO ORDER THE VALVES WITH PLASTIC ROLLER (AVAILABLE ONLY FOR THE SIZES G 1/8 AND G 1/4). E.G.: CLRN8 PUT THE LETTER “H” BEFORE THE TYPE OF 3/2 VALVES TO ORDER THE 2/2 N.O. AND 2/2 N.C. VALVES. E.G.: HCS8; HAR8

3/2 SHORT ROLLER LEVER

2 HOLES Ø4.3

* THE WAYS AREN’T COMMUNICATING IN THE INTERMEDIATE PHASE OF ACTUATION

3.20

Poppet valves series CA


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 2, 3 and 5 PORT

series

3/2 PLUNGER

3/2 ROLLER LEVER

3 3/2 UNIDIRECTIONAL ROLLER LEVER

5/2 PLUNGER

5/2 ROLLER LEVER

5/2 UNIDIRECTIONAL ROLLER LEVER

GA

A

A1

A2

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

59 75 100

74 95 123

88 111 142

GA

G

H

I

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

8,8 11,5 15

23 30 38

GA

U

V

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

16 20 25

46 54 70

6 8 10

B

C min 1,5 2 3

46 60 80 L N.O. 23 30 40

N.C. 18 25,5 30

C3

D

E

F

max 3 4 5,5

min 5,5 7,5 10,5

C1 max 10 13,5 15,5

min 5 5 7

C2 max 8 8 10

10 12 14

27 35 42,5

4,3 5,3 6,4

28 35 49

M

N

N1

O

P

Q

S

T

T2

31 40 50

19 26 32

16 19 24

6,9 9 12

53 69 80,5

36 46 63,3

23 30 40

16 20 25

32 40 50

Poppet valves series CA

3.21


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 2 and 3 PORT

series

2 AND 3 PORT MANUALLY ACTUATED G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 Controls Symbol

Function

3/2 N.O. monostable

3

Pilot

Return

Tapper

Mechanical spring

3/2 N.C. monostable

Tapper

3/2 N.O. monostable

Push-button

3/2 N.C. monostable

Mechanical spring

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Weight (g)

Port size

TYPE

740

90

G 1/8

AT8

950

195

G 1/4

AT4

2200

415

G 1/2

AT2

815

90

G 1/8

CT8

950

205

G 1/4

CT4

2250

425

G 1/2

CT2

Mechanical spring

740

125

G 1/8

AQB8*

Push-button

Mechanical spring

815

125

G 1/8

CQB8*

3/2 N.O. monostable

Mushroom

Mechanical spring

740

125

G 1/8

AQF8*

3/2 N.C. monostable

Mushroom

Mechanical spring

815

125

G 1/8

CQF8*

3/2 N.O. monostable

Vertical knob

Mechanical spring

740

185

G 1/8

AM8

950

355

G 1/4

AM4

2200

655

G 1/2

AM2

815

185

G 1/8

CM8 CM4

3/2 N.C. monostable 3/2 N.O. bistable 3/2 N.C. bistable

Vertical knob Vertical knob Vertical knob

Mechanical spring Vertical knob Vertical knob

950

355

G 1/4

2250

655

G 1/2

CM2

740

180

G 1/8

AM8F AM4F

950

345

G 1/4

2200

645

G 1/2

AM2F

815

180

G 1/8

CM8F

950

345

G 1/4

CM4F

2250

645

G 1/2

CM2F

240

G 1/8

AML8

3/2 N.O. monostable

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

740 950

400

G 1/4

AML4

3/2 N.C. monostable

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

815

240

G 1/8

CML8

950

400

G 1/4

CML4

3/2 N.O. bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

740

245

G 1/8

AML8F

950

390

G 1/4

AML4F

3/2 N.C. bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

815

245

G 1/8

CML8F

950

390

G 1/4

CML4F

3/2 N.O. monostable

Lateral hand-wheel

Mechanical spring

740

270

G 1/8

AVL8

950

415

G 1/4

AVL4

3/2 N.C. monostable

Lateral hand-wheel

Mechanical spring

815

270

G 1/8

CVL8

950

415

G 1/4

CVL4

3/2 N.O. bistable

Lateral hand-wheel

Lateral hand-wheel

740

265

G 1/8

AVL8F

950

405

G 1/4

AVL4F

3/2 N.C. bistable

Lateral hand-wheel

Lateral hand-wheel

815

265

G 1/8

CVL8F

950

405

G 1/4

CVL4F

* PUSH-BUTTON COLOUR: N = BLACK; R = RED; V = GREEN P.S.: THE VERSION WITH BLACK VERTICAL KNOB IS AVAILABLE ONLY IN THE SIZES G 1/8 AND G 1/4; TO ORDER THIS VERSION ADD THE SUFFIX “/E” TO THE TYPE. E.G.: CM8/E; AM8/E PUT THE LETTER “H” BEFORE THE TYPE OF 3/2 VALVES TO ORDER THE 2/2 N.O. AND 2/2 N.C. VALVES. E.G.: HCM4; HAT2

3.22

Poppet valves series CA


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 2 and 3 PORT

series 3/2 PUSH-BUTTON

2 HOLES Ø4.3

2 HOLES Ø4.3

3/2 MUSHROOM

3 3/2 TAPPER

3/2 VERTICAL KNOB

3/2 LATERAL KNOB

3/2 LATERAL HAND-WHEEL

GA

A

A1

A2

B

C

C1

C2

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

80 100 130

77 95 124

78 98 100

46 60 80

20 20 -

42 42 -

min 8 11 28

GA

I

L

L1

L2

M

N

O

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

6 8 10

162 188 238

100 100 -

112 130 -

31 40 50

10 10 -

9 9 -

D

D1

E

F

G

H

max 15,5 22,5 35

36 36 -

70 70 -

4,3 5,3 6,4

28 35 49

8,8 11,5 15

23 30 38

P

P2

Q

124 152 180

Poppet valves series CA

60 83 145

36 46 63,3

R N.O. 23 30 40

T N.C. 18 25,5 30

16 20 25

3.23


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 3 and 5 PORT

series

3 PORT, 3 POSITIONS AND 5 PORT MANUALLY ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 Controls Symbol

Function

5/2 monostable 5/2 monostable 5/2 bistable

3

Return

Tapper

Mechanical spring

Vertical knob Vertical knob

Mechanical spring Vertical knob

5/2 monostable

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

5/2 bistable

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

5/2 monostable

Hand-wheel

Mechanical spring

5/2 bistable

Lateral hand-wheel

Lateral hand-wheel

5/3 monostable open centre

Vertical knob

Mechanical spring

5/3 stable open centre

Vertical knob

Vertical knob

5/3 monostable open centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

5/3 stable open centre

Lateral knob

Lateral knob

5/3 monostable open centre

Lateral hand-wheel

Mechanical spring

5/3 stable open centre

Lateral hand-wheel

Lateral hand-wheel

3/3 monostable closed centre

Vertical knob

Mechanical spring

3/3 stable closed centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

3/3 monostable closed centre

Lateral knob

Mechanical spring

3/3 stable closed centre

Vertical knob

Mechanical spring

5/3 monostable closed centre

Vertical knob

Mechanical spring

5/3 stable closed centre

3.24

Pilot

Vertical knob

Vertical knob

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (Nl/min)

Weight (g)

Port size

TYPE

650

180

G 1/8

CAT8

1040

405

G 1/4

CAT4

2050

790

G 1/2

CAT2

650

315

G 1/8

CAM8

1040

600

G 1/4

CAM4

2050

1160

G 1/2

CAM2

650

290

G 1/8

CAM8F

1040

570

G 1/4

CAM4F

2050

1065

G 1/2

CAM2F

650

375

G 1/8

CAML8

1040

650

G 1/4

CAML4

650

365

G 1/8

CAML8F

1040

635

G 1/4

CAML4F

650

395

G 1/8

CAVL8

1040

665

G 1/4

CAVL4

650

380

G 1/8

CAVL8F

1040

650

G 1/4

CAVL4F

815

315

G 1/8

CCM8

950

605

G 1/4

CCM4

2250

1165

G 1/2

CCM2

815

290

G 1/8

CCM8F

950

575

G 1/4

CCM4F

2250

1095

G 1/2

CCM2F

815

385

G 1/8

CCML8

950

675

G 1/4

CCML4

815

370

G 1/8

CCML8F

950

650

G 1/4

CCML4F

815

405

G 1/8

CCVL8

950

690

G 1/4

CCVL4

815

385

G 1/8

CCVL8F

950

660

G 1/4

CCVL4F

815

310

G 1/8

HCCM8

950

600

G 1/4

HCCM4

815

310

G 1/8

HCCM8F

950

600

G 1/4

HCCM4F

815

310

G 1/8

HCCML8

950

600

G 1/4

HCCML4

815

310

G 1/8

HCCML8F

950

600

G 1/4

HCCML4F

815

740

G 1/8

XH4CM8

950

1605

G 1/4

XH4CM4

2250

3185

G 1/2

XH4CM2

815

680

G 1/8

XH4CM8F

1400

1555

G 1/4

XH4CM4F

2250

3080

G 1/2

XH4CM2F

Poppet valves series CA


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 3 and 5 PORT

series

5/2 TAPPER ????????????? ?????????? ????????

5/2 - 5/3 C.A. - 3/3 VERTICAL KNOB

3

5/2 - 5/3 C.A. - 3/3 C.C. LATERAL KNOB

GA

A

A1

A2

B

5/2 LATERAL HAND-WHEEL

C

C1

C2

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

80 100 130

77 95 124

75,5 95 83

46 60 80

20 20 -

42 42 -

min 8 11 28

GA

I

L

L1

L2

M

N

O

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

6 8 10

GA

U

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

16 20 25

162 188 238

100 100 -

112 130 -

31 40 50

10 10 -

9 9 -

D

D1

E

F

G

H

max 15,5 22,5 35

36 36 -

70 70 -

4,3 5,3 6,4

28 35 49

8,8 11,5 15

23 30 38

P

P2

Q

S

T

23 30 40

32 40 50

124 152 180

60 83 145

36 46 63,3

R N.O. 23 30 40

N.C. 18 25,5 30

P.S.: THE VERSION WITH BLACK VERTICAL KNOB IS AVAILABLE ONLY IN THE SIZES G 1/8 AND G 1/4; TO ORDER THIS VERSION ADD THE SUFFIX “/E” TO THE TYPE. E.G.: CAM8/E; CCM8/E

Poppet valves series CA

3.25


CA

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 5 PORT

series

5/3 C.C. VERTICAL KNOB G 1/8

3

5/3 C.C. VERTICAL KNOB G 1/4 - G 1/2

GA G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

3.26

A 81 100 130

E 4,3 5,3 6,4

F 28 35 49

G 8,8 11,5 15

H 23 30 38

I 6 8 10

L 157,5 185 235

M 31 40 50

M1

P with catch

without catch

111 132 162

70 84 60

15 24 29

Poppet valves series CA

Q

T

U

18 25,5 30

64 80 100

48 60 75


PC

Valves pedal actuated G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION Pedal actuated valves series "PC" are produced in the 3/2 and 5/2 pneumatic functions, with or without protection, and they are based on direct acting poppet valves and direct acting or pilot assisted spool valves in the sizes G 1/8 and G 1/4. The catch on the pedal allows obtaining the bistable pneumatic functions, while the safety device avoids the accidental actuation of the same pedal.

3 TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Nominal diameter

MATERIALS 0 ÷ 10 bar (with direct acting valves) 2,5 ÷ 10 bar (with pilot assisted valves) 0 ÷ +50 °C (-10 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 G 1/8 = 6 mm G 1/4 = 8,5 mm

Hardened and nickel - plated steel – nickel - plated brass Anodized aluminium alloy Aluminium alloy Stainless steel NBR rubber Die - cast aluminium - Plastic material Plastic material Plastic material Press-forged aluminium - Plastic material

FLOW CHART - PC G 1/4 - 5/2

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Flow rate (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART - PC G 1/8 - 5/2

Control rod Body Spool Springs Seals Protection cover Safety device Catch Control lever

Operating pressure (bar)

Operating pressure (bar)

Valves pedal actuated series PC

3.27


PC

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - 3 and 5 PORT

series

PEDAL ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - G 1/4 Symbol

3

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Weight (g)

Port size

TYPE

740

565

G 1/8

AP8�

950

700

G 1/4

AP4�

740

1020

G 1/8

AP8F�

815

570

G 1/8

CP8�

950

700

G 1/4

CP4�

Direct acting

815

570

G 1/8

FCP8*�

_

Direct acting

815

1015

G 1/8

CP8F�

5/2 monostable

_

Direct acting

650

915

G 1/8

CAP8�

5/2 bistable

_

Direct acting

650

1025

G 1/8

CAP8F�

_

Direct acting

900

970

G 1/4

PNP4

_

Direct acting

900

970

G 1/4

PNP4/F

5/2 monostable

_

Direct acting

900

1020

G 1/4

PNPCA4

5/2 bistable

_

Direct acting

900

1020

G 1/4

PNPCA4/F

5/3 monostable closed centre

_

Direct acting

780

1020

G 1/4

PNPCA4/S

5/3 stable closed centre

_

Direct acting

780

1020

G 1/4

PNPCA4/SF

5/3 monostable open centre

_

Direct acting

780

1020

G 1/4

PNPCA4/A

5/3 stable open centre

_

Direct acting

780

1020

G 1/4

PNPCA4/AF

5/2 with safety device monostable

Plastic

900

1350

G 1/4

PCA4

Function

Protection

Actuation

3/2 N.O. monostable

_

Direct acting

3/2 N.O. bistable

_

Direct acting

3/2 N.C. monostable

_

Direct acting

3/2 N.C. monostable

_

3/2 N.C. bistable

3/2 N.O. monostable 3/2 N.C. monostable 3/2 N.O. bistable 3/2 N.C. bistable

Pilot assisted

* THE WAYS AREN’T COMMUNICATING IN THE INTERMEDIATE PHASE OF ACTUATION

3.28

Valves pedal actuated series PC


PC

Pedal actuated valves G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

PEDAL ACTUATED VALVES G 1/8 - G 1/4 Function

Protection

Actuation

Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar (NI/min)

Weight (g)

Port size

TYPE

5/2 with safety device bistable

Plastic

Pilot assisted

900

1350

G 1/4

PCA4/F

5/2 with safety device monostable

Metallic

Pilot assisted

900

1750

G 1/4

PCA4M

5/2 with safety device bistable

Metallic

Pilot assisted

900

1750

G 1/4

PCA4M/F

Symbol

AP8 - AP4 - CP8 - CP4 - FCP8

G G 1/8 G 1/4

A1 193 193

H1 70 70

I1 83 83

3

AP8F - CP8F - CAP8 - CAP8F

L1 11 13

3/2 - 5/2 - 5/3 BALANCING WITHOUT PROTECTION - PNP

5 PORT PLASTIC AND METALLIC PROTECTION - PCA

Valves pedal actuated series PC

3.29


Complementary valves: shuttle, quick exhaust and check valves DESCRIPTION

3

Complementary valves are very important components of the pneumatic circuits. This group includes the: SHUTTLE VALVES: these valves are used when there is the necessity to convey, in one pipeline, two pneumatic flows coming from two different pipelines without any interference; in fact the compressed air flows from one of the two inlet ports to the working port while the second inlet port is excluded. QUICK EXHAUST VALVES: air flows from the inlet port to the working port while the exhaust port is closed. By shutting off the inlet port, the compressed air from the working port is exhausted through the exhaust port. CHECK VALVES: these valves are used to prevent loss of pressure in a pipeline when the inlet is connected to the exhaust; the compressed air can flow freely from the inlet to the working port while the opposite direction is blocked.

SHUTTLE VALVES SERIES DS DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS DS

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size

12 bar 0 ÷ +80°C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 3/8 - G 1/2

MATERIALS Body Seals

Aluminium alloy NBR rubber

Symbol

B

I

L

M

N

O

P

4,2 5,2 6,4 6,4

6 8 10 12

16 20 25 30

46 60 80 100

31 40 50 60

13 17,5 22 26

22 27 38 48

Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar (Nl/min) 700 1700 3400 5000

Pmin (bar) 0,2 0,4 0,3 0,6

Weight (g) 60 125 235 435

G

TYPE

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 1/2

DS8 DS4 DS3 DS2

QUICK EXHAUST VALVES SERIES D3/ DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS D3/

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size

12 bar 0 ÷ +80°C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/4 - G 1/2 - G 3/4

MATERIALS Body Seals Bottom

Aluminium alloy NBR rubber Aluminium alloy

Symbol

1

3 2

3.30

A

B

E

R

Flow rate from 1 to 2 at 6 bar P=1 bar (Nl/min)

Flow rate from 2 to 3 at 6 bar free exhaust (Nl/min)

Pmin (bar)

38 43 54 58 82

35 35 50 50 82

19,5 19,5 27,5 27,5 44

27 27 41 41 70

520 610 1520 2220 4400

2300 2300 4300 4300 6000

0,2 0,2 0,2 0,2 0,2

Weight (g) 70 75 135 140 510

Complementary valves: shuttle, quick exhaust and check valves

GA

GB

GC

TYPE

G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/2 G 1/2 G 3/4

G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/2 G 1/2 G 3/4

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/2 G 1/2

D3/4 D3/4B D3/2 D3/2B D3/15


Complementary valves: check and slide valves, distribution frames CHECK VALVES SERIES U

Symbol

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS U

MATERIALS

TECHNICAL DATA

Body Piston Seals Spring

Maximum pressure 12 bar Working temperature 0 ÷ +80°C (-20 °C with dry air) Fluid: Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Port size G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 - G 1 CH

A

Q

Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar (Nl/min)

13 19 19 27 50

15 21 21 30 50

34 48 48 66 110

19

21

48

Anodized aluminium Brass NBR rubber Stainless steel Weight (g) 25 75 75 170 1000

G

TYPE

70 700 725 2750 5100

Pmin (bar) 0,2 0,7 0,2 0,2 0,2

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/4 G 1/2 G1

U8 U4 U4/SM U2 U1

800

0,2

75

G 1/4

U4/SM2

3

SLIDE VALVES SERIES VC TECHNICAL DATA

MATERIALS Body Slide Seals

Operating pressure 1 ÷ 10 bar Working temperature 1 ÷ +60°C Fluid: Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Port size G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 3/8 - G 1/2 CH

B

Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar (Nl/min)

D

14 17 22 27

25 30 35 40

700 1500 2200 3400

48 58 68 80

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS VC

Weight (g) 54 102 153 204

Nickel-plated brass Anodized aluminium NBR rubber G

TYPE

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 1/2

VC-01 VC-02 VC-03 VC-04

DISTRIBUTION FRAMES SERIES RX DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS RX

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size

12 bar 0 ÷ +80°C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 3/8 - G 1/2

MATERIALS Body B 31 40 50 50

Anodized aluminium alloy C 23 30 38 38

D 22 27 39 39

E 4,5 6,5 5,5 5,5

F 4 5 6 6

G 4,3 5,3 6,3 6,3

H 16 20 25 25

A G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 1/2

Weight (g) 35 70 130 115

TYPE RX8 RX4 RX3 RX2

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT RX8/6

2 HOLES Ø5.5

Complementary valves: check and slide valves, distribution frames

WEIGHT 110 g

3.31


EL

Complementary valves: pneumatic logic elements

series

DESCRIPTION Pneumatic logic elements series "EL" are produced in the following No.5 basic functions: OR, AND, YES, NOT and MEMORY, with push-in fittings for pipe Ø 4 mm, and the pressure indicator is on body valve as standard. These elements can be mounted both separately (line mounted thanks to the No.2 holes on body valve) than on manifold bracket. The pneumatic logic element NOT is a threshold component and the pressure triggering value is 0,6 bar (at 6 bar).

TECHNICAL DATA

3

Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Rated flow rate

1,5 ÷10 bar (OR, AND, YES, NOT0, MEMORY) 0 ÷ +60 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Push-in fittings for pipe Ø 4 mm 90 Nl/min

MATERIALS Body Bushing and guide Springs Seals Spool Connections

Anodized aluminium alloy Nickel - plated brass Stainless steel NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy Nickel - plated brass, plastic material

LOGIC ELEMENT - ELO4 (OR - logical sum)

LOGIC ELEMENT - ELA4 (AND - logical multiplication)

WEIGHT 40 g

3.32

Complementary valves: pneumatic logic elements series EL

WEIGHT 40 g


EL

Complementary valves: pneumatic logic elements

series

LOGIC ELEMENT - ELY4 (YES - affirmation)

LOGIC ELEMENT - ELN4 (NOT - negation)

3

WEIGHT 82 g

LOGIC ELEMENT - ELM4 (memory)

WEIGHT 82 g

BRACKET - ELSQ

No. 2 THROUGH HOLES Ă˜4.5

WEIGHT 110 g

Complementary valves: pneumatic logic elements series EL

WEIGHT 30 g

3.33


UR

series

Complementary valves: flow regulators G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2

DESCRIPTION Flow regulators series "UR" are produced in three different versions, unidirectional (type "URG") - bi-directional (type "URF"), to have a precision in-line regulation; unidirectional (type “URE”), when it’s necessary a standard in-line regulation with reduced dimensions, and in the silenced exhaust version (type “URS”). In-line precision flow regulators type “URG”-”URF” are available in different adjustment scale in the size G 1/8 (see the flow charts).

3 IN-LINE PRECISION FLOW REGULATORS TYPE URG - URF TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size

MATERIALS 12 bar 0 ÷ +80° C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2

FLOW CHART AT 6 BAR - UR 8/2

Turns of the needle

Turns of the needle

FLOW CHART AT 6 BAR - UR 4/10

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Flow rate (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART AT 6 BAR - UR 8/5

Turns of the needle

3.34

Anodized aluminium alloy NBR rubber Aluminium (stainless steel for “URG” - “URF 8/1”) Brass Brass

Flow rate (Nl/min)

Flow rate (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART AT 6 BAR - UR 8/1

Body Seals Regulation needle Needle guide Nuts

Turns of the needle

Complementary valves: flow regulators series UR


UR

Complementary valves: flow regulators G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS URG - URF

Flow rate (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART AT 6 BAR - UR 2/25

series

3 Turns of the needle

Symbol

ACC-SIM5

ACC-SIM6

Nominal diameter (mm) 0,9 2 5 7,2 12 0,9 2 5 7,2 12

Port size

TYPE

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

URG8/1 URG8/2 URG8/5 URG4/10 URG2/25 URF8/1 URF8/2 URF8/5 URF4/10 URF2/25

A 6 8,5 13

B M12x0,75 M15x0,75 M25x1,5

C 4 5,5 7

CH 14 17 30

D 12,5 17 22

E 31 40 65

F 4,5 6,5 8,5

I 4,3 5,25 6,25

L 34 42 69

N 16 20 35

O 15,5 20 32,5

S 65 84,5 127

Weight (g) 60 120 540

G G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

H 5,5 6 12,5

IN LINE STANDARD FLOW REGULATORS TYPE URE DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS URE Symbol

A 10 6,8

B M12x0.75 M12x0.75

I 4,5 4,3

L 31 40

N 16 26

C 3 3.5

CH 14 15

O1 8,5 14,5

O2 17 13,5

D 11 11

E 25 35

F1 7

F2 5 5

* S Weight (g) G 55 55 G 1/8 58,7 101 G 1/2

H 4 5 TYPE URE8 URE2

* THE NO. 2 FIXING HOLES FOR THESE SIZES ARE ALIGNED (SEE DIMENSION “F2”)

SILENCED EXHAUST FLOW REGULATORS TYPE URS TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS - URS 12 bar 0 ÷ +80 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 3/8 - G 1/2

MATERIALS Body Silencer Symbol

Brass Sintered bronze B 15,5 17,5 20 22,5

C 6 8 9 10,5

CH 12 16 20 26

Weight (g) 15 25 40 70

G G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8 G 1/2

TYPE URS8/3 URS4/5 URS3/7 URS2/9

Complementary valves: flow regulators series UR

3.35


WB

series

Complementary valves: block valves G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2

DESCRIPTION Block valves series “WB” are produced in the 2/2 - G 1/8, G 1/4 and G 1/2 monostable pneumatic functions in both the uni- and bi-directional versions. The working of the block valve consists in avoiding unexpected depressurisation of the cylinder’s chamber due to lack of compressed air at the piloting port. For a correct functioning of the block valves we suggest to mount them directly on the cylinder.

3

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure Minimum piloting pressure (at 10 bar ) Working temperature Fluid Port size Pneumating piloting port size Nominal diameter Flow rate at 6 bar (with ΔP = 1 bar )

MATERIALS

0 ÷ 10 bar G 1/8 = 2,5 bar G 1/4 = 4 bar G 1/2 = 5 bar 0 ÷ +70°C (with dry air -10°C) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air

Control rod Body Spring End plug Seals Washer

Anodized aluminium alloy Anodized aluminium alloy Stainless steel Nick-plated brass NBR rubber Brass

G 1/8 - G 1/4 - G 1/2 G 1/8 G 1/8 = 7 mm G 1/4 = 7 mm G 1/2 = 12 mm G 1/8 = 700 Nl/min G 1/4 = 700 Nl/min G 1/2 = 1900 Nl/min

WB8U - WB8B - WB4U - WB4B - WB2U - WB2B

UNIDIRECTIONAL

Symbol

A

B

C

H

I

31 40 50 31 40 50

16 20 25 16 20 25

47 57 69 47 57 69

21,5 26,5 34,5 21,5 26,5 34,5

11,5 15 18 11,5 15 18

BIDIRECTIONAL

DESCRIPTION OF THE CONNECTION 1 = INPUT 2 = CYLINDER 12 = PILOTING

3.36

Complementary valves: block valves series WB

P

Weight (g)

G

TYPE

G 1/8

61 120 220 61 120 220

G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 1/2

WB8U WB4U WB2U WB8B WB4B WB2B


XVF

Complementary valves: amplifier valves

series

DESCRIPTION The type “XVF4” identifies a 3/2 N.C. amplifier valve that changes low pressure signals into pneumatic signals (1 ÷ 8 bar). Valve type “XVF5” is instead a 3/2 N.O. amplifier valve that changes negative pneumatic signals into pneumatic signals (1 ÷ 7 bar). Both of them are suitable to pilot directly the valves series “UDS” and “UK” with the same mounting than solenoid valves series “UL”. For single mounting there is the sub-base type “XVB” (see on page 2.8) while for manifold mounting there are the bases type “ULP” (see on page 2.7).

TECHNICAL DATA Operating pressure

XVF4: 1 ÷ 8 bar XVF5: 1 ÷ 7 bar 0 ÷ +60 °C (-10 °C with dry air)

Working temperature Fluid Piloting pressure

3

MATERIALS

Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air

XVF4: 500 mbar XVF5: -500 mbar Maximum frequency 50 Hz Flow rate 500 Nl/min at 6 bar Controlled leakage consumption 1,4 Nl/min at 7 bar Piloting hole M5

Control rod Body Springs Seals Washer Fixing screws

Aluminium Anodized aluminium alloy Phosphor bronze NBR rubber Aluminium White galvanized steel

SPARE PARTS DIMENSIONS XVF

SEALS KIT XVF

XVF/SG/4-5

FLOW CHART XVF

Flow rate (Nl/min)

No. 4 HOLES FOR CONTROLLED LEAKAGE

Operating pressure (bar)

3 PORT Symbol

Function

Controls

Response times at 6 bar (ms) Actuation

Weight (g)

TYPE

Return

Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar (Nl/min)

Actuation

Return

3/2 N.C.

Pneumatic

Mechanical spring

26,64

38,42

500

10,5

XVF4

3/2 N.O.

Vacuum

Mechanical spring

21,14

32,66

500

10,5

XVF5

Complementary valves: amplifier valves series XVF

3.37



Index chapter 4

AIR TREATMENT

Series UZ Filter UZF G 1/8 - G 1/4 ............................................................................................................................................................................. page 4.3 Pressure reducer UZRR G 1/8 - G 1/4....................................................................................................................................................... page 4.4 Filter reducer UZRRM /F G 1/8 - G 1/4 ..................................................................................................................................................... page 4.5 Lubricator UZL G 1/8 - G 1/4 .................................................................................................................................................................... page 4.6 Soft - start valve UZAP G 1/4 .................................................................................................................................................................... page 4.7 Shut - off valve UZVL G 1/4 ....................................................................................................................................................................... page 4.8 Accessories for series UZ .......................................................................................................................................................................... page 4.8 Filter reducer + lubricator G 1/8 - G 1/4 .................................................................................................................................................... page 4.9 Filter + reducer + lubricator G 1/8 - G 1/4 ................................................................................................................................................. page 4.10 Example of assembly UZ ........................................................................................................................................................................... page 4.11

Series EZ Filter EZF G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 .................................................................................................................................................................... page Pressure reducer EZRR G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 ............................................................................................................................................. page Filter reducer EZRR /F G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 ............................................................................................................................................... page Lubricator EZL G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 .......................................................................................................................................................... page Soft - start valve EZAP G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 ............................................................................................................................................... page Shut - off valve EZVL G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 ................................................................................................................................................. page Accessories for series EZ.......................................................................................................................................................................... page Filter reducer + lubricator G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 .......................................................................................................................................... page Filter + reducer + lubricator G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 ....................................................................................................................................... page Example of assembly EZ ........................................................................................................................................................................... page

4.12 4.14 4.16 4.18 4.20 4.22 4.22 4.23 4.24 4.25

Series MA Air treatment accessories: pressure gauges .............................................................................................................................................. page 4.26

Series PR Air treatment accessories: digital/analog pressure switch series PRDA ................................................................................................... page 4.27 Air treatment accessories: diaphragm pressure switch series PRC-PRA ................................................................................................. page 4.28 Air treatment accessories: contacts exchange pressure switch series PRCA .......................................................................................... page 4.29

Air treatment

4.1


Waircom air treatment: overview Before using the air as fluid for

Besides these leading articles,

the majority of the components

the f-r-l can be assembled with

mentioned in the previous chapters,

soft start and shut-off valves.

this must be properly treated;

Even the f-r-l units have their own

for this reason Waircom offers these

accessories (pressure gauges and

two series of f-r-l (filters, regulators

switches) that fulfil Waircom offer.

and lubricators) with a range of sizes that goes from G 1/8” to G 1”.

4.2

Air treatment


UZ

Air treatment: filter UZF G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION Filters series "UZF" are produced with connections G 1/8 and G 1/4; they are available with various degrees of filtration and with manual or semi-automatic condensate drainage system. The techno-polymer bowls can carry a metallic protection or being entirely metallic (without visualization of level).

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Void fraction Condensate drainage system Max. condensate capacity Type of mounting Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 20 µm standard, 5 µm and 40 µm on request Manual or semi-automatic 9 cm3 (do not exceed the level gauge) Modular, in-line and wall-mounting M4x50

MATERIALS Body Bowl

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZF TYPE UZF8 UZF4

FA G 1/8 G 1/4

WEIGHT (g) 190

Filtering element Seals Baffle

Aluminium alloy Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection or entirely metallic bowl (without visualization of level) on request. Sintered polyethylene NBR rubber Acetal resin

Pressure Pressure drop drop (bar) (bar)

FLOW CHART - UZF

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM: MANUAL

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

SEMI-AUTOMATIC

ORDER KEY UZF

SIZE

8

G 1/8

4

G 1/4

/20

20 µm

PM

Metallic protection

DEGREE OF FILTRATION

/5 /40

5 µm 40 µm

BOWL Transparent

Series Size Degree of filtration

TM

Metallic

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM Manual

/SS

Semi-automatic

Bowl Condensate drainage

SPARE PARTS Metallic protection Metallic bowl with manual drain Metallic bowl with semi-automatic drain Techno-polymer bowl with manual drain Techno-polymer bowl with semi-automatic drain Filter cartridge 5 µm Filter cartridge 20 µm Filter cartridge 40 µm

Air treatment: filter UZF

UZ/PM UZ/TM/R UZ/TM/R/SS UZF/SG/3 UZF/SG/3/SS UZF/SG/1 UZF/SG/2 UZF/SG/4

4.3

4


UZ

Air treatment: pressure reducer UZRR G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION Reducers series "UZRR" are produced in two different models: type UZRRH, fit for in-line or panel mounting and type UZRRM, fit for panel mounting or modular assembly (with filter and lubricator). Both the two models are available with different scales of regulation and with connections G 1/8 and G 1/4.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Adjusting range (bar) Type of mounting Wall clamping screws

MATERIALS

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZRRM TYPE FA UZRRM8 G 1/8 UZRRM4 G 1/4

WEIGHT (g) 195

Body Bowl

Aluminium alloy Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection or entirely metallic bowl (without visualization of level) on request Sintered porous bronze NBR rubber Acetal resin

Filtering element Seals Baffle

FLOW CHART - UZRR

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZRRH TYPE UZRRH8 UZRRH4

FA G 1/8 G 1/4

Pressure drop (bar)

4

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered, lubricated and unlubricated compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 G 1/8 0,2 ÷ 2 - 0,4 ÷ 4 - 0,8 ÷ 9 - 1,5 ÷ 12 Modular, in-line, wall and panel mounting M4x50

WEIGHT (g) 120

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

ORDER KEY UZRR

MOUNTING TAPE

H

For panel mounting

M

Modular

G 1/8

4

G 1/4

/5 /12

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

SIZE

8

ADJUSTING RAGE

/3 /7 Series Mounting type Size Adjusting range

4.4

0,2 ÷ 2 bar 0,8 ÷ 9 bar

1,5 ÷ 12 bar

P.S.: Reducers can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the series becomes UZR...

SPARE PARTS Relieving kit adjustment Non-relieving kit adjustment

Air treatment: pressure reducer UZRR

UZRR/SG/6 UZR/SG/5


UZ

Air treatment: filter reducer UZRRM /F G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION Filter reducer series "UZRRM /F", produced with connections G 1/8 and G 1/4, combine the characteristics of the filters and of the pressure reducers series "UZ", thus optimising the overall dimensions.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Void fraction Condensate drainage system Max. condensate capacity Adjusting range (bar) Type of mounting Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 G 1/8 20 µm standard, 5 µm and 40 µm on request Manual or semi-automatic 9 cm3 (do not exceed the level gauge) 0,2 ÷ 2 - 0,4 ÷ 4 - 0,8 ÷ 9 - 1,5 ÷ 12 Modular, in-line, wall and panel mounting M4x50

MATERIALS Body Bowl

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZRRM /F TYPE FA UZRRM8/F G 1/8 UZRRM4/F G 1/4

WEIGHT (g) 220

Filtering element Seals Baffle Closing plug Spring Knob Adjusting screw Diaphragm

Aluminium alloy Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection or entirely metallic bowl (without visualization of level) on request Sintered polyethylene NBR rubber Acetal resin Brass, NBR rubber Stainless steel Acetal resin Brass Brass, NBR rubber

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM: MANUAL

Pressure drop (bar)

FLOW CHART - UZRRM /F

SEMI-AUTOMATIC

SPARE PARTS See series “UZF” (on page 4.3) and “UZRR” (on page 4.4)

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

ORDER KEY UZRRM

SIZE

8

G 1/8

4

G 1/4

/5 /12

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

F20

20 µm

PM

Metallic protection

ADJUSTING RAGE

/3 /7

0,2 ÷ 2 bar 0,8 ÷ 9 bar

1,5 ÷ 12 bar

DEGREE OF FILTRATION Series Size Adjusting range Degree of filtration Bowl Condensate drainage system

F5 F40

5 µm 40 µm

BOWL Trasparent

TM

Metallic

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM Manual

/SS

Semi-automatic

P.S.: Filters reducers can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the series becomes UZRM...

Air treatment: filter reducer UZRRM /F

4.5

4


UZ

Air treatment: lubricator UZL G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION Lubricators series "UZL" are produced with connections G 1/8 and G 1/4; the techno-polymer bowls can carry a metallic protection or being entirely metallic (without visualization of level). For a correct lubrication it is advisable to set the drip rate in order to have a drop of oil (WAIRSOL class ISO22) every 300 - 500 Nl/min.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Bowl capacity Type of mounting Wall clamping screws Minimum striking flow rate

MATERIALS Body Bowl

Aluminium alloy Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection or entirely metallic bowl (without visualization of level) on request NBR rubber Acetal resin

Seals Conduits

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZL TYPE UZL8 UZL4

FA WEIGHT (g) G 1/8 175 G 1/4

FLOW CHART - UZL

Pressure drop (bar)

4

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 20 cm3 (do not exceed the level gauge) Modular, in-line and wall-mounting M4x50 20 Nl/min

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

ORDER KEY UZL

SIZE

8

G 1/8

4

G 1/4

M

Micro-oil mist

PM

Metallic protection

LUBRICATION Oil mist

BOWL Transparent

TM

Metallic

Series Size Lubrication Bowl

4.6

SPARE PARTS Metallic protection Metallic bowl Techno-polymer bowl Clear flow indicator

Air treatment: lubricator UZL

UZ/PM UZL/TM UZL/SG/3 UZL/SG/4


UZ

Air treatment: soft-start valve UZAP G 1/4

series

DESCRIPTION SOFT-START VALVE: soft-start valves series "UZAP" are produced with connection G 1/4 in the pneumatic and solenoid actuated versions. The working of the soft-start valve consists in feeding gradually air into the circuit with adjustable flow. When the pressure in the circuit reaches the 50 ÷ 60% of the upstream set pressure, the valve switches to full capacity, supplying the circuit with the maximum flow rate. AUTOMATIC SOFT-START VALVE: this valve, produced with connection G 1/4 in the 2/2 pneumatic version, even if cannot be modular assembled with the F-R-L of series “UZ”*, yet assures the same functionality of the soft-start valve above mentioned, and with the peculiarity of being “automatic”, not needing any kind of external pilot.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Piloting port size Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar Max. flow rate of the adjusting screw ot the filling time Type of mounting Wall clamping screws Piloting solenoid valve Coil Electric connector

10 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/4 G 1/8 500 Nl/min ( 750 Nl/min for type UZAP/A4) 300 Nl/min Modular*, in-line and wall-mounting M4x50 C/USCSVP - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.11 USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 USR 102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

4 MATERIALS Body Springs Pistons Seals

Anodized aluminium alloy Stainless steel Anodized aluminium alloy NBR rubber

ORDER KEY PILOT SYSTEM

UZAP

/R /A

/U

Pneumatic

Solenoid

Automatic

SIZE

4

G 1/4

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZAP/A4 Series Pilot system Size

WEIGHT 170 g

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZAP/R4

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZAP/U4

2 HOLES M5

2 HOLES M5

2 HOLES 4.3

2 HOLES 4.3

ADJUSTING SCREW OF THE PROGRESSIVE FILLING

ADJUSTING SCREW OF THE PROGRESSIVE FILLING

2 HOLES 4.2 2 HOLES 4.2

WEIGHT 365 g

Air treatment: soft-start valve UZAP

WEIGHT 400 g

4.7


UZ

series

Air treatment: shut - off valve UZVL G 1/4 and accessories

DESCRIPTION Shut - off valves series "UZVL" are produced with connection G 1/4 and they are fit to be locked in the exhaust position by means of a standard padlock.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar Type of mounting

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 1/4 1300 Nl/min Modular and in-line

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT UZVL/4 MATERIALS

4

Body Seals Slider

Anodized aluminium alloy NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy

2 HOLES 5.1

WEIGHT 150 g

ACCESSORIES MOUNTING BRACKET UZRHS

INTERMEDIATE AIR INTAKE UZPR4 (screws included)

2 HOLES 5.2

WEIGHT 20 g

ASSEMBLY SCREWS Assembly screws F+R+L Assembly screws FR+L Assembly screws F+L Assembly screws FR+L+AP - R+L+AP Assembly screws FR+AP - R+AP Assembly screws VL+F+R Assembly screws VL+FR - VL+R

4.8

WEIGHT 90 g

WALL CLAMPING SCREWS UZ/SVG UZ/SVG/1 UZ/SVG/2 UZAP/SVG UZAP/SVG/1 UZVL/SVG UZVL/SVG/1

Clamping screws F-FR-R-L-AP

Air treatment: shut - off valve UZVL and accessories

UZ/SVG/P


UZ

Air treatment: filter reducer + lubricator G 1/8 - G 1/4

series

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 G 1/8 260 Nl/min M4x50

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT FR+L

4

WEIGHT 415 g

ORDER KEY UZRRM

SIZE

8

G 1/8

4

G 1/4

/5 /12

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

F20

20 µm

LM

Micro-oil mist

/PM

Metallic protection

ADJUSTING RANGE

/3 /7

0,2 ÷ 2 bar 0,8 ÷ 9 bar

1,5 ÷ 12 bar

DEGREE OF FILTRATION Series Size Adjusting range Degree of filtration Lubrication Bowl Condensate drainage system

F5 F40

5 µm 40 µm

LUBRICATION

L

Oil mist (standard)

BOWL Transparent

/TM

Metallic

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM Manual

/SS

Semi-automatic

P.S.: Filters reducers + lubricators can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the series becomes UZRM...

Air treatment: filter reducer + lubricator series UZ

4.9


UZ

series

Air treatment: filter + reducer + lubricator G 1/8 - G 1/4

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 1/8 - G 1/4 G 1/8 220 Nl/min M4x50

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT F+R+L

4

WEIGHT 610 g

ORDER KEY UZF

SIZE

8

G 1/8

4

G 1/4

/20

20 µm

DEGREE OF FILTRATION

/5 /40

5 µm 40 µm

ADJUSTING RANGE Series Size Adjusting range Degree of filtration Lubrication Bowl Condensate drainage system

RR3 0,2 ÷ 2 bar RR7 0,8 ÷ 9 bar

RR5 0,4 ÷ 4 bar RR12 1,5 ÷ 12 bar

LUBRICATION

L

Oil mist (standard)

LM

Micro-oil mist

/PM

Metallic protection

BOWL Trasparente

/TM

Metallica

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM Manual

/SS

Semi-automatic

P.S.: Filters + reducers + lubricators can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the adjusting range becomes “R” (rather than “RR”)

4.10

Air treatment: filter + reducer + lubricator series UZ


UZ

Air treatment: example of assembly

series

SHUT-OFF VALVE + FILTER REDUCER + LUBRICATOR + SOFT-START VALVE

4

SHUT-OFF VALVE + FILTER + REDUCER + LUBRICATOR + SOFT-START VALVE

Air treatment: example of assembly series UZ

4.11


EZ

Air treatment: filter EZF G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series

DESCRIPTION Filters series "EZF" are produced with connections G 3/8, G 1/2 and G 1; they are available with various degrees of filtration and with manual, semi-automatic or automatic condensate drainage system (except the size G 3/8). The techno-polymer bowls have a metallic protection as standard for the sizes G 1/2 and G 1, and made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for the size G 3/8.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Void fraction

Max. condensate capacity

Type of mounting Wall clamping screws

Filtering element Seals Baffle

FLOW CHART - EZF G 1/2

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART - EZF G 1

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

4.12

Aluminium alloy G 3/8: Transparent techno-polymer (protection made of glass stiffened polyamide on request) G 1/2 - G 1: Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection as standard G 3/8 - G 1/2: Sintered polyethylene G 1: Sintered porus bronze NBR rubber Acetal resin

Pressure drop (bar)

Pressure drop (bar)

FLOW CHART - EZF G 3/8

MATERIALS Body Bowl

Pressure drop (bar)

4

Condensate drainage system

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 3/8 - G 1/2: 20 µm standard; 5 µm or 40 µm on request G 1: 40 µm standard G 3/8: Manual or semi-automatic G 1/2 - G 1: Manual, semi-automatic or automatic G 3/8 = 23 cm3 G 1/2 = 58 cm3 G 1 = 105 cm3 (do not exceed the level gauge) Modular, in-line and wall-mounting G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 G 1: M6x90

Air treatment: filter EZF


EZ

EZF G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series ORDER KEY SIZE

EZF

3 1

G 3/8

2

G 1/2

/20

20 µm

PM

Protection**

G1

DEGREE OF FILTRATION

/5 /40

5 µm* 40 µm

BOWL Transparent

Series Size

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM

Degree of filtration

/SM Manual /SA Automatic***

Bowl Condensate drainage system

/SS

Semi-automatic

* Available only for sizes 3 and 2 ** Metallic as standard for sizes 2 and 1, made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for size 3 *** Available only for sizes 2 and 1

SPARE PARTS DESCRIPTION Bowl protection Techno-polymer bowl with manual drainage system* Techno-polymer bowl with semi-automatic drainage system* Techno-polymer bowl with automatic drainage system* Filter cartridge 5 µm Filter cartridge 20 µm Filter cartridge 40 µm

SIZE 2 EZT/F2/PM/SM EZT/F2/PM/SS EZT/F2/PM/SA EZ2/5 EZ2/20 EZ2/40

3 EZ3/PM EZT/F3/SM EZT/F3/SS EZ3/5 EZ3/20 EZ3/40

1 EZ1/PM EZT/F1/SM EZT/F1/SS EZT/F1/SA EZ1/20 EZ1/40

* The bowls size 2 are supplied with metallic protection as standard

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZF

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM: MANUAL - SEMI-AUTOMATIC - AUTOMATIC

SIZE

DA

DB

DC

FA

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

HF

LA

LB

LC

3 2 1

4,5 5,5 6,6

G 1/8 Ø 4,3 G 1/8

Ø 6,5 Ø 6,5

G 3/8 G 1/2 G1

142 159 218

21 26 31

52 55 76

6 8,5 9

146 170 222

168 213

55 65 85

50 65 82

40 49 60

Air treatment: filter EZF

WEIGHT (g) 390 415 1815

4.13

4


EZ

series

Air treatment: pressure reducer EZRR G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

DESCRIPTION Pressure reducers series "EZRR" are produced with connections G 3/8, G 1/2 and G 1; they are available with different scales of regulation and can be supplied without the relieving seal on request.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Adjusting range (bar) Type of mounting Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered, lubricated and unlubricated compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G1 G 1/8 0,2 ÷ 2 - 0,4 ÷ 4 - 0,8 ÷ 8 Modular, in-line, wall and panel mounting G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 G 1: M6x90

MATERIALS

4

Body Closing plug Spring Knob Adjusting screw Diaphragm

FLOW CHART - EZRR G 1/2

Pressure drop (bar)

Pressure drop (bar)

FLOW CHART - EZRR G 3/8

Aluminium alloy Brass, NBR rubber Stainless steel Acetal resin Brass Brass, friction

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

Pressure drop (bar)

FLOW CHART - EZRR G 1

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

4.14

Air treatment: pressure reducer EZRR


EZ

EZRR G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series ORDER KEY SIZE

EZRR

3 1

G 3/8

2

G 1/2

/5

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

G1

ADJUSTING RANGE

/3 /7

0,2 ÷ 2 bar 0,8 ÷ 8 bar

P.S.: Reducers can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the series becomes “EZR...”

Series

SPARE PARTS

Size

Relieving kit adjustment size 3 Relieving kit adjustment size 2 Relieving kit adjustment size 1

Adjusting range

EZRR3/SG/6 EZRR2/SG/6 EZRR1/SG/6

4

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZRR

SIZE

DA

FA

FB

FC

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

HF

LA

LB

LC

3 2 1

4,5 5,5 6,6

G 3/8 G 1/2 G1

M30x1,5 M40x1,5 -

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

99 127 194,5

21 26 31

48 55 76

6 8,5 9

4 7 -

6 10,5 14

55 65 85

50 65 82

40 49 60

Air treatment: pressure reducer EZRR

WEIGHT (g) 450 465 2385

4.15


EZ

series

Air treatment: filter reducer EZRR /F G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

DESCRIPTION Filters reducers series "EZRR/F", produced with connections G 3/8, G 1/2 and G 1, combine the characteristics of the filters and of the pressure reducers series "EZ", thus optimizing the overall dimensions.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Void fraction

MATERIALS Body Bowl

Aluminium alloy G 3/8: Transparent techno-polymer (protection made of glass stiffened polyamide on request) G 1/2 - G 1: Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection as standard G 3/8 - G 1/2: Sintered polyethylene G 1: Sintered porus bronze NBR rubber Acetal resin Brass, NBR rubber Stainless steel Acetal resin Brass Brass, friction

Filtering element Seals Baffle Closing plug Spring Knob Adjusting screw Diaphragm

Pressure drop (bar)

FLOW CHART - EZRR /F G 3/8

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART - EZRR /F G 1/2

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

4.16

FLOW CHART - EZRR /F G 1

Pressure drop (bar)

Pressure drop (bar)

4

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 1/8 G 3/8 - G 1/2: 20 µm standard, 5 µm and 40 µm on request G 1: 40 µm standard Condensate drainage G 3/8: Manual or semi-automatic system G 1/2 - G 1: Manual, semi-automatic or automatic Max. condensate capacity G 3/8 = 23 cm3 G 1/2 = 58 cm3 G 1 = 105 cm3 (do not exceed the level gauge) Adjusting range (bar) 0,2 ÷ 2 - 0,4 ÷ 4 - 0,8 ÷ 8 Type of mounting Modular, in-line, wall and panel mounting Wall clamping screws G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 G 1: M6x90

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

Air treatment: filter reducer EZRR /F


EZ

EZRR G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series ORDER KEY SIZE

EZRR

3 1

G 3/8

2

G 1/2

/5

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

F20

20 µm

PM

Protection**

G1

ADJUSTING RANGE

/3 /7

0,2 ÷ 2 bar 0,8 ÷ 8 bar

DEGREE OF FILTRATION Size

F5 F40

Adjusting range

BOWL

Series

5 µm* 40 µm

Trasparent

Degree of filtation Bowl

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM

Condensate drainage system

/SM Manuale /SA Automatic***

/SS

4

Semi-automatic

* Available only for sizes 3 and 2 ** Metallic as standard for sizes 2 and 1, made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for size 3 *** Available only for sizes 2 and 1 P.S.: Filters reducers can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the series becomes “EZR...”

SPARE PARTS See series “EZF” (on page 4.13) and “EZRR” (on page 4.15)

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZRR /F

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM: MANUAL - SEMI-AUTOMATIC - AUTOMATIC

SIZE 3 2 1

DA 4,5 5,5 6,6

DB G 1/8 Ø 4,3 G 1/8

DC Ø 6,5 Ø 6,5

FA G 3/8 G 1/2 G1

FB M30x1,5 M40x1,5 -

FC G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/8

HA 193 231 337

HB 21 26 31

HC 52 55 76

SIZE

HE

HF

HG

HH

HI

LA

LB

LC

3 2 1

4 7 -

6 10,5 14

99 127 194,5

197 242 341

240 332

55 65 85

50 65 82

40 42 60

WEIGHT (g) 550 610 2790

Air treatment: filter reducer EZRR /F

HD 6 8,5 9

4.17


EZ

Air treatment: lubricator EZL G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series

DESCRIPTION Lubricators series "EZL" are produced with connections G 3/8, G 1/2 and G 1; the techno-polymer bowls have a metallic protection as standard for the sizes G 1/2 and G 1, and made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for the size G 3/8. For a correct lubrication it is advisable to set the drip rate in order to have a drop (WAIRSOL class ISO22) every 300 - 500 Nl/min. (oil mist lubrication).

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Bowl capacity

Aluminium alloy G 3/8: Transparent techno-polymer (protection made of glass stiffened polyamide on request) G 1/2 - G 1: Transparent techno-polymer with metallic protection as standard NBR rubber Acetal resin

Seals Conduits

FLOW CHART - EZL G 1/2

Pressure drop (bar)

Pressure drop (bar)

FLOW CHART - EZL G 3/8

MATERIALS Body Bowl

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

FLOW CHART - EZL G 1

Pressure drop (bar)

4

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 3/8 = 32 cm3 G 1/2 = 76 cm3 G 1 = 160 cm3 (do not exceed the level gauge) Type of mounting Modular, in-line and wall-mounting Wall clamping screws G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 G 1: M6x90 Minimum striking flow rate G 3/8 = 25 Nl/min G 1/2 = 25 Nl/min G 1 = 50 Nl/min

Flow rate at 8 bar (Nl/min)

4.18

Air treatment: lubricator EZL


EZ

EZL G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series ORDER KEY SIZE

EZL

3 1

G 3/8

2

G 1/2

PM

Protection*

G1

BOWL Transparent

LEVEL GAUGE Series Size

/CA

Open electric contact when oil is present with 2 wires cable 0,5 m length

/CC

Closed electric contact when oil is present with 2 wires cable 0,5 m length

* Metallic as standard for sizes 2 and 1, made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for size 3 P.S.: Level gauge, in both the open and closed electric contact, is fed with a voltage range from 6 V to 50 V

Bowl Level gauge

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZL

4

SPARE PARTS Lubricator bowl size 3 Lubricator bowl size 2* Lubricator bowl size 1 Lubricator bowl for level gauge size 3 Lubricator bowl for level gauge size 2* Lubricator bowl for level gauge size 1 Protection made of glass stiffened nylon size 3 Metallic protection size 1 Lubricator clear cover size 3 Lubricator clear cover size 2 Lubricator clear cover size 1 Level gauge with open electric contact size 3 Level gauge with open electric contact size 2* Level gauge with open electric contact size 1

EZT/L3 EZT/L2/PM EZT/L1 EZT/L3/SLC EZT/L2/PM/SLC EZT/L1/SLC EZ3/PM EZ1/PM EZL3/C EZL2/C EZL1/C EZT/L3/SLA EZT/L2/PM/SLA EZT/L1/SLA

* Bowls size 2 are supplied with the metallic protection as standard

SIZE

DA

FA

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

LA

LB

LC

3 2 1

4,5 5,5 6,6

G 3/8 G 1/2 G1

157,5 186,7 243,5

21 26 31

52 55 76

6 8,5 9

121 149,7 201

55 65 85

50 65 82

40 49 60

Air treatment: lubricator EZL

WEIGHT (g) 370 400 1780

4.19


EZ

series

Air treatment: soft-start valve EZAP G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

DESCRIPTION Soft - start valves series "EZAP" are produced with connections G 3/8, G 1/2 and G 1 in the pneumatic and solenoid actuated versions. The working of the soft-start valves consists in feeding gradually air into the circuit with adjustable flow. When the pressure in the circuit reaches the 50 ÷ 60% of the upstream set pressure, the valve switches to full capacity, supplying the circuit with the maximum flow rate.

TECHNICAL DATA

4

Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar Max. flow rate of the adjusting screw of the filling time Type of mounting Wall clamping screws Piloting solenoid valve Coil Electric connector

10 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10°C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 3/8 = 1000 Nl/min G 1/2 = 1650 Nl/min G 1 = 4000 Nl/min G 3/8 = 400 Nl/min G 1/2 = 500 Nl/min G 1 = 500 Nl/min Modular, in-line and wall-mounting G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 M6x90 G 1: C/USCSVP - see chapter Direct acting solenoid valves on page 2.11 USB - see chapter Coils on page 2.14 USR 102/N9 - see chapter Connectors on page 2.15

MATERIALS Body Springs Pistons Seals

Aluminium alloy Stainless steel Aluminium alloy NBR rubber

ORDER KEY EZAP

PILOT SYSTEM

/R

Pneumatic

/U

Solenoid

SIZE

3 1

G 3/8 G1

Series Pilot system Size

4.20

Air treatment: soft-start valve EZAP

2

G 1/2


EZ

EZAP G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZAP /R

2 HOLES DB

2 HOLES FC

2 HOLES FD

ADJUSTING SCREW OF THE PROGRESSIVE FILLING

2 HOLES DA

SIZE

DA

DB

FA

FB

FC

FD

FE

HA

HB

HC

3 2

4,5 5,5

5,1 6,5

G 3/8 G 1/2

G 1/8 G 3/8

M6

M6 M6

G 1/8 G 1/8

68 82,5

28,8 35

56,5 71

SIZE

HD

HE

LA

LB

LC

LD

LE

LF

3 2

28,8 27,5

15

70 85

50 65

51,5 62

35 46

20 23,5

12 17

WEIGHT (g) 505 985

4

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZAP /U

2 HOLES DB

2 HOLES FC

2 HOLES FD

ADJUSTING SCREW OF THE PROGRESSIVE FILLING

2 HOLES DA

SIZE

DA

DB

FA

FB

FC

FD

HA

HB

HC

HD

3 2

4,5 5,5

5,1 6,5

G 3/8 G 1/2

G 1/8 G 3/8

M6

M6 M6

122,5 137

28,8 35

56,5 71

28,8 27,5

SIZE

HE

HF

LA

LB

LC

LD

LE

LF

LG

3 2

15

115,5 126

70 85

50 65

51,5 62

35 46

20 23,5

12 17

79,5 87

WEIGHT (g) 540 1020

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZAP /R1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZAP /U1

2 HOLES M5

2 HOLES Ø6

2 HOLES M5

2 HOLES Ø6

ADJUSTING SCREW OF THE PROGRESSIVE FILLING ADJUSTING SCREW OF THE PROGRESSIVE FILLING

2 HOLES Ø6.5

2 HOLES Ø6.5

WEIGHT 2450 g

Air treatment: soft-start valve EZAP

WEIGHT 2550 g

4.21


EZ

Air treatment: shut-off valve EZVL G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 and accessories

series

DESCRIPTION Shut - off valves series "EZVL" are produced with connections G 3/8, G 1/2 and G 1 and they are fit to be locked in the exhaust position by means of a standard padlock.

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Flow rate at 6 bar P=1 bar

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Filtered, lubricated and unlubricated compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 3/8 = 2400 Nl/min G 1/2 = 3150 Nl/min G 1/2 = 4250 Nl/min Modular and in-line

Type of mounting

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS EZVL

MATERIALS

4

Body Seals Slider

Anodized aluminium alloy NBR rubber Anodized aluminium alloy

2 HOLES DA

TYPE

DA

DB

FA

HA

HB

HC

HD

HE

HF

LA

LB

LC

LD

EZVL/3 EZVL/2 EZVL/1

5,5 6,5 6,1

4,2 4,2 4,2

G 3/8 G 1/2 G1

50 50 60

25 28 30

15 -

36 32 34

15 15 15

21 20 22

50 65 80

39 43 60

35 46 60

25 25 25

WEIGHT (g) 260 370 700

ACCESSORIES MOUNTING BRACKET G 3/8 - UZRHS (see drawing on page 4.8)

INTERMEDIATE AIR INTAKE G 3/8 - EZPA3/3 (screws included)

MOUNTING BRACKET G 1/2 - EZS2/3

2 HOLES 5.5

WEIGHT 110 g

INTERMEDIATE AIR INTAKE G 1/2 - EZPA2/3

(screws included)

WEIGHT 105 g

ASSEMBLY SCREWS DESCRIPTION Assembly screws F+R+L Assembly screws FR+L Assembly screws F+L Assembly screws FR+L+AP - R+L+AP Assembly screws FR+AP - R+AP Assembly screws VL+F+R Assembly screws VL+FR - VL+R

3 EZ3/SVG EZ3/SVG/1 EZ3/SVG/2 EZAP3/SVG EZAP3/SVG/1 EZVL3/SVG EZVL3/SVG/1

SIZE 2 EZ2/SVG

EZAP2/SVG EZAP2/SVG/1 EZVL2/SVG EZVL2/SVG/1

1 EZ1/SVG EZ1/SVG/1 EZ1/SVG/2 EZAP1/SVG EZAP1/SVG/1 EZVL1/SVG EZVL1/SVG/1

SIZE 2 EZ/SVG/P2

1 EZ/SVG/P1

EZ2/SVG/1

2 HOLES 6.5

WEIGHT 160 g

INTERMEDIATE AIR INTAKE G 1 - EZPA1/3 (screws included)

WALL CLAMPING SCREWS DESCRIPTION Clamping screws F-FR-R-L-AP

3 EZ/SVG/P3

2 HOLES 6.5

4.22

Air treatment: shut-off valve EZVL and accessories

WEIGHT 420 g


EZ

Air treatment: filter reducer + lubricator G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar

Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 1/8 G 3/8 = 680 Nl/min G 1/2 = 1200 Nl/min G 1/2 = 2300 Nl/min G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 G 1: M6x90 1

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS FR+L

4

SIZE

HA

HB

LA

LB

3 2 1

193 231 337

52 55 76

107 130 167

50 65 82

WEIGHT (g) 940 1065 4695

ORDER KEY EZRR

SIZE

3 1

G 3/8

2

G 1/2

/5

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

F20

20 µm

LCA

Oil mist, N.O. electric contact

/PM

Protection**

G1

ADJUSTING RANGE

/3 /7

0,2 ÷ 2 bar 0,8 ÷ 8 bar

DEGREE OF FILTRATION Series Size Adjusting range Degree of filtration Lubrication Bowl Condensate drainage system

F5 F40

5 µm* 40 µm

LUBRICATION

L Oil mist (standard) LCC Oil mist, N.C. electric contact BOWL Transparent

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM

/SM Manual /SA Automatic***

/SS

Semi-automatic

*** Available only for sizes 3 and 2 *** Metallic as standard for sizes 2 and 1, made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for size 3 *** Available only for sizes 2 and 1 P.S.: Filters reducers + lubricators can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the series becomes “EZR...”

Air treatment: filter reducer + lubricator

4.23


EZ

Air treatment: filter + reducer + lubricator G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1

series

TECHNICAL DATA Maximum pressure Working temperature Fluid Port size Pressure gauge port size Flow rate at 6 bar P = 1 bar Wall clamping screws

16 bar 0 ÷ +50 °C (–10 °C with dry air) Compressed air G 3/8 - G 1/2 - G 1 G 1/8 G 3/8 = 680 Nl/min G 1/2 = 1200 Nl/min G 1/2 = 2300 Nl/min G 3/8: M4x60 G 1/2: M5x70 G 1: M6x90

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS F+R+L

4

SIZE

HA

HB

LA

LB

3 2 1

193 231 337

52 55 76

159 195 249

50 65 82

WEIGHT (g) 1260 1345 6080

ORDER KEY EZF

SIZE

3 1

G 3/8

2

G 1/2

/20

20 µm

RR5

0,4 ÷ 4 bar

LCA

Oil mist, N.O. electric contact

/PM

Protection**

G1

DEGREE OF FILTRATION

/5 /40

5 µm* 40 µm

ADJUSTING RANGE Series Size Degree of filtration Adjusting range Lubrication Bowl Condensate drainage system

RR3 0,2 ÷ 2 bar RR7 0,8 ÷ 8 bar LUBRICATION

L Oil mist (standard) LCC Oil mist, N.C. electric contact BOWL Transparent

CONDENSATE DRAINAGE SYSTEM

/SM Manual /SA Automatic***

/SS

Semi-automatic

*** Available only for sizes 3 and 2 *** Metallic as standard for sizes 2 and 1, made of glass stiffened polyamide on request for size 3 *** Available only for sizes 2 and 1 P.S.: Filters + reducers + lubricators can be supplied without the relieving seal on request; the adjusting range becomes “R” (rather than “RR”)

4.24

Air treatment: filter + reducer + lubricator


EZ

Air treatment: example of assembly

series

SHUT-OFF VALVE + FILTER REDUCER + LUBRICATOR + SOFT-START VALVE

4

SHUT-OFF VALVE + FILTER + REDUCER + LUBRICATOR + SOFT-START VALVE

Air treatment: example of assembly series EZ

4.25


MA

Air treatment accessories: pressure gauges Ø 40 - 50 - 63 - 100

series

DESCRIPTION Pressure gauges allow sensing the pressure in the pneumatic circuits. They are suitable to be applied directly on the pressure regulator or for panel mounting and they are avalailable in the versions: axial (MA), radial (MR), with flange (MF) and with bracket (MP), in the bore 40 - 50 - 63 - 100.

TECHNICAL DATA

4

Operating pressure Working temperature Fluid Accuracy Dial Port size Fixing

0 ÷ 1 bar - 0 ÷ 4 bar - 0 ÷ 6 bar - 0 ÷ 12 bar 0 ÷ +70 °C (-20 °C with dry air) Filtered, unlubricated or continuous lubricated compressed air Cl. 1.6 (DIN 16005 EN 837-1) Ø 40 - 50 - 63 - 100 G 1/8 - G 1/4 Type MA - Direct axial mounting Type MR - Direct radial mounting Type MF - Panel mounting with flange Type MP - Panel mounting with bracket

AXIAL GAUGES TYPE MA

G G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8

A 40 52 63 100

C Ch 24 12 28 14 29,5 14 36 17

E 40 52 54 65

G G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8

4.26

A 40,5 45 46,5 61 D 61 74,5 84,7 132

B 25,5 29 30 30

0 ÷ 1 bar MA 4/1 MA 5/1 MA 6/1 -

0 ÷ 1 bar MF 4/1 MF 5/1 MF 6/1 -

C 4 4 5,5 5

Type MA - Black ABS Type MR - Black ABS Type MF - Black painted steel Type MP - Galvanized steel Kostil Brass Copper Brass White ABS

Gauge crystal Port Spring Movement Dial

RADIAL GAUGES TYPE MR

TYPE 0 ÷ 4 bar 0 ÷ 6 bar MA 4/4 MA 4/6 MA 5/4 MA 5/6 MA 6/4 MA 6/6 -

0 ÷ 12 bar MA 4/12 MA 5/12 MA 6/12 MA 10/12

AXIAL GAUGES WITH FLANGE TYPE MF

G G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4 G 3/8

MATERIALS Case

Ch 11 14 14 17

D 61 74,5 84,7 132

TYPE 0 ÷ 4 bar 0 ÷ 6 bar MF 4/4 MF 4/6 MF 5/4 MF 5/6 MF 6/4 MF 6/6 -

E 51 60 75 118

WEIGHT (g) 48 75 90 230

G A G 1/8 40 G 1/8 51 G 1/4 63 G 3/8 100

C Ch 24 12 28 14 29,5 14 36 17

E 37 48 54 78

0 ÷ 1 bar MR 4/1 MR 5/1 MR 6/1 -

TYPE 0 ÷ 4 bar 0 ÷ 6 bar MR 4/4 MR 4/6 MR 5/4 MR 5/6 MR 6/4 MR 6/6 -

0 ÷ 12 bar MR 4/12 MR 5/12 MR 6/12 MR 10/12

AXIAL GAUGES WITH BRACKET TYPE MP

F 40,5 52,5 63,7 100,5

0 ÷ 12 bar MF 4/12 MF 5/12 MF 6/12 MF 10/12

H 3,6 3,6 3,6 6 WEIGHT (g) 82 120 150 250

G

A

B

C

Ch

D

E

F

G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4

43 46 48

21 23 23

5 6 6

12 14 14

43 55,5 63,8

28 35 43

39 49 59

G G 1/8 G 1/8 G 1/4

D 43 55,5 63,8

0 ÷ 1 bar MP 4/1 MP 5/1 MP 6/1

TYPE 0 ÷ 4 bar MP 4/4 MP 5/4 MP 6/4

Air treatment accessories: pressure gauges series MA

0 ÷ 6 bar MP 4/6 MP 5/6 MP 6/6

0 ÷ 12 bar MP 4/12 MP 5/12 MP 6/12

WEIGHT (g) 82 120 150

WEIGHT (g) 42 68 84 230


PR

Air treatment accessories: pressure switches

series

DIGITAL/ANALOG PRESSURE SWITCH SERIES PRDA This series of switches has been expressly designed for the pressure detection of a wide range of fluids with elevate accuracy and resolution. This series has both digital and/or analog outputs and an integrated display with a frontal interface including three buttons to programme different functions (all described in the documentation that goes with the item) among which: - setting the unit of measurement of the pressure; - managing the outputs No.1 and No.2, depending on the set pressures. This pressure switch, thanks to the very compact dimensions and to the 3 1⁄2 digit led display, is a very versatile item and suitable for the majority of the applications with not corrosive and incombustible gases, and with air. It is supplied completed with front protection cover and panel mounting system type SFPR.

TECHNICAL DATA Working temperature Operating/setting pressure Power supply voltage Fluid Max. load current Average current consumption Protection class Response time Display accuracy Analog output Linearity analog output Display resolution Switch output Unit of measurement Hysteresis

0 ÷ +50 °C -1 ÷ 10 bar (0 ÷ 10 bar recommended) 12 ÷ 24 V DC, ripple (P-P) 10% or less air; not corrosive and incombustible gases 80 mA 55 mA IP 50 < 2.5 ms < ± 2% F.S. ± 1 digit with ambient temperature of 25 ± 3 °C 1 ÷ 5 V < ± 2.5% ± 1% F.S. 3 1⁄2 digit 7 segments LED (sampling frequency: 5 Hz) PNP; (NPN on request) kPa, MPa, Bar, Psi Manually adjustable between the 1 to 10% of the rated pressure, or automatically arranged approximately to the 3% F.S.

MATERIALS Parts in contact with measured fluid Lead wire Electric connections

Carbon steel 5-conductors oil-proof cable Brown: DC + Blue: DC Black: OUT 1 White: OUT 2 Orange: Analog output

INTERNAL CIRCUIT AND WIRING PNP

MAIN CIRCUIT

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHT PRDA

4

Orange Black White Blue

WEIGHT 135 g

PROTECTION COVER AND PANEL MOUNTING SYSTEM SFPR*

Brown Analog Output

TOTAL DIMENSIONS WITH SFPR

FRONTAL INTERFACE PRDA

* SUPPLIED AS STANDARD WITH PRESSURE SWITCHES SERIES PRDA

3½ DIGIT LED

RED LED

Displays: current pressure current mode error mode

Displays OUT 2 switch output status Lights up when ON

GREEN LED

SET BUTTON

Displays OUT 1 switch output status Lights up when ON

Use this button to change the mode or set value

UP BUTTON

DOWN BUTTON

Use this button to change the mode or set value

Use this button to change the mode or set value

Air treatment accessories: pressure switches series PR

4.27


PR

Air treatment accessories: pressure switches

series

FIXING BRACKETS STPR (pair)

4

DIAPHRAGM PRESSURE SWITCH SERIES PRC-PRA TECHNICAL DATA Max. switched voltage Max. switched current Max. fluid temperature Adjusting range Static overpressure Tolerance at 20°C Max. number of insertions

MATERIALS Body Diaphragm Fixed contact Moving contact

48 V AC - DC 0,5 A 80 ÷ 120 °C 1 ÷ 10 bar 80 bar 0,5 200 per minute

PRC - PRA

CONNECTOR (protection class IP54) - CN/PR54

WEIGHT 70 g

Symbol N.C.

Symbol N.O.

4.28

Brass FPM (Viton®) Silver Phosphorous bronze with silver contact

CONNECTOR (protection class IP65) - CN/PR65

WEIGHT 15 g

Size

L1

L2

TYPE

G 1/8 G 1/4

10 12

51 53

PRC8 PRC4

Size

L1

L2

TYPE

G 1/8 G 1/4

10 12

51 53

PRA8 PRA4

Air treatment accessories: pressure switches series PR

WEIGHT 15 g


PR

Air treatment accessories: pressure switches

series

CONTACTS EXCHANGE PRESSURE SWITCH SERIES PRCA PRCA

TECHNICAL DATA Max. switched voltage Max. switched current Max. fluid temperature Protection class Adjusting range Static overpressure Tolerance at 20°C Differential Max. number of insertion Connector (included)

250 V AC - DC 5A 100 °C IP 65 0,5 ÷ 10 bar 150 bar 0,2 15 - 30% of setting value 200 per minute ULR4P

MATERIALS Body Electric box Diaphragm

Passivated steel Anodized aluminium alloy FPM (Viton®)

4 WEIGHT 180 g

Symbol N.C. / N.O.

Size

L1

L2

L3

TYPE*

G 1/8 G 1/4

10 12

56 53

74 76

PRCA8 PRCA4

* These switches can rotate of 360°

Air treatment accessories: pressure switches series PR

4.29



FITTINGS AND TUBES

Index chapter 5 Series RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings ................................................................................................................................................................. page

5.3

Series RO Push-in brass fittings ................................................................................................................................................................................. page 5.12

Series RS Standard fittings ......................................................................................................................................................................................... page 5.25

Series RC Push-on brass fittings ................................................................................................................................................................................ page 5.36

Series VS Mini ball valves ........................................................................................................................................................................................... page 5.46

Silencers............................................................................................................................................................................................ page

5.48

Series T Polyurethane tubes (PU 98 ShA)................................................................................................................................................................ page 5.49 Polyamide tubes (PA12) ............................................................................................................................................................................. page 5.50 Polyethylene tubes (LDPE) ......................................................................................................................................................................... page 5.51

Fittings and tubes

5.1


Waircom tubes & ďŹ ttings: overview Tubes and ďŹ ttings: these were

Similarly extensive is the Waircom

missing to supply an actual complete

offer for the tubes, referring to both

service to all our customers. Now

the sizes and the materials used,

they are here too and they are able

in order to covering the widest

to satisfy the different needs of a

possible pneumatic applications.

more and more dynamic market. So, together with the push-in ďŹ ttings (made in both techno-polymer or brass), Waircom offers the push-on and the standard ones, the mini-ball valves and a family of silencers.

5.2

Fittings


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

series

TECHNICAL DATA Body material Thread Seal Clamp Size Fluid Working temperature Operating pressure Negative pressure Max. pressure Recommended tubes materials

Acetal resin Metric and parallel NBR rubber Stainless steel M5 ÷ G 1/2 Air, vacuum 0 ÷ 60 °C 0 - 10 bar -750 mmHg (-1 bar) 15 bar Polyamide and Polyurethane

5

STRAIGHT MALE TYPE RT-DM-4/M5 RT-DM-6/M5 RT-DM-4/01 RT-DM-4/02 RT-DM-6/01 RT-DM-6/02 RT-DM-8/01 RT-DM-8/02 RT-DM-8/03 RT-DM-8/04 RT-DM-10/02 RT-DM-10/03 RT-DM-10/04 RT-DM-12/03 RT-DM-12/04 RT-DM-14/03 RT-DM-16/04

L 19,3 20,7 19,5 18,1 20,7 22,1 25,1 23,5 21,1 25,1 29,3 26,8 25,1 29,6 30,6 37,5 40

A 14 15 14,6 14,6 15,2 15,2 16,2 16,2 16,2 16,2 18,7 18,7 18,7 21,7 21,7 24,5 24,5

B 4 4 5,5 7,5 5,5 7,5 5,5 7,5 8,5 11 7,5 8,5 11 8,5 11 8,5 11

ØD 4 6 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12 16 16

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/4 M5 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

CH 10 12 14 17 14 17 14 17 20 24 17 20 24 21 24 24 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

A 14,6 15,2 15,2 16,2 16,2 16,2 18,7 18,7 21,7 21,7

B 7 7 10 7 10 11 10 11 11 13

ØD 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12

G G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 10 12 12 14 14 14 17 17 20 20

CH 14 14 17 14 17 21 17 21 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

STRAIGHT FEMALE TYPE RT-DF-4/01 RT-DF-6/01 RT-DF-6/02 RT-DF-8/01 RT-DF-8/02 RT-DF-8/03 RT-DF-10/02 RT-DF-10/03 RT-DF-12/03 RT-DF-12/04

L 23,5 24,4 27,4 25,1 28,1 29,1 30,5 31,5 34,6 36,6

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

5.3


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

series

SWIVELLING ELBOW MALE TYPE RT-G-4/M5 RT-G-6/M5 RT-G-4/01 RT-G-4/02 RT-G-6/01 RT-G-6/02 RT-G-8/01 RT-G-8/02 RT-G-8/03 RT-G-8/04 RT-G-10/02 RT-G-10/03 RT-G-10/04 RT-G-12/03 RT-G-12/04 RT-G-16/04

5

L 18 18 24,5 27 25,7 28,2 29 31,5 33 37 35,8 37,3 41,3 39 45,5 45,5

A 16 20 17,7 17,7 19,3 19,3 22,8 22,8 22,8 22,8 27,6 27,6 27,6 29,6 33 33

B 4 4 5.5 7.5 5.5 7.5 5.5 7.5 8,5 11 7.5 8.5 11 8.5 11 11

C 13 16 15,1 15,1 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 24.5 24,6

Ød 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 5,1 5,1

ØD 4 6 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12 17

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2

CH 8 8 14 17 14 17 14 17 20 24 17 20 24 21 24 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

A 18 20 17,7 17,7 19,3 19,3 19,3 22,8 22,8 22,8 27,6 27,6 27,6 29,6 29,6

B 4 4 5.5 7.5 5.5 7.5 8.5 5.5 7.5 8.5 7.5 8.5 11 8.5 11

C 17 19 15,1 15,1 16 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 23,2

Ød 6 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2

ØD 4 6 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 11 13 11 11 13 13 13 14,8 14,8 14,8 18,4 18,4 18,4 21 21

CH 10 12 14 17 14 17 20 14 17 20 17 20 24 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

ØD 4 6 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

E 23,5 24,5 25,5 26 28,5 29 31,5 33 36,5 38 42 39 43

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 11 13 11 13 13 14,8 14,8 14,8 18,4 18,4 18,4 21 21

CH 10 12 14 14 17 14 17 20 17 20 24 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

SWIVELLING LONG ELBOW MALE TYPE RT-GL-4/M5 RT-GL-6/M5 RT-GL-4/01 RT-GL-4/02 RT-GL-6/01 RT-GL-6/02 RT-GL-6/03 RT-GL-8/01 RT-GL-8/02 RT-GL-8/03 RT-GL-10/02 RT-GL-10/03 RT-GL-10/04 RT-GL-12/03 RT-GL-12/04

L 35 37 35,5 39 39,2 42,2 43,7 44,3 46,8 48,4 56,3 57,3 60,8 62,5 65,5

SWIVELLING CENTRAL TEE TYPE RT-TC-4/M5 RT-TC-6/M5 RT-TC-4/01 RT-TC-6/01 RT-TC-6/02 RT-TC-8/01 RT-TC-8/02 RT-TC-8/03 RT-TC-10/02 RT-TC-10/03 RT-TC-10/04 RT-TC-12/03 RT-TC-12/04

5.4

L 37 39 37,4 39,2 39,2 45,5 45,5 45,5 56,3 56,3 56,3 59,2 59,2

A 15 16 14 16 16 18 18 18 24 24 24 27 27

B 4 4 5,5 5,5 7,5 5,5 7,5 8,5 7,5 8,5 11 8,5 11

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

C Ød 15 5 16 6 15,1 3,2 16 3,2 16 3,2 18,1 3,2 18,1 3,2 18,1 3,2 20,4 4,2 20,4 4,2 20,4 4,2 23,2 4,2 23,2 4,2


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

serie

SWIVELLING LATERAL TEE TYPE RT-TL-4/M5 RT-TL-6/M5 RT-TL-4/01 RT-TL-6/01 RT-TL-6/02 RT-TL-8/01 RT-TL-8/02 RT-TL-8/03 RT-TL-10/02 RT-TL-10/03 RT-TL-10/04 RT-TL-12/03 RT-TL-12/04

L 41 42,3 44,2 45,6 48,1 51,7 54,2 55,7 64,8 66,3 70,3 68,6 72,6

A 14 16 14 16 16 18 18 18 24 24 24 27 27

B 4 4 5.5 5.5 7.5 5.5 7.5 8.5 7.5 8.5 11 8.5 11

C 12 15 15,1 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 23,2

E 18 18,5 18,7 19,6 19,6 22,8 22,8 22,8 28,3 28,3 28,3 29,6 29,6

Ød 5 6 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2

ØD 4 6 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 11 13 11 13 13 14,8 14,8 14,8 18,4 18,4 18,4 21 21

CH 10 12 14 14 17 14 17 20 17 20 24 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

SWIVELLING MALE Y TYPE RT-YM-4/M5 RT-YM-6/M5 RT-YM-4/01 RT-YM-6/01 RT-YM-6/02 RT-YM-8/01 RT-YM-8/02 RT-YM-8/03 RT-YM-10/02 RT-YM-10/03 RT-YM-10/04 RT-YM-12/03 RT-YM-12/04

L 40 41 35,5 39,2 42,2 44,3 46,8 48,4 56,3 57,3 60,8 62,5 65,5

A 14 14 10 10,5 10,5 13,4 13,4 13,4 15,5 15,5 15,5 15,5 15,5

B 4 4 5.5 5.5 7.5 5.5 7.5 8.5 7.5 8.5 11 8.5 11

C 14 14 15,1 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 23,2

Ød 6 6 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2

ØD 4 6 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 11 13 11 13 13 14,8 14,8 14,8 18,4 18,4 18,4 21 21

CH 10 12 14 14 17 14 17 20 17 20 24 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

ØD 4 6 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

E 12 17 15,1 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 23,2

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØK 10 10 14,4 14,4 18,3 14,4 18,3 22 18,3 22 28 22 28

ØP 11 13 11 13 13 14,8 14,8 14,8 18,4 18,4 18,4 21 21

CH 8 8 14 14 17 14 17 21 17 21 24 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

SWIVELLING LOW ELBOW TYPE RT-GG-4/M5 RT-GG-6/M5 RT-GG-4/01 RT-GG-6/01 RT-GG-6/02 RT-GG-8/01 RT-GG-8/02 RT-GG-8/03 RT-GG-10/02 RT-GG-10/03 RT-GG-10/04 RT-GG-12/03 RT-GG-12/04

L 17 17 23,5 23,5 27 23,5 27 32,7 27 32,7 38,1 32,7 38,1

A B 22,5 4 23,4 4 22,5 5,7 23,4 5,7 25,5 8,3 25,6 5,7 28,7 8,3 29,6 13,9 33,1 8,3 32,9 13,9 35,9 11 35,6 13,9 36,6 11

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

C 3 3 3 3 4 3 4 4,5 4 4,5 5,5 4,5 5,5

5.5

5


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

series

SWIVELLING LATERAL MULTI-TEE TYPE RT-MTL-4/01 RT-MTL-4/02 RT-MTL-6/01 RT-MTL-6/02 RT-MTL-6/03 RT-MTL-8/01 RT-MTL-8/02 RT-MTL-8/03

5

L 64,2 66,7 68,6 71,1 72,6 87,8 90,3 91,8

A 36 36 42 42 42 48 48 48

B 5.5 7.5 5.5 7.5 8.5 5.5 7.5 8.5

C 15,1 15,1 16 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1

Ød 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2

ØD 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8

G G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8

CH 14 17 14 17 20 14 17 20

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

SWIVELLING DIFFERENT Ø LATERAL MULTI-TEE TYPE RT-MDL6/4/01 RT-MDL8/4/02 RT-MDL8/6/02 RT-MDL10/8/03

L 64,2 70,7 71,1 91,8

A 36 42 42 48

B 5.5 7.5 7.5 8.5

C 16 18,1 18,1 20,4

Ød 3,2 3,2 3,2 3,2

ØD1 4 4 6 8

ØD2 E G 6 15,1 G1/8 8 15,1 G1/4 8 16 G1/4 10 18.1 G3/8

CH 14 17 17 20

q.ty 10 10 10 10

UNION STRAIGHT TYPE RT-DI-4 RT-DI-6 RT-DI-8 RT-DI-10 RT-DI-12 RT-DI-16

5.6

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

L 33 35,2 39,1 47,8 49,2 51

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 16

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10


Push-in techno-polymer fittings

RT

series

REDUCED UNION STRAIGHT TYPE RT-DIR-6/4 RT-DIR-8/6 RT-DIR-10/8 RT-DIR-12/10 RT-DIR-16/12

L 34,9 38,6 47,3 48,9 51

ØD1 6 8 10 12 16

ØD2 4 6 8 10 12

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

TYPE RT-GI-4 RT-GI-6 RT-GI-8 RT-GI-10 RT-GI-12 RT-GI-16

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 16

Ød 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,3 5,1

E 17,5 19 22,8 27,6 29,6 33

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10

TYPE RT-TI-4 RT-TI-6 RT-TI-8 RT-TI-10 RT-TI-12

ØD 4 6 8 10 12

Ød 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,3

E 18,5 19,3 22,75 28,3 29,6

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

UNION ELBOW

UNION TEE

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

5.7

5


RT

series

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

UNION Y TYPE RT-YI-4 RT-YI-6 RT-YI-8 RT-YI-10 RT-YI-12

5

L 35,5 37,1 40,4 49,7 53,2

Ød 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,2

ØD 4 6 8 10 12

F 14 14,8 18,2 20,8 21,6

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

ØD1 6 8 10 12 16

ØD2 4 6 8 10 12

F 14,5 17,7 20,3 21,3 24,5

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

Ød 3,2 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,3

E 17,5 19,3 22,75 28,3 29,6

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

REDUCED UNION Y TYPE RT-YIR-6/4 RT-YIR-8/6 RT-YIR-10/8 RT-YIR-12/10 RT-YIR-16/12

L 36,8 39,9 49,2 52,9 62

Ød 3,2 3,2 4,2 4,2 5,1

CROSS JUNCTION TYPE RT-C-4 RT-C-6 RT-C-8 RT-C-10 RT-C-12

5.8

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

ØD 4 6 8 10 12


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

serie

MULTI-TEE TYPE RT-MT-4 RT-MT-6 RT-MT-8

L 57 61 81,6

Ød ØD1 3,2 4 3,2 6 3,2 8

E 19 20,3 24,3

F 36 42 48

q.ty 10 10 10

DIFFERENT Ø MULTI-TEE TYPE RT-MTD-6/4 RT-MTD-8/4 RT-MTD-8/6 RT-MTD-10/6 RT-MTD-10/8

L 57,6 62,6 62,6 77,3 77,3

Ød ØD1 ØD2 3,2 6 4 3,2 8 4 3,2 8 6 3,2 10 6 3,2 10 8

E 19 20 20,3 23,8 24,3

F 36 42 42 48 48

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

ØD2 4 8 8 10 10 12 12

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

REDUCER TYPE RT-RC-6/4 RT-RC-8/4 RT-RC-8/6 RT-RC-10/6 RT-RC-10/8 RT-RC-12/8 RT-RC-12/10

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

L 42 44,5 45 47 47 54 54,5

C 17 18 18 20 20 23,5 23,5

ØD1 6 8 8 10 10 12 12

5.9

5


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

series

BULKHEAD CONNECTOR TYPE RT-P-4 RT-P-6 RT-P-8 RT-P-10 RT-P-12

5

L 30,1 31,8 35,3 41,6 45,3

ØD 4 6 8 10 12

E 9,7 7,5 6,8 11,5 12,8

M M12 M14 M16 M20 M22

CH 14 17 19 24 27

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

L 28 33 37 42 44

C 15 17 18 20,5 23

ØD 4 6 8 10 12

ØP1 5 7 9 11 13

ØP2 3 3 4 5 6

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

MALE PLUG TYPE RT-TM-4 RT-TM-6 RT-TM-8 RT-TM-10 RT-TM-12

SWIVELLING MALE/FEMALE ELBOW TYPE RT-GMF-4/01 RT-GMF-4/02 RT-GMF-6/01 RT-GMF-6/02 RT-GMF-8/01 RT-GMF-8/02 RT-GMF-8/03 RT-GMF-8/04 RT-GMF-10/02 RT-GMF-10/03 RT-GMF-10/04 RT-GMF-12/02 RT-GMF-12/03 RT-GMF-12/04

5.10

L 29,5 35 29,5 35 29,5 35 41,2 47 35 41,2 47 35 41,2 47

A 22,5 23,6 23,4 25,5 25,6 28,7 29,6 32,6 33,1 32,9 35,9 33,5 35,6 36,6

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

B C ØD E 5,7 9 4 7 8,3 12 4 10 5,7 9 6 7 8,3 12 6 10 5,7 9 8 7 8,3 12 8 10 13,9 13 8 11 11 14,4 8 13 8,3 12 10 10 13,9 13 10 11 11 14,4 10 13 8,3 12 12 10 13,9 13 12 11 11 14,4 12 13

G G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

ØK 14,4 18,3 14,4 18,3 14,4 18,3 22 28 18,3 22 28 18,3 22 28

ØP 11 11 13 11 14,8 14,8 14,8 14,8 18,4 18,4 18,4 21 21 21

CH 14 17 14 17 14 17 21 24 17 21 24 21 21 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10


RT

Push-in techno-polymer fittings

series

INLINE UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR TYPE RT-RFL-4 RT-RFL-6 RT-RFL-8 RT-RFL-10 RT-RFL-12

L 39,5 47,6 52,6 63,1 74,2

A 14 20 22 26 32

B 25,7 41,9 45,6 52,3 55

Ød 3,2 4,3 4,3 4,3 4,3

ØD 4 6 8 10 12

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10

UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR FOR CYLINDER (OUT) TYPE RT-RF-4/M5 RT-RF-6/M5 RT-RF-4/01 RT-RF-4/02 RT-RF-6/01 RT-RF-6/02 RT-RF-8/01 RT-RF-8/02 RT-RF-8/03 RT-RF-10/02 RT-RF-10/03 RT-RF-10/04 RT-RF-12/03 RT-RF-12/04

L 28,2 28,2 41,1 48,8 41,1 48,8 41,1 48,8 54,5 48,8 54,5 60 54,5 60

A 21 21 22,5 24,3 23,4 25,5 25,6 28,7 29,6 32,3 32,9 35,9 35,6 36,6

B 5 5,7 8,3 5,7 8,3 5,7 8,3 13,9 8,3 13,9 11 13,9 11

C 12 15,1 15,1 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 23,2

ØD 4 6 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 11 13 10 10 12 12 14 14 14 17 17 17 20 20

CH 8 8 10 14 10 14 10 14 19 14 19 19 19 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR FOR VALVE (IN) TYPE RT-RFV-4/M5 RT-RFV-6/M5 RT-RFV-4/01 RT-RFV-4/02 RT-RFV-6/01 RT-RFV-6/02 RT-RFV-8/01 RT-RFV-8/02 RT-RFV-8/03 RT-RFV-10/02 RT-RFV-10/03 RT-RFV-10/04 RT-RFV-12/03 RT-RFV-12/04

L 28,2 28,2 41,1 48,8 41,1 48,8 41,1 48,8 54,5 48,8 54,5 60 54,5 60

A 21 21 22,5 24,3 23,4 25,5 25,6 28,7 29,6 32,3 32,9 35,9 35,6 36,6

Push-in techno-polymer fittings series RT

B 5 5 5,7 8,3 5,7 8,3 5,7 8,3 13,9 8,3 13,9 11 13,9 11

C 12 16 15,1 15,1 16 16 18,1 18,1 18,1 20,4 20,4 20,4 23,2 23,2

ØD 4 6 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

G M5 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

ØP 10 13 10 10 12 12 14 14 14 17 17 17 20 20

CH 8 8 10 14 10 14 10 14 19 14 19 19 19 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

5.11

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

TECHNICAL DATA Material Thread Seal Clamp Size Fluid Working temperature Max. pressure Permissible tolerances for tubes

Body and thrust ring: nickel plated brass Metric, taper and parallel NBR rubber Stainless steel AISI 316 M5 ÷ G1/2 Air, water, oil, steam -20 ÷ +70 °C 16 bar Polyamide PA11 - PA12 Polyurethane PU Outside tube diameter Outside tube diameter tolerance Outside tube diameter Outside tube diameter tolerance 4 - 8 mm +0,1 -0,1 4 - 8 mm +0,1 -0,1 10 - 22 mm +0,15 -0,15 10 - 14 mm +0,15 -0,1

PARALLEL STRAIGHT MALE TYPE RO-DM - 4/M5 RO-DM - 4/M6 RO-DM - 4/M7 RO-DM - 4/M8 RO-DM - 4/01 RO-DM - 4/02 RO-DM - 6/M5 RO-DM - 6/M6 RO-DM - 6/M7 RO-DM - 6/M12 RO-DM - 6/M12A RO-DM - 6/01 RO-DM - 6/02 RO-DM - 6/03 RO-DM - 8/01 RO-DM - 8/02 RO-DM - 8/03 RO-DM - 8/04 RO-DM - 10/01 RO-DM - 10/02 RO-DM - 10/03 RO-DM - 10/04 RO-DM - 12/02 RO-DM - 12/03 RO-DM -12/04 RO-DM - 14/03 RO-DM - 14/04

5

L 20,5 20,5 22,2 23,5 20 21 22,5 21,5 24 24 24 24 24 24 26,5 25 25 31 28 29,5 29,5 30 31,5 31 31 34 34

ØB 9 9 10,5 12 13,5 17 10,5 11 10,5 16 16 13,5 17 20 13 17 20 23 13,5 16 21 24 16 21 24 21 25

ØC 2,6 2,6 3,6 2,6 2,6 2,6 2,6 2,5 3,6 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 4,2 5,2 6,2 6,2 6,2 5,2 7,3 8,3 8,3 7,3 10,3 10,3 10,3 12

ØD G 4 M5 4 M6 4 M7 4 M8 4 G1/ 8 4 G1/ 4 6 M5 6 M6 6 M7 6 M12X1,25 6 M12X1,5 6 G1/8 6 G1/4 6 G3/8 8 G1/8 8 G1/4 8 G3/8 8 G1/2 10 G1/8 10 G1/4 10 G3/8 10 G1/2 12 G1/4 12 G3/8 12 G1/2 14 G3/8 14 G1/2

H 4 5 6 7 6 8 4 4 6 8 8 6 8 9 6 8 9 11 6 8 9 11 8 9 11 9 11

CH1 9 10 9 9 11 11 11 11 13 13 13 13 13 16 16 16 16 18 18 18 21 21

CH2 2,5 2,5 3,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 2,5 3,5 4 4 4 4 4 5 6 6 6 5 7 8 8 7 10 10 10 12

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 50 50 50 25 50 25 25 25 25

PARALLEL STRAIGHT FEMALE TYPE RO-DF-4/M5 RO-DF-4/01 RO-DF-4/02 RO-DF-6/01 RO-DF-6/02 RO-DF-8/01 RO-DF-8/02 RO-DF-10/02 RO-DF-10/03

5.12

Push-in brass fittings series RO

L 21,5 26,5 29,5 27 31 28 32 32 38

ØB 9 12 17 12 17 12 17 16 20

ØC 3 3 3 5 5 7 7 9 9

ØD 4 4 4 6 6 8 8 10 10

G M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

H 5 6,5 10 6,5 10 6,5 10 10 13

CH 9 9 9 11 11 13 13 16 20

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

PARALLEL SWIVEL MALE ELBOW TYPE RO-GM-4/M5 RO-GM-4/M6 RO-GM-4/M7 RO-GM-4/01 RO-GM-4/02 RO-GM-6/M5 RO-GM-6/M6 RO-GM-6/M7 RO-GM-6/M12 RO-GM-6/M12A RO-GM-6/01 RO-GM-6/02 RO-GM-6/03 RO-GM-8/01 RO-GM-8/02 RO-GM-8/03 RO-GM-10/02 RO-GM-10/03 RO-GM-10/04 RO-GM-12/02 RO-GM-12/03 RO-GM-12/04 RO-GM-14/03 RO-GM-14/04

L 17,5 21,5 17,5 19 21 19,5 19,5 19 19 21 21 21 24 24 24 27 27 27 28 28 28 31 31

L1 20 18 18,5 22,5 14,5 15,5 16,5 25 25 20 24 25,5 20 24 25,5 24 28 30 27,5 28,5 33,5 28,5 30,5

ØB 8 10,5 12,8 12,8 8 9 10 16 16 13 16 20 13 16 20 16 20 25 16 20 25 20 25

ØD 4 4 4 4 4 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12 12 14 14

G M5 M6 M7 G1/8 G1/8 M5 M6 M7 M12x1,25 M12x1,50 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

H 4 6 5,8 8 4 5 6 8 8 6 8 9 6 8 9 8 9 11 8 9 11 9 11

CH 8 11 13 16 9 9 9 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 16 16 16 16 20 20 20 21

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 50 50 50 50 50 25 50 25 25 25 25

R 1/8 1/8 1/8 1/4 1/8 1/4 1/4

CH 10 10 10 12 11 12 14

q.ty 50 50 50 25 25 25 25

TAPER FIXED MALE ELBOW TYPE RO1-GM-4/01 RO1-GM-5/01 RO1-GM-6/01 RO1-GM-6/02 RO1-GM-8/01 RO1-GM-8/02 RO1-GM-10/02

Push-in brass fittings series RO

L1 18 18 22 23 24 24 24

L2 16,5 16,5 22,5 18,5 22,5 22,5 22,5

ØD1 4 5 6 6 8 8 10

H 8 9 8 11,5 9 11,5 11,5

5.13

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

TAPER SWIVEL MALE ELBOW TYPE RO1-GMG-4/01 RO1-GMG-4/02 RO1-GMG-6/01 RO1-GMG-6/02 RO1-GMG-8/01 RO1-GMG-8/02 RO1-GMG-8/03 RO1-GMG-10/02 RO1-GMG-10/03 RO1-GMG-12/03 RO1-GMG-12/04 RO1-GMG-14/03 RO1-GMG-14/04

5

L1 20,2 25 20,2 25 20,2 25 28 26 30 32,5 35,5 32,5 35,5

L2 19 19 21 21 24 24 24 27 27 28 28 31 31

ØD 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12 14 14

H 7 11 7 11 7 11 11 11 11 11 14 11 14

R R1/8 R1/4 R1/8 R1/4 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/4 R3/8 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2

CH 13 14 13 14 13 14 18 16 16 20 22 20 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25

PARALLEL SWIVELLING CENTRAL MALE TEE TYPE RO-TC-4/M5 RO-TC-4/01 RO-TC-4/02 RO-TC-6/01 RO-TC-6/02 RO-TC-8/01 RO-TC-8/02 RO-TC-8/03 RO-TC-10/02 RO-TC-10/03 RO-TC-12/02 RO-TC-12/03 RO-TC-14/04

L 17,5 17,5 19 21 21 23 23 25,5 25,5 25,5 27 27 31

L1 16,5 20 24 20 24 20 24 25,5 28 29 30,5 28,5 33,5

ØB 8 13 16 13 16 13 16 20 16 12 16 20 25

ØD 4 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12 14

G M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

L1 16,5 20 24 20 24 20 24 25,5 24 28 30,5 28,5 33,5

ØB 8 13 13 13 16 13 16 20 16 20 16 20 25

ØD 4 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12 14

G M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

H 4 6 8 6 8 6 8 9 8 9 8 9 11

CH 9 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 16 16 16 20 20

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25

CH 9 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 16 16 16 20 20

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25

PARALLEL SWIVELLING LATERAL MALE TEE TYPE RO-TL-4/M5 RO-TL-4/01 RO-TL-4/02 RO-TL-6/01 RO-TL-6/02 RO-TL-8/01 RO-TL-8/02 RO-TL-8/03 RO-TL-10/02 RO-TL-10/03 RO-TL-12/02 RO-TL-12/03 RO-TL-14/04

5.14

Push-in brass fittings series RO

L 17,5 17,5 19 19,5 21 23 23 25,5 25,5 25,5 27 21 31

H 4 6 8 6 8 6 8 9 8 9 8 9 11


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

COMPLETE PARALLEL SINGLE BANJO, ROTATING 360° TYPE RO-BSR-4/M5 RO-BSR-4/01 RO-BSR-6/01 RO-BSR-8/01 RO-BSR-6/02 RO-BSR-8/02 RO-BSR-10/02 RO-BSR-8/03 RO-BSR-10/03 RO-BSR-12/02 RO-BSR-12/03

L 18,5 21 23,5 24,5 24,5 26 27 29 29 29,3 29

L1 17 25 25 25 29,3 29,3 29,3 34 34 28 34

ØA 2 5,5 5,5 5,5 7,8 7,8 7,8 10 10 7,8 10

ØD 4 4 6 8 6 8 10 8 10 12 12

G M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8

H 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 9 9 8 9

CH 2 3 3 3 4 4 4 5 5 4 5

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25 25 25 25

TYPE RO-BDR-4/M5 RO-BDR-4/01 RO-BDR-5/M5 RO-BDR-5/01 RO-BDR-6/01 RO-BDR-8/01 RO-BDR-6/02 RO-BDR-8/02 RO-BDR-10/02 RO-BDR-8/03 RO-BDR-10/03 RO-BDR-12/03

L 18,5 21 19,5 22,5 23 24 24 26 27 28 29 30

L1 17 25 17 25 25 25 29,3 29,3 29,3 34 34 34

ØA 2 5,5 2 5,5 5,5 5,5 7,8 7,8 7,8 10 10 10

ØD 4 4 5 5 6 8 6 8 10 8 10 12

G M5 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 10 10 10

H 4 6 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 9 9 9

CH 2 3 2 3 3 3 4 4 4 5 5 5

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25 25

L3 15 15 15 17 17 17 17

L4 21 23 24 24 26 27 28

ØB 13 13 13 17 17 17 17

ØD 4 6 8 6 8 10 12

G G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4

H 6 6 6 8 8 8 8

CH 14 14 14 17 17 17 17

q.ty 25 25 25 25 10 10 10

COMPLETE PARALLEL DOUBLE BANJO, ROTATING 360°

COMPLETE PARALLEL TWO SINGLE BANJO, ROTATING 360° TYPE RO-2BSR-4/01 RO-2BSR-6/01 RO-2BSR-8/01 RO-2BSR-6/02 RO-2BSR-8/02 RO-2BSR-10/02 RO-2BSR-12/02

L1 44 44 44 50 50 50 50

L2 19 19 19 22,5 22,5 22,5 22,5

Push-in brass fittings series RO

5.15

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

COMPLETE PARALLEL THREE SINGLE BANJO, ROTATING 360° TYPE RO-3BSR-4/01 RO-3BSR-6/01 RO-3BSR-8/01 RO-3BSR-6/02 RO-3BSR-8/02 RO-3BSR-10/02 RO-3BSR-12/02

5

L1 59 59 59 67 67 67 67

L2 19 19 19 21,5 21,5 21,5 21,5

L3 15 15 15 17 17 17 17

L4 21 23 24 24 26 27 28

ØB 13 13 13 17 17 17 17

ØD 4 6 8 6 8 10 12

G G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4

H 6 6 6 8 8 8 8

CH 14 14 14 17 17 17 17

q.ty 25 25 25 25 10 10 10

TYPE RO-BS-4/M5 RO-BS-4/M6 RO-BS-4/01 RO-BS-6/M5 RO-BS-6/01 RO-BS-6/02 RO-BS-8/01 RO-BS-8/02 RO-BS-8/03 RO-BS-10/02 RO-BS-10/03 RO-BS-12/02 RO-BS-12/03

L 18,5 21 21 19 22,5 24 24,5 26 28 27 29 28 30

L1 17,5 18 28 17,5 28 33 28 33 37 33 37 33 37

ØB 7 14 14 10 14 18 14 18 21 18 21 18 21

ØD 4 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12

G M5 M6 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8

H 4,5 4,5 7,5 4,5 7,5 9 7,5 9 10 9 10 9 10

CH 8 9 14 8 14 17 14 17 22 17 22 17 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25 25 25 25 10

TYPE RO-BD-4/M5 RO-BD-4/01 RO-BD-6/01 RO-BD-6/02 RO-BD-8/01 RO-BD-8/02 RO-BD-8/03 RO-BD-10/02 RO-BD-10/03 RO-BD-12/03

L 18,5 21 22,5 24 24,5 26 28 27 29 30

L1 17,5 28 28 33 28 33 37 33 37 37

ØB 7 14 14 18 14 18 21 18 21 21

ØD 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12

G M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8

H 4,5 7,5 7,5 9 7,5 9 10 9 9 9

CH 8 14 14 17 14 17 22 17 22 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 25 25 25 25 10

COMPLETE PARALLEL SINGLE SWIVEL BANJO

COMPLETE PARALLEL DOUBLE SWIVEL BANJO

5.16

Push-in brass fittings series RO


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

UNION STRAIGHT TYPE RO-DI-4 RO-DI-6 RO-DI-8 RO-DI-10 RO-DI-12 RO-DI-14

L 30 31,5 36 37 40,5 45

ØA 9 11 13 15 17 20

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 14

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50

REDUCED UNION STRAIGHT TYPE RO-DIR-6/4 RO-DIR-8/6 RO-DIR-10/8 RO-DIR-12/10 RO-DIR-14/12

L 33,5 37 39,5 40 43

ØA 11 13 16 20 22

ØD 4 6 8 10 12

ØD2 6 8 10 12 14

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50

TYPE RO-GI-4 RO-GI-6 RO-GI-8 RO-GI-10 RO-GI-12 RO-GI-14

L 17,5 19,5 23 25 27 30

ØB 9 11 13 15 17 20

ØC 3 5 7 8 10 12

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 14

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 25

UNION ELBOW

Push-in brass fittings series RO

5.17

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series UNION TEE

TYPE RO-TI-4 RO-TI-6 RO-TI-6/4 RO-TI-8 RO-TI-8/6 RO-TI-10 RO-TI-10/8 RO-TI-12 RO-TI-14

5

L 17,5 19,5 19,5 23 23 25 25 27 30

ØB 9 11 11 13 13 15 15 17 20

ØC 3 5 3 7 5 8 7 10 12

ØD1 4 6 6 8 8 10 10 12 14

ØD2 4 6 4 8 6 10 8 12 14

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 20 20 20 20

BULKHEAD CONNECTOR TYPE RO-P-4 RO-P-6 RO-P-8 RO-P-10 RO-P-12 RO-P-14

L 32 33,5 37 39,5 42 45

ØB 10 14 16 17 20 22

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 14

Imax 8 8 10 12 17 18

M M10x1 M14x1 M16x1 M17x1 M20x1 M22x1

G G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4

H 6,5 6,5 10,5 6,5 10,5

CH1 13 17 17 19 19

CH q.ty 13 50 17 50 18 50 20 25 24 25 25 25

FEMALE BULKHEAD CONNECTOR TYPE RO-PF-4/01 RO-PF-6/01 RO-PF-6/02 RO-PF-8/01 RO-PF-8/02

5.18

L1 13 13 13 13 13

Push-in brass fittings series RO

L2 25 27 21 28 33

B M10x1 M14x1 M14x1 M13x1 M13x1

ØD 4 6 6 8 8

CH2 15 17 17 17 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

REDUCER TYPE RO-R-6/4 RO-R-6/5 RO-R-8/4 RO-R-8/5 RO-R-8/6 RO-R-10/6 RO-R-10/8 RO-R-12/4 RO-R-12/6 RO-R-12/8 RO-R-12/10 RO-R-14/4 RO-R-14/6 RO-R-14/8 RO-R-14/10 RO-R-14/12

L 28,5 35,5 31 32,5 33,5 36,5 38 39,5 39,5 38,5 41 43 43 43 43 43

ØB 9 9,5 9 9,5 10,5 10,5 13 13 13 13 15 15 15 15 15 17

ØC 3 4 3 4 5 5 7 3 5 7 9 3 5 7 9 11

ØD1 ØD2 6 4 6 5 8 4 8 5 8 6 10 6 10 8 12 4 12 6 12 8 12 10 14 4 14 6 14 8 14 10 14 12

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25

TYPE RO-E-4/6 RO-E-6/8

L 33,5 38

ØB 10,5 13

ØC 2 4

ØD1 ØD2 4 6 6 8

q.ty 25 25

L 25,5 27,5 30 35 37 39,5

ØB 5 7 9 11 13 15

q.ty 50 50 50 25 25 25

INCREASER

PLUG TYPE RO-T-4 RO-T-6 RO-T-8 RO-T-10 RO-T-12 RO-T-14

Push-in brass fittings series RO

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 14

5.19

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

UNION CONNECTOR TYPE RO-CI-4 RO-CI-6 RO-CI-8 RO-CI-10 RO-CI-12 RO-CI-14

5

L 32 35 38 45,5 48 52

ØC 2 4 6 8 10 12

ØD 4 6 8 10 12 14

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20

PARALLEL LONG ADAPTER TYPE RO-ACL-4/M7 RO-ACL-4/01 RO-ACL-6/M7 RO-ACL-6/01 RO-ACL-6/02 RO-ACL-8/01 RO-ACL-8/02 RO-ACL-10/02

L 38 39,2 42 43,5 46 46,7 49,7 55,5

ØA 4 6 4 6 7,5 6 7,5 8

ØB 13 13 16 13 16 16

ØC 2 2 4 4 4 6 6 8

ØC 2 2 2 2 2,6 4 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12

ØD 4 4 4 4 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12 12 12 14 14

ØD 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 10

G M7 G1/8 M7 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

H 6 6 6 6 8 6 8 8

CH 10 13 10 13 14 13 14 14

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50

P.S.: THIS ADAPTER CAN BE USED EVEN WITH THE UNION FITTINGS OF SERIES “RT”

PARALLEL ADAPTER

P.S.: THIS ADAPTER CAN BE USED EVEN WITH THE UNION FITTINGS OF SERIES “RT”

5.20

TYPE RO-AC-4/M5 RO-AC-4/M7 RO-AC-4/01 RO-AC-4/02 RO-AC-6/M5 RO-AC-6/M7 RO-AC-6/01 RO-AC-6/02 RO-AC-8/01 RO-AC-8/02 RO-AC-8/03 RO-AC-10/01 RO-AC-10/02 RO-AC-10/03 RO-AC-12/02 RO-AC-12/03 RO-AC-12/04 RO-AC-14/03 RO-AC-14/04

L 24,5 26 27,7 30,2 26 28 29,5 32 31 33,5 35,5 35,5 38 41 39 42 44 44 46

Push-in brass fittings series RO

ØA 2 4 6 7,5 2,6 4 6 7,5 6 7,5 9 6 8 8 10 11 13 12 13

ØB 8 13 16 8 13 16 13 16 20 16 20 16 20 24 20 24

G M5 M7 G1/8 G1/4 M5 M7 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2

H 4 6 6 8 4 6 6 8 6 8 9 6 8 9 8 9 11 9 11

CH 8 10 13 13 8 10 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 16 16 16

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25 25


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

TUBE CONNECTOR TYPE RO-CT-6/4 RO-CT-8/6 RO-CTL-8/6 RO-CT-12/10 RO-CT-14/11

L 36,5 38 43 57 60

ØD 6 8 8 12 14

ØD1 4 6 6 10 11

LW 6 6 8 13 14

q.ty 25 25 25 25 25

SINGLE BANJO BODY TYPE RO-CBS-4/M5 RO-CBS-4/M6 RO-CBS-4/01 RO-CBS-6/M5 RO-CBS-6/01 RO-CBS-6/02 RO-CBS-8/01 RO-CBS-8/02 RO-CBS-8/03 RO-CBS-10/02 RO-CBS-10/03 RO-CBS-12/02 RO-CBS-12/03

L 19 19 21 19 23 24 24,5 26 28 27 29 28 30

ØA 5 6 9,9 5,1 9,9 13,3 9,9 13,3 16,6 13,3 16,6 13,6 16,6

ØB 9 9 14 10 14 18 14 18 21 18 21 18 21

ØD 4 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12

M5 M6 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8

H 9 9 15 10,5 15 17 15 17 20 17 20 17 20

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 25

TYPE RO-CBD-4/M5 RO-CBD-4/01 RO-CBD-6/01 RO-CBD-6/02 RO-CBD-8/01 RO-CBD-8/02 RO-CBD-8/03 RO-CBD-10/02 RO-CBD-10/03 RO-CBD-12/03

L 18,5 21 23 24 24,5 26 28 27 29 30

ØA 5 9,9 9,9 13,3 9,9 13,3 16,6 13,3 16,6 16,6

ØB 7 14 14 18 14 18 21 18 21 21

ØD 4 4 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12

M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8

H 9 15 15 17 15 17 20 17 20 20

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25

DOUBLE BANJO BODY

Push-in brass fittings series RO

5.21

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

serie

SINGLE BANJO STEM TYPE RO-VBS-M5 RO-VBS-M6 RO-VBS-01 RO-VBS-02 RO-VBS-03 RO-VBS-04

5

L 17,5 19 28 33 37 42

A M5 M6 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B 7,6 7,5 9 13 12 14,5

C 9,6 10,8 15 18 21,5 23,5

CH 8 8 14 17 22 27

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25

B 9 11 12 13

C 15 17 20,5 23,5

D 31 36 42 49,5

CH 14 17 19 27

q.ty 25 25 25 25

ØB 7,7 13 17,9 21,8 26,5 32,4

ØD 5,3 10,2 13,4 17,1 21,3 26,7

H 1 1,5 2 2 2 2

M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4

q.ty 100 100 100 100 100 100

DOUBLE BANJO STEM TYPE RO-VBD-01 RO-VBD-02 RO-VBD-03 RO-VBD-04

L 44,5 51,5 58,6 68

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

WASHER TYPE RO-RD-M5 RO-RD-01 RO-RD-02 RO-RD-03 RO-RD-04 RO-RD-06

For banjo stem type RC-VBS,RO-VBS and RO-VBD, order No. 2 spacers type RO-RD, to be fitted as follow: one under the head of the screw, and one under the last banjo. TYPE RO-DIS-01 RO-DIS-02

Spacer for RO-VB and RC-VBD* ØB ØD H 14 10,2 5 G1/8 17,5 13,2 5 G1/4

* To be fitted between the two rings.

5.22

Push-in brass fittings series RO

q.ty 50 50


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

PARALLEL UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR (SCREWDRIVER) FOR CYLINDER (OUT) TYPE RO-RC-4/M5 RO-RC-4/01 RO-RC-6/M5 RO-RC-6/01 RO-RC-6/02 RO-RC-8/01 RO-RC-8/02 RO-RC-8/03 RO-RC-10/02 RO-RC-10/03 RO-RC-12/02 RO-RC-12/03

L 24,5 31,5 24,5 31,5 38 31,5 38 40 38 47 38 47

B 6 5,5 4 5,5 6 5,5 6 6 6 6 6 6

D 17 21 21 22,5 24 24,5 26 28 28 29 28 30

ØD 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12

G M5 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8

CH 8 14 8 14 17 14 17 20 17 20 17 20

NI/min* q.tà 45 50 310 50 45 50 390 50 710 50 390 25 810 25 1050 25 810 25 1050 25 810 25 1050 10

B 6 5,5 4 5,5 6 5,5 6 6 6 6 6 6

D 17 21 21 22,5 24 24,5 26 28 28 29 28 30

ØD 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 10 12 12

G M5 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8

CH 8 14 8 14 17 14 17 20 17 20 17 20

NI/min* q.tà 45 50 310 50 45 50 390 50 710 50 390 25 810 25 1050 25 810 25 1050 25 810 25 1050 10

C 17 21 22,5 22,5 24 24,5 26

ØD 4 6 8 6 8 10 12

G NI/min* G1/8 310 G1/8 390 G1/8 390 G1/4 710 G1/4 810 G1/4 810 G1/4 810

* Nominal flow rate at 6 bar

PARALLEL UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR (SCREWDRIVER) FOR VALVE (IN) TYPE RO-RV-4/M5 RO-RV-4/01 RO-RV-6/M5 RO-RV-6/01 RO-RV-6/02 RO-RV-8/01 RO-RV-8/02 RO-RV-8/03 RO-RV-10/02 RO-RV-10/03 RO-RV-12/02 RO-RV-12/03

L 24,5 31,5 24,5 31,5 38 31,5 38 40 38 47 38 47

* Nominal flow rate at 6 bar

PARALLEL UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR (HANDWHEEL) FOR CYLINDER (OUT) TYPE RO-RF-4/01 RO-RF-6/01 RO-RF-8/01 RO-RF-6/02 RO-RF-8/02 RO-RF-10/02 RO-RF-12/02

L 49 49 49 56,5 56,5 56,5 56,5

B 5,5 5,5 5,5 6 6 6 6

CH 14 14 14 17 17 17 17

q.tà 50 50 50 25 25 25 25

* Nominal flow rate at 6 bar

Push-in brass fittings series RO

5.23

5


RO

Push-in brass fittings

series

PARALLEL UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR (HANDWHEEL) FOR VALVE (IN) TYPE RO-RFV-4/01 RO-RFV-6/01 RO-RFV-8/01 RO-RFV-6/02 RO-RFV-8/02 RO-RFV-10/02 RO-RFV-12/02

L 49 49 49 56,5 56,5 56,5 56,5

* Nominal flow rate at 6 bar

5

5.24

Push-in brass fittings series RO

B 5,5 5,5 5,5 6 6 6 6

C 17 21 22,5 22,5 24 24,5 26

ØD 4 6 8 6 8 10 12

G G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4

NI/min* 310 390 390 710 810 810 810

CH 14 14 14 17 17 17 17

q.tà 50 50 50 25 25 25 25


RS

Standard fittings

series

TECHNICAL DATA Material Thread Size Fluid Max. temperature Max. pressure

Nickel plated brass Metric, taper and parallel M5 ÷ G1 Air, water, oil, steam 150 °C 50 bar

PARALLEL NIPPLE TYPE RS-N-M5 RS-N-M5/01 RS-N-01 RS-N-01/02 RS-N-01/03 RS-N-02 RS-N-02/03 RS-N-02/04 RS-N-03 RS-N-03/04 RS-N-04 RS-N-04/06 RS-N-06 RS-N-06/08

L 11,5 14,5 16,5 19 20 21 22 23,5 23 24,5 25,5 27,5 28,5 32

A M5 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2 G3/4 G3/4

B M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2 G3/4 G3/4 G1

E 4 6 6 8 9 8 9 10 9 10 10 11 11 23

TYPE RS1-N-01 RS1-N-01/02 RS1-N-01/03 RS1-N-02 RS1-N-02/03 RS1-N-02/04 RS1-N-03 RS1-N-03/04 RS1-N-04 RS1-N-04/06 RS1-N-06 RS1-N-06/08 RS1-N-08

L 20,5 24 24,5 27 27,5 30,5 28 31 33,5 37 39,5 42,5 45,5

A R1/8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 R3/8 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2 R3/4 R3/4 R1

B R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2 R3/4 R3/4 R1 R1

E 8 11 11,5 11 11,5 14 11,5 14 14 16,5 16,5 19 19,0

F 4 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 9 9 10 10 11 15

CH 8 14 14 17 19 17 19 24 19 24 24 30 30 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 20 20 20

F 8 8 8 11 11 11 11,5 11,5 14 14 16,5 16,5 19

CH 12 14 17 14 17 22 17 22 22 27 27 34 34

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 20 10 10

TAPER NIPPLE

Standard fittings series RS

5.25

5


RS

Standard fittings

series SLEEVE

TYPE RS-M-M5 RS-M-01 RS-M-02 RS-M-03 RS-M-04 RS-M-06

5

L 11 15 22 23 28 32

A M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4

CH 8 14 17 22 26 32

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20

TAPER REDUCER TYPE RS1-RMF-02/01 RS1-RMF-03/01 RS1-RMF-04/01 RS1-RMF-03/02 RS1-RMF-04/02 RS1-RMF-04/03 RS1-RMF-06/04 RS1-RMF-06/03

L 16 16,5 19,5 16,5 19,5 19,5 23 23,5

A R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2 R3/4 R3/4

B R1/8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8

C 11 11,5 14 11,5 14 14 16,5 16,5

CH 14 17 22 17 22 22 27 27

q.ty 50 50 25 50 50 50 20 20

TYPE RS-RMF-01/M5 RS-RMF-02/01 RS-RMF-03/01 RS-RMF-03/02 RS-RMF-04/01 RS-RMF-04/02 RS-RMF-04/03 RS-RMF-06/03 RS-RMF-06/04

L 10,5 13 14 14 15,5 15,5 15,5 17,5 17,5

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2 G1/2 G3/4 G3/4

B M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2

C 6 8 9 9 10 10 10 11 11

CH 14 17 19 19 24 24 24 30 30

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 50 50 25 20

PARALLEL REDUCER

5.26

Standard fittings series RS


RS

Standard fittings

series

TAPER MALE/FEMALE EXTENSION TYPE RS1-PMF-01 RS1-PMF-01/02 RS1-PMF-01/03 RS1-PMF-02 RS1-PMF-02/03 RS1-PMF-02/04 RS1-PMF-03 RS1-PMF-03/04 RS1-PMF-04 RS1-PMF-04/06

L 18 21,5 22,5 24,5 25,5 29 26 29,5 32 35

A R1/8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 R3/8 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2

B G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2 G3/4

C 8 8 8 11 11 11 11,5 11,5 14 14

CH 14 17 22 17 22 24 22 24 26 32

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 20

TYPE RS-PMF-M5/01 RS-PMF-01 RS-PMF-01/02 RS-PMF-01/03 RS-PMF-02 RS-PMF-02/03 RS-PMF-02/04 RS-PMF-03 RS-PMF-03/04 RS-PMF-04

L 14,5 16 19,5 20,5 21,5 22,5 26 23,5 27 28

A M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8 G3/8 G1/2

B G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2

C 4 6 6 6 8 8 8 9 9 10

CH 14 14 17 22 17 22 24 22 24 26

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25

TYPE RS-PL-01A RS-PL-01B RS-PL-01C RS-PL-02A RS-PL-02B

L 22 42 51 35 51

A G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

A1 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

B 6 6 6 8 8

CH 14 14 14 17 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50

PARALLEL MALE/FEMALE EXTENSION

PARALLEL MALE/FEMALE LONG EXTENSION

Standard fittings series RS

5.27

5


RS

Standard fittings

series

REDUCING SLEEVE

5

TYPE RS-MR-M5/01 RS-MR-01/02 RS-MR-01/03 RS-MR-01/04 RS-MR-02/03 RS-MR-02/04 RS-MR-03/04 RS-MR-04/06

L 13,5 19 20 24 22,5 26 26 30

A M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2 G3/4

CH 14 17 22 24 22 24 24 32

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25

TYPE RS-TC-M5 RS-TC-01 RS-TC-02 RS-TC-03 RS-TC-04 RS-TC-06 RS-TC-08

L 7 10 12,5 13,5 15,5 16,5 19

A M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B 4 6,5 8 9 10 11 13

CH 8 14 17 19 24 30 38

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 10

A M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B 4,5 6,5 8 9 10

ØD 8 14 17 20 26

CH 2,5 5 6 8 10

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25

PARALLEL MALE PLUG

PARALLEL MALE PLUG WITH O-RING TYPE RS-TMO-M5 RS-TMO-01 RS-TMO-02 RS-TMO-03 RS-TMO-04

5.28

Standard fittings series RS

L 7,2 9,5 11,5 12,5 14


RS

Standard fittings

series

FEMALE PLUG TYPE RS-TFE-01 RS-TFE-02 RS-TFE-03 RS-TFE-04

L 11,5 15 15,5 20

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B 8 11 11,5 14

CH 14 17 20 24

q.ty 50 50 50 25

TYPE RS-GF-M5 RS-GF-01 RS-GF-02 RS-GF-03 RS-GF-04 RS-GF-06 RS-GF-08

A M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B 4 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 19

C 11 21 25,5 28 33,5 36,5 45

CH 8 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

A2 M5 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B2 5 8 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 19

C 11,5 21,5 18,5 23,5 26 31 33 39

CH 9 10 10 13 17 21 25 30

D 11 21 21 25,5 28 33,5 36,5 45

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

FEMALE ELBOW

TAPER MALE/FEMALE ELBOW TYPE RS-GMF-M5 RS-GMF-02/01 RS-GMF-01 RS-GMF-02 RS-GMF-03 RS-GMF-04 RS-GMF-06 RS-GMF-08

Standard fittings series RS

A1 M5 R1/4 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1

B1 4 11 8 11 11,5 14 16 19

5.29

5


RS

Standard fittings

series

TAPER MALE ELBOW TYPE RS-GM-M5 RS-GM-01 RS-GM-02/01 RS-GM-02 RS-GM-03 RS-GM-04 RS-GM-06 RS-GM-08

5

A M5 R1/8 R1/4 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1

B1 4 8 11 11 11,5 14 16 17

C 11,5 18,5 21,5 23,5 26 31 33 39

D 11,5 18,5 19 23,5 26 31 33 39

CH 8 10 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 25 50 50 25 20 10

L 22 42 51 56 67 73 90

A M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B 5 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 19

C 11 21 25,5 28 33,5 36,5 45

CH 9 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

A2 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G2

B1 4 8 11 11,5 14 16 17,5

B2 5 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 19

C 11,5 18,5 23,5 26 31 33 39

CH 9 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

FEMALE TEE TYPE RS-TF-M5 RS-TF-01 RS-TF-02 RS-TF-03 RS-TF-04 RS-TF-06 RS-TF-08

TAPER UNION MALE TEE TYPE RS-TMC-M5 RS-TMC-01 RS-TMC-02 RS-TMC-03 RS-TMC-04 RS-TMC-06 RS-TMC-08

5.30

Standard fittings series RS

L 22 42 51 56 67 73 90

A1 M5 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1


RS

Standard fittings

series

TAPER LATERAL MALE TEE TYPE RS-TML-M5 RS-TML-01 RS-TML-02 RS-TML-03 RS-TML-04 RS-TML-06 RS-TML-08

L 22,5 39,5 49 54 64,5 69,5 84

A1 M5 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1

A2 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B1 4 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 17,5

B2 5 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 19

C 11 21 25,5 28 33,5 36,5 45

CH 9 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

L 37 47 52 62 66,4 78

A R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1

B 8 11 11,5 14 16,2 17,5

C 18,5 23,5 26 31 33 39

CH 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 25 20 10

A2 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B1 8 11 11,5 14 16,2 17,5

B2 8 11 11,5 14 16,5 19

C 21 25,5 28 33,5 36,5 45

CH 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 25 20 10

TAPER MALE TEE TYPE RS-TM-01 RS-TM-02 RS-TM-03 RS-TM-04 RS-TM-06 RS-TM-08

TAPER UNION FEMALE TEE TYPE RS-TCF-01 RS-TCF-02 RS-TCF-03 RS-TCF-04 RS-TCF-06 RS-TCF-08

Standard fittings series RS

L 37 47 52 62 66,4 78

A1 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1

5.31

5


RS

Standard fittings

series

TAPER LATERAL FEMALE TEE TYPE RS-TLF-01 RS-TLF-02 RS-TLF-03 RS-TLF-04 RS-TLF-06 RS-TLF-08

5

A1 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R1

A2 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1

B 8 11 11,5 14 16 17,5

C 18,5 23,5 26 31 33 39

D 39,5 49 54 64,5 69,5 84

CH 10 13 17 21 25 30

q.ty 50 50 50 25 20 10

L 42 51 56 67

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B 8 11 11,5 14

CH 10 13 17 21

q.ty 25 25 25 20

A2 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B 8 11 11,5 14

C 18,5 23,5 26 31

CH 10 13 17 21

q.ty 25 25 25 20

FEMALE CROSS TYPE RS-CF-01 RS-CF-02 RS-CF-03 RS-CF-04

TAPER M/F/F/F CROSS (M=MALE; F=FEMALE) TYPE RS-MFFF-01 RS-MFFF-02 RS-MFFF-03 RS-MFFF-04

5.32

Standard fittings series RS

L 42 49 56 67

A1 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2


RS

Standard fittings

series

TAPER MALE Y CONNECTOR TYPE RS-YCM-01 RS-YCM-02 RS-YCM-03 RS-YCM-04

A R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2

B 8 11 11,5 14

CH 13 17 20 25

q.ty 25 25 20 10

TYPE RS-YF-01 RS-YF-02 RS-YF-03 RS-YF-04

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

B 8 11 11,5 14

CH 13 17 20 25

q.ty 25 25 20 10

G M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

CH1 14 22 27 32 36

CH2 14 19 24 30 32

q.ty 50 50 50 25 20

FEMALE Y

FEMALE BULKHEAD CONNECTOR TYPE RS-PF-M5 RS-PF-01 RS-PF-02 RS-PF-03 RS-PF-04

Standard fittings series RS

L 14 18 25 26 33

A B M10x1 10,5 M16x1,5 14 M20x1,5 21 M26x1,5 21 M28x1,5 27

5.33

5


RS

Standard fittings

series

PARALLEL MALE HOSE ADAPTER

5

TYPE RS-PM-4,5/M5 RS-PM-6/01 RS-PM-6/02 RS-PM-7/01 RS-PM-7/02 RS-PM-8/01 RS-PM-8/02 RS-PM-8/03 RS-PM-9/01 RS-PM-9/02 RS-PM-9/03 RS-PM-10/01 RS-PM-10/02 RS-PM-10/03 RS-PM-12/02 RS-PM-12/03 RS-PM-12/04 RS-PM-14/03 RS-PM-14/04 RS-PM-17/03 RS-PM-17/04 RS-PM-18/06 RS-PM-20/04 RS-PM-20/06

L 22,5 29,5 32 29,5 32 29,5 32 33 29,5 32 33 30,5 33 34 33 34 35,5 36 37,5 38 39,5 41,5 39,5 41,5

A M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1/2 G3/4

B 4 6 8 6 8 6 8 9 6 8 9 6 8 9 8 9 10 9 10 9 10 11 10 11

C 15 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 20 20 20 20 20 20 22 22 24 24 24 24 24

LW 4,5 6 6 7 7 8 8 8 9 9 9 10 10 10 12 12 12 14 14 17 17 18 20 20

CH 8 12 14 12 14 12 14 19 12 14 19 12 14 19 14 19 22 19 22 19 22 30 22 30

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 20 25 20

TYPE RS-PG-6/01 RS-PG-6/01A RS-PG-6/02 RS-PG-7/01 RS-PG-7/01A RS-PG-7/02

L 18,5 23 23 18,5 23 23

L2 22,5 22,5 23 22,5 22,5 23

B 8 8 11 8 8 11

R R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4

LW 6 6 6 7 7 7

CH 8 8 9 8 8 9

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50

TAPER ELBOW HOSE ADAPTER

5.34

Standard fittings series RS


RS

Standard fittings

series

TAPER MALE HOSE ADAPTER TYPE RS1-PM-6/01 RS1-PM-6/02 RS1-PM-7/01 RS1-PM-7/02 RS1-PM-8/01 RS1-PM-8/02 RS1-PM-9/01 RS1-PM-9/02 RS1-PM-9/03 RS1-PM-9/04 RS1-PM-10/01 RS1-PM-10/02 RS1-PM-10/03 RS1-PM-10/04 RS1-PM-12/02 RS1-PM-12/03 RS1-PM-12/04 RS1-PM-14/03 RS1-PM-14/04 RS1-PM-16/03 RS1-PM-16/04 RS1-PM-16/06 RS1-PM-17/03 RS1-PM-17/04 RS1-PM-18/03 RS1-PM-18/04 RS1-PM-18/06 RS1-PM-20/03 RS1-PM-20/04 RS1-PM-20/06 RS1-PM-25/06 RS1-PM-25/08

Standard fittings series RS

L 31,5 35 31,5 35 31,5 35 31,5 35 35,5 38,5 32,5 36 36,5 39,5 36 36,5 39,5 38,5 41,5 38,5 41,5 45 40,5 43,5 40,5 43,5 47 41 43,5 46,5 53 56

A R1/8 R1/4 R1/8 R1/4 R1/8 R1/4 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/4 R3/4 R1

B 8 11 8 11 8 11 8 11 11,5 14 8 11 11,5 14 11 11,5 14 11,5 14 11,5 14 16,5 11,5 14 11,5 14 16,5 11,5 14 16,5 16,5 19

C 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 22 22 22 22 22 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 30 30

LW 6 6 7 7 8 8 9 9 9 9 10 10 10 10 12 12 12 14 14 16 16 16 17 17 18 18 18 20 20 20 25 25

CH 12 14 12 12 12 14 12 14 17 22 12 14 17 22 14 17 22 17 22 17 22 27 18 22 19 22 27 22 22 27 27 34

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 20 20 10

5.35

5


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

TECHNICAL DATA Material Thread Size Max. pressure Recommended tubes materials

5

Nickel plated brass Metric, taper and parallel M5 ÷ G1/2 60 bar Polyamide, polyethylene, polyurethane

TAPER STRAIGHT MALE TYPE RC1-DM-4/01 RC1-DM-5/01 RC1-DM-6/01 RC1-DM-6/02 RC1-DM-6/03 RC1-DM-8/01 RC1-DM-8/02 RC1-DM-8/03 RC1-DM-8/04 RC1-DM-10/01 RC1-DM-10/02 RC1-DM-10/03 RC1-DM-10/04 RC1-DM-12/03 RC1-DM-12/04 RC1-DM-15/04

L 23,8 25 27,5 31 31,5 27,5 31 31,5 34,5 29,5 32,5 33 36 34,5 37,5 39,5

TYPE RC-DM-5/01 RC-DM-6/01 RC-DM-6/02 RC-DM-6/03 RC-DM-8/01 RC-DM-8/02 RC-DM-8/03 RC-DM-10/01 RC-DM-10/02 RC-DM-10/03 RC-DM-10/04 RC-DM-12/03 RC-DM-12/04 RC-DM-15/04

L 23 25,5 28 29 25,5 28 29 27 29,5 30,5 32 32 33,5 35,5

A R1/8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2

B ØD CH1 8 4/2,7 8 8 5/3 8 8 6/4 12 11 6/4 12 11,5 6/4 12 8 8/6 14 11 8/6 14 11,5 8/6 14 14 8/6 14 8 10/8 16 11 10/8 16 11,5 10/8 16 14 10/8 16 11,5 12/10 18 14 12/10 18 14 15/12,5 22

CH2 12 12 12 14 17 12 14 17 22 14 14 17 22 17 22 22

q.tà 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 20 20 10

ØD CH1 CH2 5/3 8 14 6/4 12 14 6/4 12 17 6/4 12 19 8/6 14 14 8/6 14 17 8/6 14 19 10/8 16 14 10/8 16 17 10/8 16 19 10/8 16 24 12/10 18 19 12/10 18 24 15/12,5 22 24

q.tà 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 20 20 10

PARALLEL STRAIGHT MALE

5.36

Push-on brass fittings series RC

A G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8 G1/2 G1/2

B 6 6 8 9 6 8 9 6 8 9 10 9 10 10


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

PARALLEL STRAIGHT FEMALE TYPE RC-DF-4/01 RC-DF-5/01 RC-DF-6/01 RC-DF-6/02 RC-DF-6/03 RC-DF-8/01 RC-DF-8/02 RC-DF-8/03 RC-DF-10/01 RC-DF-10/02 RC-DF-10/03 RC-DF-10/04 RC-DF-12/03

L 21,3 22,5 25 29 29,5 25 29 29,5 26,5 30,5 31 34,5 32,5

A G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/8

B 8 8 8 11 11,5 8 11 11,5 8 11 11,5 14 11,5

ØD 4/2,7 5/3 6/4 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 8/6 10/8 10/8 10/8 10/8 12/10

CH1 8 8 12 12 12 14 14 14 16 16 16 16 18

CH2 14 14 14 17 20 14 17 20 14 17 20 24 20

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 20 20

H/max 8,5 8,5 10,5 10,5 8,5 8,5 8,5

CH1 8 8 12 14 16 18 22

CH2 8 9 14 16 17 19 24

q.ty 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

BULKHEAD CONNECTOR TYPE RC-P4 RC-P5 RC-P6 RC-P8 RC-P10 RC-P12 RC-P15

L 36,7 40 48 48 50 53 58

ØD 4/2,7 5/3 6/4 8/6 10/8 12/10 15/12,5

UNION STRAIGHT TYPE RC-DI-4 RC-DI-5 RC-DI-6 RC-DI-8/6 RC-DI-8 RC-DI-10 RC-DI-12 RC-DI-15

Push-on brass fittings series RC

L ØD 26,1 4/2,7 28,5 5/3 34,5 6/4 35 8/6 x 6/4 35 8/6 38 10/8 41 12/10 45,5 15/12,5

CH1 8 8 12 14 14 16 18 22

CH2 8 8 12 14 14 16 17 22

CH3 8 8 12 12 14 14 18 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 10

5.37

5


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

TAPER ELBOW MALE

5

TYPE RC1-G-4/01 RC1-G-5/01 RC1-G-6/01 RC1-G-6/02 RC1-G-6/03 RC1-G-8/01 RC1-G-8/02 RC1-G-8/03 RC1-G-10/01 RC1-G-10/02 RC1-G-10/03 RC1-G-10/04 RC1-G-12/02 RC1-G-12/03 RC1-G-12/04 RC1-G-15/04

L 19,5 21,5 22,5 22,5 23,5 22,5 22,5 24 25,5 25,5 25,5 28 30 30 30,5 34

A R1/8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2

TYPE RC-GG-4/01 RC-GG-6/01 RC-GG-6/02 RC-GG-8/01 RC-GG-8/02 RC-GG-10/02

L 21,5 22,5 23,5 23,5 23,5 25,5

A G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

B 8 8 8 11 11,5 8 11 11,5 8 11 11,5 14 11 11,5 14 14

C ØD CH1 17 4/2,7 8 17 5/3 8 17 6/4 12 20 6/4 12 22,5 6/4 12 17 8/6 14 20 8/6 14 20 8/6 14 22,5 10/8 16 18,5 10/8 16 21,5 10/8 16 28 10/8 16 24 12/10 18 24,5 12/10 18 28 12/10 18 28 15/12,5 22

CH2 8 8 8 10 11 10 10 11 11 11 11 17 14 14 17 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 20 20 20 10

C 22,5 22,5 25 22,5 25 25,5

CH2 14 14 17 14 17 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25

PARALLEL SWIVEL ELBOW WITH O-RING B 6 6 8 6 8 8

ØD 4/2,7 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 10/8

CH1 12 12 12 14 14 16

PARALLEL ELBOW FEMALE TYPE RC-GF-5/01 RC-GF-6/01 RC-GF-6/02 RC-GF-8/01 RC-GF-8/02 RC-GF-10/02 RC-GF-12/03

5.38

Push-on brass fittings series RC

L 21,5 22,5 25 22,5 25 26 30,5

A G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G3/8

B 8 8 10,5 8 10,5 11 11,5

C 19 19 23 19 23 23,5 28

ØD 5/3 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 10/8 12/10

CH1 8 12 12 14 14 16 18

CH2 10 10 11 10 11 13 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 20


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

UNION ELBOW TYPE RC-GI-4 RC-GI-5 RC-GI-6 RC-GI-8/6 RC-GI-8 RC-GI-10 RC-GI-12 RC-GI-15

L 20,3 21,5 21,5 22,5 22,5 25,5 30 34

ØD CH1 4/2,7 8 5/3 8 6/4 12 8/6 12 8/6 14 10/8 16 12/10 18 15/12,5 22

CH2 8 8 8 10 10 11 14 17

CH3 8 8 12 14 14 16 18 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

TAPER CENTRAL MALE TEE TYPE RC1-TC-4/01 RC1-TC-5/M5 RC1-TC-5/01 RC1-TC-6/01 RC1-TC-6/02 RC1-TC-6/03 RC1-TC-8/01 RC1-TC-8/02 RC1-TC-8/03 RC1-TC-10/01 RC1-TC-10/02 RC1-TC-10/03 RC1-TC-10/04 RC1-TC-12/03 RC1-TC-12/04 RC1-TC-15/04

L 40,6 43 43 45 45,5 47 45,5 45,5 48 51 51 51 57 60 61 68

A B R1/8 8 M5 4 R1/8 8 R1/8 8 R1/4 11 R3/8 11,5 R1/8 8 R1/4 11 R3/8 11,5 R1/8 8 R1/4 11 R3/8 11,5 R1/2 14 R3/8 11,5 R1/2 14 R1/2 14

C ØD CH1 17 4/2,7 8 15 5/3 8 17 5/3 8 17 6/4 11 20,5 6/4 11 22,5 6/4 12 17,5 8/6 14 20,5 8/6 14 21,5 8/6 14 18,5 10/8 16 21,5 10/8 16 22,5 10/8 16 28 10/8 16 22,5 12/10 18 28 12/10 18 28 15/12,5 22

CH2 8 8 8 8 10 11 10 10 11 11 11 11 17 14 17 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 20 20 10

PARALLEL SWIVELLING CENTRAL MALE TEE TYPE RC-TG-4/01 RC-TG-6/01 RC-TG-6/02 RC-TG-8/02 RC-TG-10/02

Push-on brass fittings series RC

L 45 45 45,5 45,5 51

A G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4 G1/4

B 6 6 8 8 8

C 25,7 25,7 29 28 29

ØD 4/2,7 6/4 6/4 8/6 10/8

CH1 8 12 12 14 16

CH2 13 13 16 16 16

q.ty 25 25 20 20 10

5.39

5


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

TAPER LATERAL MALE TEE TYPE RC1-TL-4/01 RC1-TL-5/M5 RC1-TL-5/01 RC1-TL-6/01 RC1-TL-6/02 RC1-TL-6/03 RC1-TL-8/01 RC1-TL-8/02 RC1-TL-8/03 RC1-TL-10/01 RC1-TL-10/02 RC1-TL-10/03 RC1-TL-10/04 RC1-TL-12/03 RC1-TL-12/04 RC1-TL-15/04

5

L 38 36,5 38,5 39,5 42,5 46,5 40,5 43,5 46,5 44 46,5 48 57 54,5 58,5 62

A R1/8 M5 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2

B 8 4 8 8 11 11,5 8 11 11,5 8 11 11,5 14 11,5 14 14

C ØD CH 1 CH 2 21,5 4/2,7 8 8 21,5 5/3 8 8 21,5 5/3 8 8 22,5 6/4 11 8 22,5 6/4 11 10 24 6/4 12 11 22,5 8/6 14 10 22,5 8/6 14 10 23,5 8/6 14 11 25,5 10/8 16 11 25,5 10/8 16 11 25,5 10/8 16 11 29 10/8 16 17 30 12/10 18 14 30,5 12/10 18 17 34 15/12,5 22 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25 25 20 20 10

UNION TEE TYPE RC-TI-4 RC-TI-5 RC-TI-6 RC-TI-8/6 RC-TI-8 RC-TI-10 RC-TI-12 RC-TI-15

L 20,3 43 45 45 45 51 60 68

C ØD CH 1 CH 2 20,3 4/2,7 8 8 21,5 5/3 8 8 22,5 6/4 12 8 22,5 8/6 14 10 22,5 8/6 12 10 25,5 10/8 16 11 30 12/10 18 14 34 15/12,5 22 17

CH 3 8 8 12 14 14 16 18 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 25 20 10

CH 2 8 8 10 11

q.ty 20 20 20 10

CROSS CONNECTOR TYPE RC-C-5 RC-C-6 RC-C-8 RC-C-10

5.40

Push-on brass fittings series RC

L 43 45 45 51

ØD 5/3 6/4 8/6 10/8

CH 1 8 12 14 16


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

SINGLE BANJO STEM TYPE RC-VBS-M5 RC-VBS-M6 RC-VBS-01 RC-VBS-02

L 18 18,5 27 29,5

A M5 M6 G1/8 G1/4

B 6 6 8 11

C 14,5 14,5 23 25

CH 8 8 14 17

q.ty 50 50 50 50

TYPE RC-VBD-01 RC-VBD-02

L 43 45,5

A G1/8 G1/4

B 8 11

C 39 41

CH 14 17

q.ty 50 50

DOUBLE BANJO STEM

LOCKING NUT TYPE A RC-DS-4/M6 4/2,7 RC-DS-6/M8 6/4 RC-DS-6/M10 6/4 RC-DS-8/M12 8/6 RC-DS-10/M14 10/8 RC-DS-12/M16 12/10 RC-DS-15/M20 15/12,5

Push-on brass fittings series RC

B 8,1 9 10,5 10,5 11,5 13 15,5

D M6x0,5 M8x0,75 M10x1 M12x1 M14x1 M16x1 M20x1

CH q.ty 8 50 9 50 12 50 14 50 16 25 18 20 22 10

5.41

5


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

SINGLE BANJO BODY

5

TYPE RC-CBS-4/M5 RC-CBS-4/M6 RC-CBS-4/01 RC-CBS-5/M5 RC-CBS-5/01 RC-CBS-6/M5 RC-CBS-6/01 RC-CBS-6/02 RC-CBS-8/01 RC-CBS-8/02 RC-CBS-10/02

L 15,8 15,8 21,3 17 22,5 18 24 26 24 26 27,5

ØA M5 M6 G1/8 M5 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

B 9 9 14,5 9 14,5 9 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5

ØD 4/2,7 4/2,7 4/2,7 5/3 5/3 6/4 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 10/8

CH 8 8 8 8 8 9 12 12 14 14 16

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 25

TYPE RC-CBD-4/01 RC-CBD-5/01 RC-CBD-6/01 RC-CBD-6/02 RC-CBD-8/01 RC-CBD-8/02 RC-CBD-10/02

L 42,6 45 48 52 48 52 55

ØA G1/8 G1/8 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G1/4

B 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5 14,5

ØD 4/2,7 5/3 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 10/8

CH 8 8 12 12 14 14 16

q.ty 50 50 50 50 50 50 25

TYPE RC-CBF-01 RC-CBF-02 RC-CBF-03

L 20 24,5 29

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8

ØB G1/8 G1/4 G3/8

ØC 14 18 21

H 14,5 17,5 21

q.ty 25 25 20

DOUBLE BANJO BODY

FEMALE BANJO BODY

5.42

Push-on brass fittings series RC


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

QUICK COUPLER WITH SPRING TYPE RC-G-6/M10 RC-G-8/M12 RC-G-10/M14 RC-G-12/M16

L 95 93,5 96,5 106

A Ø M10x1 6/4 M12x1 8/6 M14x1 10/8 M16x1 12/10

CH 12 14 16 18

q.ty 10 10 10 10

TAPER FIXED STRAIGHT MALE ADAPTER + NUT WITH SPRING TYPE RC1-DFM-6/01 RC1-DFM-6/02 RC1-DFM-8/01 RC1-DFM-8/02 RC1-DFM-8/03 RC1-DFM-8/04 RC1-DFM-10/01 RC1-DFM-10/02 RC1-DFM-10/03 RC1-DFM-10/04 RC1-DFM-12/03 RC1-DFM-12/04

L 109,5 113 124,5 128 128,5 131,5 123 125 125,5 130 134,5 140

B 8 11 8 11 11,5 14 8 11 11,5 14 11,5 14

R 1/8 1/4 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/8 1/2

Ø 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 8/6 8/6 10/8 10/8 10/8 10/8 12/10 12/10

CH 12 14 12 14 17 22 14 14 17 22 17 22

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

TYPE RC-DFM-6/01 RC-DFM-6/02 RC-DFM-6/03 RC-DFM-6/04 RC-DFM-8/01 RC-DFM-8/02 RC-DFM-8/03 RC-DFM-8/04 RC-DFM-10/01 RC-DFM-10/02 RC-DFM-10/03 RC-DFM-10/04 RC-DFM-12/03 RC-DFM-12/04

L 111 111 112 113 110 111 112 113 116 117 118,5 119 129 130

B 6 8 9 10 6 8 9 10 6 8 9 10 9 10

G 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/8 1/2

Ø 6/4 6/4 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 8/6 8/6 10/8 10/8 10/8 10/8 12/10 12/10

CH 13 16 19 24 14 16 19 24 14 16 19 24 19 24

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

PARALLEL FIXED STRAIGHT MALE ADAPTER + NUT WITH SPRING

Push-on brass fittings series RC

5.43

5


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

TAPER SWIVEL STRAIGHT MALE ADAPTER + NUT WITH SPRING TYPE RC1-DGM-6/01 RC1-DGM-6/02 RC1-DGM-8/01 RC1-DGM-8/02 RC1-DGM-8/01A RC1-DGM-8/02A RC1-DGM-10/02 RC1-DGM-10/02A RC1-DGM-12/03 RC1-DGM-12/03A

L 116,9 118,9 122,4 124,4 122,4 124,4 132,4 132,4 141,9 141,9

R Ø CH1 1/8 6/4 15 1/4 6/4 15 1/8 *8/5 16 1/4 *8/5 13 1/8 8/6 16 1/4 8/6 16 1/4 *10/6,5 16 1/4 10/8 13 3/8 *12/8 16 3/8 12/10 16

CH2 13 13 16 13 16 16 16 13 16 16

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

CH2 13 13 16 13 16 16 16 13 16 16

q.ty 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10

M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4

q.ty 100 100 100 100 100 100

* Specific dimensions for PU tube

5

PARALLEL SWIVEL STRAIGHT MALE ADAPTER + NUT WITH SPRING TYPE RC-DGM-6/01 RC-DGM-6/02 RC-DGM-8/01 RC-DGM-8/02 RC-DGM-8/01A RC-DGM-8/02A RC-DGM-10/02 RC-DGM-10/02A RC-DGM-12/03 RC-DGM-12/03A

L 116,9 118,9 122,4 124,4 122,4 124,4 132,4 132,4 141,9 141,9

G Ø CH1 1/8 6/4 13 1/4 6/4 13 1/8 *8/5 16 1/4 *8/5 13 1/8 8/6 16 1/4 8/6 16 1/4 *10/6,5 16 1/4 10/8 13 3/8 *12/8 16 3/8 12/10 16

* Specific dimensions for PU tube

WASHER TYPE RO-RD-M5 RO-RD-01 RO-RD-02 RO-RD-03 RO-RD-04 RO-RD-06

ØB 7,7 13 17,9 21,8 26,5 32,4

ØD 5,3 10,2 13,4 17,1 21,3 26,7

H 1 1,5 2 2 2 2

For banjo stem type RC-VBS,RO-VBS and RO-VBD, order No. 2 spacers type RO-RD, to be fitted as follow: one under the head of the screw, and one under the last banjo.

TYPE RO-DIS-01 RO-DIS-02

Spacer for RO-VB and RC-VBD* ØB ØD H 14 10,2 5 G1/8 17,5 13,2 5 G1/4

* To be fitted between the two rings.

5.44

Push-on brass fittings series RC

q.ty 50 50


RC

Push-on brass fittings

series

UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR FOR VALVE (IN) TYPE RC-RV-5/M5 RC-RV-5/01 RC-RV-6/M5 RC-RV-6/01 RC-RV-6/02 RC-RV-8/01 RC-RV-8/02

L 24,5 31,5 24,5 31,5 38 31,5 38

A M5 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4

B 4 5,5 4 5,5 6 5,5 6

D 15 23 15 23 26 23 26

Ø 5/3 5/3 6/4 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6

NI/min* CH1 45 8 310 8 45 9 310 10 420 10 310 12 420 12

CH2 8 14 8 14 17 14 17

q.ty 25 25 25 25 25 25 25

A M5 G1/8 M5 G1/8 G1/4 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8

B 4 5,5 4 5,5 6 5,5 6 7

D 15 23 15 23 26 23 26 26

Ø 5/3 5/3 6/4 6/4 6/4 8/6 8/6 8/6

NI/min* CH1 45 8 310 8 45 9 310 10 420 10 310 12 420 12 500 12

CH2 8 14 8 14 17 14 17 20

q.ty 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25

* Nominal flow rate at 6 bar

UNIDIRECTIONAL FLOW REGULATOR FOR CYLINDER (OUT) TYPE RC-RC-5/M5 RC-RC-5/01 RC-RC-6/M5 RC-RC-6/01 RC-RC-6/02 RC-RC-8/01 RC-RC-8/02 RC-RC-8/03

L 24,5 34 24,5 31,5 38 31,5 38 47

* Nominal flow rate at 6 bar

Push-on brass fittings series RC

5.45

5


VS

Mini ball-valves

series

TECHNICAL DATA Body Ball Lever Seals O-Ring Surface treatment Thread Max. pressure Working temperature Acuation Nominal orifice Flow direction

5

Nickel-plated brass Hard chromium-plated brass Polyamide Polytetrafluoroethylene NBR rubber Chromium- plating Parallel (BSPP) and taper (BSPT): 1/8 ÷ 3/4 20 bar -18 ÷ +80 °C 90° 5 ÷ 14 mm Bidirectional

FEMALE/FEMALE WITH HEXAGONAL BODY TYPE VSR-FF-01 VSR-FF-02 VSR-FF-03 VSR-FF-04 VSR-FF-06

L 40 40 40 46 52

TYPE VSR-MF-01 VSR-MF-02 VSR-MF-03 VSR-MF-04 VSR-MF-06

L 40 39 40 48 54

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4

D 30 22 22 22 22

E 38 38 38 42 48

F 21 21 21 25 30

Ø 6 8 8 10 14

CH 21 21 21 25 30

q.ty 20 20 20 20 15

D 30 22 22 22 22

E 38 38 38 42 48

F 21 21 21 25 30

Ø 6 8 8 10 14

CH 21 21 21 25 30

q.ty 20 20 20 20 15

MALE/FEMALE WITH HEXAGONAL BODY

5.46

Mini ball-valves series VS

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4


VS

Mini ball-valves

series

FEMALE/FEMALE TYPE VS-FF-01 VS-FF-02 VS-FF-03 VS-FF-04

L 36,5 43 48 59

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

P1 8 11 11,5 16

P2 8 11 16 23

D 19 19 18 25

E 21,5 21,5 22,5 32

Ø 5,5 5,5 7 10

CH 14 14 18 22

q.ty 20 20 20 20

MALE/FEMALE WITH TAPER THREAD TYPE VS1-MF-01 VS1-MF-02 VS1-MF-03 VS1-MF-04

L 35,5 40,5 48 58

A R1/8 R1/4 R3/8 R1/2

A1 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

D 19 19 19 26

E 21,5 21,5 22,5 32

P1 8 11 13 17

P2 8 11 16 23

Ø 5,5 5,5 8 10

CH 14 14 18 22

q.ty 20 20 20 20

TYPE VS-MF-01 VS-MF-02 VS-MF-03 VS-MF-04

L 34,5 35,5 37,5 38,5

A G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

A1 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

D 19 19 19 19

E 21,5 21,5 21,5 21,5

P1 7 8 8 8

P2 8 8 11 11

Ø 5,5 5,5 5,5 5,5

CH 14 14 14 14

q.ty 20 20 20 20

MALE/FEMALE WITH PARALLEL THREAD

Mini ball-valves series VS

5.47

5


Silencers PARALLEL SILENCER TYPE ES8/N ES4/N ES3/N ES2/N ES15/N ES1/N

5

A 15,5 19,5 24,5 24,5 48 48

C 6 8 11 11 18 18

D 26,5 35 47 47 97 97

G 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1

q.ty 100 100 50 50 10 10

CH 9 12 16 19 22

q.ty 50 50 50 50 20

CH 10 13 17 22 24 30 36

q.ty 100 50 50 50 50 50 50

FLAT SILENCER TYPE SP-M5 SP-01 SP-02 SP-03 SP-04

L 9,5 11 14,5 17 19

B 5 6 8,5 10 11

ØD 6,4 10 13 16 17

G M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2

CONICAL SILENCER TYPE SC-M5 SC-01 SC-02 SC-03 SC-04 SC-06 SC-08

5.48

Silencers

L 20 24 33 44 49 57 72

B 3,5 4 4 5 6,5 7,5 8,5

ØD 5,5 8 11 14 18 21 27

F 5 6 8 10 10 11 15,5

R M5 G1/8 G1/4 G3/8 G1/2 G3/4 G1


T

Polyurethane tubes (PU 98 ShA)

series DESCRIPTION Polyurethane tubes type T-PU have been designed to satisfy the needs of “heavy duty” applications such oleo-dynamics, robotics, pneumatic, tools & industrial machinery thanks to their outstanding technical features. These tubes show very high flexibility to low temperatures, low sensibility to “click” and “stress cracking” effects, excellent resistance to abrasion, good resistance to atnospheric agents, good aging, extremely resistant to exertion.

TECHNICAL DATA Working temperature Hardness Density Elongation at break Tear resistance Flexural modulus Abrasion loss Break resistance

-20 ÷ +70°C 98 ShA/52ShD 1.22 g/cm3 500 % 130 N/mm 140 MPa 25 mm3 55 MPa

MATERIALS Tube Standard colour Alternative colours upon request

Poliurethane 98 ShA Sky-Blue (SB) Red (R) - Green (G) - Yellow (Y) - Sky-Blue (SB) Cyan (CN) - Black (BK) - Grey (GY) - Natural (N)

5

MEAN FEATURES TUBES T-PU Ø (mm) External

Internal

4 6 8 8 8 10 10 10 12

2 4 5 5,5 6 7 7,5 8 9

BURSTING PRESSURE (bar) 23°C

WORKING PRESSURE (bar) 23°C

BENDING RAY (mm)

REELS LENGHT (m)

60 40 52 40 28 35 30 27 25

15 10 13 10 7 8,5 7,5 5,5 6

11 18 25 30 35 30 40 45 50

100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100

TYPE

T-PU-4X2 T-PU-6X4 T-PU-8X5 T-PU-8X5,5 T-PU-8X6 T-PU-10X7 T-PU-10X7,5 T-PU-10X8 T-PU-12X9

P.S.: Please specify the colour of the tube with the order

ALTERATION SCALE ACCORDING TO TEMPERATURE -20°C

0°C

+23°C

+30°C

+40°C

+50°C

+60°C

1,87

1,4

1

0,84

0,70

0,60

0,52

P.S.: This information is only indicative. The validation of the application is at the user charge. For this kind of tubing the manifacturer suggests to use a working pressure of 1/4 than the bursting pressure. These tubing respect the tolerance indicated in the DIN 73 873 standard

ATTENTION The use of this tubing typology with continuous pulsing pressure can create heat accumulation, although it is particulary resistant to labour and tension flexions. Polyurethane is generally resistant to ozone, oil, fats, fuels and chemical solutions. Poyurethane is not resistant, or low resistant, to concentrate acids, keton, hydrocarbon and chloride.

Polyurethane tubes series T

5.49


T

Polyamide tubes (PA12)

series

DESCRIPTION Polyamide tubes type T-PA12 are for technical applications due to theirs characteristics of flexibility and mechanical performances. These tubes show high mechanical properties to traction and to continuous & alternate flexion, notable flexibility, good stability to heat, remarkable resistance to aging, low water absorption, remarkable resistance to hydrocarbons and oils and good inertness to chemical agents. This kind of materil is particularly indicated for the accomplishment os tubing for pneumatics, robotics, steel, industrial machinery, etc., when there is the necessity to remarkeable flexibility.

TECHNICAL DATA Working temperature Hardness Density Elongation at break Resistenza a strappo Flexural modulus

5

-40 ÷ +70°C 65 ShD 1.03 g/cm3 > 300 % 130 N/mm 410 MPa

MATERIALS Tube Standard colour Alternative colours upon request

Polyamide (PA12) Sky Blue (SB) Red (R) - Green (G) - Yellow (Y) - Blue (B) - Orange (O) Sky-Blue (SB) - Black (BK) - Grey (GY) Natural (N) - Brown (M)

MAIN FEATURES TUBES T-PA12 Ø (mm) External

Internal

4 4 4 6 8 10 12

2 2,5 2,7 4 6 8 10

BURSTING PRESSURE (bar) 23°C

WORKING PRESSURE (bar) 23°C

BENDING RAY (mm)

REELS LENGTH (m)

130 108 78 81 60 45 39

44 36 26 27 20 15 13

15 20 25 30 40 60 85

100 100 100 100 100 100 100

TYPE

T-PA12-4X2 T-PA12-4X2,5 T-PA12-4X2,7 T-PA12-6X4 T-PA12-8X6 T-PA12-10X8 T-PA12-12X10

P.S.: Please specify the colour of the tube with the order

ALTERATION SCALE ACCORDING TO TEMPERATURE -20°C

0°C

+23°C

+30°C

+40°C

+50°C

+60°C

1,87

1,4

1

0,80

0,65

0,55

0,45

P.S.: This information is only indicative. The validation of the application is at the user charge. For this kind of tubing the manifacturer suggests to use a working pressure of 1/4 than the bursting pressure. These tubing respect the tolerance indicated in the DIN 73 873 standard

5.50

Polyamide tubes series T


T

Polyethylene tubes (LDPE)

series DESCRIPTION Polyethylene tubes type T-PELD are particularly indicated for all applications where there are not specific problems pressures and very high temperatures, as for example for water treatment, chemical industry, agriculture, irrigation applications and compressed air. They are even suitable for alimentary applications and food contact, complying with the D.M. 21/03/73 and following adjournments, the Directive 90/128/CEE, the FDA 21 CFR 177.1520, and even European Pharacopoeia. These tubes are totally recyclable and show high impact resistance, low sensibility to “click” and “stress cracking” effect, excellent resistance to chemical agents, good electrical properties, optimal flexibility.

TECHNICAL DATA Working temperature Density Elongation at break Tear resistance Impact resistance Flexural modulus Tensile strenght at break

-20 ÷ +60°C 0.921 g/cm3 400 % 30 N/mm 310 g 100 MPa 26 MPa

MATERIALS Tube Standard colour Alternative colours upon request

Polyethylene low density (LDPE) Sky-Blue (SB) Red (R) - Green (G) - Yellow (Y) - Blue (B) Sky-Blue (SB) - Black (BK) - Grey (GY) - Natural (N)

5

MAIN FEATURES TUBES T-PELD Ø (mm) External

Internal

4 4 5 6 6,35 8 9,54 10 12 12 12

2 2,5 3 4 4,35 6 6,36 8 8 9 10

BURSTING PRESSURE (bar) 23°C

WORKING PRESSURE (bar) 23°C

BENDING RAY (mm)

REELS LENGTH (m)

75 60 50 40 36 30 40 25 30 28 20

18,5 15 12,5 10 9 7,5 10 6 7,5 7 5

20 25 30 40 50 50 100 120 160 120 120

100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100

TYPE

T-PELD-4X2 T-PELD-4X2,5 T-PELD-5X3 T-PELD-6X4 T-PELD-6,35X4,35 T-PELD-8X6 T-PELD-9,54X6,36 T-PELD-10X8 T-PELD-12X8 T-PELD-12X9 T-PELD-12X10

P.S.: Please specify the colour of the tube with the order

ALTERATION SCALE ACCORDING TO TEMPERATURE -20°C

0°C

+23°C

+30°C

+40°C

+50°C

+60°C

1,87

1,4

1

0,80

0,60

0,50

0,40

P.S.: This information is only indicative. The validation of the application is at the user charge. For this kind of tubing the manifacturer suggests to use a working pressure of 1/4 than the bursting pressure. These tubing respect the tolerance indicated in the DIN 73 873 standard

ATTENTION It is recommended to avoid connecting the polyethylene tubing with fittings that may deform its extremity, because this material does not resist to enlargements approximately over 15%. “Creep” problems could occur with non-suitable fittings.

Polyethylene tubes series T

5.51


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM Ø/BM/Z/mm Ø/BP/Z/mm Ø/stroke CPA/M Ø/stroke CPA/M Ø/stroke CPU Ø/stroke CPU Ø/stroke CPU/FM Ø/stroke CPU/FM Ø/stroke CPUI/M Ø/stroke CPUI/M Ø/stroke CPUI/MZ Ø/stroke CPUI/N Ø/stroke CPUI/N Ø/stroke CPUI/N _ 2 Ø/stroke CPUI/NZ Ø/stroke CPUI/Z Ø/stroke CX Ø/stroke CX Ø/stroke CX/FM Ø/stroke CX/FM Ø/stroke DB Ø/stroke DB Ø/stroke DB/M Ø/stroke DB/M Ø/stroke DBA Ø/stroke DBA/M Ø/stroke DBA_ Ø/stroke DBG_2 Ø/stroke DBGB Ø/stroke DBGB Ø/stroke DBGM Ø/stroke DBGM Ø/stroke DBU/M7 Ø/stroke DBU/M7 Ø/stroke DBU/M8 Ø/stroke DBU/M8 Ø/stroke DBU7 Ø/stroke DBU7 Ø/stroke DBU8 Ø/stroke DBUA/M8 Ø/stroke DBUA8 Ø/stroke DBUI Ø/stroke DBUI/M Ø/stroke DBUI/M7 Ø/stroke DBUI/M8 Ø/stroke DBUI7 Ø/stroke DBUI8 Ø/stroke DBUIA Ø/stroke DBUIA/M Ø/stroke DBUIA/M7 Ø/stroke DBUIA/M7 Ø/stroke DBUIA/M8 Ø/stroke DBUIA7 Ø/stroke DBUIA8 Ø/stroke DCB Ø/stroke DCB Ø/stroke DFAB Ø/stroke DFAB Ø/stroke DFPB Ø/stroke DPB Ø/stroke DVB Ø/stroke P _ _ _2 Ø/stroke P_ _ _1 Ø/stroke P_ _X Ø/stroke PDC

a

PAGE 1.75 1.75 1.38 1.38 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.24 1.47 1.25 1.24 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.24 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.51 1.59 1.51 1.59 1.51 1.51 1.59 1.59 1.51 1.67 1.51 1.67 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.8

ITEM Ø/stroke PDC Ø/stroke PDC Ø/stroke PDE Ø/stroke PDX Ø/stroke PSC Ø/stroke PSE Ø/stroke PYC Ø/stroke PYE Ø/stroke SB_ Ø/stroke SBU_ _ Ø/stroke SCB Ø/stroke SCB Ø/stroke SFAB Ø/stroke SFAB Ø/stroke SFPB Ø/stroke SFPB Ø/stroke SPB Ø/stroke SPB Ø/stroke SVB Ø/stroke SVB Ø/stroke U_ _ _ _2 Ø/stroke U_ _ _A Ø/stroke U_ _ _Z Ø/stroke U_ _X Ø/stroke UDC Ø/stroke UDE Ø/stroke UPDC Ø/stroke UPDE Ø/stroke USC Ø/stroke USE Ø/stroke UYC Ø/stroke UYE Ø/stroke X/M Ø/stroke X/N Ø/stroke YB_ Ø/stroke YBU_ _ Ø/stroke YCB Ø/stroke YFAB Ø/stroke YFPB Ø/stroke YPB Ø/stroke YVB Ø/stroke Z_ _1 Ø/stroke Z_ _2 Ø/stroke ZK Ø/stroke ZK Ø/stroke ZKF Ø/stroke ZKF Ø/stroke ZS Ø/stroke ZSF Ø/stroke ZSFF Ø/stroke_B_ _ _2 Ø/stroke_B_ _1 Ø/stroke_BUA_ _8 Ø/stroke_CBC Ø/stroke_FPBC Ø/strokeX/_ _ _4 Ø/strokeX/_Z Ø/strokeX/N_2 Ø/SG/BG Ø/SG/BG Ø/SG/BU Ø/SG/BU Ø/SG/BU2 Ø/SG/BU2 Ø/SG/CPA/M

PAGE 1.8 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.59 1.51 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.15 1.15 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.21 1.21 1.69 1.51 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.75 1.59 1.59 1.51 1.69 1.69 1.21 1.21 1.21 1.67 1.67 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.38

ITEM Ø/SG/CPU Ø/SG/CPU Ø/SG/CPU/FM Ø/SG/CPU/FM Ø/SG/CPU2 Ø/SG/CPU2 Ø/SG/CPUI/M Ø/SG/CPUI/M Ø/SG/CPUI/N Ø/SG/CPUI/N Ø/SG/CPUI/N2 Ø/SG/CPUI/N2 Ø/SG/CX Ø/SG/CX Ø/SG/CX 2 Ø/SG/CX/FM Ø/SG/CX/FM Ø/SG/CX2 Ø/SG/HB Ø/SG/HB Ø/SG/HB2 Ø/SG/HB2 Ø/SG/R/BU Ø/SG/R/BU Ø/SG/R/BU2 Ø/SG/R/CPU Ø/SG/R/CPU Ø/SG/R/CPU/FM Ø/SG/R/CPU2 Ø/SG/R/CPUI/M Ø/SG/R/CPUI/M Ø/SG/R/CPUI/N Ø/SG/R/CPUI/N Ø/SG/R/CPUI/N2 Ø/SG/R/CPUI/N2 Ø/SG/R/CX Ø/SG/R/CX Ø/SG/R/CX/FM Ø/SG/R/CX2 Ø/SG/R/CX2 Ø/SG/R/HB Ø/SG/R/HB Ø/SG/R/HB2 Ø/SG/R/X Ø/SG/R/X2 Ø/SG/X Ø/SG/X2 Ø/SG/Z Ø/SG/Z Ø_ stroke CPA/M1 Ø_stroke _BU_ _ 1 Ø_stroke CPU _ 1 Ø_stroke CPU2 Ø_stroke CPUI/M_ 1 Ø_stroke CPUI/N_ 1 Ø_stroke CX _ 1 Ø_stroke CX_ _4 Ø_stroke CX_ _6 Ø_stroke CX2 Ø_stroke_BU_ _2 Ø_stroke_BUI_ _ Ø_stroke_CB_ _ _5 Ø_stroke_CB_ _4 Ø_stroke_CB_1 Ø_stroke_CB_2

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.21 1.21 1.21 1.21 1.75 1.75 1.38 1.51 1.47 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.41 1.51 1.51 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69

ITEM Ø_stroke_FAB_ _ _5 Ø_stroke_FAB_ _4 Ø_stroke_FAB_1 Ø_stroke_FAB_2 Ø_stroke_FPB_ _ _5 Ø_stroke_FPB_ _4 Ø_stroke_FPB_1 Ø_stroke_FPB_2 Ø_stroke_PB_ _ _5 Ø_stroke_PB_ _4 Ø_stroke_PB_1 Ø_stroke_PB_2 Ø_stroke_VB_ _ _5 Ø_stroke_VB_ _4 Ø_stroke_VB_1 Ø_stroke_VB_2 Ø_strokeX/_ _1 Ø_Pstroke 1 + stroke 2 CX_ Ø_Vstroke 1 + stroke 2 CX_ ØDFPB ØDPB ØDVB ØF stroke _BU_ _ ØH stroke PDC ØH stroke PDE ØH stroke UDC ØH stroke UDE ØPstroke1+stroke2CPUI/M ØPstroke1+stroke2CPUI/N ØPstroke1+stroke2DBU_ _ ØPstroke1+stroke2X/M ØPstroke1+stroke2X/N ØPstroke1+stroke2CPUI/M ØPstroke1+stroke2CPUI/N ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUI ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUI/M ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUI/M7 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUI/M8 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUI7 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUI8 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUIA ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUIA/M ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUIA/M7 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUIA/M8 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUIA7 ØPstroke1+stroke2DBUIA8 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUI ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUI/M ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUI/M7 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUI/M8 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUI7 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUI8 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUIA ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUIA/M ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUIA/M7 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUIA/M8 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUIA7 ØPstroke1+stroke2SBUIA8 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUI ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUI/M ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUI/M7 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUI/M8 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUI7 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUI8 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUIA

PAGE 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.21 1.41 1.41 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.51 1.12 1.12 1.3 1.3 1.25 1.25 1.51 1.21 1.21 1.25 1.25 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUIA/M ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUIA/M7 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUIA/M8 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUIA7 ØPstroke1+stroke2YBUIA8 ØRAstroke CPA/M ØRBstroke CPA/M ØRAstroke CPU/M ØRBstroke CPU/FM ØRstroke CPUI/.Z ØRstroke CPUI/M ØRstroke CPUI/N ØRstroke CX ØRstroke CX/FM ØRstrokeDB ØRstrokeDB/M ØRstrokeDBU/M7 ØRstrokeDBU/M8 ØRstrokeDBU7 ØRstrokeDBU8 ØRstrokeDBUIA ØRstrokeDBUIA/M ØRstrokeDBUIA/M7 ØRstrokeDBUIA/M8 ØRstrokeDBUIA7 ØRstrokeDBUIA8 ØRstrokeDBUI ØRstroke DFAB ØRstroke DFABC ØRstroke DPB ØRstroke DVB ØRstroke DVBC ØRstroke PD.X ØRstroke PDC ØRstroke PDE ØRstroke PYE ØRstrokeSBU/M7 ØRstrokeSBU/M8 ØRstrokeSBU7 ØRstrokeSBU8 ØRstrokeSBUI ØRstrokeSBUI/M7 ØRstrokeSBUI/M8 ØRstrokeSBUI7 ØRstrokeSBUI8 ØRstrokeSBUIA ØRstrokeSBUIA/M ØRstrokeSBUIA/M7 ØRstrokeSBUIA/M8 ØRstrokeSBUIA7 ØRstrokeSBUIA8 ØRstrokeYBUI/M7 ØRstrokeYBUI/M8 ØRstrokeYBUI7 ØRstrokeYBUI8 ØRstrokeYBUIA ØRstrokeYBUIA/M ØRstrokeYBUIA/M7 ØRstrokeYBUIA/M8 ØRstrokeYBUIA7 ØRstrokeYBUIA8 ØRstroke UD..Z ØRstroke UD.X ØRstroke UDC ØRstroke UDE

PAGE 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.38 1.38 1.47 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.59 1.59 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.69 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.12 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3

ITEM ØRstroke USC ØRstroke USE ØRstroke UYC ØRstroke UYE ØRstrokeX/M ØRstrokeX/N ØSstrokeCPU ØSstrokeCPU/FM ØSstrokeCPUI/M ØSstrokeCPUI/N ØSstrokeCX ØSstrokeCX/FM ØSstrokeX/M ØSstrokeX/N ØRAstroke CPA/M ØRBstroke CPA/M ØRAstroke CPU/M ØRBstroke CPU/FM ØTstroke CPUI/M ØTstroke CPUI/N ØTstroke CX ØTstroke CX/FM ØTstrokeDBU/M7 ØTstrokeDBU/M8 ØTstrokeDBU7 ØTstrokeDBU8 ØTstrokeDBUIA ØTstrokeDBUIA/M ØTstrokeDBUIA/M7 ØTstrokeDBUIA/M8 ØTstrokeDBUIA7 ØTstrokeDBUIA8 ØTstrokeSBUI ØTstrokeSBUI/M7 ØTstrokeSBUI/M8 ØTstrokeSBUI7 ØTstrokeSBUI8 ØTstrokeSBUIA ØTstrokeSBUIA/M ØTstrokeSBUIA/M7 ØTstrokeSBUIA/M8 ØTstrokeSBUIA7 ØTstrokeSBUIA8 ØTstrokeYBUI/M7 ØTstrokeYBUI/M8 ØTstrokeYBUI7 ØTstrokeYBUI8 ØTstrokeYBUIA ØTstrokeYBUIA/M ØTstrokeYBUIA/M7 ØTstrokeYBUIA/M8 ØTstrokeYBUIA7 ØTstrokeYBUIA8 ØTstrokeX/M ØTstrokeX/N ØVstroke1+stroke2DBU/7 ØVstroke1+stroke2DBU/8 ØVstroke1+stroke2DBU/M7 ØVstroke1+stroke2DBU/M8 ØVstroke1+stroke2X/M ØVstroke1+stroke2X/N ØVstroke CPUI/M ØVstroke CPUI/N ØVstroke CX ØVstroke CX/FM

PAGE 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.21 1.21 1.47 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.21 1.21 1.38 1.38 1.47 1.47 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.21 1.21 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.21 1.21 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41

ITEM ØVstrokeDBU/M7 ØVstrokeDBU/M8 ØVstrokeDBU7 ØVstrokeDBU8 ØVstrokeDBUIA ØVstrokeDBUIA/M ØVstrokeDBUIA/M7 ØVstrokeDBUIA/M8 ØVstrokeDBUIA7 ØVstrokeDBUIA8 ØVstrokeSBUI ØVstrokeSBUI/M7 ØVstrokeSBUI/M8 ØVstrokeSBUI7 ØVstrokeSBUI8 ØVstrokeSBUIA ØVstrokeSBUIA/M ØVstrokeSBUIA/M7 ØVstrokeSBUIA/M8 ØVstrokeSBUIA7 ØVstrokeSBUIA8 ØVstrokeYBUI/M7 ØVstrokeYBUI/M8 ØVstrokeYBUI7 ØVstrokeYBUI8 ØVstrokeYBUIA ØVstrokeYBUIA/M ØVstrokeYBUIA/M7 ØVstrokeYBUIA/M8 ØVstrokeYBUIA7 ØVstrokeYBUIA8 ØVstrokeX/M ØVstrokeX/N ØYstroke CPUI/M ØYstroke CPUI/N ØYstroke CX ØYstroke CX/FM ØYstrokeX/M ØYstrokeX/N A/SG/2 A/SG/4 A/SG/8 ALR2 ALR4 ALR8 ALRN4 ALRN8 ALRNU4 ALRNU8 ALRU2 ALRU4 ALRU8 AM2 AM2F AM4 AM4/E AM4F AM4F/E AM8 AM8/E AM8F AM8F/E AML4 AML4F AML8

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.51 1.21 1.21 1.25 1.25 1.41 1.41 1.21 1.21 3.19 3.19 3.19 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22

ITEM AML8F AP4 AP8 AP8F AQB8N AQB8R AQB8V AQF8N AQF8R AQF8V AR8 ARN8 AS2 AS4 AS8 AT2 AT4 AT8 AVL4 AVL4F AVL8 AVL8F B/PB Ø COPPIA BG/PFØ BU/CF Ø BU/CF Ø AC BU/CM Ø AC BU/CM Ø BU/CTA Ø BU/F Ø BU/F Ø AC BU/PB Ø C/ELP8M C/SG/2 C/SG/4 C/SG/8 C/UEASGB C/UEASVB C/UECSPB C/UECSVB C/USASGP C/USASVP C/USCSGP C/USCSVG C/USCSVP C4/USASGG C4/USCSGG C8/USAP/4 C8/USAP/6 C8/USAP/8 C8/USASGG C8/USCP/4 C8/USCP/6 C8/USCP/8 C8/USCSGG CA/SG/2 CA/SG/4 CA/SG/8 CALR2 CALR4 CALR8 CALRN4 CALRN8 CALRNU4 CALRNU8

PAGE 3.22 3.28 3.28 3.28 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 1.66 1.68 1.58 1.58 1.57 1.57 1.58 1.57 1.57 1.57 2.13 3.19 3.19 3.19 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.11 2.11 2.11 2.13 2.11 2.9 2.9 2.10 2.10 2.10 2.9 2.10 2.10 2.10 2.9 3.19 3.19 3.19 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20

b


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM CALRU2 CALRU4 CALRU8 CAM2 CAM2F CAM4 CAM4/E CAM4F CAM4F/E CAM8 CAM8/E CAM8F CAM8F/E CAML4 CAML4F CAML8 CAML8F CAP8 CAP8F CASS2 CASS4 CASS8 CAT2 CAT4 CAT8 CAVL4 CAVL4F CAVL8 CAVL8F CCM2 CCM2F CCM4 CCM4/E CCM4F CCM4F/E CCM8 CCM8/E CCM8F CCM8F/E CCML4 CCML4F CCML8 CCML8F CCVL4 CCVL4F CCVL8 CCVL8F CEK8/2 CEK8/3 CEK8/5 CK2/2 CK2/3 CK2/5 CK4/2 CK4/3 CK4/4 CK4/5 CK4/8 CK8/2 CK8/3 CK8/5 CLR2 CLR4 CLR8 CLRN4

c

PAGE 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.28 3.28 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.71 2.71 2.71 2.68 2.68 2.68 2.68 2.68 2.65 2.65 2.65 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20

ITEM CLRN8 CLRNU4 CLRNU8 CLRU2 CLRU4 CLRU8 CM2 CM2F CM4 CM4/E CM4F CM4F/E CM8 CM8/E CM8F CM8F/E CML4 CML4F CML8 CML8F CN/PR54 CN/PR65 CNT3 CNT5 CP4 CP8 CP8F CPA/FØ CPA/PBØ CPU/CF Ø CPU/CM Ø CPU/CPUI/SEC Ø CPU/F Ø CPU/P Ø CPUI/AS Ø CPUI/AS Ø AC CPUI/ASSS Ø AC CPUI/CF Ø CPUI/CF Ø AC CPUI/CF Ø B CPUI/CFA Ø CPUI/CFS Ø CPUI/CFS Ø AC CPUI/CM Ø CPUI/CM Ø AC CPUI/CM Ø B CPUI/CMSS Ø CPUI/CMSS Ø AC CPUI/CT Ø CPUI/CTA Ø CPUI/CTL Ø CPUI/F Ø CPUI/PB Ø CPUI/SCT Ø CPUI/SEC Ø AC CPUI/SEC Ø AT CQB8N CQB8R CQB8V CQF8N CQF8R CQF8V CR8 CRN8 CS2

PAGE 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 4.28 4.28 1.94 1.94 3.28 3.28 3.28 1.40 1.40 1.50 1.50 1.29-1.50 1.49 1.49 1.30 1.30 1.31 1.29 1.29 1.29 1.29 1.30 1.30 1.29 1.29 1.29 1.31 1.31 1.32 1.31 1.32 1.28 1.28 1.32 1.29 1.30 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.20 3.20 3.20

ITEM CS4 CS8 CT2 CT4 CT8 CVL4 CVL4F CVL8 CVL8F CX/AN Ø CX/AS Ø/SQ CX/CF Ø CX/CPU/CT Ø CX/CPUI/CT Ø CX/F Ø CX/FF10 CX/FF16x1,5 CX/FF20x1,5 CX/FF27x2 CX/FFP10 CX/FFP16x1,5 CX/FFP20x1,5 CX/FFP27x2 CX/FFP36x2 CX/FM10 CX/FM16x1,5 CX/FM20x1,5 CX/FM27x2 CX/FM36x2 CX/P Ø CX/PB Ø CX/PL Ø CX/SEC Ø D3/15 D3/2 D3/2B D3/4 D3/4B DS2 DS3 DS4 DS8 DST10 DST10x1,25 DST12x1,25 DST16x1,5 DST20x1,5 DST27x2 DST36x2 DST4 DST6 DST8 EK/M/SG/4 EK/M/SG/8 EK/SG/2 EK/SG/4 EK/SG/8 EK2 KLC/KLC EK2 KLR/KLR EK2 KR/KR EK2 KUC/KUC EK2 KUR/KUR EK4 KLC/KLC EK4 KLR/KLR EK4 KR/KR

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 1.46 1.46 1.44 1.46-1.49 1.32-1.46 1.44 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.44 1.45 1.44 1.45 3.30 3.30 3.30 3.30 3.30 3.30 3.30 3.30 3.30 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 1.92 3.8 3.8 2.43 2.43 2.43 2.57 2.57 2.56 2.57 2.57 2.52 2.49 2.49

ITEM EK4 KR/TR EK4 KUC/KUC EK4 KUR/KUR EK4/LR EK4/LRLR EK4/LRLRN EK4/LRN EK4/M EK4/MF EK4/MV EK4/MVF EK4/PS EK4/PSS EK4/T EK4/TF EK8 KLC/KLC EK8 KLR/KLR EK8 KR/KR EK8 KR/TR EK8 KUC/KUC EK8 KUR/KUR EK8/LR EK8/LRLR EK8/LRLRN EK8/LRLRU EK8/LRN EK8/LRU EK8/M EK8/MF EK8/MV EK8/MVF EK8/PS EK8/PSS EK8/T EK8/TF EKA2 KLC/TQ EKA2 KLC/ZR EKA2 KLR/ZR EKA2 KR/TQ EKA2 KR/ZR EKA2 KUC/TQ EKA2 KUC/ZR EKA2 KUR/ZR EKA4 KLC/TQ EKA4 KLC/ZR EKA4 KLR/ZR EKA4 KR/TQ EKA4 KR/ZR EKA4 KUC/TQ EKA4 KUC/ZR EKA4 KUR/ZR EKA8 KLC/TQ EKA8 KLC/ZR EKA8 KLR/ZR EKA8 KR/TQ EKA8 KR/ZR EKA8 KUC/TQ EKA8 KUC/ZR EKA8 KUR/ZR EKA8/A EKA8/Q EKA8/TD EKC2 KLC/TQ EKC2 KLC/ZR EKC2 KLR/TQ

PAGE 2.49 2.52 2.52 3.14 3.14 3.14 3.14 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.14 3.14 3.16 3.16 2.44 2.44 2.46 2.46 2.46 2.46 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.9 3.9 3.12 3.12 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.52 2.52 2.52 2.49 2.49 2.52 2.52 2.52 2.46 2.46 2.46 2.44 2.44 2.46 2.46 2.46 3.9 3.9 3.9 2.57 2.57 2.57


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM EKC2 KLR/ZR EKC2 KR/TQ EKC2 KR/ZR EKC2 KUC/TQ EKC2 KUC/ZR EKC2 KUR/TQ EKC2 KUR/ZR EKC4 KLC/TQ EKC4 KLC/ZR EKC4 KLR/ZR EKC4 KR/TQ EKC4 KR/ZR EKC4 KUC/TQ EKC4 KUC/ZR EKC4 KUR/ZR EKC8 KLC/TQ EKC8 KLC/ZR EKC8 KLR/ZR EKC8 KR/TQ EKC8 KR/ZR EKC8 KUC/TQ EKC8 KUC/ZR EKC8 KUR/ZR EKC8/A EKC8/Q EKC8/TD EKCA/M/SG/2 EKCA/M/SG/4 EKCA/M/SG/8 EKCA/SG/2 EKCA/SG/4 EKCA/SG/8 EKCA2 KLC/KLC EKCA2 KLC/TQ EKCA2 KLC/ZR EKCA2 KLR/KLR EKCA2 KLR/ZR EKCA2 KR/KR EKCA2 KR/TQ EKCA2 KR/ZR EKCA2 KUC/KUC EKCA2 KUC/TQ EKCA2 KUC/ZR EKCA2 KUR/KUR EKCA2 KUR/ZR EKCA2 SLC/SLC EKCA2 SLR/SLR EKCA2 SR/SR EKCA2 SUC/SUC EKCA2 SUR/SUR EKCA2/M EKCA2/MA EKCA2/MAF EKCA2/MF EKCA2/MS EKCA2/MSF EKCA4 ALC/ALC EKCA4 ALR/ALR EKCA4 AR/AR EKCA4 AUC/AUC EKCA4 AUR/AUR EKCA4 KLC/KLC EKCA4 KLC/TQ EKCA4 KLC/ZR EKCA4 KLR/KLR

PAGE 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.57 2.52 2.52 2.52 2.59 2.59 2.52 2.52 2.52 2.46 2.46 2.46 2.44 2.44 2.46 2.46 2.46 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.8 3.8 3.8 2.43 2.43 2.43 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.56 2.56 2.56 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.58 2.56 2.58 2.58 3.18 3.18 3.18 3.18 3.18 3.18 2.53 2.53 2.50 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53

ITEM EKCA4 KLR/ZR EKCA4 KR/KR EKCA4 KR/TQ EKCA4 KR/TR EKCA4 KR/ZR EKCA4 KUC/KUC EKCA4 KUC/TQ EKCA4 KUC/ZR EKCA4 KUR/KUR EKCA4 KUR/ZR EKCA4 PLC/PLC EKCA4 PLR/PLR EKCA4 PR/PR EKCA4 PUC/PUC EKCA4 PUR/PUR EKCA4 SLC/SLC EKCA4 SLR/SLR EKCA4 SR/SR EKCA4 SUC/SUC EKCA4 SUR/SUR EKCA4/LR EKCA4/LRLR EKCA4/LRLRN EKCA4/LRN EKCA4/M EKCA4/MA EKCA4/MA/F EKCA4/MF EKCA4/MS EKCA4/MS/F EKCA4/MV EKCA4/MVF EKCA4/PS EKCA4/PSS EKCA4/T EKCA4/TF EKCA8 ALC/ALC EKCA8 ALR/ALR EKCA8 AR/AR EKCA8 AUC/AUC EKCA8 AUR/AUR EKCA8 KLC/KLC EKCA8 KLC/TQ EKCA8 KLC/ZR EKCA8 KLR/KLR EKCA8 KLR/ZR EKCA8 KUC/KUC EKCA8 KUC/TQ EKCA8 KUC/ZR EKCA8 KUR/KUR EKCA8 KUR/ZR EKCA8 PLC/PLC EKCA8 PLR/PLR EKCA8 PUC/PUC EKCA8 PUR/PUR EKCA8 SLC/SLC EKCA8 SLR/SLR EKCA8 SR/SR EKCA8 SUC/SUC EKCA8 SUR/SUR EKCA8/A EKCA8/LR EKCA8/LRLR EKCA8/LRLRN EKCA8/LRLRU

PAGE 2.53 2.50 2.50 2.50 2.50 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.50 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.53 2.50 2.53 2.53 3.14 3.14 3.10 3.10 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.16 3.14 3.14 3.16 3.16 2.47 2.47 2.45 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.47 2.45 2.47 2.47 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.9

ITEM EKCA8/LRN EKCA8/LRU EKCA8/M EKCA8/MA EKCA8/MAF EKCA8/MF EKCA8/MS EKCA8/MSF EKCA8/MV EKCA8/MVF EKCA8/PS EKCA8/PSS EKCA8/Q EKCA8/T EKCA8/TD EKCA8/TF ELA4 ELM4 ELN4 ELO4 ELPG8S ELPG8S/B ELPG8S/B/USBG/voltage ELPG8S/BAG ELPG8S/BAG/USBG/voltage ELPG8S/BAV ELPG8S/BAV/USBG/voltage ELPG8S/BP ELPG8S/BP/USBG/voltage ELPP8S ELPP8S/P ELPP8S/P/USB/voltage ELPP8S/PAG ELPP8S/PAG/USB/voltage ELPP8S/PAV/USB/voltage ELSQ ELY4 ENCA/SG/4 ENCA4 ALC/ALC ENCA4 ALR/ALR ENCA4 AR/AR ENCA4 AUC/PUC ENCA4 AUR/AUR ENCA4 KLC/KLC ENCA4 KLC/TQ ENCA4 KLC/ZR ENCA4 KLR/KLR ENCA4 KLR/ZR ENCA4 KR/KR ENCA4 KR/TQ ENCA4 KR/TR ENCA4 KR/ZR ENCA4 KUC/KUC ENCA4 KUC/TQ ENCA4 KUC/ZR ENCA4 KUR/KUR ENCA4 KUR/ZR ENCA4 PLC/PLC ENCA4 PLR/PLR ENCA4 PR/PR ENCA4 PR/PR ENCA4 PUC/PUC ENCA4 SLC/SLC ENCA4 SLR/SLR ENCA4 SR/SR

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 3.9 3.9 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.12 3.9 3.9 3.9 3.12 3.9 3.12 3.32 3.33 3.33 3.32 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.12 2.11 2.11 2.11 2.11 2.11 2.11 3.33 3.33 2.43 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.51 2.51 2.51 2.51 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.51 2.51 2.54 2.54 2.54 2.51

ITEM ENCA4 SUC/SUC ENCA4 SUR/SUR ENCA4 TQ/KUC ES…/N EV1 EV12 EV16 EV2 EV3 EV4 EV6 EV8 EZ/SVG/P1 EZ/SVG/P2 EZ/SVG/P3 EZ1/20 EZ1/40 EZ1/PM EZ1/SVG EZ1/SVG/1 EZ1/SVG/2 EZ2/20 EZ2/40 EZ2/5 EZ2/SVG EZ2/SVG/1 EZ3/20 EZ3/40 EZ3/5 EZ3/PM EZ3/SVG EZ3/SVG/1 EZ3/SVG/2 EZAP/R1 EZAP/R2 EZAP/R3 EZAP/U1 EZAP/U2 EZAP/U3 EZAP1/SVG EZAP1/SVG/1 EZAP2/SVG EZAP2/SVG/1 EZAP3/SVG EZAP3/SVG/1 EZF1/40PM/SA EZF1/40PM/SM EZF1/40PM/SS EZF1/40RR7L/PM/SA EZF1/40RR7L/PM/SM EZF1/40RR7L/PM/SS EZF1/40RR7LCA/PM/SA EZF1/40RR7LCA/PM/SM EZF1/40RR7LCA/PM/SS EZF1/40RR7LCC/PM/SA EZF1/40RR7LCC/PM/SM EZF1/40RR7LCC/PM/SS EZF2/20PM/SA EZF2/20PM/SM EZF2/20PM/SS EZF3/20/SM EZF3/20/SS EZF3/20PM/SM EZF3/20PM/SS EZF3/20RR7L/PM/SM

PAGE 2.54 2.54 2.54 5.48 2.94 2.94 2.94 2.94 2.94 2.94 2.94 2.94 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.13 4.13 4.19 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.22 4.22 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13-4.19 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.24

d


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM EZF3/20RR7L/PM/SS EZF3/20RR7L/SM EZF3/20RR7L/SS EZF3/20RR7LCA/PM/SM EZF3/20RR7LCA/PM/SS EZF3/20RR7LCA/SM EZF3/20RR7LCA/SS EZF3/20RR7LCC/PM/SM EZF3/20RR7LCC/PM/SS EZF3/20RR7LCC/SM EZF3/20RR7LCC/SS EZL1/C EZL1PM/CA EZL1PM/CC EZL2/C EZL2PM EZL2PM/CA EZL2PM/CC EZL3 EZL3/C EZL3/CA EZL3/CC EZL3PM EZL3PM/CA EZL3PM/CC EZPA1/3 EZPA2/3 EZPA3/3 EZRR1/7 EZRR1/7F40L/PM/SA EZRR1/7F40L/PM/SM EZRR1/7F40L/PM/SS EZRR1/7F40LCA/PM/SA EZRR1/7F40LCA/PM/SM EZRR1/7F40LCA/PM/SS EZRR1/7F40LCC/PM/SA EZRR1/7F40LCC/PM/SM EZRR1/7F40LCC/PM/SS EZRR1/7F40PM/SA EZRR1/7F40PM/SM EZRR1/7F40PM/SS EZRR1/SG/6 EZRR2/7 EZRR2/7F20L/PM/SA EZRR2/7F20L/PM/SM EZRR2/7F20L/PM/SS EZRR2/7F20LCA/PM/SA EZRR2/7F20LCA/PM/SM EZRR2/7F20LCA/PM/SS EZRR2/7F20LCC/PM/SA EZRR2/7F20LCC/PM/SM EZRR2/7F20LCC/PM/SS EZRR2/7F20PM/SA EZRR2/7F20PM/SM EZRR2/7F20PM/SS EZRR2/SG/6 EZRR3/7 EZRR3/7F20/SM EZRR3/7F20/SS EZRR3/7F20L/PM/SM EZRR3/7F20L/PM/SS EZRR3/7F20L/SM EZRR3/7F20L/SS EZRR3/7F20LCA/PM/SM EZRR3/7F20LCA/PM/SS

e

PAGE 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.24 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.19 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.17 4.17 4.17 4.19 4.15 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.17 4.17 4.17 4.19 4.19 4.17 4.17 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23

ITEM EZRR3/7F20LCA/SM EZRR3/7F20LCA/SS EZRR3/7F20LCC/PM/SM EZRR3/7F20LCC/PM/SS EZRR3/7F20LCC/SM EZRR3/7F20LCC/SS EZRR3/7F20PM/SM EZRR3/7F20PM/SS EZRR3/SG/6 EZS2/3 EZT/F1/SA EZT/F1/SM EZT/F1/SS EZT/F2/PM/SA EZT/F2/PM/SM EZT/F2/PM/SS EZT/F3/SM EZT/F3/SS EZT/L1 EZT/L1/SLA EZT/L1/SLC EZT/L2/PM EZT/L2/PM/SLA EZT/L2/PM/SLC EZT/L3 EZT/L3/SLA EZT/L3/SLC EZVL/1 EZVL/2 EZVL/3 EZVL1/SVG EZVL1/SVG/1 EZVL2/SVG EZVL2/SVG/1 EZVL3/SVG EZVL3/SVG/1 FCLR4 FCLR8 FCLRN4 FCLRN8 FCLRNU4 FCLRNU8 FCLRU4 FCLRU8 FCP8 FCR8 FCRN8 FCS4 FCS8 FF10x1,25 FF10x1,25/SA FF10x1,25/SS FF12x1,25 FF12x1,25/SA FF12x1,25/SS FF16x1,5 FF16x1,5/SA FF16x1,5/SS FF20x1,5 FF20x1,5/SA FF20x1,5/SS FF27x2/SA FF27x2/SS FF36x2/SS FF4

PAGE 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.23 4.17 4.17 4.15 4.22 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.13 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.19 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 4.22 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.28 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 1.90 1.91 1.90 1.90 1.91 1.90 1.90 1.91 1.90 1.90 1.91 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.90

ITEM FF4/SS FF6 FF6 FF6/SA FF6/SS FF8 FF8 FF8/SA FF8/SS FFP10x1,25 FFP12x1,25 FFP16x1,5 FFP20x1,5 FFP27x2 FFP36x2 FFP6 FFP8 FG/050 FG/051 FG/052 FG/053 FG/054 FG/055 FG/056 FG/057 FG/058 FG/059 FG10 FG12 FG16 FG20 FG25 FG32 FG40 FG50 FG63 FG8 FM100 FM100/C FM100E FM100E/C FM100EN FM100EN/C FM100N FM100N/C FM100R FM100R/C FM101 FM101/C FM101E FM101E/C FM157 FM157/C FM157E FM157E/C FM158 FM158/C FM158E FM158E/C FS112 FS125 FS34 FS345 FS56 FS681

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 1.90 1.90 1.90 1.91 1.90 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.94 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.93 1.96 1.96 1.96 1.96 1.97 1.97 1.97 1.97 1.99 1.99 1.99 1.99 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95 1.95

ITEM FS81 HALR2 HALR4 HALR8 HALRN4 HALRN8 HALRNU4 HALRNU8 HALRU2 HALRU4 HALRU8 HAM2 HAM2F HAM4 HAM4/E HAM4F HAM4F/E HAM8 HAM8/E HAM8F HAM8F/E HAML4 HAML4F HAML8 HAML8F HAQB8N HAQB8R HAQB8V HAQF8N HAQF8R HAQF8V HAR8 HARN8 HAS2 HAS4 HAS8 HAT2 HAT4 HAT8 HAVL4 HAVL4F HAVL8 HAVL8F HB/FF10 HB/FF12 HB/FF14 HB/FF16 HB/FF18 HB/FF20 HB/SEC Ø HCCM4 HCCM4/E HCCM4F HCCM4F/E HCCM8 HCCM8/E HCCM8F HCCM8F/E HCCML4 HCCML4F HCCML8 HCCML8F HCLR2 HCLR4 HCLR8

PAGE 1.95 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.91 1.70 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.20 3.20 3.20


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM HCLRN4 HCLRN8 HCLRNU4 HCLRNU8 HCLRU2 HCLRU4 HCLRU8 HCM2 HCM2F HCM4 HCM4/E HCM4F HCM4F/E HCM8 HCM8/E HCM8F HCM8F/E HCML4 HCML4F HCML8 HCML8F HCQB8N HCQB8R HCQB8V HCQF8N HCQF8R HCQF8V HCR8 HCRN8 HCS2 HCS4 HCS8 HCT2 HCT4 HCT8 HCVL4 HCVL4F HCVL8 HCVL8F HFCLR4 HFCLR8 HFCLRN4 HFCLRN8 HFCLRNU4 HFCLRNU8 HFCLRU4 HFCLRU8 HFCR8 HFCRN8 HFCS4 HFCS8 HS/BF Ø HS/BR Ø HS/NP Ø HS/PT Ø KB/EK 4/10 KB/EK 4/12 KB/EK 4/14 KB/EK 4/16 KB/EK 4/18 KB/EK 4/2 KB/EK 4/20 KB/EK 4/3 KB/EK 4/4 KB/EK 4/5

PAGE 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.22 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 3.20 1.86 1.86 1.86 1.86 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55 2.55

ITEM KB/EK 4/6 KB/EK 4/8 KB/EK 8/10 KB/EK 8/12 KB/EK 8/14 KB/EK 8/16 KB/EK 8/18 KB/EK 8/2 KB/EK 8/20 KB/EK 8/3 KB/EK 8/4 KB/EK 8/5 KB/EK 8/6 KB/EK 8/8 KB/MEK 4/10 KB/MEK 4/12 KB/MEK 4/14 KB/MEK 4/16 KB/MEK 4/18 KB/MEK 4/2 KB/MEK 4/20 KB/MEK 4/3 KB/MEK 4/4 KB/MEK 4/5 KB/MEK 4/6 KB/MEK 4/8 KB/MEK 8/10 KB/MEK 8/12 KB/MEK 8/14 KB/MEK 8/16 KB/MEK 8/18 KB/MEK 8/2 KB/MEK 8/20 KB/MEK 8/3 KB/MEK 8/4 KB/MEK 8/5 KB/MEK 8/6 KB/MEK 8/8 KB/MEV 8/10 KB/MEV 8/12 KB/MEV 8/14 KB/MEV 8/16 KB/MEV 8/18 KB/MEV 8/2 KB/MEV 8/20 KB/MEV 8/3 KB/MEV 8/4 KB/MEV 8/5 KB/MEV 8/6 KB/MEV 8/8 KIT/IR/MEK4 KIT/IR/MEK8 KIT/PC/EK8 KIT/PC/MEK4 KIT/PC/MEK8 KIT/PC/UL KIT/PC/UL KIT/PC/UM KIT/UDP/ISO1 KIT/UDP/ISO2 KIT/UDP/ISO3 M/CPUI/CT Ø M/CX/CPU/CT Ø M/WBZ M/WUG-WUGD

PAGE 2.55 2.55 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.48 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.42 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.36 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.21 2.42 2.36 2.48 2.42 2.36 2.21 2.8 2.4 2.83 2.83 2.83 1.32 1.48 1.7 1.8

ITEM MA10/12 MA4/1 MA4/12 MA4/4 MA4/6 MA5/1 MA5/12 MA5/4 MA5/6 MA6/1 MA6/12 MA6/4 MA6/6 MALR1/8 MALR4 MALR4/L MALRM5 MALRM5/L MALRU1/8 MALRU4 MALRU4/L MALRUM5 MALRUM5/L MAP1/8 MAP4 MAP4/L MAPM5 MAPM5/L MAS1/8 MAS4 MAS4/L MASM5 MASM5/L MAT1/8 MAT4 MAT4/L MATM5 MATM5/L MCLR1/8 MCLR4 MCLR4/L MCLRM5 MCLRM5/L MCLRU1/8 MCLRU4 MCLRU4/L MCLRUM5 MCLRUM5/L MCP1/8 MCP4 MCP4/L MCPM5 MCPM5/L MCS1/8 MCS4 MCS4/L MCS-CB2 MCS-FBR MCS-FMR MCS-LCB MCS-LCM MCS-LCSB MCS-LCSM MCSM5 MCSM5/L

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.3 3.3

ITEM MCS-PMN MCS-PMR MCS-PMV MCS-SA MCS-SAD MCT1/8 MCT4 MCT4/L MCTM5 MCTM5/L MEK192/N MEK192/NLED Voltage MEK192/NVD Voltage MEKCA4 AR/AR MEKCA4 AUC/AUC voltage MEKCA4 AUCG/AUCG MEKCA4 AUR/AUR voltage MEKCA4 AURG/AURG MEKCA4 KR/KR MEKCA4 KR/ZQ MEKCA4 KUC/KUC voltage MEKCA4 KUC/ZQ voltage MEKCA4 KUCG/KUCG MEKCA4 KUCG/ZQ MEKCA4 KUR/KUR voltage MEKCA4 KUR/ZQ voltage MEKCA4 KURG/KURG MEKCA4 KURG/ZQ MEKCA4 PR/PR MEKCA4 PUC/PUC voltage MEKCA4 PUCG/PUCG MEKCA4 PUR/PUR voltage MEKCA4 PURG/PURG MEKCA4 SR/SR MEKCA4 SUC/SUC voltage MEKCA4 SUCG/SUCG MEKCA4 SUR/SUR voltage MEKCA4 SURG/SURG MEKCA8 AR/AR MEKCA8 AUC/AUC voltage MEKCA8 AUR/AUR voltage MEKCA8 KUC/KUC voltage MEKCA8 KUR/KUR voltage MEKCA8 KUR/ZQ voltage MEKCA8 PR/PR MEKCA8 PUC/PUC voltage MEKCA8 PUR/PUR voltage MEKCA8 SR/SR MEKCA8 SUC/SUC voltage MEKCA8 SUR/SUR voltage MEV/C MEV/C1 MEV/C2 MEV/CA/SG MEV/CC/SG MEV/CF10 MEV/CF3 MEV/CF5 MEV/CP/SG MEV/M2D/AC MEV/M2D/DC MEV/M2S/AC MEV/M2S/DC MEV/M4D/AC MEV/M4D/DC

PAGE 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.6 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 2.15 2.15 2.15 2.37 2.38 2.40 2.38 2.40 2.37 2.37 2.38 2.40 2.40 2.40 2.38 2.38 2.40 2.40 2.37 2.38 2.40 2.38 2.40 2.37 2.38 2.40 2.38 2.40 2.33 2.34 2.34 2.34 2.34 2.34 2.33 2.34 2.34 2.33 2.34 2.34 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.16 2.16 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.16 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.28

f


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM MEV/M4S/AC MEV/M4S/DC MEV/P MEV/PM MEV/SG MEV18 AUC/AUC voltage MEV18 AUR/AUR voltage MEV18 KUC/KUC voltage MEV18 KUC/TQ voltage MEV18 KUC/ZR voltage MEV18 KUR/KUR voltage MEV18 KUR/ZR voltage MEV18 PUC/PUC voltage MEV18 PUR/PUR voltage MEV18 SUC/SUC voltage MEV18 SUR/SUR voltage MEV18BM MEV18BS MEV18DG MEV18DP MEV18PC MEV18PE MEV18PUS MEV8 AR/AR MEV8 AUC/AUC voltage MEV8 AUR/AUR voltage MEV8 KR/KR MEV8 KR/TQ MEV8 KR/ZR MEV8 KUC/KUC voltage MEV8 KUC/TQ voltage MEV8 KUC/ZR voltage MEV8 KUC/ZR voltage MEV8 KUR/KUR voltage MEV8 KUR/ZR voltage MEV8 PR/PR MEV8 PUC/PUC voltage MEV8 PUR/PUR voltage MEV8 SR/SR MEV8 SUC/SUC voltage MEV8 SUR/SUR voltage MEV8/PC MEV8/PF MEVX18 AUC/AUC voltage MEVX18 AUR/AUR voltage MEVX18 KUC/KUC voltage MEVX18 KUC/TQ voltage MEVX18 KUC/ZR voltage MEVX18 KUR/KUR voltage MEVX18 KUR/ZR voltage MEVX18 PUC/PUC voltage MEVX18 PUR/PUR voltage MEVX18 SUC/SUC voltage MEVX18 SUR/SUR voltage MEVX8 AUC/AUC voltage MEVX8 AUR/AUR voltage MEVX8 KUC/KUC voltage MEVX8 KUC/TQ voltage MEVX8 KUC/ZR voltage MEVX8 KUR/KUR voltage MEVX8 KUR/ZR voltage MEVX8 PUC/PUC voltage MEVX8 PUR/PUR voltage MEVX8 SUC/SUC voltage MEVX8 SUR/SUR voltage

g

PAGE 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.28 2.16 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.23 2.26 2.26 2.26 2.26 2.26 2.26 2.26 2.17 2.18 2.18 2.17 2.17 2.17 2.18 2.18 2.18 2.18 2.18 2.18 2.17 2.18 2.18 2.17 2.18 2.18 2.21-2.31 2.21 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.25 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20 2.20

ITEM MF/CX/CPU/CT Ø ** MF/CX/CPUI/CT Ø ** MF10/12 MF4/1 MF4/12 MF4/4 MF4/6 MF5/1 MF5/12 MF5/4 MF5/6 MF6/1 MF6/12 MF6/4 MF6/6 MHALR1/8 MHALR4 MHALR4/L MHALRM5 MHALRM5/L MHALRU1/8 MHALRU4 MHALRUM5 MHALRUM5/L MHAP1/8 MHAP4 MHAP4/L MHAPM5 MHAPM5/L MHARLU4/L MHAS1/8 MHAS4 MHAS4/L MHASM5 MHASM5/L MHAT1/8 MHAT4 MHAT4/L MHATM5 MHATM5/L MHCLR1/8 MHCLR4 MHCLR4/L MHCLRM5 MHCLRM5/L MHCLRU1/8 MHCLRU4 MHCLRU4/L MHCLRUM5 MHCLRUM5/L MHCP1/8 MHCP4 MHCP4/L MHCPM5 MHCPM5/L MHCS1/8 MHCS4 MHCS4/L MHCSM5 MHCSM5/L MHCT1/8 MHCT4 MHCT4/L MHCTM5 MHCTM5/L

PAGE 1.49 1.32-1.46 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 4.26 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.3 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4 3.4

ITEM MP4/1 MP4/12 MP4/4 MP4/6 MP5/1 MP5/12 MP5/4 MP5/6 MP6/1 MP6/12 MP6/4 MP6/6 MR10/12 MR4/1 MR4/12 MR4/4 MR4/6 MR5/1 MR5/12 MR5/4 MR5/6 MR6/1 MR6/12 MR6/4 MR6/6 NB Ø NBG Ø PCA4 PCA4/F PCA4M PCA4M/F PFPØ PGØ PNP4 PNP4/F PNPCA4 PNPCA4/A PNPCA4/AF PNPCA4/F PNPCA4/S PNPCA4/SF PRA4 PRA8 PRC4 PRC8 PRCA4 PRCA8 PRDA RC1-DFM-… RC1-DGM-… RC1-DM-… RC1-G-… RC1-TC-… RC1-TL-… RC-C-… RC-CBD-… RC-CBF-… RC-CBS-… RC-DF-… RC-DFM-… RC-DGM-… RC-DI-… RC-DM-… RC-DS-… RC-G-…

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 4.20 1.66 1.66 3.28 3.29 3.29 3.29 1.14 1.14 3.28 3.28 3.28 3.28 3.28 3.28 3.28 3.28 4.28 4.28 4.28 4.28 4.28 4.29 4.27 5.43 5.44 5.36 5.38 5.39 5.40 5.40 5.42 5.42 5.42 5.37 5.43 5.44 5.37 5.36 5.41 5.43

ITEM RC-GF-… RC-GG-… RC-GI-… RC-P-… RC-RC-… RC-RV-… RC-TG-… RC-TI-… RO1-GM-... RO1-GMG-... RO-2BSR-... RO-3BSR-... RO-AC-… RO-ACL-… RO-BD-... RO-BDR-... RO-BS-... RO-BSR-... RO-CBD-... RO-CBS-... RO-CI-... RO-CT-... RO-DF-… RO-DI-… RO-DIR-… RO-DM-… RO-E-… RO-GI-… RO-GM-… RO-P-... RO-PF-... RO-R-... RO-RC-... RO-RD-… RO-RF-... RO-RFV-... RO-RV-... RO-T-… RO-TC-... RO-TI-… RO-TL-... RO-VBD-… RO-VBS-… RS1-N-… RS1-PM-… RS1-PMF-... RS1-RMF-… RS-CF-... RS-GF-... RS-GM-... RS-GMF-... RS-M-... RS-MFFF-... RS-MR-… RS-N-… RS-PF-... RS-PG-... RS-PL-… RS-PM-… RS-PMF-… RS-RMF-... RS-TC-... RS-TCF-... RS-TF-... RS-TFE-...

PAGE 5.38 5.38 5.39 5.37 5.45 5.45 5.39 5.40 5.13 5.14 5.15 5.16 5.20 5.20 5.16 5.15 5.16 5.15 5.21 5.21 5.20 5.21 5.12 5.17 5.17 5.12 5.19 5.17 5.13 5.18 5.18 5.19 5.23 5.22 5.24 5.23 5.23 5.19 5.14 5.18 5.14 5.22 5.22 5.25 5.35 5.27 5.26 5.32 5.29 5.30 5.29 5.26 5.32 5.28 5.25 5.33 5.34 5.27 5.27 5.27 5.26 5.28 5.31 5.30 5.29


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM RS-TLF-... RS-TM-... RS-TMC-... RS-TML-... RS-TMO-... RS-YCM-... RS-YF-... RT-C-… RT-DF-… RT-DI-… RT-DIR-… RT-DM-… RT-G-… RT-GG-… RT-GI-… RT-GMF-… RT-MDL-… RT-MT-… RT-MTD-… RT-MTL-… RT-P-… RT-RC-… RT-RF-… RT-RFL-… RT-RFV-… RT-TC-… RT-TI-… RT-TL-… RT-TM-… RT-YI-… RT-YIR-… RT-YM-… RX2 RX3 RX4 RX8 RX8/6 SC-… SCP-… SFPR SQ125/A SQ32-40/EK SQ32-40/A SQ50-63/EK SQ50-63/A SQ80-100/EK SQ80-100/A SQB SQB12 SQZ ST102 ST34 ST56 ST80 STPR Size PM/WBZ Size SG/WBZ T-PA-… T-PELD-… T-PU-… U1 U2 U4 U4/SM U4/SM2

PAGE 5.32 5.31 5.30 5.31 5.28 5.33 5.33 5.8 5.3 5.6 5.7 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.7 5.10 5.6 5.9 5.9 5.6 5.10 5.9 5.11 5.11 5.11 5.4 5.7 5.5 5.10 5.8 5.8 5.5 3.31 3.31 3.31 3.31 3.31 5.48 5.48 4.27 1.98-1.100 2.59 1.98-1.100 2.59 1.100 2.59 1.98-1.100 1.94 1.94 1.95 1.98 1.98 1.98 1.98 4.28 1.33 1.33 5.50 5.50 5.50 3.31 3.31 3.31 3.31 3.31

ITEM U8 UAFØ UCT Ø UDP/ISO1/3M/L UDP/ISO1/4M/Q UDP/ISO1/4MS/Q UDP/ISO1/8M/Q UDP/ISO1/8MS/Q UDP/ISO1/B4 UDP/ISO1/B8 UDP/ISO1/PC UDP/ISO1/S4 UDP/ISO1/S8 UDP/ISO1/T UDP/ISO1-2 UDP/ISO1BM UDP/ISO1D UDP/ISO1PE UDP/ISO1PT UDP/ISO1PU UDP/ISO1PUI UDP/ISO1PUL UDP/ISO1PUS UDP/ISO2/2M/L UDP/ISO2/3M/Q UDP/ISO2/3MS/Q UDP/ISO2/B3 UDP/ISO2/B4 UDP/ISO2/BM UDP/ISO2/PC UDP/ISO2/PE UDP/ISO2/PT UDP/ISO2/PU UDP/ISO2/PUI UDP/ISO2/PUL UDP/ISO2/PUS UDP/ISO2/S3 UDP/ISO2/S4 UDP/ISO2/T UDP/ISO2-3 UDP/ISO2D UDP/ISO3/1M/L UDP/ISO3/2M/Q UDP/ISO3/B2 UDP/ISO3/S2 UDP/ISO3/T UDP/ISODT 1-2 UDP2B UDP2M/2 UDP2M/3 UDP2M/4 UDP2M/5 UDP2S UDP4B UDP4M/10 UDP4M/2 UDP4M/3 UDP4M/4 UDP4M/5 UDP4M/6 UDP4M/7 UDP4M/8 UDP4M/9 UDP4S UDP8B

PAGE 3.31 1.18 1.6 2.82 2.82 2.82 2.82 2.82 2.81 2.81 2.83 2.81 2.81 2.83 2.83 2.84 2.84 2.84 2.84 2.84 2.84 2.84 2.84 2.82 2.82 2.82 2.81 2.81 2.84 2.83 2.85 2.85 2.85 2.85 2.85 2.85 2.81 2.81 2.83 2.83 2.84 2.82 2.82 2.81 2.81 2.83 2.84 2.89 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.89 2.89 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.89 2.89

ITEM UDP8M/10 UDP8M/2 UDP8M/3 UDP8M/4 UDP8M/5 UDP8M/6 UDP8M/7 UDP8M/8 UDP8M/9 UDP8S UDS/SG/05 UDS/SG/105 UDS/SG/12 UDS/SG/212 UDS/SG/35 UDS05 KR/KR UDS05 KR/KUC UDS05 KR/KUR UDS05 KR/TQ UDS05 KR/TR UDS05 KR/ZR UDS05 KUC/KR UDS05 KUC/KUC UDS05 KUC/TQ UDS05 KUC/TR UDS05 KUC/ZR UDS05 KUR/KR UDS05 KUR/KUR UDS05 KUR/TR UDS05 KUR/ZR UDS05 SR/SR UDS05 SUC/SUC UDS05 SUR/SUR UDS05 TQ/KR UDS05 TQ/KUC UDS05 TR/KR UDS05 TR/KUC UDS05 TR/KUR UDS05 ZR/KR UDS05 ZR/KUC UDS05 ZR/KUR UDS105 AR/AR UDS105 AUC/AUC UDS105 AUEC/AUEC UDS105 AUER/AUER UDS105 AUPC/AUPC UDS105 AUPR/AUPR UDS105 KR/KR UDS105 KR/TQ UDS105 KR/TR UDS105 KR/ZR UDS105 KRP/KRP UDS105 KUEC/KUEC UDS105 KUEC/KUEC UDS105 KUEC/TQ UDS105 KUEC/TR UDS105 KUEC/ZR UDS105 KUER/KUER UDS105 KUER/TR UDS105 KUER/ZR UDS105 KUPC/KUPC UDS105 KUPC/TQ UDS105 KUPC/TR UDS105 KUPC/ZR UDS105 KUPR/KUPR

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.90 2.89 2.86 2.74 2.86 2.74 2.86 2.87 2.88 2.87 2.87 2.87 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.75 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76

ITEM UDS105 KUPR/TR UDS105 KUPR/ZR UDS105 PR/PR UDS105 PUEC/PUEC UDS105 PUER/PUER UDS105 PUPC/PUPC UDS105 PUPR/PUPR UDS105 SR/SR UDS105 SUEC/SUEC UDS105 SUER/SUER UDS105 SUPC/SUPC UDS105 SUPR/SUPR UDS12 AR/AR UDS12 KR/KR UDS12 KR/KUC UDS12 KR/KUR UDS12 KR/TQ UDS12 KR/TR UDS12 KR/ZR UDS12 KUC/KR UDS12 KUC/KUC UDS12 KUC/TQ UDS12 KUC/TR UDS12 KUC/ZR UDS12 KUR/KR UDS12 KUR/KUR UDS12 KUR/TR UDS12 KUR/ZR UDS12 SR/SR UDS12 SUC/SUC UDS12 SUR/SUR UDS12 TQ/KR UDS12 TQ/KUC UDS12 TR/KR UDS12 TR/KUC UDS12 TR/KUR UDS12 ZR/KR UDS12 ZR/KUC UDS12 ZR/KUR UDS212 AR/AR UDS212 AUC/AUC UDS212 AUEC/AUEC UDS212 AUER/AUER UDS212 AUPC/AUPC UDS212 AUPR/AUPR UDS212 AUR/AUR UDS212 KR/KR UDS212 KR/TQ UDS212 KR/TR UDS212 KR/ZR UDS212 KUEC/KUEC UDS212 KUEC/TQ UDS212 KUEC/TR UDS212 KUEC/ZR UDS212 KUER/KUER UDS212 KUER/TR UDS212 KUER/ZR UDS212 KUPC/KUPC UDS212 KUPC/TQ UDS212 KUPC/TR UDS212 KUPC/ZR UDS212 KUPR/KUPR UDS212 KUPR/TR UDS212 KUPR/ZR UDS212 PR/PR

PAGE 2.76 2.76 2.75 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.75 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.76 2.77 2.77 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.87 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.77 2.78 2.77 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.77 2.77 2.77 2.77 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.77

h


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM UDS212 PUC/PUC UDS212 PUEC/PUEC UDS212 PUER/PUER UDS212 PUPC/PUPC UDS212 PUPR/PUPR UDS212 SR/SR UDS212 SUEC/SUEC UDS212 SUER/SUER UDS212 SUPC/SUPC UDS212 SUPR/SUPR UDS35 KR/KR UDS35 KR/KUC UDS35 KR/KUR UDS35 KR/TQ UDS35 KR/TR UDS35 KR/ZR UDS35 KUC/KR UDS35 KUC/KUC UDS35 KUC/TQ UDS35 KUC/TR UDS35 KUC/ZR UDS35 KUR/KR UDS35 KUR/KUR UDS35 KUR/TR UDS35 KUR/ZR UDS35 SR/SR UDS35 SUC/SUC UDS35 SUR/SUR UDS35 TQ/KR UDS35 TQ/KUC UDS35 TR/KR UDS35 TR/KUC UDS35 TR/KUR UDS35 ZR/KR UDS35 ZR/KUC UDS35 ZR/KUR UDSI/SG/3 UDSI3 AR/AR UDSI3 AUC/AUC UDSI3 AUEC/AUEC UDSI3 AUER/AUER UDSI3 AUPC/AUPC UDSI3 AUPR/AUPR UDSI3 AUR/AUR UDSI3 KR/KR UDSI3 KR/TQ UDSI3 KR/TR UDSI3 KR/ZR UDSI3 KUEC/KUEC UDSI3 KUEC/TQ UDSI3 KUEC/TR UDSI3 KUEC/ZR UDSI3 KUER/KUER UDSI3 KUER/TR UDSI3 KUER/ZR UDSI3 KUPC/KUPC UDSI3 KUPC/TQ UDSI3 KUPC/TR UDSI3 KUPC/ZR UDSI3 KUPR/KUPR UDSI3 KUPR/TR UDSI3 KUPR/ZR UDSI3 SR/SR UDSI3 SUEC/SUEC UDSI3 SUER/SUER

i

PAGE 2.77 2.77 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.77 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.78 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.87 2.87 2.87 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.88 2.74 2.79 2.80 2.80 2.80 2.80 2.80 2.80 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.79 2.80 2.80

ITEM UDSI3 SUPC/SUPC UDSI3 SUPR/SUPR UDT Ø UF Ø UKA/12/SG/8 UKA/16/SG/4 UKA/20/SG/2 UKA/25/SG/8 UKA/32/SG/4 UKA/40/SG/2 UKA/SG/1 UKA1 UKA1/U UKA2/20 UKA2/20/U voltage UKA2/40 UKA2/40/U UKA4/16 UKA4/16/U voltage UKA4/32 UKA4/32/U UKA8/12 UKA8/12/U voltage UKA8/25 UKA8/25/U UKC/12/SG/8 UKC/16/SG/4 UKC/20/SG/2 UKC/25/SG/8 UKC/32/SG/4 UKC/40/SG/2 UKC/SG/1 UKC1 UKC1/MR UKC1/U UKC2/20 UKC2/20/SA UKC2/20/U voltage UKC2/40 UKC2/40/MR UKC2/40/SA UKC2/40/U UKC4/16 UKC4/16/SA UKC4/16/U voltage UKC4/32 UKC4/32/MR UKC4/32/SA UKC4/32/U UKC8/12 UKC8/12/SA UKC8/12/T UKC8/12/U voltage UKC8/25 UKC8/25/MR UKC8/25/SA UKC8/25/T UKC8/25/U UKCA/SG/2 UKCA/SG/4 UKCA/SG/8 UKCA1 UKCA1/U UKCA2 UKCA2/SA

PAGE 2.80 2.80 1.5 1.6 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.72 2.73 2.69 2.70 2.69 2.70 2.66 2.67 2.66 2.67 2.62 2.64 2.62 2.64 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.77 2.77 2.73 2.69 2.69 2.70 2.69 2.69 2.69 2.70 2.66 2.66 2.67 2.66 2.66 2.66 2.67 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.64 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.61 2.72 2.73 2.70 2.69

ITEM UKCA2/U UKCA4 UKCA4/SA UKCA4/U UKCA8 UKCA8/SA UKCA8/U UKHA1 UKHA1/U UKHA2/20 UKHA2/20/U voltage UKHA2/40 UKHA2/40/U UKHA4/16 UKHA4/16/U voltage UKHA4/32 UKHA4/32/U UKHA8/12 UKHA8/12/U voltage UKHA8/25 UKHA8/25/U UKHC1 UKHC1/U UKHC2/20 UKHC2/20 UKHC2/20/SA UKHC2/20/U voltage UKHC2/40 UKHC2/40/SA UKHC2/40/U UKHC4/16 UKHC4/16/SA UKHC4/16/U voltage UKHC4/32 UKHC4/32/SA UKHC4/32/U UKHC8/12 UKHC8/12/SA UKHC8/12/T UKHC8/12/U voltage UKHC8/25 UKHC8/25/SA UKHC8/25/T UKHC8/25/U ULARG/R voltage ULARV/R voltage ULASG/R voltage ULASG/RA voltage ULASG/U voltage ULASV/R voltage ULASV/RA voltage ULASV/U voltage ULCRG/R voltage ULCRV/R voltage ULCSG/R voltage ULCSG/RA voltage ULCSG/U voltage ULCSV/R voltage ULCSV/RA voltage ULCSV/U voltage ULP8B/2 ULP8B/3 ULP8B/5 ULP8S/2 ULP8S/3

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 2.70 2.66 2.66 2.67 2.62 2.62 2.64 2.72 2.73 2.49 2.70 2.69 2.69 2.66 2.67 2.66 2.67 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.64 2.72 2.73 2.62 2.69 2.62 2.62 2.69 2.69 2.70 2.66 2.66 2.66 2.66 2.66 2.67 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.62 2.5 2.5 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.5 2.5 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.6 2.7 2.7 2.7 2.7 2.7

ITEM ULP8S/5 ULR1B UMASV/voltage UMP4-2/10 UMP4-2/2 UMP4-2/3 UMP4-2/4 UMP4-2/5 UMP4-2/6 UMP4-2/7 UMP4-2/8 UMP4-2/9 UMP5/1 UMPM5/10 UMPM5/2 UMPM5/3 UMPM5/4 UMPM5/5 UMPM5/6 UMPM5/7 UMPM5/8 UMPM5/9 UPDTØ UPFØ UPFPØ UPGØ UPPØ UPSCØ URE2 URE8 URF2/25 URF4/10 URF8/1 URF8/2 URF8/5 URG2/25 URG4/10 URG8/1 URG8/2 URG8/5 URS2/9 URS3/7 URS4/5 URS8/3 USB/voltage USB-BA/voltage USBG/voltage USBG-BA/voltage USC Ø USR102/N9 USR102/N9LED Voltage USR102/N9VD Voltage UZ/PM UZ/SVG UZ/SVG/1 UZ/SVG/2 UZ/SVG/P UZ/TM/R UZ/TM/R/SS UZAP/R4 UZAP/SVG UZAP/SVG/1 UZAP/U4 UZF/SG/1 UZF/SG/2

PAGE 2.7 2.15 2.3 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.3 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 2.4 1.18 1.17 1.18 1.19 1.18 1.18 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 3.35 2.14 2.14 2.14 2.14 1.6 2.15 2.15 2.15 4.3 4.8 4.8 4.8 4.8 4.3 4.3 4.7 4.8 4.8 4.7 4.3 4.3


ALPHANUMERIC INDEX ITEM UZF/SG/3 UZF/SG/3/SS UZF/SG/4 UZF4/20 UZF4/20/SS UZF4/20PM UZF4/20PM/SS UZF4/20RR7L UZF4/20RR7L/PM UZF4/20RR7L/PM/SS UZF4/20RR7L/SS UZF4/20RR7L/TM UZF4/20RR7L/TM/SS UZF4/20TM UZF4/20TM/SS UZF8/20 UZF8/20/SS UZF8/20PM UZF8/20PM/SS UZF8/20RR7L UZF8/20RR7L/PM UZF8/20RR7L/PM/SS UZF8/20RR7L/SS UZF8/20RR7L/TM UZF8/20RR7L/TM/SS UZF8/20TM UZF8/20TM/SS UZL/SG/3 UZL/SG/4 UZL/TM UZL4 UZL4PM UZL4TM UZL8 UZL8PM UZL8TM UZPR4 UZR/SG/5 UZRHS UZRHS UZRR/SG/6 UZRRH4/7 UZRRH8/7 UZRRM4/7 UZRRM4/7F20 UZRRM4/7F20/SS UZRRM4/7F20L UZRRM4/7F20L/PM UZRRM4/7F20L/PM/SS UZRRM4/7F20L/SS UZRRM4/7F20L/TM UZRRM4/7F20L/TM/SS UZRRM4/7F20PM UZRRM4/7F20PM/SS UZRRM4/7F20TM UZRRM4/7F20TM/SS UZRRM8/7 UZRRM8/7F20 UZRRM8/7F20/SS UZRRM8/7F20L UZRRM8/7F20L/PM UZRRM8/7F20L/PM/SS UZRRM8/7F20L/SS UZRRM8/7F20L/TM UZRRM8/7F20L/TM/SS

PAGE 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.3 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.10 4.3 4.3 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.6 4.8 4.4 4.8 4.8 4.4 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.5 4.4 4.5 4.5 4.9 4.9 4.9 4.9 4.9 4.9

ITEM UZRRM8/7F20PM UZRRM8/7F20PM/SS UZRRM8/7F20TM UZRRM8/7F20TM/SS UZVL/4 UZVL/SVG UZVL/SVG/1 VC-01 VC-02 VC-03 VC-04 VM1 VM15 VM2 VM3 VM4 VM8 VS1-MF-… VS-FF-… VS-MF-… VSR-FF-… VSR-MF… W 105 1 B E3A W 105 1 E E3A W 105 1 V E3A W 105 2 B E3A W 105 2 E E3A W 105 2 V E3A W 105 3 B E3A W 105 3 E E3A W 105 3 V E3A W 105 4 B E3A W 105 4 E E3A W 105 4 V E3A W 105 5 B E3A W 105 5 E E3A W 105 5 V E3A W 106 1 B E2A W 106 1 E E2A W 106 1 V E2A W 106 10 B E2A W 106 10 E E2A W 106 10 V E2A W 106 11 B E2A W 106 11 E E2A W 106 11 V E2A W 106 2 B E2A W 106 2 E E2A W 106 2 V E2A W 106 3 B E2A W 106 3 E E2A W 106 3 V E2A W 106 4 B E2A W 106 4 E E2A W 106 4 V E2A W 106 5 B E2A W 106 5 E E2A W 106 5 V E2A W 106 6 B E2A W 106 6 E E2A W 106 6 V E2A W 106 7 B E2A W 106 7 E E2A W 106 7 V E2A W 106 8 B E2A

PAGE 4.5 4.9 4.5 4.5 4.8 4.8 4.8 3.31 3.31 3.31 3.31 2.96 2.96 2.96 2.96 2.96 2.96 5.47 5.47 5.47 5.46 5.46 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.91 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92

ITEM W 106 8 E E2A W 106 8 V E2A W 106 9 B E2A W 106 9 E E2A W 106 9 V E2A W 107 1 B E3A W 107 1 E E3A W 107 1 V E3A W 107 2 B E3A W 107 2 E E3A W 107 2 V E3A W 107 3 B E3A W 107 3 E E3A W 107 3 V E3A W 107 4 B E3A W 107 4 E E3A W 107 4 V E3A W 107 5 B E2A W 107 5 E E2A W 107 5 V E2A W 107 6 B E2A W 107 6 E E2A W 107 6 V E2A W 107 7 B E2A W 107 7 E E2A W 107 7 V E2A W 108 1 B E2A W 108 1 B E5A W 108 1 E E2A W 108 1 E E5A W 108 1 V E2A W 108 1 V E5A W 108 2 B E2A W 108 2 B E5A W 108 2 E E2A W 108 2 E E5A W 108 2 V E2A W 108 2 V E5A W 108 3 B E5A W 108 3 E E5A W 108 3 V E5A W 108 4 B E5A W 108 4 E E5A W 108 4 V E5A WAIRSOL (1L) WAIRSOL HS(1L) WB2B WB2U WB4B WB4U WB8B WB8U WBZ size WBZ size G WE2A/voltage WE3A/voltage WE5A/voltage WRFØ/Rotation angle WRM Ø/Rotation angle WUGB Size/stroke WUGCD Size WUGCP Size WUGDB Size/stroke WUGDM Size/stroke WUGM Size/stroke

Alphanumeric index

PAGE 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.92 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 2.93 4.6 1.81 3.36 3.36 3.36 3.36 3.36 3.36 1.7-1.33 1.7-1.33 2.93 2.93 2.93 1.88 1.88 1.8-1.34 1.11-1.36 1.11-1.36 1.8-1.34 1.8-1.34 1.8-1.34

ITEM X/CG X/CP X/CT X/P/M3 X/P/M4 XH4CM2 XH4CM2F XH4CM4 XH4CM4F XH4CM8 XH4CM8F XVB XVF/SG/4-5 XVF4 XVF5 ZCL Ø ZCS Ø ZPB Ø ZTI Ø

PAGE 1.24 1.24 1.32 1.24 1.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 3.24 2.8 3.37 3.37 3.37 1.80 1.80 1.79 1.80

j



CAT. 08/EN


Waircom M.B.S. S.p.A. Via Piemonte, 13/15 - 20070 Vizzolo Predabissi (MILAN) ITALY - Tel: +39 02 98230821 - Fax: +39 02 98231854 www.waircom-mbs.com - info@waircom-mbs.com


Turn static files into dynamic content formats.

Create a flipbook
Issuu converts static files into: digital portfolios, online yearbooks, online catalogs, digital photo albums and more. Sign up and create your flipbook.